New command line option -D.
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 @node Sample Session
545 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
546
547 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
548 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
549 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
550
551 @iftex
552 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
553 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
554 @end iftex
555
556 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
557 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
558
559 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
560 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
561 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
562 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
563 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
564 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
565 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
566 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
567 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
568
569 @smallexample
570 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
571 $ @b{./m4}
572 @b{define(foo,0000)}
573
574 @b{foo}
575 0000
576 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
577
578 @b{bar}
579 0000
580 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
581
582 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
583 @b{baz}
584 @b{Ctrl-d}
585 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
586 @end smallexample
587
588 @noindent
589 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
590
591 @smallexample
592 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
593 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
594 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
595 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
596 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
597 the conditions.
598 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
599 for details.
600
601 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
602 (@value{GDBP})
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
607 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
608 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
609 that examples fit in this manual.
610
611 @smallexample
612 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
613 @end smallexample
614
615 @noindent
616 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
617 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
618 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
619 @code{break} command.
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
623 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
628 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
629 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
633 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
634 @b{define(foo,0000)}
635
636 @b{foo}
637 0000
638 @end smallexample
639
640 @noindent
641 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
642 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
643 context where it stops.
644
645 @smallexample
646 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
647
648 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
649 at builtin.c:879
650 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
651 @end smallexample
652
653 @noindent
654 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
655 the next line of the current function.
656
657 @smallexample
658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
659 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
660 : nil,
661 @end smallexample
662
663 @noindent
664 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
665 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
666 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
667 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
668
669 @smallexample
670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
671 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
672 at input.c:530
673 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
678 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
679 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
680 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
681 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
682 stack frame for each active subroutine.
683
684 @smallexample
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
686 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
687 at input.c:530
688 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
689 at builtin.c:882
690 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
691 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
692 at macro.c:71
693 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
694 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
699 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
700 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
704 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
706 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
707 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
709 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
710 : xstrdup(rq);
711 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
712 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
713 @end smallexample
714
715 @noindent
716 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
717 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
718 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
719 (@code{print}) to see their values.
720
721 @smallexample
722 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
723 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
725 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
726 @end smallexample
727
728 @noindent
729 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
730 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
731 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
732
733 @smallexample
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
735 533 xfree(rquote);
736 534
737 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
738 : xstrdup (lq);
739 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
740 : xstrdup (rq);
741 537
742 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
743 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
744 540 @}
745 541
746 542 void
747 @end smallexample
748
749 @noindent
750 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
751 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
752
753 @smallexample
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
755 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
757 540 @}
758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
759 $3 = 9
760 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
761 $4 = 7
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
766 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
767 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
768 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
769 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
770 assignments.
771
772 @smallexample
773 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
774 $5 = 7
775 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
776 $6 = 9
777 @end smallexample
778
779 @noindent
780 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
781 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
782 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
783 example that caused trouble initially:
784
785 @smallexample
786 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
787 Continuing.
788
789 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
790
791 baz
792 0000
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
797 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
798 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
799
800 @smallexample
801 @b{Ctrl-d}
802 Program exited normally.
803 @end smallexample
804
805 @noindent
806 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
807 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
808 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
809
810 @smallexample
811 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
812 @end smallexample
813
814 @node Invocation
815 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
816
817 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
818 The essentials are:
819 @itemize @bullet
820 @item
821 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
822 @item
823 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
824 @end itemize
825
826 @menu
827 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
828 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
829 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
830 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
831 @end menu
832
833 @node Invoking GDB
834 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
835
836 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
837 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
838
839 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
840 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
841
842 The command-line options described here are designed
843 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
844 options may effectively be unavailable.
845
846 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
847 specifying an executable program:
848
849 @smallexample
850 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
851 @end smallexample
852
853 @noindent
854 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
855 specified:
856
857 @smallexample
858 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
859 @end smallexample
860
861 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
862 to debug a running process:
863
864 @smallexample
865 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
866 @end smallexample
867
868 @noindent
869 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
870 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
871
872 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
873 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
874 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
875 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
876 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
877
878 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
879 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
880 option processing.
881 @smallexample
882 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
883 @end smallexample
884 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
885 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
886
887 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
888 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
889
890 @smallexample
891 @value{GDBP} -silent
892 @end smallexample
893
894 @noindent
895 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
896 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
897
898 @noindent
899 Type
900
901 @smallexample
902 @value{GDBP} -help
903 @end smallexample
904
905 @noindent
906 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
907 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
908
909 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
910 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
911 @samp{-x} option is used.
912
913
914 @menu
915 * File Options:: Choosing files
916 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
917 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
918 @end menu
919
920 @node File Options
921 @subsection Choosing Files
922
923 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
924 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
925 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
926 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
927 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
928 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
929 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
930 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
931 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
932 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
933 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
934 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
935 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
936
937 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
938 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
939 argument and ignore it.
940
941 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
942 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
943 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
944 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
945 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
946
947 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
948 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
949 @c it.
950
951 @table @code
952 @item -symbols @var{file}
953 @itemx -s @var{file}
954 @cindex @code{--symbols}
955 @cindex @code{-s}
956 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
957
958 @item -exec @var{file}
959 @itemx -e @var{file}
960 @cindex @code{--exec}
961 @cindex @code{-e}
962 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
963 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
964
965 @item -se @var{file}
966 @cindex @code{--se}
967 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
968 file.
969
970 @item -core @var{file}
971 @itemx -c @var{file}
972 @cindex @code{--core}
973 @cindex @code{-c}
974 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
975
976 @item -pid @var{number}
977 @itemx -p @var{number}
978 @cindex @code{--pid}
979 @cindex @code{-p}
980 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
981
982 @item -command @var{file}
983 @itemx -x @var{file}
984 @cindex @code{--command}
985 @cindex @code{-x}
986 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
987 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
988 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
989
990 @item -eval-command @var{command}
991 @itemx -ex @var{command}
992 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
993 @cindex @code{-ex}
994 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
995
996 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
997 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
998
999 @smallexample
1000 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1001 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1002 @end smallexample
1003
1004 @item -init-command @var{file}
1005 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1006 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1007 @cindex @code{-ix}
1008 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1009 after loading gdbinit files).
1010 @xref{Startup}.
1011
1012 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1013 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1014 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1015 @cindex @code{-iex}
1016 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1017 after loading gdbinit files).
1018 @xref{Startup}.
1019
1020 @item -directory @var{directory}
1021 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1022 @cindex @code{--directory}
1023 @cindex @code{-d}
1024 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1025
1026 @item -r
1027 @itemx -readnow
1028 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1029 @cindex @code{-r}
1030 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1031 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1032 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1033
1034 @end table
1035
1036 @node Mode Options
1037 @subsection Choosing Modes
1038
1039 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1040 batch mode or quiet mode.
1041
1042 @table @code
1043 @anchor{-nx}
1044 @item -nx
1045 @itemx -n
1046 @cindex @code{--nx}
1047 @cindex @code{-n}
1048 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1049 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1050
1051 @table @code
1052 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1053 This is the system-wide init file.
1054 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1055 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1056 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1057 have been processed.
1058 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1059 This is the init file in your home directory.
1060 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1061 command options have been processed.
1062 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1063 This is the init file in the current directory.
1064 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1065 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1066 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1067 @end table
1068
1069 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1070 For documentation on how to write command files,
1071 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1072
1073 @anchor{-nh}
1074 @item -nh
1075 @cindex @code{--nh}
1076 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1077 in your home directory.
1078 @xref{Startup}.
1079
1080 @item -quiet
1081 @itemx -silent
1082 @itemx -q
1083 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1084 @cindex @code{--silent}
1085 @cindex @code{-q}
1086 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1087 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1088
1089 @item -batch
1090 @cindex @code{--batch}
1091 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1092 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1093 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1094 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1095 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1096 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1097 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1098
1099 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1100 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1101 make this more useful, the message
1102
1103 @smallexample
1104 Program exited normally.
1105 @end smallexample
1106
1107 @noindent
1108 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1109 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1110 mode.
1111
1112 @item -batch-silent
1113 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1114 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1115 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1116 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1117 for an interactive session.
1118
1119 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1120 messages, for example.
1121
1122 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1123 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1124
1125 @item -return-child-result
1126 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1127 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1128 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1129
1130 @itemize @bullet
1131 @item
1132 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1133 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1134 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1135 @item
1136 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1137 @item
1138 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1139 the exit code will be -1.
1140 @end itemize
1141
1142 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1143 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1144 interface.
1145
1146 @item -nowindows
1147 @itemx -nw
1148 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1149 @cindex @code{-nw}
1150 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1151 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1152 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1153
1154 @item -windows
1155 @itemx -w
1156 @cindex @code{--windows}
1157 @cindex @code{-w}
1158 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1159 used if possible.
1160
1161 @item -cd @var{directory}
1162 @cindex @code{--cd}
1163 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1164 instead of the current directory.
1165
1166 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1167 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1168 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1169 @cindex @code{-D}
1170 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1171 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1172 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1173
1174 @item -fullname
1175 @itemx -f
1176 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1177 @cindex @code{-f}
1178 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1179 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1180 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1181 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1182 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1183 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1184 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1185 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1186 frame.
1187
1188 @item -annotate @var{level}
1189 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1190 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1191 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1192 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1193 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1194 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1195 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1196 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1197 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1198
1199 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1200 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1201
1202 @item --args
1203 @cindex @code{--args}
1204 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1205 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1206 This option stops option processing.
1207
1208 @item -baud @var{bps}
1209 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1210 @cindex @code{--baud}
1211 @cindex @code{-b}
1212 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1213 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1214
1215 @item -l @var{timeout}
1216 @cindex @code{-l}
1217 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1218 for remote debugging.
1219
1220 @item -tty @var{device}
1221 @itemx -t @var{device}
1222 @cindex @code{--tty}
1223 @cindex @code{-t}
1224 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1225 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1226
1227 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1228 @item -tui
1229 @cindex @code{--tui}
1230 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1231 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1232 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1233 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1234 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1235 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1236
1237 @c @item -xdb
1238 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1239 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1240 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1241 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1242 @c systems.
1243
1244 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1245 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1246 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1247 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1248 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1249 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1250
1251 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1252 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1253 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1254 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1255 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1256 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1257
1258 @item -write
1259 @cindex @code{--write}
1260 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1261 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1262 (@pxref{Patching}).
1263
1264 @item -statistics
1265 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1266 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1267 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1268
1269 @item -version
1270 @cindex @code{--version}
1271 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1272 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1273
1274 @item -configuration
1275 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1276 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1277 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1278 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1279
1280 @end table
1281
1282 @node Startup
1283 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1284 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1285
1286 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1287
1288 @enumerate
1289 @item
1290 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1291 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1292
1293 @item
1294 @cindex init file
1295 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1296 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1297 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1298 that file.
1299
1300 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1301 @item
1302 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1303 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1304 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1305 that file.
1306
1307 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1308 @item
1309 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1310 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1311 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1312 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1313 gets loaded.
1314
1315 @item
1316 Processes command line options and operands.
1317
1318 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1319 @item
1320 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1321 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1322 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1323 This is only done if the current directory is
1324 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1325 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1326 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1327 @value{GDBN}.
1328
1329 @item
1330 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1331 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1332 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1333 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1334
1335 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1336 you must do something like the following:
1337
1338 @smallexample
1339 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1340 @end smallexample
1341
1342 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1343 off too late.
1344
1345 @item
1346 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1347 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1348 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1349
1350 @item
1351 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1352 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1353 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1354 @end enumerate
1355
1356 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1357 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1358 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1359 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1360 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1361 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1362
1363 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1364 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1365
1366 @cindex init file name
1367 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1368 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1369 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1370 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1371 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1372 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1373 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1374 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1375
1376
1377 @node Quitting GDB
1378 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1379 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1380 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1381
1382 @table @code
1383 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1384 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1385 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1386 @itemx q
1387 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1388 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1389 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1390 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1391 error code.
1392 @end table
1393
1394 @cindex interrupt
1395 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1396 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1397 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1398 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1399 until a time when it is safe.
1400
1401 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1402 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1403 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1404
1405 @node Shell Commands
1406 @section Shell Commands
1407
1408 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1409 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1410 just use the @code{shell} command.
1411
1412 @table @code
1413 @kindex shell
1414 @kindex !
1415 @cindex shell escape
1416 @item shell @var{command-string}
1417 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1418 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1419 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1420 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1421 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1422 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1423 @end table
1424
1425 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1426 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1427 @value{GDBN}:
1428
1429 @table @code
1430 @kindex make
1431 @cindex calling make
1432 @item make @var{make-args}
1433 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1434 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1435 @end table
1436
1437 @node Logging Output
1438 @section Logging Output
1439 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1440 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1441
1442 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1443 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1444
1445 @table @code
1446 @kindex set logging
1447 @item set logging on
1448 Enable logging.
1449 @item set logging off
1450 Disable logging.
1451 @cindex logging file name
1452 @item set logging file @var{file}
1453 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1454 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1455 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1456 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1457 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1458 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1459 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1460 @kindex show logging
1461 @item show logging
1462 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1463 @end table
1464
1465 @node Commands
1466 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1467
1468 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1469 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1470 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1471 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1472 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1473
1474 @menu
1475 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1476 * Completion:: Command completion
1477 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1478 @end menu
1479
1480 @node Command Syntax
1481 @section Command Syntax
1482
1483 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1484 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1485 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1486 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1487 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1488 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1489
1490 @cindex abbreviation
1491 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1492 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1493 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1494 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1495 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1496 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1497 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1498
1499 @cindex repeating commands
1500 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1501 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1502 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1503 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1504 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1505 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1506 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1507
1508 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1509 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1510 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1511
1512 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1513 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1514 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1515 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1516 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1517
1518 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1519 @cindex comment
1520 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1521 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1522 Files,,Command Files}).
1523
1524 @cindex repeating command sequences
1525 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1526 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1527 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1528 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1529 for editing.
1530
1531 @node Completion
1532 @section Command Completion
1533
1534 @cindex completion
1535 @cindex word completion
1536 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1537 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1538 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1539 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1540
1541 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1542 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1543 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1544 enter it). For example, if you type
1545
1546 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1547 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1548 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1549 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1550 @smallexample
1551 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1552 @end smallexample
1553
1554 @noindent
1555 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1556 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1557
1558 @smallexample
1559 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1560 @end smallexample
1561
1562 @noindent
1563 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1564 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1565 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1566 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1567 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1568 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1569
1570 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1571 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1572 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1573 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1574 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1575 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1576 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1577 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1578 example:
1579
1580 @smallexample
1581 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1582 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1583 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1584 make_abs_section make_function_type
1585 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1586 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1587 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1588 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1589 @end smallexample
1590
1591 @noindent
1592 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1593 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1594 command.
1595
1596 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1597 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1598 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1599 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1600 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1601
1602 @cindex quotes in commands
1603 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1604 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1605 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1606 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1607 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1608 @value{GDBN} commands.
1609
1610 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1611 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1612 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1613 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1614 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1615 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1616 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1617 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1618 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1619 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1620 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1621
1622 @smallexample
1623 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1624 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1625 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1626 @end smallexample
1627
1628 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1629 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1630 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1631 place:
1632
1633 @smallexample
1634 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1635 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1636 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1637 @end smallexample
1638
1639 @noindent
1640 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1641 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1642 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1643
1644 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1645 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1646 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1647 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1648
1649 @cindex completion of structure field names
1650 @cindex structure field name completion
1651 @cindex completion of union field names
1652 @cindex union field name completion
1653 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1654 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1655 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1656 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1657 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1658 left-hand-side:
1659
1660 @smallexample
1661 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1662 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1663 to_data to_isatty to_write
1664 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1665 to_flush to_read
1666 @end smallexample
1667
1668 @noindent
1669 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1670 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1671 follows:
1672
1673 @smallexample
1674 struct ui_file
1675 @{
1676 int *magic;
1677 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1678 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1679 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1680 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1681 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1682 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1683 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1684 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1685 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1686 void *to_data;
1687 @}
1688 @end smallexample
1689
1690
1691 @node Help
1692 @section Getting Help
1693 @cindex online documentation
1694 @kindex help
1695
1696 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1697 using the command @code{help}.
1698
1699 @table @code
1700 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1701 @item help
1702 @itemx h
1703 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1704 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1705
1706 @smallexample
1707 (@value{GDBP}) help
1708 List of classes of commands:
1709
1710 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1711 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1712 data -- Examining data
1713 files -- Specifying and examining files
1714 internals -- Maintenance commands
1715 obscure -- Obscure features
1716 running -- Running the program
1717 stack -- Examining the stack
1718 status -- Status inquiries
1719 support -- Support facilities
1720 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1721 stopping the program
1722 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1723
1724 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1725 commands in that class.
1726 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1727 documentation.
1728 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1729 (@value{GDBP})
1730 @end smallexample
1731 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1732
1733 @item help @var{class}
1734 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1735 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1736 help display for the class @code{status}:
1737
1738 @smallexample
1739 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1740 Status inquiries.
1741
1742 List of commands:
1743
1744 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1745 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1746 info -- Generic command for showing things
1747 about the program being debugged
1748 show -- Generic command for showing things
1749 about the debugger
1750
1751 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1752 documentation.
1753 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1754 (@value{GDBP})
1755 @end smallexample
1756
1757 @item help @var{command}
1758 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1759 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1760
1761 @kindex apropos
1762 @item apropos @var{args}
1763 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1764 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1765 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1766
1767 @smallexample
1768 apropos alias
1769 @end smallexample
1770
1771 @noindent
1772 results in:
1773
1774 @smallexample
1775 @c @group
1776 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1777 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1778 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1779 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1780 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1781 @c @end group
1782 @end smallexample
1783
1784 @kindex complete
1785 @item complete @var{args}
1786 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1787 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1788 command you want completed. For example:
1789
1790 @smallexample
1791 complete i
1792 @end smallexample
1793
1794 @noindent results in:
1795
1796 @smallexample
1797 @group
1798 if
1799 ignore
1800 info
1801 inspect
1802 @end group
1803 @end smallexample
1804
1805 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1806 @end table
1807
1808 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1809 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1810 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1811 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1812 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1813 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1814 Index}.
1815
1816 @c @group
1817 @table @code
1818 @kindex info
1819 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1820 @item info
1821 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1822 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1823 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1824 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1825 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1826 @w{@code{help info}}.
1827
1828 @kindex set
1829 @item set
1830 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1831 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1832 @code{set prompt $}.
1833
1834 @kindex show
1835 @item show
1836 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1837 @value{GDBN} itself.
1838 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1839 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1840 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1841 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1842
1843 @kindex info set
1844 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1845 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1846 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1847 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1848 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1849 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1850 @end table
1851 @c @end group
1852
1853 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1854 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1855
1856 @table @code
1857 @kindex show version
1858 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1859 @item show version
1860 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1861 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1862 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1863 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1864 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1865 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1866 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1867 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1868 @value{GDBN}.
1869
1870 @kindex show copying
1871 @kindex info copying
1872 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1873 @item show copying
1874 @itemx info copying
1875 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1876
1877 @kindex show warranty
1878 @kindex info warranty
1879 @item show warranty
1880 @itemx info warranty
1881 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1882 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1883
1884 @kindex show configuration
1885 @item show configuration
1886 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1887 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1888 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1889 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1890 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1891 your report.
1892
1893 @end table
1894
1895 @node Running
1896 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1897
1898 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1899 debugging information when you compile it.
1900
1901 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1902 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1903 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1904 kill a child process.
1905
1906 @menu
1907 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1908 * Starting:: Starting your program
1909 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1910 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1911
1912 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1913 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1914 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1915 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1916
1917 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1918 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1919 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1920 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1921 @end menu
1922
1923 @node Compilation
1924 @section Compiling for Debugging
1925
1926 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1927 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1928 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1929 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1930 and addresses in the executable code.
1931
1932 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1933 the compiler.
1934
1935 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1936 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1937 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1938 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1939 executables containing debugging information.
1940
1941 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1942 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1943 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1944 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1945 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1946
1947 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1948 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1949 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1950
1951 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1952 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1953 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1954 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1955 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1956 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1957
1958 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1959 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1960 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1961
1962 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1963 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1964 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1965 format in @value{GDBN}.
1966
1967 @need 2000
1968 @node Starting
1969 @section Starting your Program
1970 @cindex starting
1971 @cindex running
1972
1973 @table @code
1974 @kindex run
1975 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1976 @item run
1977 @itemx r
1978 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1979 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1980 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1981 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1982 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1983
1984 @end table
1985
1986 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1987 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1988 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1989 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1990 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1991 message like this one:
1992
1993 @smallexample
1994 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1995 Try "help target" or "continue".
1996 @end smallexample
1997
1998 @noindent
1999 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2000 first (@pxref{load}).
2001
2002 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2003 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2004 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2005 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2006 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2007 divided into four categories:
2008
2009 @table @asis
2010 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2011 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2012 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2013 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2014 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2015 the arguments.
2016 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2017 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2018 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2019 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2020 below for details).
2021
2022 @item The @emph{environment.}
2023 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2024 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2025 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2026 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2027
2028 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2029 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
2030 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2031 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2032
2033 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2034 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2035 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2036 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2037 set a different device for your program.
2038 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2039
2040 @cindex pipes
2041 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2042 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2043 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2044 wrong program.
2045 @end table
2046
2047 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2048 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2049 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2050 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2051 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2052
2053 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2054 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2055 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2056 your current breakpoints.
2057
2058 @table @code
2059 @kindex start
2060 @item start
2061 @cindex run to main procedure
2062 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2063 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2064 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2065 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2066 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2067 procedure, depending on the language used.
2068
2069 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2070 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2071 the @samp{run} command.
2072
2073 @cindex elaboration phase
2074 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2075 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2076 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2077 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2078 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2079 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2080 will remain to halt execution.
2081
2082 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2083 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2084 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2085 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2086 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2087
2088 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2089 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2090 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2091 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2092 elaboration code before running your program.
2093
2094 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2095 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2096 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2097 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2098 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2099 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2100 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2101 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2102 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2103 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2104 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2105 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2106
2107 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2108 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2109 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2110 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2111
2112 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2113 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2114 environment:
2115
2116 @smallexample
2117 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2118 (@value{GDBP}) run
2119 @end smallexample
2120
2121 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2122 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2123
2124 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2125 @item set startup-with-shell
2126 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2127 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2128 @itemx show set startup-with-shell
2129 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2130 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2131 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2132 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2133 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2134 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2135 startup failures such as:
2136
2137 @smallexample
2138 (@value{GDBP}) run
2139 Starting program: ./a.out
2140 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2141 @end smallexample
2142
2143 @noindent
2144 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2145 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2146 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2147 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2148 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2149 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2150
2151 @kindex set disable-randomization
2152 @item set disable-randomization
2153 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2154 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2155 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2156 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2157 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2158
2159 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2160 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2161
2162 @smallexample
2163 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2164 @end smallexample
2165
2166 @item set disable-randomization off
2167 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2168 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2169 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2170 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2171 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2172 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2173
2174 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2175 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2176 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2177 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2178 a code at its expected addresses.
2179
2180 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2181 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2182 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2183 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2184 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2185 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2186 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2187 a randomly chosen address.
2188
2189 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2190 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2191 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2192 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2193 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2194
2195 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2196 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2197
2198 @item show disable-randomization
2199 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2200 the virtual address space of the started program.
2201
2202 @end table
2203
2204 @node Arguments
2205 @section Your Program's Arguments
2206
2207 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2208 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2209 @code{run} command.
2210 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2211 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2212 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2213 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2214 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2215
2216 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2217 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2218 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2219 the program, not by the shell.
2220
2221 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2222 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2223
2224 @table @code
2225 @kindex set args
2226 @item set args
2227 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2228 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2229 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2230 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2231 it again without arguments.
2232
2233 @kindex show args
2234 @item show args
2235 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2236 @end table
2237
2238 @node Environment
2239 @section Your Program's Environment
2240
2241 @cindex environment (of your program)
2242 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2243 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2244 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2245 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2246 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2247 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2248 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2249
2250 @table @code
2251 @kindex path
2252 @item path @var{directory}
2253 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2254 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2255 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2256 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2257 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2258 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2259 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2260
2261 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2262 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2263 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2264 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2265 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2266 @var{directory} to the search path.
2267 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2268 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2269
2270 @kindex show paths
2271 @item show paths
2272 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2273 environment variable).
2274
2275 @kindex show environment
2276 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2277 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2278 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2279 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2280 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2281
2282 @kindex set environment
2283 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2284 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2285 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2286 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may be any string; the
2287 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2288 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2289 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2290 null value.
2291 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2292 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2293
2294 For example, this command:
2295
2296 @smallexample
2297 set env USER = foo
2298 @end smallexample
2299
2300 @noindent
2301 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2302 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2303 are not actually required.)
2304
2305 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2306 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2307 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2308 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2309 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2310
2311 @kindex unset environment
2312 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2313 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2314 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2315 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2316 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2317 @end table
2318
2319 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2320 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2321 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2322 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2323 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2324 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2325 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2326 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2327 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2328 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2329
2330 @node Working Directory
2331 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2332
2333 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2334 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2335 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2336 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2337 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2338 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2339
2340 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2341 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2342 Specify Files}.
2343
2344 @table @code
2345 @kindex cd
2346 @cindex change working directory
2347 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2348 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2349 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2350
2351 @kindex pwd
2352 @item pwd
2353 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2354 @end table
2355
2356 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2357 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2358 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2359 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2360 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2361 current working directory of the debuggee.
2362
2363 @node Input/Output
2364 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2365
2366 @cindex redirection
2367 @cindex i/o
2368 @cindex terminal
2369 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2370 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2371 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2372 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2373 running your program.
2374
2375 @table @code
2376 @kindex info terminal
2377 @item info terminal
2378 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2379 program is using.
2380 @end table
2381
2382 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2383 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2384
2385 @smallexample
2386 run > outfile
2387 @end smallexample
2388
2389 @noindent
2390 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2391
2392 @kindex tty
2393 @cindex controlling terminal
2394 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2395 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2396 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2397 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2398 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2399
2400 @smallexample
2401 tty /dev/ttyb
2402 @end smallexample
2403
2404 @noindent
2405 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2406 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2407 that as their controlling terminal.
2408
2409 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2410 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2411 terminal.
2412
2413 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2414 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2415 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2416 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2417
2418 @cindex inferior tty
2419 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2420 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2421 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2422 program.
2423
2424 @table @code
2425 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2426 @kindex set inferior-tty
2427 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2428
2429 @item show inferior-tty
2430 @kindex show inferior-tty
2431 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2432 @end table
2433
2434 @node Attach
2435 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2436 @kindex attach
2437 @cindex attach
2438
2439 @table @code
2440 @item attach @var{process-id}
2441 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2442 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2443 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2444 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2445 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2446
2447 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2448 executing the command.
2449 @end table
2450
2451 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2452 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2453 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2454 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2455
2456 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2457 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2458 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2459 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2460 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2461 Specify Files}.
2462
2463 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2464 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2465 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2466 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2467 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2468 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2469 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2470
2471 @table @code
2472 @kindex detach
2473 @item detach
2474 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2475 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2476 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2477 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2478 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2479 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2480 executing the command.
2481 @end table
2482
2483 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2484 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2485 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2486 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2487 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2488 Messages}).
2489
2490 @node Kill Process
2491 @section Killing the Child Process
2492
2493 @table @code
2494 @kindex kill
2495 @item kill
2496 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2497 @end table
2498
2499 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2500 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2501 is running.
2502
2503 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2504 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2505 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2506 outside the debugger.
2507
2508 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2509 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2510 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2511 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2512 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2513 breakpoint settings).
2514
2515 @node Inferiors and Programs
2516 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2517
2518 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2519 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2520 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2521 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2522 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2523 from multiple executables.
2524
2525 @cindex inferior
2526 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2527 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2528 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2529 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2530 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2531 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2532 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2533 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2534 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2535 threads running in it.
2536
2537 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2538 inferiors}}:
2539
2540 @table @code
2541 @kindex info inferiors
2542 @item info inferiors
2543 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2544
2545 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2546
2547 @enumerate
2548 @item
2549 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2550
2551 @item
2552 the target system's inferior identifier
2553
2554 @item
2555 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2556
2557 @end enumerate
2558
2559 @noindent
2560 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2561 indicates the current inferior.
2562
2563 For example,
2564 @end table
2565 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2566
2567 @smallexample
2568 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2569 Num Description Executable
2570 2 process 2307 hello
2571 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2572 @end smallexample
2573
2574 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2575
2576 @table @code
2577 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2578 @item inferior @var{infno}
2579 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2580 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2581 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2582 @end table
2583
2584
2585 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2586 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2587 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2588 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2589 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2590 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2591
2592 @table @code
2593 @kindex add-inferior
2594 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2595 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2596 executable. @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2597 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2598 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2599 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2600
2601 @kindex clone-inferior
2602 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2603 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2604 @var{infno}. @var{n} defaults to 1. @var{infno} defaults to the
2605 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2606 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2607
2608 @smallexample
2609 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2610 Num Description Executable
2611 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2612 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2613 Added inferior 2.
2614 1 inferiors added.
2615 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2616 Num Description Executable
2617 2 <null> helloworld
2618 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2619 @end smallexample
2620
2621 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2622
2623 @kindex remove-inferiors
2624 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2625 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2626 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2627 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2628
2629 @end table
2630
2631 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2632 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2633 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2634 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2635
2636 @table @code
2637 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2638 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2639 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2640 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2641 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2642 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2643
2644 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2645 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2646 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2647 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2648 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2649 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2650 @end table
2651
2652 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2653 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2654 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2655 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2656
2657
2658 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2659 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2660
2661 @table @code
2662 @kindex set print inferior-events
2663 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2664 @item set print inferior-events
2665 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2666 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2667 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2668 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2669 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2670 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2671
2672 @kindex show print inferior-events
2673 @item show print inferior-events
2674 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2675 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2676 @end table
2677
2678 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2679 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2680 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2681
2682
2683 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2684 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2685 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2686 info program-spaces}} command.
2687
2688 @table @code
2689 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2690 @item maint info program-spaces
2691 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2692 @value{GDBN}.
2693
2694 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2695
2696 @enumerate
2697 @item
2698 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2699
2700 @item
2701 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2702 the @code{file} command.
2703
2704 @end enumerate
2705
2706 @noindent
2707 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2708 indicates the current program space.
2709
2710 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2711 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2712 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2713
2714 @smallexample
2715 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2716 Id Executable
2717 2 goodbye
2718 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2719 * 1 hello
2720 @end smallexample
2721
2722 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2723 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2724 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2725 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2726 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2727
2728 @smallexample
2729 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2730 Id Executable
2731 * 1 vfork-test
2732 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2733 @end smallexample
2734
2735 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2736 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2737 @end table
2738
2739 @node Threads
2740 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2741
2742 @cindex threads of execution
2743 @cindex multiple threads
2744 @cindex switching threads
2745 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2746 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2747 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2748 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2749 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2750 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2751 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2752
2753 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2754 programs:
2755
2756 @itemize @bullet
2757 @item automatic notification of new threads
2758 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2759 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2760 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2761 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2762 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2763 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2764 messages on thread start and exit.
2765 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2766 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2767 isn't compatible with the program.
2768 @end itemize
2769
2770 @quotation
2771 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2772 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2773 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2774 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2775 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2776 like this:
2777
2778 @smallexample
2779 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2780 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2781 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2782 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2783 @end smallexample
2784 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2785 @c doesn't support threads"?
2786 @end quotation
2787
2788 @cindex focus of debugging
2789 @cindex current thread
2790 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2791 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2792 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2793 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2794 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2795
2796 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2797 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2798 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2799 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2800 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2801 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2802 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2803 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2804 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2805 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2806
2807 @smallexample
2808 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2809 @end smallexample
2810
2811 @noindent
2812 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2813 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2814 further qualifier.
2815
2816 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2817 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2818 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2819 @c program?
2820 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2821 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2822 @c threads ab initio?
2823
2824 @cindex thread number
2825 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2826 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2827 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2828
2829 @table @code
2830 @kindex info threads
2831 @item info threads @r{[}@var{id}@dots{}@r{]}
2832 Display a summary of all threads currently in your program. Optional
2833 argument @var{id}@dots{} is one or more thread ids separated by spaces, and
2834 means to print information only about the specified thread or threads.
2835 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2836
2837 @enumerate
2838 @item
2839 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2840
2841 @item
2842 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2843
2844 @item
2845 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
2846 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
2847 program itself.
2848
2849 @item
2850 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2851 @end enumerate
2852
2853 @noindent
2854 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2855 indicates the current thread.
2856
2857 For example,
2858 @end table
2859 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2860
2861 @smallexample
2862 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2863 Id Target Id Frame
2864 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2865 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2866 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2867 at threadtest.c:68
2868 @end smallexample
2869
2870 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2871 Solaris-specific command:
2872
2873 @table @code
2874 @item maint info sol-threads
2875 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2876 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2877 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2878 @end table
2879
2880 @table @code
2881 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2882 @item thread @var{threadno}
2883 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2884 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2885 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2886 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2887 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2888
2889 @smallexample
2890 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2891 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
2892 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
2893 8 printf ("hello\n");
2894 @end smallexample
2895
2896 @noindent
2897 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2898 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2899 threads.
2900
2901 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2902 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_thread} contains the number
2903 of the current thread. You may find this useful in writing breakpoint
2904 conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth. See
2905 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2906 information on convenience variables.
2907
2908 @kindex thread apply
2909 @cindex apply command to several threads
2910 @item thread apply [@var{threadno} | all] @var{command}
2911 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2912 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2913 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2914 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2915 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2916 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2917 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2918
2919 @kindex thread name
2920 @cindex name a thread
2921 @item thread name [@var{name}]
2922 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
2923 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
2924 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
2925
2926 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
2927 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
2928 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
2929 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
2930 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
2931
2932 @kindex thread find
2933 @cindex search for a thread
2934 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
2935 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
2936 matches the supplied regular expression.
2937
2938 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
2939 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
2940 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
2941 is the LWP id.
2942
2943 @smallexample
2944 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
2945 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
2946 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
2947 Id Target Id Frame
2948 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
2949 @end smallexample
2950
2951 @kindex set print thread-events
2952 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2953 @item set print thread-events
2954 @itemx set print thread-events on
2955 @itemx set print thread-events off
2956 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2957 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2958 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2959 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2960 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2961
2962 @kindex show print thread-events
2963 @item show print thread-events
2964 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2965 have started and exited.
2966 @end table
2967
2968 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2969 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2970 programs with multiple threads.
2971
2972 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2973 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2974
2975 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
2976 @table @code
2977 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
2978 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
2979 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
2980 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
2981 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
2982 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
2983 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
2984 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
2985 macro.
2986
2987 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
2988 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
2989 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
2990 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
2991 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
2992 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
2993
2994 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
2995 refers to the default system directories that are
2996 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
2997 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
2998 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
2999
3000 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3001 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3002 was loaded in the inferior process.
3003
3004 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3005 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3006 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3007 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3008 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3009 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3010 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3011
3012 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3013 only on some platforms.
3014
3015 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3016 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3017 Display current libthread_db search path.
3018
3019 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3020 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3021 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3022 @item set debug libthread-db
3023 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3024 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3025 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3026 @end table
3027
3028 @node Forks
3029 @section Debugging Forks
3030
3031 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3032 @cindex multiple processes
3033 @cindex processes, multiple
3034 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3035 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3036 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3037 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3038 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3039 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3040 will cause it to terminate.
3041
3042 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3043 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3044 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3045 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3046 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3047 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3048 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3049 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3050 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3051 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3052
3053 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
3054 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
3055 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
3056 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
3057
3058 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3059 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3060
3061 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3062 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3063
3064 @table @code
3065 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3066 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3067 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3068 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3069 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3070
3071 @table @code
3072 @item parent
3073 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3074 unimpeded. This is the default.
3075
3076 @item child
3077 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3078 unimpeded.
3079
3080 @end table
3081
3082 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3083 @item show follow-fork-mode
3084 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3085 @end table
3086
3087 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3088 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3089 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3090
3091 @table @code
3092 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3093 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3094 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3095 retain debugger control over them both.
3096
3097 @table @code
3098 @item on
3099 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3100 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3101 independently. This is the default.
3102
3103 @item off
3104 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3105 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3106 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3107 is held suspended.
3108
3109 @end table
3110
3111 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3112 @item show detach-on-fork
3113 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3114 @end table
3115
3116 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3117 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3118 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3119 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3120 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3121 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3122
3123 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3124 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3125 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3126 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3127 and Programs}.
3128
3129 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3130 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3131 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3132 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3133 the child process's @code{main}.
3134
3135 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3136 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3137
3138 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3139 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3140 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3141 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3142 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3143 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3144 command.
3145
3146 @table @code
3147 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3148 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3149
3150 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3151 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3152
3153 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3154
3155 @table @code
3156 @item new
3157 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3158 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3159 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3160 original inferior.
3161
3162 For example:
3163
3164 @smallexample
3165 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3166 (gdb) info inferior
3167 Id Description Executable
3168 * 1 <null> prog1
3169 (@value{GDBP}) run
3170 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3171 Program exited normally.
3172 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3173 Id Description Executable
3174 * 2 <null> prog2
3175 1 <null> prog1
3176 @end smallexample
3177
3178 @item same
3179 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3180 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3181 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3182 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3183 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3184
3185 For example:
3186
3187 @smallexample
3188 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3189 Id Description Executable
3190 * 1 <null> prog1
3191 (@value{GDBP}) run
3192 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3193 Program exited normally.
3194 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3195 Id Description Executable
3196 * 1 <null> prog2
3197 @end smallexample
3198
3199 @end table
3200 @end table
3201
3202 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3203 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3204 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3205
3206 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3207 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3208
3209 @cindex checkpoint
3210 @cindex restart
3211 @cindex bookmark
3212 @cindex snapshot of a process
3213 @cindex rewind program state
3214
3215 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3216 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3217 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3218 later.
3219
3220 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3221 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3222 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3223 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3224 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3225
3226 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3227 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3228 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3229 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3230 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3231 start again from there.
3232
3233 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3234 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3235
3236 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3237
3238 @table @code
3239 @kindex checkpoint
3240 @item checkpoint
3241 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3242 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3243 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3244
3245 @kindex info checkpoints
3246 @item info checkpoints
3247 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3248 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3249 listed:
3250
3251 @table @code
3252 @item Checkpoint ID
3253 @item Process ID
3254 @item Code Address
3255 @item Source line, or label
3256 @end table
3257
3258 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3259 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3260 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3261 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3262 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3263 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3264 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3265
3266 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3267 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3268 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3269 the debugger.
3270
3271 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3272 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3273 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3274
3275 @end table
3276
3277 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3278 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3279 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3280 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3281 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3282 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3283 previously read data can be read again.
3284
3285 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3286 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3287 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3288 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3289 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3290 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3291
3292 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3293 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3294 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3295 different execution path this time.
3296
3297 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3298 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3299 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3300 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3301 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3302 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3303 potentially pose a problem.
3304
3305 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3306
3307 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3308 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3309 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3310 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3311 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3312 next.
3313
3314 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3315 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3316 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3317 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3318 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3319
3320 @node Stopping
3321 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3322
3323 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3324 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3325 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3326
3327 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3328 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3329 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3330 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3331 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3332 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3333 explicitly request this information at any time.
3334
3335 @table @code
3336 @kindex info program
3337 @item info program
3338 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3339 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3340 @end table
3341
3342 @menu
3343 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3344 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3345 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3346 Skipping over functions and files
3347 * Signals:: Signals
3348 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3349 @end menu
3350
3351 @node Breakpoints
3352 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3353
3354 @cindex breakpoints
3355 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3356 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3357 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3358 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3359 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3360 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3361 program.
3362
3363 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3364 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
3365 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
3366 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
3367 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
3368 call).
3369
3370 @cindex watchpoints
3371 @cindex data breakpoints
3372 @cindex memory tracing
3373 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3374 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3375 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3376 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3377 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3378 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3379 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3380 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3381 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3382 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3383 same commands.
3384
3385 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3386 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3387 Automatic Display}.
3388
3389 @cindex catchpoints
3390 @cindex breakpoint on events
3391 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3392 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3393 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3394 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3395 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3396 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3397 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3398
3399 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3400 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3401 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3402 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3403 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3404 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3405 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3406 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3407 enable it again.
3408
3409 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3410 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3411 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3412 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3413 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3414 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3415 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3416
3417 @menu
3418 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3419 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3420 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3421 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3422 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3423 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3424 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3425 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3426 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3427 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3428 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3429 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3430 @end menu
3431
3432 @node Set Breaks
3433 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3434
3435 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3436 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3437 @c
3438 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3439
3440 @kindex break
3441 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3442 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3443 @cindex latest breakpoint
3444 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3445 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3446 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3447 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3448 convenience variables.
3449
3450 @table @code
3451 @item break @var{location}
3452 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3453 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3454 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3455 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3456 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3457
3458 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3459 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3460 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3461 that situation.
3462
3463 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3464 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3465 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3466
3467 @item break
3468 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3469 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3470 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3471 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3472 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3473 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3474 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3475 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3476 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3477 inside loops.
3478
3479 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3480 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3481 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3482 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3483 existed when your program stopped.
3484
3485 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3486 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3487 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3488 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3489 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3490 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3491 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3492
3493 @kindex tbreak
3494 @item tbreak @var{args}
3495 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
3496 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3497 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3498 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3499
3500 @kindex hbreak
3501 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3502 @item hbreak @var{args}
3503 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
3504 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3505 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3506 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3507 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3508 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3509 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3510 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3511 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3512 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3513 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3514 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3515 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3516 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3517 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3518 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3519 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3520 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3521
3522 @kindex thbreak
3523 @item thbreak @var{args}
3524 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
3525 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3526 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3527 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3528 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3529 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3530 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3531 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3532
3533 @kindex rbreak
3534 @cindex regular expression
3535 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3536 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3537 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3538 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3539 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3540 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3541 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3542 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3543 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3544
3545 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3546 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3547 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3548 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3549 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3550 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3551
3552 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3553 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3554 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3555 classes.
3556
3557 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3558 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3559 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3560
3561 @smallexample
3562 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3563 @end smallexample
3564
3565 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3566 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3567 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3568 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3569 every function in a given file:
3570
3571 @smallexample
3572 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3573 @end smallexample
3574
3575 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3576 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3577
3578 @kindex info breakpoints
3579 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3580 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3581 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3582 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3583 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3584 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3585 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3586
3587 @table @emph
3588 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3589 @item Type
3590 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3591 @item Disposition
3592 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3593 @item Enabled or Disabled
3594 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3595 that are not enabled.
3596 @item Address
3597 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3598 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3599 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3600 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3601 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3602 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3603 @item What
3604 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3605 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3606 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3607 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3608 @end table
3609
3610 @noindent
3611 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3612 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3613 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3614 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3615 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3616 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3617
3618 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3619 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3620 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3621 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3622
3623 @noindent
3624 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3625 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3626 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3627 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3628 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3629
3630 @noindent
3631 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3632 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3633 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3634 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3635 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3636 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3637
3638 @noindent
3639 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3640 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3641
3642 @end table
3643
3644 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3645 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3646 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3647 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3648
3649 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3650 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3651 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3652 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3653
3654 @itemize @bullet
3655 @item
3656 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3657
3658 @item
3659 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3660 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3661
3662 @item
3663 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3664 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3665
3666 @item
3667 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3668 several places where that function is inlined.
3669 @end itemize
3670
3671 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3672 the relevant locations.
3673
3674 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3675 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3676 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3677 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3678 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3679 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3680 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3681
3682 For example:
3683
3684 @smallexample
3685 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3686 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3687 stop only if i==1
3688 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3689 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3690 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3691 @end smallexample
3692
3693 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3694 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3695 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3696 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3697 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3698 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3699 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3700 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3701 that belong to that breakpoint.
3702
3703 @cindex pending breakpoints
3704 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3705 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3706 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3707 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3708 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3709 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3710 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3711 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3712 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3713 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3714 is not yet resolved.
3715
3716 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3717 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3718 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3719 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3720 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3721 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3722
3723 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3724 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3725 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3726 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3727
3728 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3729 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3730 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3731
3732 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3733 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3734 address specification to an address:
3735
3736 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3737 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3738 @table @code
3739 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3740 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3741 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3742
3743 @item set breakpoint pending on
3744 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3745 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3746
3747 @item set breakpoint pending off
3748 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3749 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3750 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3751
3752 @item show breakpoint pending
3753 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3754 @end table
3755
3756 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3757 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3758 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3759
3760 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3761 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3762 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3763 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3764 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3765 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3766 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3767 breakpoints.
3768
3769 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3770
3771 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3772 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3773 @table @code
3774 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3775 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3776 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3777 breakpoint must be used.
3778
3779 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3780 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3781 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3782 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3783 @end table
3784
3785 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3786 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3787 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3788 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3789 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3790 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3791 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3792 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3793 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3794
3795 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3796 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3797 @table @code
3798 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3799 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3800 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3801 removed from the target when it stops.
3802
3803 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3804 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3805 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3806 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3807 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is removed.
3808
3809 @cindex non-stop mode, and @code{breakpoint always-inserted}
3810 @item set breakpoint always-inserted auto
3811 This is the default mode. If @value{GDBN} is controlling the inferior
3812 in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), gdb behaves as if
3813 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is on. If @value{GDBN} is
3814 controlling the inferior in all-stop mode, @value{GDBN} behaves as if
3815 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is off.
3816 @end table
3817
3818 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
3819 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
3820 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
3821
3822 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
3823 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
3824
3825 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
3826
3827 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
3828 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
3829 @table @code
3830 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
3831 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
3832 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
3833 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
3834 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
3835
3836 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
3837 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
3838 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
3839 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
3840 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
3841 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
3842 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
3843 that is only known to the host. Examples include
3844 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
3845 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
3846 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
3847 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
3848 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
3849
3850 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
3851 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
3852 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
3853 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
3854 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
3855 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
3856 @end table
3857
3858
3859 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3860 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3861 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3862 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3863 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3864 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3865 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3866 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3867
3868
3869 @node Set Watchpoints
3870 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3871
3872 @cindex setting watchpoints
3873 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3874 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3875 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3876 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3877 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3878
3879 @itemize @bullet
3880 @item
3881 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3882
3883 @item
3884 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3885 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3886 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3887
3888 @item
3889 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3890 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3891 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3892 @end itemize
3893
3894 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3895 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3896 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3897 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3898 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3899 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3900 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3901 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3902 the expression changes.
3903
3904 @cindex software watchpoints
3905 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3906 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3907 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3908 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3909 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3910 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3911 culprit.)
3912
3913 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3914 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3915 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3916
3917 @table @code
3918 @kindex watch
3919 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3920 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3921 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3922 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3923 to watch the value of a single variable:
3924
3925 @smallexample
3926 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3927 @end smallexample
3928
3929 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3930 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3931 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3932 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3933 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3934 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3935
3936 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
3937 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
3938 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
3939 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
3940 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
3941 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
3942 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
3943 error.
3944
3945 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
3946 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
3947 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
3948 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
3949 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
3950 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
3951 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
3952 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
3953 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
3954 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
3955 Examples:
3956
3957 @smallexample
3958 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
3959 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
3960 @end smallexample
3961
3962 @kindex rwatch
3963 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3964 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3965 by the program.
3966
3967 @kindex awatch
3968 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3969 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3970 or written into by the program.
3971
3972 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3973 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3974 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
3975 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3976 @end table
3977
3978 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
3979 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
3980 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
3981 a never-changing value:
3982
3983 @smallexample
3984 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
3985 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
3986 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
3987 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
3988 @end smallexample
3989
3990 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3991 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3992 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3993 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3994 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3995 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3996
3997 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3998 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3999 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4000 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4001 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4002 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4003 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4004 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4005
4006 @table @code
4007 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4008 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4009 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4010
4011 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4012 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4013 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4014 @end table
4015
4016 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4017 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4018 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4019
4020 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4021
4022 @smallexample
4023 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4024 @end smallexample
4025
4026 @noindent
4027 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4028
4029 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4030 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4031 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4032 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4033 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4034 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4035 will print a message like this:
4036
4037 @smallexample
4038 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4039 @end smallexample
4040
4041 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4042 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4043 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4044 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4045 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4046 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4047 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4048 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4049
4050 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4051 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4052 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4053 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4054 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4055 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4056
4057 @smallexample
4058 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4059 @end smallexample
4060
4061 @noindent
4062 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4063
4064 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4065 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4066 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4067 expression with separately allocated resources.
4068
4069 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4070 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4071 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4072
4073 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4074 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4075 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4076 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4077 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4078 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4079 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4080 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4081 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4082
4083 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4084 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4085 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4086 watched expression from every thread.
4087
4088 @quotation
4089 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4090 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4091 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4092 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4093 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4094 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4095 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4096 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4097 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4098 @end quotation
4099
4100 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4101
4102 @node Set Catchpoints
4103 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4104 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4105 @cindex exception handlers
4106 @cindex event handling
4107
4108 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4109 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4110 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4111
4112 @table @code
4113 @kindex catch
4114 @item catch @var{event}
4115 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
4116
4117 @table @code
4118 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4119 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4120 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4121 @kindex catch throw
4122 @kindex catch rethrow
4123 @kindex catch catch
4124 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4125 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4126
4127 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4128 regular expression will be caught.
4129
4130 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4131 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4132 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4133 exception being thrown.
4134
4135 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4136 @value{GDBN}:
4137
4138 @itemize @bullet
4139 @item
4140 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4141 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4142 supported.
4143
4144 @item
4145 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4146 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4147 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4148 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4149 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4150 built.
4151
4152 @item
4153 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4154 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4155
4156 @item
4157 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4158 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4159 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4160 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4161
4162 @item
4163 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4164 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4165 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4166 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4167 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4168 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4169 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4170 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4171 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4172
4173 @item
4174 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4175
4176 @item
4177 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4178 @end itemize
4179
4180 @item exception
4181 @kindex catch exception
4182 @cindex Ada exception catching
4183 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4184 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4185 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4186 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4187 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4188
4189 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4190 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4191 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4192 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4193 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4194 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4195 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4196 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4197
4198 @item exception unhandled
4199 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4200 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4201
4202 @item assert
4203 @kindex catch assert
4204 A failed Ada assertion.
4205
4206 @item exec
4207 @kindex catch exec
4208 @cindex break on fork/exec
4209 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4210 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4211
4212 @item syscall
4213 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
4214 @kindex catch syscall
4215 @cindex break on a system call.
4216 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4217 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4218 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4219 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4220 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4221 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4222 will be caught.
4223
4224 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4225 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4226 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4227 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4228
4229 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4230 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4231 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4232 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4233
4234 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4235 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4236 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4237 available choices.
4238
4239 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4240 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4241 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4242 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4243 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4244 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4245 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4246 behind the OS upgrades).
4247
4248 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4249 arguments to it:
4250
4251 @smallexample
4252 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4253 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4254 (@value{GDBP}) r
4255 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4256
4257 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4258 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4259 (@value{GDBP}) c
4260 Continuing.
4261
4262 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4263 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4264 (@value{GDBP})
4265 @end smallexample
4266
4267 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4268
4269 @smallexample
4270 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4271 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4272 (@value{GDBP}) r
4273 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4274
4275 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4276 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4277 (@value{GDBP}) c
4278 Continuing.
4279
4280 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4281 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4282 (@value{GDBP})
4283 @end smallexample
4284
4285 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4286 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4287 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4288
4289 @smallexample
4290 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4291 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4292 (@value{GDBP}) r
4293 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4294
4295 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4296 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4297 (@value{GDBP}) c
4298 Continuing.
4299
4300 Program exited normally.
4301 (@value{GDBP})
4302 @end smallexample
4303
4304 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4305 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4306 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4307 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4308
4309 @smallexample
4310 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4311 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4312 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4313 (@value{GDBP})
4314 @end smallexample
4315
4316 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4317 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4318 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4319 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4320 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4321 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4322
4323 @smallexample
4324 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4325 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4326 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4327 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4328 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4329 (@value{GDBP})
4330 @end smallexample
4331
4332 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4333
4334 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4335 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4336
4337 @smallexample
4338 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4339 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4340 @end smallexample
4341
4342 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4343
4344 @item fork
4345 @kindex catch fork
4346 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4347 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4348
4349 @item vfork
4350 @kindex catch vfork
4351 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4352 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4353
4354 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4355 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4356 @kindex catch load
4357 @kindex catch unload
4358 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4359 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4360 matches one of the affected libraries.
4361
4362 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4363 @kindex catch signal
4364 The delivery of a signal.
4365
4366 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4367 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4368 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4369
4370 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4371 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4372 signal names.
4373
4374 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4375 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4376 will be caught.
4377
4378 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4379 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4380 catchpoint.
4381
4382 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4383 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4384 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4385 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4386 commands.
4387
4388 @end table
4389
4390 @item tcatch @var{event}
4391 @kindex tcatch
4392 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4393 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4394
4395 @end table
4396
4397 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4398
4399
4400 @node Delete Breaks
4401 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4402
4403 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4404 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4405 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4406 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4407 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4408 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4409
4410 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4411 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4412 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4413 their breakpoint numbers.
4414
4415 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4416 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4417 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4418
4419 @table @code
4420 @kindex clear
4421 @item clear
4422 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4423 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4424 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4425 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4426
4427 @item clear @var{location}
4428 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4429 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4430 most useful ones are listed below:
4431
4432 @table @code
4433 @item clear @var{function}
4434 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4435 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4436
4437 @item clear @var{linenum}
4438 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4439 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4440 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4441 @end table
4442
4443 @cindex delete breakpoints
4444 @kindex delete
4445 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4446 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4447 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4448 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4449 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4450 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4451 @end table
4452
4453 @node Disabling
4454 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4455
4456 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4457 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4458 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4459 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4460 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4461
4462 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4463 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4464 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4465 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4466 do not know which numbers to use.
4467
4468 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4469 affects all of its locations.
4470
4471 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4472 different states of enablement:
4473
4474 @itemize @bullet
4475 @item
4476 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4477 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4478 @item
4479 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4480 @item
4481 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4482 disabled.
4483 @item
4484 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4485 N times, then becomes disabled.
4486 @item
4487 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4488 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4489 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4490 @end itemize
4491
4492 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4493 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4494
4495 @table @code
4496 @kindex disable
4497 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4498 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4499 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4500 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4501 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4502 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4503 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4504
4505 @kindex enable
4506 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4507 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4508 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4509
4510 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4511 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4512 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4513
4514 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{range}@dots{}
4515 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4516 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4517 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4518 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4519 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4520 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4521
4522 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4523 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4524 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4525 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4526 @end table
4527
4528 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4529 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4530 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4531 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4532 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4533 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4534 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4535 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4536 Stepping}.)
4537
4538 @node Conditions
4539 @subsection Break Conditions
4540 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4541 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4542
4543 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4544 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4545 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4546 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4547 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4548 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4549 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4550 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4551
4552 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4553 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4554 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4555 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4556 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4557
4558 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4559 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4560 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4561 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4562 one.
4563
4564 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4565 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4566 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4567 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4568 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4569 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4570 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4571 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4572 conditions for the
4573 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4574 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4575
4576 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4577 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4578 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4579 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4580 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4581 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4582
4583 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4584 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4585 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4586 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4587 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4588
4589 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4590 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4591 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4592 with the @code{condition} command.
4593
4594 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4595 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4596 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4597 catchpoint.
4598
4599 @table @code
4600 @kindex condition
4601 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4602 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4603 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4604 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4605 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4606 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4607 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4608 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4609 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4610 prints an error message:
4611
4612 @smallexample
4613 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4614 @end smallexample
4615
4616 @noindent
4617 @value{GDBN} does
4618 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4619 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4620 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4621
4622 @item condition @var{bnum}
4623 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4624 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4625 @end table
4626
4627 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4628 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4629 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4630 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4631 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4632 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4633 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4634 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4635 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4636 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4637 your program reaches it.
4638
4639 @table @code
4640 @kindex ignore
4641 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4642 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4643 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4644 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4645 takes no action.
4646
4647 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4648 a count of zero.
4649
4650 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4651 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4652 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4653 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4654
4655 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4656 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4657 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4658
4659 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4660 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4661 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4662 Variables}.
4663 @end table
4664
4665 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4666
4667
4668 @node Break Commands
4669 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4670
4671 @cindex breakpoint commands
4672 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4673 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4674 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4675 enable other breakpoints.
4676
4677 @table @code
4678 @kindex commands
4679 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4680 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4681 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4682 @itemx end
4683 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4684 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4685 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4686
4687 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4688 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4689
4690 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4691 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4692 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4693 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4694 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4695 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4696 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4697 Expressions}).
4698 @end table
4699
4700 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4701 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4702
4703 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4704 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4705 that resumes execution.
4706
4707 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4708 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4709 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4710 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4711 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4712
4713 @kindex silent
4714 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4715 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4716 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4717 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4718 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4719 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4720
4721 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4722 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4723 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4724
4725 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4726 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4727
4728 @smallexample
4729 break foo if x>0
4730 commands
4731 silent
4732 printf "x is %d\n",x
4733 cont
4734 end
4735 @end smallexample
4736
4737 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4738 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4739 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4740 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4741 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4742 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4743 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4744
4745 @smallexample
4746 break 403
4747 commands
4748 silent
4749 set x = y + 4
4750 cont
4751 end
4752 @end smallexample
4753
4754 @node Dynamic Printf
4755 @subsection Dynamic Printf
4756
4757 @cindex dynamic printf
4758 @cindex dprintf
4759 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4760 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4761 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4762 having to recompile it.
4763
4764 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
4765 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4766 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4767 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
4768 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4769 redirects to files and so forth.
4770
4771 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4772 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
4773 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4774 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4775 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4776 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4777 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4778
4779 @table @code
4780 @kindex dprintf
4781 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4782 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4783 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4784 To print several values, separate them with commas.
4785
4786 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4787 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4788 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
4789 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
4790 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
4791 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
4792
4793 @item gdb
4794 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
4795 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
4796
4797 @item call
4798 @kindex dprintf-style call
4799 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
4800 @code{printf}).
4801
4802 @item agent
4803 @kindex dprintf-style agent
4804 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
4805 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
4806 support running commands on the target.
4807
4808 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
4809 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
4810 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
4811 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
4812 command.
4813
4814 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
4815 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
4816 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
4817 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
4818 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
4819 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
4820
4821 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
4822 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
4823 you could do the following:
4824
4825 @example
4826 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
4827 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
4828 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
4829 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
4830 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
4831 (gdb) info break
4832 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
4833 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
4834 continue
4835 (gdb)
4836 @end example
4837
4838 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
4839 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
4840 the variable settings.
4841
4842 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
4843 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
4844 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
4845 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
4846 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
4847 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
4848
4849 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
4850 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
4851 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
4852
4853 @end table
4854
4855 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
4856 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
4857 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
4858 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
4859 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
4860 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
4861
4862 @node Save Breakpoints
4863 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
4864
4865 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
4866 breakpoints}} command.
4867
4868 @table @code
4869 @kindex save breakpoints
4870 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
4871 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
4872 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
4873 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
4874 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
4875 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
4876 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
4877 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
4878 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
4879 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
4880 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
4881 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
4882 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
4883 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
4884 that can no longer be recreated.
4885 @end table
4886
4887 @node Static Probe Points
4888 @subsection Static Probe Points
4889
4890 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
4891 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
4892 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
4893 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations. They are
4894 usable from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages. See
4895 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
4896 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.
4897
4898 Currently, @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
4899 @acronym{SDT} probes are supported on ELF-compatible systems. See
4900 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
4901 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT} probes
4902 in your applications.
4903
4904 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
4905 Some probes have an associated semaphore variable; for instance, this
4906 happens automatically if you defined your probe using a DTrace-style
4907 @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore, @value{GDBN} will
4908 automatically enable it when you specify a breakpoint using the
4909 @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a breakpoint at a probe's
4910 location by some other method (e.g., @code{break file:line}), then
4911 @value{GDBN} will not automatically set the semaphore.
4912
4913 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
4914 probes}, with optional arguments:
4915
4916 @table @code
4917 @kindex info probes
4918 @item info probes stap @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
4919 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
4920 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
4921 probes from all providers are listed.
4922
4923 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
4924 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
4925 considered when deciding whether to display them.
4926
4927 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
4928 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
4929 given, all object files are considered.
4930
4931 @item info probes all
4932 List the available static probes, from all types.
4933 @end table
4934
4935 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
4936 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
4937 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
4938 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
4939 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
4940 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. Each probe argument is
4941 an integer of the appropriate size; types are not preserved. The
4942 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
4943 at the current probe point.
4944
4945 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
4946 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
4947 an error message.
4948
4949
4950 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
4951 @node Error in Breakpoints
4952 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
4953
4954 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
4955 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
4956
4957 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
4958 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
4959 @smallexample
4960 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
4961 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
4962 @end smallexample
4963
4964 @noindent
4965 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
4966 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
4967 watchpoints it needs to insert.
4968
4969 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
4970 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
4971
4972 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
4973 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
4974 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
4975
4976 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
4977 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
4978 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
4979 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
4980
4981 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
4982 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
4983 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
4984 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
4985 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
4986 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
4987 first in the bundle.
4988
4989 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
4990 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
4991 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
4992 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
4993 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
4994 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
4995 is hit.
4996
4997 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
4998 that's been subject to address adjustment:
4999
5000 @smallexample
5001 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5002 @end smallexample
5003
5004 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5005 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5006 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5007 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5008 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5009 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5010 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5011 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5012
5013 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5014 adjusted breakpoints:
5015
5016 @smallexample
5017 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5018 to 0x00010410.
5019 @end smallexample
5020
5021 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5022 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5023 frequently than expected.
5024
5025 @node Continuing and Stepping
5026 @section Continuing and Stepping
5027
5028 @cindex stepping
5029 @cindex continuing
5030 @cindex resuming execution
5031 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5032 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5033 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5034 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5035 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5036 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5037 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5038 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
5039
5040 @table @code
5041 @kindex continue
5042 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5043 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5044 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5045 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5046 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5047 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5048 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5049 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5050 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5051 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5052
5053 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5054 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5055 @code{continue} is ignored.
5056
5057 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5058 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5059 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5060 @code{continue}.
5061 @end table
5062
5063 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5064 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5065 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5066 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5067
5068 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5069 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5070 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5071 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5072 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5073 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5074
5075 @table @code
5076 @kindex step
5077 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5078 @item step
5079 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5080 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5081 abbreviated @code{s}.
5082
5083 @quotation
5084 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5085 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5086 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5087 @c distinction here.
5088 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5089 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5090 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5091 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5092 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5093 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5094 below.
5095 @end quotation
5096
5097 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5098 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5099 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5100 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5101 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5102 called within the line.
5103
5104 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5105 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5106 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5107 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5108 was any debugging information about the routine.
5109
5110 @item step @var{count}
5111 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5112 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5113 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5114
5115 @kindex next
5116 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5117 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5118 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5119 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5120 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5121 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5122 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5123 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5124
5125 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5126
5127
5128 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5129 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5130 @c
5131 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5132 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5133 @c function are executed without stopping.
5134
5135 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5136 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5137 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5138
5139 @kindex set step-mode
5140 @item set step-mode
5141 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5142 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5143 @itemx set step-mode on
5144 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5145 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5146 information rather than stepping over it.
5147
5148 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5149 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5150 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5151
5152 @item set step-mode off
5153 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5154 debug information. This is the default.
5155
5156 @item show step-mode
5157 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5158 source line debug information.
5159
5160 @kindex finish
5161 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5162 @item finish
5163 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5164 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5165 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5166
5167 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5168 ,Returning from a Function}).
5169
5170 @kindex until
5171 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5172 @cindex run until specified location
5173 @item until
5174 @itemx u
5175 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5176 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5177 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5178 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5179 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5180 than the address of the jump.
5181
5182 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5183 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5184 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5185 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5186 through the next iteration.
5187
5188 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5189 stack frame.
5190
5191 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5192 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5193 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5194 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5195 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5196
5197 @smallexample
5198 (@value{GDBP}) f
5199 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5200 206 expand_input();
5201 (@value{GDBP}) until
5202 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5203 @end smallexample
5204
5205 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5206 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5207 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5208 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5209 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5210 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5211 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5212
5213 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5214 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5215 argument.
5216
5217 @item until @var{location}
5218 @itemx u @var{location}
5219 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
5220 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
5221 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5222 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5223 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5224 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5225 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5226 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5227 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5228 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5229 invocations have returned.
5230
5231 @smallexample
5232 94 int factorial (int value)
5233 95 @{
5234 96 if (value > 1) @{
5235 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5236 98 @}
5237 99 return (value);
5238 100 @}
5239 @end smallexample
5240
5241
5242 @kindex advance @var{location}
5243 @item advance @var{location}
5244 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5245 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5246 @ref{Specify Location}.
5247 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5248 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5249 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5250 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5251
5252
5253 @kindex stepi
5254 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5255 @item stepi
5256 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5257 @itemx si
5258 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5259
5260 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5261 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5262 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5263 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5264
5265 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5266
5267 @need 750
5268 @kindex nexti
5269 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5270 @item nexti
5271 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5272 @itemx ni
5273 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5274 proceed until the function returns.
5275
5276 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5277
5278 @end table
5279
5280 @anchor{range stepping}
5281 @cindex range stepping
5282 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5283 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5284 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5285 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5286 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5287 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5288 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5289 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5290 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5291 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5292 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5293 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5294 if necessary:
5295
5296 @table @code
5297 @kindex set range-stepping
5298 @kindex show range-stepping
5299 @item set range-stepping
5300 @itemx show range-stepping
5301 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5302
5303 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5304 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5305 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5306 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5307 default is @code{on}.
5308
5309 @end table
5310
5311 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5312 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5313 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5314
5315 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5316 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} comand lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5317 skip a function or all functions in a file when stepping.
5318
5319 For example, consider the following C function:
5320
5321 @smallexample
5322 101 int func()
5323 102 @{
5324 103 foo(boring());
5325 104 bar(boring());
5326 105 @}
5327 @end smallexample
5328
5329 @noindent
5330 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5331 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5332 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5333 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5334
5335 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5336 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5337 is called from many places.
5338
5339 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5340 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5341 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5342 @code{foo}.
5343
5344 You can also instruct @value{GDBN} to skip all functions in a file, with, for
5345 example, @code{skip file boring.c}.
5346
5347 @table @code
5348 @kindex skip function
5349 @item skip @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5350 @itemx skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5351 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5352 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5353 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5354
5355 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5356 will be skipped.
5357
5358 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5359 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5360
5361 @kindex skip file
5362 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5363 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5364 will be skipped over when stepping.
5365
5366 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5367 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5368 @end table
5369
5370 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5371 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5372
5373 @table @code
5374 @kindex info skip
5375 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5376 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5377 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5378 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5379
5380 @table @emph
5381 @item Identifier
5382 A number identifying this skip.
5383 @item Type
5384 The type of this skip, either @samp{function} or @samp{file}.
5385 @item Enabled or Disabled
5386 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}. Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5387 @item Address
5388 For function skips, this column indicates the address in memory of the function
5389 being skipped. If you've set a function skip on a function which has not yet
5390 been loaded, this field will contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Once a shared library
5391 which has the function is loaded, @code{info skip} will show the function's
5392 address here.
5393 @item What
5394 For file skips, this field contains the filename being skipped. For functions
5395 skips, this field contains the function name and its line number in the file
5396 where it is defined.
5397 @end table
5398
5399 @kindex skip delete
5400 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5401 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5402 skips.
5403
5404 @kindex skip enable
5405 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5406 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5407 skips.
5408
5409 @kindex skip disable
5410 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5411 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5412 skips.
5413
5414 @end table
5415
5416 @node Signals
5417 @section Signals
5418 @cindex signals
5419
5420 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5421 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5422 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5423 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5424 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5425 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5426 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5427 requested an alarm).
5428
5429 @cindex fatal signals
5430 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5431 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5432 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5433 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5434 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5435 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5436
5437 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5438 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5439 signal.
5440
5441 @cindex handling signals
5442 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5443 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5444 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5445 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5446 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5447
5448 @table @code
5449 @kindex info signals
5450 @kindex info handle
5451 @item info signals
5452 @itemx info handle
5453 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5454 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5455 the defined types of signals.
5456
5457 @item info signals @var{sig}
5458 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5459
5460 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5461
5462 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5463 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5464 for details about this command.
5465
5466 @kindex handle
5467 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5468 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
5469 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5470 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5471 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5472 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5473 say what change to make.
5474 @end table
5475
5476 @c @group
5477 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5478 Their full names are:
5479
5480 @table @code
5481 @item nostop
5482 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5483 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5484
5485 @item stop
5486 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5487 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5488
5489 @item print
5490 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5491
5492 @item noprint
5493 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5494 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5495
5496 @item pass
5497 @itemx noignore
5498 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5499 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5500 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5501
5502 @item nopass
5503 @itemx ignore
5504 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5505 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5506 @end table
5507 @c @end group
5508
5509 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5510 program until you
5511 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5512 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5513 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5514 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5515 program sees that signal when you continue.
5516
5517 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5518 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5519 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5520 erroneous signals.
5521
5522 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5523 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5524 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5525 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5526 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5527 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5528 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5529 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5530 Program a Signal}.
5531
5532 @cindex extra signal information
5533 @anchor{extra signal information}
5534
5535 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5536 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5537 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5538 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5539 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5540 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5541 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5542 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5543 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5544 system header.
5545
5546 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5547 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5548
5549 @smallexample
5550 @group
5551 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5552 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5553 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5554 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5555 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5556 type = struct @{
5557 int si_signo;
5558 int si_errno;
5559 int si_code;
5560 union @{
5561 int _pad[28];
5562 struct @{...@} _kill;
5563 struct @{...@} _timer;
5564 struct @{...@} _rt;
5565 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5566 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5567 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5568 @} _sifields;
5569 @}
5570 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5571 type = struct @{
5572 void *si_addr;
5573 @}
5574 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5575 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5576 @end group
5577 @end smallexample
5578
5579 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5580
5581 @node Thread Stops
5582 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5583
5584 @cindex stopped threads
5585 @cindex threads, stopped
5586
5587 @cindex continuing threads
5588 @cindex threads, continuing
5589
5590 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5591 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5592 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
5593 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
5594 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
5595 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5596 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5597 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5598 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5599
5600 @menu
5601 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
5602 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
5603 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
5604 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
5605 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
5606 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
5607 @end menu
5608
5609 @node All-Stop Mode
5610 @subsection All-Stop Mode
5611
5612 @cindex all-stop mode
5613
5614 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
5615 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
5616 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
5617 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
5618 underfoot.
5619
5620 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
5621 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5622 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
5623
5624 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
5625 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
5626 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
5627 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
5628 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
5629 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
5630 stops.
5631
5632 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
5633 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
5634 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
5635 first thread completes whatever you requested.
5636
5637 @cindex automatic thread selection
5638 @cindex switching threads automatically
5639 @cindex threads, automatic switching
5640 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
5641 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
5642 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
5643 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
5644 thread.
5645
5646 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
5647 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
5648
5649 @table @code
5650 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
5651 @cindex scheduler locking mode
5652 @cindex lock scheduler
5653 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
5654 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
5655 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
5656 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
5657 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
5658 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
5659 Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
5660 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
5661 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
5662 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
5663 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
5664 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
5665
5666 @item show scheduler-locking
5667 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
5668 @end table
5669
5670 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
5671 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
5672 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
5673 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
5674 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
5675 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
5676 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
5677 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
5678 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
5679 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
5680 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
5681 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
5682 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
5683 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
5684
5685 @table @code
5686 @kindex set schedule-multiple
5687 @item set schedule-multiple
5688 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
5689 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
5690 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
5691 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
5692 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
5693 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
5694
5695 @item show schedule-multiple
5696 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
5697 multiple processes.
5698 @end table
5699
5700 @node Non-Stop Mode
5701 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
5702
5703 @cindex non-stop mode
5704
5705 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
5706 @c with more details.
5707
5708 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
5709 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
5710 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
5711 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
5712 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
5713 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
5714
5715 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
5716 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
5717 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
5718 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
5719 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
5720 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
5721 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
5722 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
5723 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
5724 independently and simultaneously.
5725
5726 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
5727 or attach to your program:
5728
5729 @smallexample
5730 # Enable the async interface.
5731 set target-async 1
5732
5733 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
5734 set pagination off
5735
5736 # Finally, turn it on!
5737 set non-stop on
5738 @end smallexample
5739
5740 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
5741
5742 @table @code
5743 @kindex set non-stop
5744 @item set non-stop on
5745 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
5746 @item set non-stop off
5747 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
5748 @kindex show non-stop
5749 @item show non-stop
5750 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
5751 @end table
5752
5753 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
5754 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
5755 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
5756 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
5757 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
5758 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
5759 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
5760 default.
5761
5762 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
5763 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
5764 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
5765
5766 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
5767 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
5768 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
5769 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
5770 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
5771
5772 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
5773 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
5774 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
5775 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
5776 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
5777
5778 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
5779
5780 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
5781 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
5782 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
5783 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
5784 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
5785 previously current thread.
5786
5787 @node Background Execution
5788 @subsection Background Execution
5789
5790 @cindex foreground execution
5791 @cindex background execution
5792 @cindex asynchronous execution
5793 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
5794
5795 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
5796 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
5797 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
5798 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
5799 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
5800 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
5801
5802 You need to explicitly enable asynchronous mode before you can use
5803 background execution commands. You can use these commands to
5804 manipulate the asynchronous mode setting:
5805
5806 @table @code
5807 @kindex set target-async
5808 @item set target-async on
5809 Enable asynchronous mode.
5810 @item set target-async off
5811 Disable asynchronous mode.
5812 @kindex show target-async
5813 @item show target-async
5814 Show the current target-async setting.
5815 @end table
5816
5817 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
5818 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
5819
5820 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
5821 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
5822 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
5823 are:
5824
5825 @table @code
5826 @kindex run&
5827 @item run
5828 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
5829
5830 @item attach
5831 @kindex attach&
5832 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
5833
5834 @item step
5835 @kindex step&
5836 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
5837
5838 @item stepi
5839 @kindex stepi&
5840 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
5841
5842 @item next
5843 @kindex next&
5844 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
5845
5846 @item nexti
5847 @kindex nexti&
5848 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
5849
5850 @item continue
5851 @kindex continue&
5852 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
5853
5854 @item finish
5855 @kindex finish&
5856 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
5857
5858 @item until
5859 @kindex until&
5860 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
5861
5862 @end table
5863
5864 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
5865 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
5866 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
5867 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
5868 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
5869 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
5870
5871 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
5872 using the @code{interrupt} command.
5873
5874 @table @code
5875 @kindex interrupt
5876 @item interrupt
5877 @itemx interrupt -a
5878
5879 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
5880 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
5881 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
5882 use @code{interrupt -a}.
5883 @end table
5884
5885 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5886 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5887
5888 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
5889 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
5890 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
5891
5892 @table @code
5893 @cindex breakpoints and threads
5894 @cindex thread breakpoints
5895 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
5896 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
5897 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
5898 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
5899 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
5900 specify some source line.
5901
5902 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
5903 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
5904 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
5905 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
5906 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
5907
5908 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
5909 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
5910 program.
5911
5912 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
5913 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before or
5914 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
5915
5916 @smallexample
5917 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
5918 @end smallexample
5919
5920 @end table
5921
5922 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
5923 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
5924 thread list. For example:
5925
5926 @smallexample
5927 (@value{GDBP}) c
5928 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
5929 @end smallexample
5930
5931 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
5932 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
5933 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
5934 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
5935 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
5936 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
5937 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
5938 command.
5939
5940 @node Interrupted System Calls
5941 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
5942
5943 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
5944 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
5945 @cindex premature return from system calls
5946 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
5947 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
5948 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
5949 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
5950 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
5951 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
5952 stop execution.
5953
5954 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
5955 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
5956 style anyways.
5957
5958 For example, do not write code like this:
5959
5960 @smallexample
5961 sleep (10);
5962 @end smallexample
5963
5964 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
5965 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
5966
5967 Instead, write this:
5968
5969 @smallexample
5970 int unslept = 10;
5971 while (unslept > 0)
5972 unslept = sleep (unslept);
5973 @end smallexample
5974
5975 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
5976 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
5977 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
5978 @value{GDBN}.
5979
5980 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
5981 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
5982 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
5983 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
5984
5985 @node Observer Mode
5986 @subsection Observer Mode
5987
5988 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
5989 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
5990 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
5991 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
5992 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
5993
5994 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
5995 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
5996 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
5997 mode.
5998
5999 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6000 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6001 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6002 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6003 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6004
6005 @table @code
6006
6007 @kindex observer
6008 @item set observer on
6009 @itemx set observer off
6010 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6011 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6012 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6013 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6014
6015 @item show observer
6016 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6017
6018 @kindex may-write-registers
6019 @item set may-write-registers on
6020 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6021 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6022 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6023 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6024
6025 @item show may-write-registers
6026 Show the current permission to write registers.
6027
6028 @kindex may-write-memory
6029 @item set may-write-memory on
6030 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6031 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6032 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6033 defaults to @code{on}.
6034
6035 @item show may-write-memory
6036 Show the current permission to write memory.
6037
6038 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6039 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6040 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6041 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6042 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6043 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6044
6045 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6046 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6047
6048 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6049 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6050 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6051 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6052 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6053 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6054 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6055
6056 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6057 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6058
6059 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6060 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6061 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6062 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6063 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6064 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6065 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6066
6067 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6068 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6069
6070 @kindex may-interrupt
6071 @item set may-interrupt on
6072 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6073 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6074 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6075 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6076 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6077
6078 @item show may-interrupt
6079 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6080
6081 @end table
6082
6083 @node Reverse Execution
6084 @chapter Running programs backward
6085 @cindex reverse execution
6086 @cindex running programs backward
6087
6088 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6089 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6090 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6091 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6092
6093 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6094 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6095 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6096 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6097 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6098 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6099
6100 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6101 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6102 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6103 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6104 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6105 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6106 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6107 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6108 prior values@footnote{
6109 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6110 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6111 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6112
6113 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6114 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6115 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6116 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6117 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6118 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6119 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6120 }.
6121
6122 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6123 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6124
6125 @table @code
6126 @kindex reverse-continue
6127 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6128 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6129 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6130 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6131 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6132 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6133 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6134
6135 @kindex reverse-step
6136 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6137 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6138 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6139 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6140
6141 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6142 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6143 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6144 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6145 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6146 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6147
6148 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6149 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6150
6151 @kindex reverse-stepi
6152 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6153 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6154 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6155 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6156 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6157 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6158 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6159
6160 @kindex reverse-next
6161 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6162 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6163 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6164 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6165 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6166 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6167 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6168 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6169 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6170 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6171
6172 @kindex reverse-nexti
6173 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6174 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6175 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6176 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6177 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6178 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6179 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6180 frame) is reached.
6181
6182 @kindex reverse-finish
6183 @item reverse-finish
6184 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6185 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6186 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6187 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6188
6189 @kindex set exec-direction
6190 @item set exec-direction
6191 Set the direction of target execution.
6192 @item set exec-direction reverse
6193 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6194 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6195 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6196 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6197 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6198 @item set exec-direction forward
6199 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6200 This is the default.
6201 @end table
6202
6203
6204 @node Process Record and Replay
6205 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6206 @cindex process record and replay
6207 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6208
6209 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6210 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6211 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6212
6213 @cindex replay mode
6214 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6215 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6216 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6217 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6218 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6219 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6220 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6221 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6222 execution log.
6223
6224 @cindex record mode
6225 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6226 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6227 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6228 for future replay.
6229
6230 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6231 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6232 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6233 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6234 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6235 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6236
6237 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6238 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6239 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6240 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6241
6242 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6243 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6244
6245 @table @code
6246 @kindex target record
6247 @kindex target record-full
6248 @kindex target record-btrace
6249 @kindex record
6250 @kindex record full
6251 @kindex record btrace
6252 @kindex rec
6253 @kindex rec full
6254 @kindex rec btrace
6255 @item record @var{method}
6256 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6257 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6258 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6259 recording methods are available:
6260
6261 @table @code
6262 @item full
6263 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6264 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6265 execution.
6266
6267 @item btrace
6268 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6269 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6270 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited replay and
6271 reverse execution.
6272
6273 This recording method may not be available on all processors.
6274 @end table
6275
6276 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6277 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6278 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6279 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6280
6281 Both @code{record @var{method}} and @code{rec @var{method}} are
6282 aliases of @code{target record-@var{method}}.
6283
6284 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6285 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6286 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6287 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6288 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6289
6290 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6291 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6292 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6293 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6294 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6295 does not support these two modes.
6296
6297 @kindex record stop
6298 @kindex rec s
6299 @item record stop
6300 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6301 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6302 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6303
6304 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6305 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6306 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6307 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6308 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6309
6310 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6311 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6312 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6313 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6314 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6315
6316 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6317 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6318
6319 @kindex record goto
6320 @item record goto
6321 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6322 ways to specify the location to go to:
6323
6324 @table @code
6325 @item record goto begin
6326 @itemx record goto start
6327 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6328
6329 @item record goto end
6330 Go to the end of the execution log.
6331
6332 @item record goto @var{n}
6333 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6334 @end table
6335
6336 @kindex record save
6337 @item record save @var{filename}
6338 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6339 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6340 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6341
6342 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6343
6344 @kindex record restore
6345 @item record restore @var{filename}
6346 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6347 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6348
6349 @kindex set record full
6350 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6351 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6352 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6353 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6354
6355 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6356 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6357 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6358 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6359 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6360 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6361 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6362 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6363
6364 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6365 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6366 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6367
6368 @kindex show record full
6369 @item show record full insn-number-max
6370 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6371 recording method.
6372
6373 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6374 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6375 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6376 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6377 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6378 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6379 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6380 oldest one to be deleted.
6381
6382 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6383 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6384
6385 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6386 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6387
6388 @item set record full memory-query
6389 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6390 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6391 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6392 case.
6393
6394 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6395 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6396 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6397 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6398 results.
6399
6400 @item show record full memory-query
6401 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6402
6403 @kindex info record
6404 @item info record
6405 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6406 method:
6407
6408 @table @code
6409 @item full
6410 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6411 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6412
6413 @itemize @bullet
6414 @item
6415 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6416 @item
6417 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6418 @item
6419 Highest recorded instruction number.
6420 @item
6421 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6422 @item
6423 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6424 @item
6425 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6426 @end itemize
6427
6428 @item btrace
6429 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows the number of
6430 instructions that have been recorded and the number of blocks of
6431 sequential control-flow that is formed by the recorded instructions.
6432 @end table
6433
6434 @kindex record delete
6435 @kindex rec del
6436 @item record delete
6437 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6438 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6439 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
6440 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6441
6442 @kindex record instruction-history
6443 @kindex rec instruction-history
6444 @item record instruction-history
6445 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
6446 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
6447 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
6448 are printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify
6449 what part of the execution log to disassemble:
6450
6451 @table @code
6452 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
6453 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
6454 @var{insn}.
6455
6456 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
6457 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
6458 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
6459 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
6460 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
6461 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
6462
6463 @item record instruction-history
6464 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
6465
6466 @item record instruction-history -
6467 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
6468
6469 @item record instruction-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6470 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
6471 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
6472 number @var{end} is included.
6473 @end table
6474
6475 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6476
6477 @kindex set record
6478 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
6479 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
6480 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6481 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
6482 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
6483
6484 @kindex show record
6485 @item show record instruction-history-size
6486 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6487 instruction-history} command.
6488
6489 @kindex record function-call-history
6490 @kindex rec function-call-history
6491 @item record function-call-history
6492 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
6493 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
6494 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
6495 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
6496 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
6497 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
6498 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
6499 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
6500 given together.
6501
6502 @smallexample
6503 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
6504 1 void foo (void)
6505 2 @{
6506 3 @}
6507 4
6508 5 void bar (void)
6509 6 @{
6510 7 ...
6511 8 foo ();
6512 9 ...
6513 10 @}
6514 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
6515 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
6516 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
6517 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
6518 @end smallexample
6519
6520 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
6521 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
6522 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
6523 to print:
6524
6525 @table @code
6526 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
6527 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
6528
6529 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
6530 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
6531 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
6532 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
6533 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
6534
6535 @item record function-call-history
6536 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
6537
6538 @item record function-call-history -
6539 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
6540
6541 @item record function-call-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6542 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
6543 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
6544 @end table
6545
6546 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6547
6548 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
6549 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
6550 Define how many lines to print in the
6551 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
6552 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
6553
6554 @item show record function-call-history-size
6555 Show how many lines to print in the
6556 @code{record function-call-history} command.
6557 @end table
6558
6559
6560 @node Stack
6561 @chapter Examining the Stack
6562
6563 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
6564 stopped and how it got there.
6565
6566 @cindex call stack
6567 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
6568 is generated.
6569 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
6570 the arguments of the call,
6571 and the local variables of the function being called.
6572 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
6573 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
6574 stack}.
6575
6576 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
6577 stack allow you to see all of this information.
6578
6579 @cindex selected frame
6580 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
6581 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
6582 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
6583 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
6584 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
6585 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6586
6587 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
6588 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
6589 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
6590
6591 @menu
6592 * Frames:: Stack frames
6593 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
6594 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
6595 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
6596 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
6597
6598 @end menu
6599
6600 @node Frames
6601 @section Stack Frames
6602
6603 @cindex frame, definition
6604 @cindex stack frame
6605 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
6606 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
6607 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
6608 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
6609 which the function is executing.
6610
6611 @cindex initial frame
6612 @cindex outermost frame
6613 @cindex innermost frame
6614 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
6615 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
6616 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
6617 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
6618 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
6619 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
6620 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
6621 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
6622
6623 @cindex frame pointer
6624 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
6625 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
6626 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
6627 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
6628 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
6629 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
6630
6631 @cindex frame number
6632 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
6633 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
6634 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
6635 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
6636 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
6637
6638 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
6639 @c underflow problems.
6640 @cindex frameless execution
6641 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6642 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
6643 @smallexample
6644 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
6645 @end smallexample
6646 generates functions without a frame.)
6647 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
6648 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
6649 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
6650 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
6651 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
6652 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
6653 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
6654
6655 @table @code
6656 @kindex frame@r{, command}
6657 @cindex current stack frame
6658 @item frame @var{args}
6659 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
6660 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
6661 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
6662 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
6663
6664 @kindex select-frame
6665 @cindex selecting frame silently
6666 @item select-frame
6667 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
6668 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
6669 @code{frame}.
6670 @end table
6671
6672 @node Backtrace
6673 @section Backtraces
6674
6675 @cindex traceback
6676 @cindex call stack traces
6677 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
6678 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
6679 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
6680 stack.
6681
6682 @anchor{backtrace-command}
6683 @table @code
6684 @kindex backtrace
6685 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
6686 @item backtrace
6687 @itemx bt
6688 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
6689 frames in the stack.
6690
6691 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
6692 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
6693
6694 @item backtrace @var{n}
6695 @itemx bt @var{n}
6696 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
6697
6698 @item backtrace -@var{n}
6699 @itemx bt -@var{n}
6700 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
6701
6702 @item backtrace full
6703 @itemx bt full
6704 @itemx bt full @var{n}
6705 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
6706 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
6707 number of frames to print, as described above.
6708
6709 @item backtrace no-filters
6710 @itemx bt no-filters
6711 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
6712 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
6713 @itemx bt no-filters full
6714 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
6715 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
6716 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
6717 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
6718 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
6719 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
6720 support.
6721 @end table
6722
6723 @kindex where
6724 @kindex info stack
6725 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
6726 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
6727
6728 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
6729 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
6730 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
6731 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
6732 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
6733 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
6734 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
6735 multi-threaded program.
6736
6737 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
6738 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
6739 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
6740 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
6741 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
6742 line number.
6743
6744 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
6745 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
6746
6747 @smallexample
6748 @group
6749 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
6750 at builtin.c:993
6751 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
6752 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
6753 at macro.c:71
6754 (More stack frames follow...)
6755 @end group
6756 @end smallexample
6757
6758 @noindent
6759 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
6760 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
6761 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
6762
6763 @noindent
6764 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
6765 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
6766 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
6767 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
6768 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
6769
6770 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
6771 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
6772 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
6773 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
6774 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
6775 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
6776 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
6777 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
6778 such a backtrace might look like:
6779
6780 @smallexample
6781 @group
6782 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
6783 at builtin.c:993
6784 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
6785 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
6786 at macro.c:71
6787 (More stack frames follow...)
6788 @end group
6789 @end smallexample
6790
6791 @noindent
6792 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
6793 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
6794
6795 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
6796 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
6797 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
6798
6799 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
6800 @cindex program entry point
6801 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
6802 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
6803 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
6804 @code{main}@footnote{
6805 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
6806 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
6807 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
6808 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
6809 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
6810 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
6811
6812 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
6813 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
6814
6815 @table @code
6816 @item set backtrace past-main
6817 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
6818 @kindex set backtrace
6819 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
6820
6821 @item set backtrace past-main off
6822 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
6823 default.
6824
6825 @item show backtrace past-main
6826 @kindex show backtrace
6827 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
6828
6829 @item set backtrace past-entry
6830 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
6831 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
6832 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
6833 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
6834
6835 @item set backtrace past-entry off
6836 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
6837 application. This is the default.
6838
6839 @item show backtrace past-entry
6840 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
6841
6842 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
6843 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
6844 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
6845 @cindex backtrace limit
6846 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
6847 or zero means unlimited levels.
6848
6849 @item show backtrace limit
6850 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
6851 @end table
6852
6853 You can control how file names are displayed.
6854
6855 @table @code
6856 @item set filename-display
6857 @itemx set filename-display relative
6858 @cindex filename-display
6859 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
6860
6861 @item set filename-display basename
6862 Display only basename of a filename.
6863
6864 @item set filename-display absolute
6865 Display an absolute filename.
6866
6867 @item show filename-display
6868 Show the current way to display filenames.
6869 @end table
6870
6871 @node Frame Filter Management
6872 @section Management of Frame Filters.
6873 @cindex managing frame filters
6874
6875 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
6876 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
6877
6878 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
6879 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
6880
6881 @table @code
6882 @kindex info frame-filter
6883 @item info frame-filter
6884 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
6885 their name, priority and enabled status.
6886
6887 @kindex disable frame-filter
6888 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
6889 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
6890 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
6891 @var{filter-dictionary}, or @code{all}, and @var{filter-name}.
6892 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
6893 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
6894 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
6895 across all dictionaries are disabled. @var{filter-name} is the name
6896 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
6897 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
6898 may be enabled again later.
6899
6900 @kindex enable frame-filter
6901 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
6902 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
6903 @var{filter-dictionary}, or @code{all}, and @var{filter-name}.
6904 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
6905 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
6906 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
6907 all dictionaries are enabled. @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
6908 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
6909 @var{filter-dictionary}.
6910
6911 Example:
6912
6913 @smallexample
6914 (gdb) info frame-filter
6915
6916 global frame-filters:
6917 Priority Enabled Name
6918 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
6919 100 Yes Reverse
6920
6921 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
6922 Priority Enabled Name
6923 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
6924
6925 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
6926 Priority Enabled Name
6927 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
6928
6929 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
6930 (gdb) info frame-filter
6931
6932 global frame-filters:
6933 Priority Enabled Name
6934 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
6935 100 Yes Reverse
6936
6937 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
6938 Priority Enabled Name
6939 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
6940
6941 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
6942 Priority Enabled Name
6943 999 No BuildProgramFilter
6944
6945 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
6946 (gdb) info frame-filter
6947
6948 global frame-filters:
6949 Priority Enabled Name
6950 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
6951 100 Yes Reverse
6952
6953 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
6954 Priority Enabled Name
6955 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
6956
6957 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
6958 Priority Enabled Name
6959 999 No BuildProgramFilter
6960 @end smallexample
6961
6962 @kindex set frame-filter priority
6963 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
6964 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
6965 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
6966 @var{filter-name}. @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
6967 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
6968 dictionary resides. @var{priority} is an integer.
6969
6970 @kindex show frame-filter priority
6971 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
6972 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
6973 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
6974 @var{filter-name}. @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
6975 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
6976 dictionary resides.
6977
6978 Example:
6979
6980 @smallexample
6981 (gdb) info frame-filter
6982
6983 global frame-filters:
6984 Priority Enabled Name
6985 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
6986 100 Yes Reverse
6987
6988 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
6989 Priority Enabled Name
6990 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
6991
6992 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
6993 Priority Enabled Name
6994 999 No BuildProgramFilter
6995
6996 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
6997 (gdb) info frame-filter
6998
6999 global frame-filters:
7000 Priority Enabled Name
7001 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7002 50 Yes Reverse
7003
7004 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7005 Priority Enabled Name
7006 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7007
7008 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7009 Priority Enabled Name
7010 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7011 @end smallexample
7012 @end table
7013
7014 @node Selection
7015 @section Selecting a Frame
7016
7017 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7018 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7019 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7020 of the stack frame just selected.
7021
7022 @table @code
7023 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7024 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7025 @item frame @var{n}
7026 @itemx f @var{n}
7027 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7028 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7029 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7030 @code{main}.
7031
7032 @item frame @var{addr}
7033 @itemx f @var{addr}
7034 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7035 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7036 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7037 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7038 switches between them.
7039
7040 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
7041 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
7042
7043 On the @acronym{MIPS} and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
7044 pointer and a program counter.
7045
7046 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
7047 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
7048
7049 @kindex up
7050 @item up @var{n}
7051 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
7052 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
7053 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
7054
7055 @kindex down
7056 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7057 @item down @var{n}
7058 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
7059 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
7060 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
7061 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7062 @end table
7063
7064 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7065 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7066 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7067 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7068
7069 @need 1000
7070 For example:
7071
7072 @smallexample
7073 @group
7074 (@value{GDBP}) up
7075 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7076 at env.c:10
7077 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7078 @end group
7079 @end smallexample
7080
7081 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7082 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7083 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7084 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7085 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7086 for details.
7087
7088 @table @code
7089 @kindex down-silently
7090 @kindex up-silently
7091 @item up-silently @var{n}
7092 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7093 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7094 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7095 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7096 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7097 distracting.
7098 @end table
7099
7100 @node Frame Info
7101 @section Information About a Frame
7102
7103 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7104 stack frame.
7105
7106 @table @code
7107 @item frame
7108 @itemx f
7109 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7110 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7111 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7112 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7113 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7114
7115 @kindex info frame
7116 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7117 @item info frame
7118 @itemx info f
7119 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7120 including:
7121
7122 @itemize @bullet
7123 @item
7124 the address of the frame
7125 @item
7126 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7127 @item
7128 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7129 @item
7130 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7131 @item
7132 the address of the frame's arguments
7133 @item
7134 the address of the frame's local variables
7135 @item
7136 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7137 @item
7138 which registers were saved in the frame
7139 @end itemize
7140
7141 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7142 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7143 the usual conventions.
7144
7145 @item info frame @var{addr}
7146 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7147 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7148 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7149 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7150 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7151 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7152
7153 @kindex info args
7154 @item info args
7155 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7156
7157 @item info locals
7158 @kindex info locals
7159 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7160 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7161 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7162
7163 @end table
7164
7165
7166 @node Source
7167 @chapter Examining Source Files
7168
7169 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7170 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7171 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7172 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7173 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7174 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7175 source files by explicit command.
7176
7177 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7178 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7179 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7180
7181 @menu
7182 * List:: Printing source lines
7183 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7184 * Edit:: Editing source files
7185 * Search:: Searching source files
7186 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7187 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7188 @end menu
7189
7190 @node List
7191 @section Printing Source Lines
7192
7193 @kindex list
7194 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7195 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7196 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7197 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7198 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7199
7200 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7201
7202 @table @code
7203 @item list @var{linenum}
7204 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7205 current source file.
7206
7207 @item list @var{function}
7208 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7209 @var{function}.
7210
7211 @item list
7212 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7213 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7214 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7215 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7216 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7217
7218 @item list -
7219 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7220 @end table
7221
7222 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7223 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7224 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7225
7226 @table @code
7227 @kindex set listsize
7228 @item set listsize @var{count}
7229 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7230 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7231 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7232 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7233
7234 @kindex show listsize
7235 @item show listsize
7236 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7237 @end table
7238
7239 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7240 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7241 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7242 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7243 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7244
7245 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7246 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
7247 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7248 to specify some source line.
7249
7250 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7251
7252 @table @code
7253 @item list @var{linespec}
7254 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
7255
7256 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7257 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7258 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
7259 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
7260 the same source file as the first linespec.
7261
7262 @item list ,@var{last}
7263 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7264
7265 @item list @var{first},
7266 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7267
7268 @item list +
7269 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7270
7271 @item list -
7272 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7273
7274 @item list
7275 As described in the preceding table.
7276 @end table
7277
7278 @node Specify Location
7279 @section Specifying a Location
7280 @cindex specifying location
7281 @cindex linespec
7282
7283 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7284 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7285 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
7286 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
7287
7288 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
7289 @value{GDBN} understands:
7290
7291 @table @code
7292 @item @var{linenum}
7293 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7294
7295 @item -@var{offset}
7296 @itemx +@var{offset}
7297 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7298 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7299 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7300 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7301 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7302 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7303 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7304 linespec.
7305
7306 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7307 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7308 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7309 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7310 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7311 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7312 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7313
7314 @item @var{function}
7315 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7316 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7317
7318 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7319 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7320
7321 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7322 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7323 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7324 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7325 functions in different source files.
7326
7327 @item @var{label}
7328 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears.
7329 @value{GDBN} searches for the label in the function corresponding to
7330 the currently selected stack frame. If there is no current selected
7331 stack frame (for instance, if the inferior is not running), then
7332 @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7333
7334 @item *@var{address}
7335 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
7336 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
7337 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
7338 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7339 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7340 source files.
7341
7342 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7343 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7344 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7345 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
7346 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
7347 of @var{address}:
7348
7349 @table @code
7350 @item @var{expression}
7351 Any expression valid in the current working language.
7352
7353 @item @var{funcaddr}
7354 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
7355 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7356 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7357 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7358 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7359 (although the Pascal form also works).
7360
7361 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7362 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7363
7364 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
7365 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7366 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
7367 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7368 functions with identical names in different source files.
7369 @end table
7370
7371 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7372 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7373 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7374 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7375 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7376 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7377
7378 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7379 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7380 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7381 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7382 each one of those probes.
7383
7384 @end table
7385
7386
7387 @node Edit
7388 @section Editing Source Files
7389 @cindex editing source files
7390
7391 @kindex edit
7392 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7393 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7394 The editing program of your choice
7395 is invoked with the current line set to
7396 the active line in the program.
7397 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
7398 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
7399
7400 @table @code
7401 @item edit @var{location}
7402 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
7403 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
7404 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
7405 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
7406 command most commonly used:
7407
7408 @table @code
7409 @item edit @var{number}
7410 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
7411
7412 @item edit @var{function}
7413 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
7414 @end table
7415
7416 @end table
7417
7418 @subsection Choosing your Editor
7419 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
7420 @footnote{
7421 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
7422 following command-line syntax:
7423 @smallexample
7424 ex +@var{number} file
7425 @end smallexample
7426 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
7427 the file where to start editing.}.
7428 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
7429 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
7430 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
7431 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
7432 @smallexample
7433 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
7434 export EDITOR
7435 gdb @dots{}
7436 @end smallexample
7437 or in the @code{csh} shell,
7438 @smallexample
7439 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
7440 gdb @dots{}
7441 @end smallexample
7442
7443 @node Search
7444 @section Searching Source Files
7445 @cindex searching source files
7446
7447 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
7448 regular expression.
7449
7450 @table @code
7451 @kindex search
7452 @kindex forward-search
7453 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
7454 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
7455 @itemx search @var{regexp}
7456 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
7457 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
7458 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
7459 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
7460 @code{fo}.
7461
7462 @kindex reverse-search
7463 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
7464 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
7465 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
7466 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
7467 this command as @code{rev}.
7468 @end table
7469
7470 @node Source Path
7471 @section Specifying Source Directories
7472
7473 @cindex source path
7474 @cindex directories for source files
7475 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
7476 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
7477 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
7478 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
7479 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
7480 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
7481 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
7482
7483 For example, suppose an executable references the file
7484 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
7485 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
7486 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
7487 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
7488 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
7489 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
7490 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
7491 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
7492 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
7493 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
7494
7495 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
7496 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
7497 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
7498 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
7499 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
7500 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
7501
7502 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
7503 source files.
7504
7505 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
7506 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
7507 each line is in the file.
7508
7509 @kindex directory
7510 @kindex dir
7511 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
7512 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
7513 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
7514
7515 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
7516 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
7517
7518 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
7519 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
7520 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
7521 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
7522 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
7523 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
7524 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
7525 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
7526 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
7527 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
7528 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
7529 name to look up the sources.
7530
7531 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
7532 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
7533 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
7534 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
7535 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
7536 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
7537 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
7538 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
7539
7540 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
7541 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
7542 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
7543 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
7544 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
7545 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
7546 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
7547
7548 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
7549 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
7550 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
7551 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
7552 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
7553 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
7554 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
7555 command.
7556
7557 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
7558 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
7559 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
7560 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
7561 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
7562 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
7563 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
7564
7565 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
7566 @cindex default source path substitution
7567 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
7568 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
7569 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
7570 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
7571 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
7572 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
7573 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
7574 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
7575 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
7576 together.
7577
7578 @table @code
7579 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
7580 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
7581 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
7582 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
7583 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
7584 part of absolute file names) or
7585 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
7586 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
7587
7588 @kindex cdir
7589 @kindex cwd
7590 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
7591 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
7592 @cindex compilation directory
7593 @cindex current directory
7594 @cindex working directory
7595 @cindex directory, current
7596 @cindex directory, compilation
7597 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
7598 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
7599 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
7600 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
7601 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
7602 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
7603
7604 @item directory
7605 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
7606
7607 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
7608 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
7609
7610 @item set directories @var{path-list}
7611 @kindex set directories
7612 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
7613 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
7614
7615 @item show directories
7616 @kindex show directories
7617 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
7618
7619 @anchor{set substitute-path}
7620 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
7621 @kindex set substitute-path
7622 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
7623 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
7624 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
7625
7626 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
7627 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
7628
7629 @smallexample
7630 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
7631 @end smallexample
7632
7633 @noindent
7634 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
7635 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
7636 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
7637
7638 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
7639 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
7640 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
7641 the substitution.
7642
7643 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
7644
7645 @smallexample
7646 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
7647 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
7648 @end smallexample
7649
7650 @noindent
7651 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
7652 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
7653 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
7654 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
7655
7656
7657 @item unset substitute-path [path]
7658 @kindex unset substitute-path
7659 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
7660 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
7661 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
7662
7663 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
7664
7665 @item show substitute-path [path]
7666 @kindex show substitute-path
7667 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
7668 which would rewrite that path, if any.
7669
7670 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
7671 rules.
7672
7673 @end table
7674
7675 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
7676 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
7677 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
7678
7679 @enumerate
7680 @item
7681 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
7682
7683 @item
7684 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
7685 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
7686 directories in one command.
7687 @end enumerate
7688
7689 @node Machine Code
7690 @section Source and Machine Code
7691 @cindex source line and its code address
7692
7693 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
7694 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
7695 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
7696 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
7697 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
7698 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
7699 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
7700 well as hex.
7701
7702 @table @code
7703 @kindex info line
7704 @item info line @var{linespec}
7705 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
7706 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
7707 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
7708 @end table
7709
7710 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
7711 the object code for the first line of function
7712 @code{m4_changequote}:
7713
7714 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
7715 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
7716 @smallexample
7717 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
7718 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
7719 @end smallexample
7720
7721 @noindent
7722 @cindex code address and its source line
7723 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
7724 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
7725 @smallexample
7726 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
7727 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
7728 @end smallexample
7729
7730 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
7731 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
7732 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
7733 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
7734 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
7735 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
7736 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
7737 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
7738 Variables}).
7739
7740 @table @code
7741 @kindex disassemble
7742 @cindex assembly instructions
7743 @cindex instructions, assembly
7744 @cindex machine instructions
7745 @cindex listing machine instructions
7746 @item disassemble
7747 @itemx disassemble /m
7748 @itemx disassemble /r
7749 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
7750 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
7751 the @code{/m} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex as well as
7752 in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r}.
7753 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
7754 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
7755 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
7756 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
7757 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
7758 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
7759
7760 @table @code
7761 @item @var{start},@var{end}
7762 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
7763 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
7764 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
7765 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
7766 @end table
7767
7768 @noindent
7769 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
7770 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
7771
7772 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
7773 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
7774
7775 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
7776 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
7777 @end table
7778
7779 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
7780 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
7781
7782 @smallexample
7783 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
7784 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
7785 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
7786 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
7787 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
7788 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
7789 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
7790 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
7791 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
7792 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
7793 End of assembler dump.
7794 @end smallexample
7795
7796 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86, when the
7797 program is stopped just after function prologue:
7798
7799 @smallexample
7800 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
7801 Dump of assembler code for function main:
7802 5 @{
7803 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
7804 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
7805 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
7806 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
7807 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
7808
7809 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
7810 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
7811 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
7812
7813 7 return 0;
7814 8 @}
7815 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
7816 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
7817 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
7818
7819 End of assembler dump.
7820 @end smallexample
7821
7822 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
7823
7824 @smallexample
7825 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
7826 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
7827 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
7828 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
7829 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
7830 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
7831 End of assembler dump.
7832 @end smallexample
7833
7834 Addresses cannot be specified as a linespec (@pxref{Specify Location}).
7835 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
7836 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
7837 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
7838
7839 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
7840 mnemonics or other syntax.
7841
7842 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
7843 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
7844 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
7845 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
7846 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
7847
7848 @table @code
7849 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
7850 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
7851 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
7852 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
7853 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
7854 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
7855
7856 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
7857 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
7858 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
7859 assemblers for x86-based targets.
7860
7861 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
7862 @item show disassembly-flavor
7863 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
7864 @end table
7865
7866 @table @code
7867 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
7868 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
7869 @item set disassemble-next-line
7870 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
7871 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
7872 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
7873 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
7874 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
7875 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
7876 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
7877 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
7878 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
7879 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
7880 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
7881 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
7882 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
7883 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
7884 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
7885 instruction.
7886 @end table
7887
7888
7889 @node Data
7890 @chapter Examining Data
7891
7892 @cindex printing data
7893 @cindex examining data
7894 @kindex print
7895 @kindex inspect
7896 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7897 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
7898 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
7899 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
7900 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
7901 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
7902
7903 @table @code
7904 @item print @var{expr}
7905 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
7906 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
7907 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
7908 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
7909 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
7910 Formats}.
7911
7912 @item print
7913 @itemx print /@var{f}
7914 @cindex reprint the last value
7915 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
7916 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
7917 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
7918 @end table
7919
7920 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
7921 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
7922 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
7923
7924 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
7925 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
7926 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7927 Table}.
7928
7929 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
7930 @kindex explore
7931 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
7932 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
7933 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
7934 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
7935 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
7936 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
7937 embedded in the higher level data types.
7938
7939 @table @code
7940 @item explore @var{arg}
7941 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
7942 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
7943 @end table
7944
7945 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
7946 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
7947 C program as
7948
7949 @smallexample
7950 struct SimpleStruct
7951 @{
7952 int i;
7953 double d;
7954 @};
7955
7956 struct ComplexStruct
7957 @{
7958 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
7959 int arr[10];
7960 @};
7961 @end smallexample
7962
7963 @noindent
7964 followed by variable declarations as
7965
7966 @smallexample
7967 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
7968 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
7969 @end smallexample
7970
7971 @noindent
7972 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
7973 @code{explore} command as follows.
7974
7975 @smallexample
7976 (gdb) explore cs
7977 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
7978 the following fields:
7979
7980 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
7981 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
7982
7983 Enter the field number of choice:
7984 @end smallexample
7985
7986 @noindent
7987 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
7988 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
7989 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
7990 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
7991 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
7992 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
7993 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
7994 field will be explored as if it were an array.
7995
7996 @smallexample
7997 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
7998 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
7999 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8000 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8001
8002 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8003 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8004
8005 Press enter to return to parent value:
8006 @end smallexample
8007
8008 @noindent
8009 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8010 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8011 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8012 to explore.
8013
8014 @smallexample
8015 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8016 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8017
8018 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8019
8020 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8021
8022 Press enter to return to parent value:
8023 @end smallexample
8024
8025 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8026 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8027 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8028 level data structure).
8029
8030 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8031 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8032 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8033 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8034 same example as above, your can explore the type
8035 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8036 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8037
8038 @smallexample
8039 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8040 @end smallexample
8041
8042 @noindent
8043 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8044 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8045 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8046 example.
8047
8048 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8049 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8050 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8051 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8052 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8053
8054 @table @code
8055 @item explore value @var{expr}
8056 @cindex explore value
8057 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8058 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8059 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8060 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8061 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8062
8063 @item explore type @var{arg}
8064 @cindex explore type
8065 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8066 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8067 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8068 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8069 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8070 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8071 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8072 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8073 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8074 @end table
8075
8076 @menu
8077 * Expressions:: Expressions
8078 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8079 * Variables:: Program variables
8080 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8081 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8082 * Memory:: Examining memory
8083 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8084 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8085 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8086 * Value History:: Value history
8087 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8088 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8089 * Registers:: Registers
8090 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8091 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8092 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8093 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8094 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8095 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8096 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8097 character set than GDB does
8098 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8099 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8100 @end menu
8101
8102 @node Expressions
8103 @section Expressions
8104
8105 @cindex expressions
8106 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8107 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8108 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8109 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8110 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8111 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8112 @ref{Compilation}.
8113
8114 @cindex arrays in expressions
8115 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8116 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8117 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8118 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8119 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8120 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8121
8122 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8123 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8124 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8125 languages.
8126
8127 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8128 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8129
8130 @cindex casts, in expressions
8131 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8132 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8133 at that address in memory.
8134 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8135
8136 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8137 to programming languages:
8138
8139 @table @code
8140 @item @@
8141 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8142 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8143
8144 @item ::
8145 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8146 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8147
8148 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8149 @cindex type casting memory
8150 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8151 @cindex casts, to view memory
8152 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8153 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8154 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
8155 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
8156 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
8157 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8158 @end table
8159
8160 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8161 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8162 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8163
8164 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8165 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8166 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8167 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8168 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8169 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8170 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8171
8172 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8173 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8174 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8175 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8176 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8177 as well.
8178
8179 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8180 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8181 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8182 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8183 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8184 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8185 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8186 choices.
8187
8188 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8189 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8190 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8191
8192 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8193 @smallexample
8194 @group
8195 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8196 [0] cancel
8197 [1] all
8198 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8199 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8200 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8201 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8202 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8203 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8204 > 2 4 6
8205 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8206 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8207 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8208 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8209 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8210 breakpoints.
8211 (@value{GDBP})
8212 @end group
8213 @end smallexample
8214
8215 @table @code
8216 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8217 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8218 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8219
8220 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8221 is ambiguous.
8222
8223 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8224 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8225 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8226 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8227 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8228 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8229 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8230 in the use of the menu.
8231
8232 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8233 when an ambiguity is detected.
8234
8235 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8236 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8237
8238 @kindex show multiple-symbols
8239 @item show multiple-symbols
8240 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8241 @end table
8242
8243 @node Variables
8244 @section Program Variables
8245
8246 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8247 in your program.
8248
8249 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8250 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8251
8252 @itemize @bullet
8253 @item
8254 global (or file-static)
8255 @end itemize
8256
8257 @noindent or
8258
8259 @itemize @bullet
8260 @item
8261 visible according to the scope rules of the
8262 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8263 @end itemize
8264
8265 @noindent This means that in the function
8266
8267 @smallexample
8268 foo (a)
8269 int a;
8270 @{
8271 bar (a);
8272 @{
8273 int b = test ();
8274 bar (b);
8275 @}
8276 @}
8277 @end smallexample
8278
8279 @noindent
8280 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8281 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8282 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
8283 the block where @code{b} is declared.
8284
8285 @cindex variable name conflict
8286 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
8287 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
8288 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
8289 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
8290 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
8291 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
8292 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
8293
8294 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
8295 @ifnotinfo
8296 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
8297 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
8298 @end ifnotinfo
8299 @smallexample
8300 @var{file}::@var{variable}
8301 @var{function}::@var{variable}
8302 @end smallexample
8303
8304 @noindent
8305 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
8306 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
8307 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
8308 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
8309
8310 @smallexample
8311 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
8312 @end smallexample
8313
8314 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
8315 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
8316 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
8317 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
8318 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
8319
8320 @smallexample
8321 void
8322 foo (int a)
8323 @{
8324 if (a < 10)
8325 bar (a);
8326 else
8327 process (a); /* Stop here */
8328 @}
8329
8330 int
8331 bar (int a)
8332 @{
8333 foo (a + 5);
8334 @}
8335 @end smallexample
8336
8337 @noindent
8338 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
8339 here is what you might see
8340 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
8341
8342 @smallexample
8343 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8344 $1 = 10
8345 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8346 $2 = 5
8347 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
8348 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
8349 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8350 $3 = 5
8351 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8352 $4 = 0
8353 @end smallexample
8354
8355 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
8356 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
8357 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
8358 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
8359 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
8360
8361 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
8362 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
8363 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
8364 @code{some_global}.
8365
8366 @smallexample
8367 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
8368 $1 = 23
8369 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
8370 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
8371 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
8372 $2 = 27
8373 @end smallexample
8374
8375 @cindex wrong values
8376 @cindex variable values, wrong
8377 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
8378 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
8379 @quotation
8380 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
8381 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
8382 scope, and just before exit.
8383 @end quotation
8384 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
8385 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
8386 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
8387 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
8388 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
8389 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
8390 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
8391 variable definitions may be gone.
8392
8393 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
8394 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
8395 when compiling.
8396
8397 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
8398 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
8399 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
8400 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
8401 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
8402 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
8403 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
8404
8405 @smallexample
8406 No symbol "foo" in current context.
8407 @end smallexample
8408
8409 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
8410 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
8411 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
8412 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
8413 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
8414
8415 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
8416 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
8417 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
8418 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
8419
8420 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
8421 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
8422 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
8423 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
8424 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
8425
8426 @smallexample
8427 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
8428 29 i++;
8429 (gdb) next
8430 30 e (i);
8431 (gdb) print i
8432 $1 = 31
8433 (gdb) print i@@entry
8434 $2 = 30
8435 @end smallexample
8436
8437 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
8438 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
8439 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
8440 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
8441 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
8442 For program code
8443
8444 @smallexample
8445 char var0[] = "A";
8446 signed char var1[] = "A";
8447 @end smallexample
8448
8449 You get during debugging
8450 @smallexample
8451 (gdb) print var0
8452 $1 = "A"
8453 (gdb) print var1
8454 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
8455 @end smallexample
8456
8457 @node Arrays
8458 @section Artificial Arrays
8459
8460 @cindex artificial array
8461 @cindex arrays
8462 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
8463 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
8464 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
8465 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
8466 program.
8467
8468 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
8469 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
8470 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
8471 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
8472 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
8473 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
8474 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
8475 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
8476 example. If a program says
8477
8478 @smallexample
8479 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
8480 @end smallexample
8481
8482 @noindent
8483 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
8484
8485 @smallexample
8486 p *array@@len
8487 @end smallexample
8488
8489 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
8490 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
8491 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
8492 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
8493 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
8494
8495 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
8496 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
8497 The value need not be in memory:
8498 @smallexample
8499 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
8500 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8501 @end smallexample
8502
8503 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
8504 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
8505 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
8506 @smallexample
8507 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
8508 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8509 @end smallexample
8510
8511 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
8512 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
8513 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
8514 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
8515 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8516 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
8517 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
8518 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
8519 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
8520 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
8521
8522 @smallexample
8523 set $i = 0
8524 p dtab[$i++]->fv
8525 @key{RET}
8526 @key{RET}
8527 @dots{}
8528 @end smallexample
8529
8530 @node Output Formats
8531 @section Output Formats
8532
8533 @cindex formatted output
8534 @cindex output formats
8535 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
8536 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
8537 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
8538 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
8539 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
8540
8541 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
8542 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
8543 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
8544 letters supported are:
8545
8546 @table @code
8547 @item x
8548 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
8549 hexadecimal.
8550
8551 @item d
8552 Print as integer in signed decimal.
8553
8554 @item u
8555 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
8556
8557 @item o
8558 Print as integer in octal.
8559
8560 @item t
8561 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
8562 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
8563 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
8564 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
8565
8566 @item a
8567 @cindex unknown address, locating
8568 @cindex locate address
8569 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
8570 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
8571 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
8572
8573 @smallexample
8574 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
8575 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
8576 @end smallexample
8577
8578 @noindent
8579 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
8580 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
8581
8582 @item c
8583 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
8584 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
8585 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
8586 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
8587
8588 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
8589 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
8590 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
8591 data.
8592
8593 @item f
8594 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
8595 using typical floating point syntax.
8596
8597 @item s
8598 @cindex printing strings
8599 @cindex printing byte arrays
8600 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
8601 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
8602 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
8603 natural types.
8604
8605 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
8606 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
8607 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
8608 array.
8609
8610 @item z
8611 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
8612 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
8613 to the size of the integer type.
8614
8615 @item r
8616 @cindex raw printing
8617 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
8618 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
8619 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
8620 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
8621 pretty-printer which might exist.
8622 @end table
8623
8624 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
8625
8626 @smallexample
8627 p/x $pc
8628 @end smallexample
8629
8630 @noindent
8631 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
8632 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
8633
8634 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
8635 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
8636 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
8637
8638 @node Memory
8639 @section Examining Memory
8640
8641 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
8642 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
8643
8644 @cindex examining memory
8645 @table @code
8646 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
8647 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
8648 @itemx x @var{addr}
8649 @itemx x
8650 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
8651 @end table
8652
8653 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
8654 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
8655 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
8656 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
8657 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
8658
8659 @table @r
8660 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
8661 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
8662 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
8663 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
8664 @c 4.1.2.
8665
8666 @item @var{f}, the display format
8667 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
8668 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
8669 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
8670 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
8671 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
8672
8673 @item @var{u}, the unit size
8674 The unit size is any of
8675
8676 @table @code
8677 @item b
8678 Bytes.
8679 @item h
8680 Halfwords (two bytes).
8681 @item w
8682 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
8683 @item g
8684 Giant words (eight bytes).
8685 @end table
8686
8687 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
8688 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
8689 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
8690 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
8691 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
8692 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
8693 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
8694 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
8695 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
8696 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
8697 be altered.
8698
8699 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
8700 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
8701 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
8702 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
8703 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
8704 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
8705 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
8706 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
8707 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
8708 a value from memory).
8709 @end table
8710
8711 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
8712 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
8713 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
8714 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
8715 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
8716
8717 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
8718 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
8719 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
8720 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
8721 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
8722
8723 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
8724 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
8725 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
8726 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
8727 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
8728 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
8729 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
8730 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
8731 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
8732
8733 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
8734 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
8735 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
8736 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
8737 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
8738 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
8739 for successive uses of @code{x}.
8740
8741 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
8742 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
8743
8744 @smallexample
8745 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
8746 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
8747 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
8748 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
8749 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
8750 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
8751 @end smallexample
8752
8753 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
8754 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
8755 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
8756 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
8757 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
8758 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
8759 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
8760 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
8761 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
8762
8763 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
8764 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
8765 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
8766
8767 @cindex remote memory comparison
8768 @cindex verify remote memory image
8769 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
8770 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
8771 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
8772 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
8773 situations.
8774
8775 @table @code
8776 @kindex compare-sections
8777 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
8778 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
8779 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
8780 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
8781 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
8782 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections. This command's
8783 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
8784 remote request.
8785 @end table
8786
8787 @node Auto Display
8788 @section Automatic Display
8789 @cindex automatic display
8790 @cindex display of expressions
8791
8792 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
8793 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
8794 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
8795 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
8796 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
8797 The automatic display looks like this:
8798
8799 @smallexample
8800 2: foo = 38
8801 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
8802 @end smallexample
8803
8804 @noindent
8805 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
8806 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
8807 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
8808 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
8809 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
8810 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
8811
8812 @table @code
8813 @kindex display
8814 @item display @var{expr}
8815 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
8816 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8817
8818 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
8819
8820 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
8821 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
8822 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
8823 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
8824 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
8825
8826 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
8827 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
8828 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
8829 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
8830 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8831 @end table
8832
8833 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
8834 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
8835 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
8836
8837 @table @code
8838 @kindex delete display
8839 @kindex undisplay
8840 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
8841 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
8842 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
8843 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
8844 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
8845 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
8846 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
8847
8848 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
8849 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
8850
8851 @kindex disable display
8852 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
8853 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
8854 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
8855 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
8856 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
8857 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
8858 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
8859 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
8860
8861 @kindex enable display
8862 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
8863 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
8864 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
8865 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
8866 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
8867 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
8868 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
8869
8870 @item display
8871 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
8872 done when your program stops.
8873
8874 @kindex info display
8875 @item info display
8876 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
8877 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
8878 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
8879 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
8880 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
8881 @end table
8882
8883 @cindex display disabled out of scope
8884 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
8885 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
8886 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
8887 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
8888 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
8889 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
8890 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
8891 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
8892 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
8893 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
8894
8895 @node Print Settings
8896 @section Print Settings
8897
8898 @cindex format options
8899 @cindex print settings
8900 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
8901 and symbols are printed.
8902
8903 @noindent
8904 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
8905
8906 @table @code
8907 @kindex set print
8908 @item set print address
8909 @itemx set print address on
8910 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
8911 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
8912 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
8913 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
8914 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
8915 @code{set print address on}:
8916
8917 @smallexample
8918 @group
8919 (@value{GDBP}) f
8920 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
8921 at input.c:530
8922 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
8923 @end group
8924 @end smallexample
8925
8926 @item set print address off
8927 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
8928 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
8929
8930 @smallexample
8931 @group
8932 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
8933 (@value{GDBP}) f
8934 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
8935 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
8936 @end group
8937 @end smallexample
8938
8939 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
8940 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
8941 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
8942 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
8943
8944 @kindex show print
8945 @item show print address
8946 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
8947 @end table
8948
8949 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
8950 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
8951 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
8952 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
8953 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
8954 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
8955 it prints a symbolic address:
8956
8957 @table @code
8958 @item set print symbol-filename on
8959 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
8960 @cindex symbol, source file and line
8961 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
8962 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
8963
8964 @item set print symbol-filename off
8965 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
8966 default.
8967
8968 @item show print symbol-filename
8969 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
8970 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
8971 @end table
8972
8973 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
8974 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
8975 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
8976
8977 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
8978 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
8979
8980 @table @code
8981 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
8982 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
8983 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
8984 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
8985 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
8986 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
8987 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
8988 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
8989
8990 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
8991 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
8992 symbolic address.
8993 @end table
8994
8995 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
8996 @cindex pointer, finding referent
8997 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
8998 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
8999 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9000 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9001 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9002 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9003
9004 @smallexample
9005 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9006 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9007 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9008 @end smallexample
9009
9010 @quotation
9011 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9012 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9013 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9014 @end quotation
9015
9016 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9017 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9018
9019 @table @code
9020 @item set print symbol on
9021 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9022 one exists.
9023
9024 @item set print symbol off
9025 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9026 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9027 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9028
9029 @item show print symbol
9030 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9031 address.
9032 @end table
9033
9034 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9035
9036 @table @code
9037 @item set print array
9038 @itemx set print array on
9039 @cindex pretty print arrays
9040 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9041 but uses more space. The default is off.
9042
9043 @item set print array off
9044 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9045
9046 @item show print array
9047 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9048 arrays.
9049
9050 @cindex print array indexes
9051 @item set print array-indexes
9052 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9053 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9054 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9055 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9056
9057 @item set print array-indexes off
9058 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9059
9060 @item show print array-indexes
9061 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9062 arrays.
9063
9064 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9065 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9066 @cindex number of array elements to print
9067 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9068 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9069 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9070 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9071 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9072 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9073 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9074 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9075
9076 @item show print elements
9077 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9078 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9079
9080 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9081 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9082 @cindex printing frame argument values
9083 @cindex print all frame argument values
9084 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9085 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9086 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9087 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9088 values are:
9089
9090 @table @code
9091 @item all
9092 The values of all arguments are printed.
9093
9094 @item scalars
9095 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9096 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9097 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9098 only scalar arguments are shown:
9099
9100 @smallexample
9101 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9102 at frame-args.c:23
9103 @end smallexample
9104
9105 @item none
9106 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9107 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9108
9109 @smallexample
9110 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9111 at frame-args.c:23
9112 @end smallexample
9113 @end table
9114
9115 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9116 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9117 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9118 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9119 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9120 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9121 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9122 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9123 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9124 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9125
9126 @item show print frame-arguments
9127 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9128
9129 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9130 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9131
9132 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9133 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9134 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9135 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9136 This is the default.
9137
9138 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9139 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9140
9141 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9142 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9143 @kindex set print entry-values
9144 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9145 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9146 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9147 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9148 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9149
9150 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9151 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9152 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9153 @code{no} setting.
9154
9155 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9156 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
9157 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9158 this information.
9159
9160 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9161
9162 @table @code
9163 @item no
9164 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9165 point.
9166 @smallexample
9167 #0 equal (val=5)
9168 #0 different (val=6)
9169 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9170 #0 born (val=10)
9171 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9172 @end smallexample
9173
9174 @item only
9175 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9176 values are never printed.
9177 @smallexample
9178 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9179 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9180 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9181 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9182 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9183 @end smallexample
9184
9185 @item preferred
9186 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9187 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9188 value for such parameter.
9189 @smallexample
9190 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9191 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9192 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9193 #0 born (val=10)
9194 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9195 @end smallexample
9196
9197 @item if-needed
9198 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9199 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9200 parameter.
9201 @smallexample
9202 #0 equal (val=5)
9203 #0 different (val=6)
9204 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9205 #0 born (val=10)
9206 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9207 @end smallexample
9208
9209 @item both
9210 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9211 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9212 optimizations.
9213 @smallexample
9214 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9215 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9216 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9217 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9218 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9219 @end smallexample
9220
9221 @item compact
9222 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9223 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
9224 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9225 values are known and identical, print the shortened
9226 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9227 @smallexample
9228 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9229 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9230 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9231 #0 born (val=10)
9232 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9233 @end smallexample
9234
9235 @item default
9236 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
9237 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
9238 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
9239 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9240 @smallexample
9241 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9242 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9243 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9244 #0 born (val=10)
9245 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9246 @end smallexample
9247 @end table
9248
9249 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
9250 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
9251
9252 @item show print entry-values
9253 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
9254 entry.
9255
9256 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
9257 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
9258 @cindex repeated array elements
9259 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
9260 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
9261 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
9262 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
9263 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
9264 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
9265 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
9266 is 10.
9267
9268 @item show print repeats
9269 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
9270 elements.
9271
9272 @item set print null-stop
9273 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
9274 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
9275 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
9276 contain only short strings.
9277 The default is off.
9278
9279 @item show print null-stop
9280 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
9281 @sc{null} character.
9282
9283 @item set print pretty on
9284 @cindex print structures in indented form
9285 @cindex indentation in structure display
9286 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
9287 per line, like this:
9288
9289 @smallexample
9290 @group
9291 $1 = @{
9292 next = 0x0,
9293 flags = @{
9294 sweet = 1,
9295 sour = 1
9296 @},
9297 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
9298 @}
9299 @end group
9300 @end smallexample
9301
9302 @item set print pretty off
9303 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
9304
9305 @smallexample
9306 @group
9307 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
9308 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
9309 @end group
9310 @end smallexample
9311
9312 @noindent
9313 This is the default format.
9314
9315 @item show print pretty
9316 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
9317
9318 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
9319 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
9320 @cindex octal escapes in strings
9321 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
9322 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
9323 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
9324 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
9325 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
9326
9327 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
9328 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
9329 international character sets, and is the default.
9330
9331 @item show print sevenbit-strings
9332 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
9333
9334 @item set print union on
9335 @cindex unions in structures, printing
9336 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
9337 and other unions. This is the default setting.
9338
9339 @item set print union off
9340 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
9341 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
9342 instead.
9343
9344 @item show print union
9345 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
9346 structures and other unions.
9347
9348 For example, given the declarations
9349
9350 @smallexample
9351 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
9352 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
9353 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
9354 Bug_forms;
9355
9356 struct thing @{
9357 Species it;
9358 union @{
9359 Tree_forms tree;
9360 Bug_forms bug;
9361 @} form;
9362 @};
9363
9364 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
9365 @end smallexample
9366
9367 @noindent
9368 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
9369
9370 @smallexample
9371 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
9372 @end smallexample
9373
9374 @noindent
9375 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
9376
9377 @smallexample
9378 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
9379 @end smallexample
9380
9381 @noindent
9382 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
9383 and in Pascal.
9384 @end table
9385
9386 @need 1000
9387 @noindent
9388 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
9389
9390 @table @code
9391 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
9392 @item set print demangle
9393 @itemx set print demangle on
9394 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
9395 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
9396 linkage. The default is on.
9397
9398 @item show print demangle
9399 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
9400
9401 @item set print asm-demangle
9402 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
9403 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
9404 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
9405 The default is off.
9406
9407 @item show print asm-demangle
9408 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
9409 or demangled form.
9410
9411 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
9412 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
9413 @kindex set demangle-style
9414 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
9415 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
9416 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
9417
9418 @table @code
9419 @item auto
9420 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
9421 This is the default.
9422
9423 @item gnu
9424 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
9425
9426 @item hp
9427 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
9428
9429 @item lucid
9430 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
9431
9432 @item arm
9433 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
9434 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
9435 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
9436 require further enhancement to permit that.
9437
9438 @end table
9439 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
9440
9441 @item show demangle-style
9442 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
9443
9444 @item set print object
9445 @itemx set print object on
9446 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
9447 @cindex display derived types
9448 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
9449 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
9450 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
9451 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
9452 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
9453 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
9454 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
9455
9456 @item set print object off
9457 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
9458 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
9459
9460 @item show print object
9461 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
9462
9463 @item set print static-members
9464 @itemx set print static-members on
9465 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
9466 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
9467
9468 @item set print static-members off
9469 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
9470
9471 @item show print static-members
9472 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
9473
9474 @item set print pascal_static-members
9475 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
9476 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
9477 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
9478 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
9479
9480 @item set print pascal_static-members off
9481 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
9482
9483 @item show print pascal_static-members
9484 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
9485
9486 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
9487 @item set print vtbl
9488 @itemx set print vtbl on
9489 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
9490 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
9491 @cindex VTBL display
9492 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
9493 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9494 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9495
9496 @item set print vtbl off
9497 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
9498
9499 @item show print vtbl
9500 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
9501 @end table
9502
9503 @node Pretty Printing
9504 @section Pretty Printing
9505
9506 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
9507 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
9508 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
9509
9510 @menu
9511 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
9512 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
9513 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
9514 @end menu
9515
9516 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
9517 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
9518
9519 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
9520 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
9521 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
9522
9523 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
9524 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
9525 pretty-printers with their names.
9526 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
9527 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
9528 Each such subprinter has its own name.
9529 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
9530
9531 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
9532 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
9533 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
9534 do anything special.
9535
9536 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
9537
9538 @itemize @bullet
9539 @item
9540 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
9541 all inferiors.
9542
9543 @item
9544 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
9545 when debugging that program.
9546 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
9547
9548 @item
9549 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
9550 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
9551 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
9552 @end itemize
9553
9554 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
9555 pretty-printers are selected,
9556
9557 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
9558 for new types.
9559
9560 @node Pretty-Printer Example
9561 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
9562
9563 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
9564
9565 @smallexample
9566 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9567 $1 = @{
9568 static npos = 4294967295,
9569 _M_dataplus = @{
9570 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
9571 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
9572 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
9573 @},
9574 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
9575 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
9576 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
9577 @}
9578 @}
9579 @end smallexample
9580
9581 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
9582
9583 @smallexample
9584 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9585 $2 = "abcd"
9586 @end smallexample
9587
9588 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
9589 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
9590 @cindex pretty-printer commands
9591
9592 @table @code
9593 @kindex info pretty-printer
9594 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9595 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
9596 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
9597
9598 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
9599 whose pretty-printers to list.
9600 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
9601 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
9602 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
9603 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
9604 looks up a printer from these three objects.
9605
9606 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
9607 to list.
9608
9609 @kindex disable pretty-printer
9610 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9611 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9612 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
9613
9614 @kindex enable pretty-printer
9615 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9616 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9617 @end table
9618
9619 Example:
9620
9621 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
9622 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
9623 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
9624 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
9625
9626 @smallexample
9627 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9628 library1.so:
9629 foo
9630 library2.so:
9631 bar
9632 bar1
9633 bar2
9634 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9635 library2.so:
9636 bar
9637 bar1
9638 bar2
9639 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
9640 1 printer disabled
9641 2 of 3 printers enabled
9642 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9643 library1.so:
9644 foo [disabled]
9645 library2.so:
9646 bar
9647 bar1
9648 bar2
9649 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
9650 1 printer disabled
9651 1 of 3 printers enabled
9652 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9653 library1.so:
9654 foo [disabled]
9655 library2.so:
9656 bar
9657 bar1 [disabled]
9658 bar2
9659 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
9660 1 printer disabled
9661 0 of 3 printers enabled
9662 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9663 library1.so:
9664 foo [disabled]
9665 library2.so:
9666 bar [disabled]
9667 bar1 [disabled]
9668 bar2
9669 @end smallexample
9670
9671 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
9672 as can each individual subprinter.
9673
9674 @node Value History
9675 @section Value History
9676
9677 @cindex value history
9678 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
9679 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
9680 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
9681 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
9682 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
9683 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
9684 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
9685 symbol table.
9686
9687 @cindex @code{$}
9688 @cindex @code{$$}
9689 @cindex history number
9690 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
9691 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
9692 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
9693 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
9694 history number.
9695
9696 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
9697 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
9698 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
9699 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
9700 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
9701 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
9702 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
9703
9704 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
9705 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
9706
9707 @smallexample
9708 p *$
9709 @end smallexample
9710
9711 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
9712 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
9713
9714 @smallexample
9715 p *$.next
9716 @end smallexample
9717
9718 @noindent
9719 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
9720 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
9721
9722 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
9723 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
9724
9725 @smallexample
9726 print x
9727 set x=5
9728 @end smallexample
9729
9730 @noindent
9731 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
9732 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
9733
9734 @table @code
9735 @kindex show values
9736 @item show values
9737 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
9738 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
9739 values} does not change the history.
9740
9741 @item show values @var{n}
9742 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
9743
9744 @item show values +
9745 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
9746 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
9747 @end table
9748
9749 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
9750 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
9751
9752 @node Convenience Vars
9753 @section Convenience Variables
9754
9755 @cindex convenience variables
9756 @cindex user-defined variables
9757 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
9758 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
9759 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
9760 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
9761 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
9762
9763 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
9764 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
9765 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9766 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
9767 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
9768
9769 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
9770 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
9771 For example:
9772
9773 @smallexample
9774 set $foo = *object_ptr
9775 @end smallexample
9776
9777 @noindent
9778 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
9779 @code{object_ptr}.
9780
9781 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
9782 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
9783 value with another assignment at any time.
9784
9785 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
9786 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
9787 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
9788 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
9789
9790 @table @code
9791 @kindex show convenience
9792 @cindex show all user variables and functions
9793 @item show convenience
9794 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
9795 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
9796 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
9797
9798 @kindex init-if-undefined
9799 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
9800 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
9801 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
9802 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
9803 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
9804 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
9805 override default values used in a command script.
9806
9807 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
9808 any side-effects do not occur.
9809 @end table
9810
9811 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
9812 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
9813 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
9814
9815 @smallexample
9816 set $i = 0
9817 print bar[$i++]->contents
9818 @end smallexample
9819
9820 @noindent
9821 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
9822
9823 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
9824 values likely to be useful.
9825
9826 @table @code
9827 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
9828 @item $_
9829 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
9830 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
9831 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
9832 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
9833 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
9834 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
9835 to the type of @code{$__}.
9836
9837 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
9838 @item $__
9839 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
9840 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
9841 to match the format in which the data was printed.
9842
9843 @item $_exitcode
9844 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
9845 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
9846 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
9847 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
9848
9849 @item $_exitsignal
9850 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
9851 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
9852 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
9853 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
9854
9855 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
9856 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
9857 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
9858 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
9859 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
9860
9861 @smallexample
9862 #include <signal.h>
9863
9864 int
9865 main (int argc, char *argv[])
9866 @{
9867 raise (SIGALRM);
9868 return 0;
9869 @}
9870 @end smallexample
9871
9872 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
9873 or signalled would be:
9874
9875 @smallexample
9876 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
9877 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
9878 End with a line saying just ``end''.
9879 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
9880 >echo The program has exited\n
9881 >else
9882 >echo The program has signalled\n
9883 >end
9884 >end
9885 (@value{GDBP}) run
9886 Starting program:
9887
9888 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
9889 The program no longer exists.
9890 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
9891 The program has signalled
9892 @end smallexample
9893
9894 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
9895 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
9896 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
9897 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
9898
9899 @smallexample
9900 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
9901 The program has exited
9902 @end smallexample
9903
9904 @item $_exception
9905 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
9906 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
9907
9908 @item $_probe_argc
9909 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
9910 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
9911
9912 @item $_sdata
9913 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
9914 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
9915 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
9916 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
9917 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
9918
9919 @item $_siginfo
9920 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
9921 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
9922 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
9923 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
9924 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
9925
9926 @item $_tlb
9927 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
9928 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
9929 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
9930 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
9931 @xref{General Query Packets}.
9932 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
9933
9934 @end table
9935
9936 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
9937 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
9938 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
9939
9940 @node Convenience Funs
9941 @section Convenience Functions
9942
9943 @cindex convenience functions
9944 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
9945 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
9946 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
9947 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
9948 @value{GDBN}.
9949
9950 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
9951 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
9952
9953 @table @code
9954
9955 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
9956 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
9957 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
9958 returns zero.
9959
9960 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
9961 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
9962 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
9963 it is @code{void}:
9964
9965 @smallexample
9966 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
9967 $1 = void
9968 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
9969 $2 = 1
9970 (@value{GDBP}) run
9971 Starting program: ./a.out
9972 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
9973 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
9974 $3 = 0
9975 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
9976 $4 = 0
9977 @end smallexample
9978
9979 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
9980 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
9981 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
9982 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
9983 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
9984 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
9985 anymore.
9986
9987 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
9988 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
9989
9990 @smallexample
9991 void
9992 foo (void)
9993 @{
9994 @}
9995 @end smallexample
9996
9997 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
9998
9999 @smallexample
10000 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10001 $1 = void
10002 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10003 $2 = 1
10004 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10005 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10006 $3 = void
10007 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10008 $4 = 1
10009 @end smallexample
10010
10011 @end table
10012
10013 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10014 @code{Python} support.
10015
10016 @table @code
10017
10018 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10019 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10020 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10021 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10022 Otherwise it returns zero.
10023
10024 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10025 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10026 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10027 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10028 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10029 regular expression support.
10030
10031 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10032 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10033 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10034 Otherwise it returns zero.
10035
10036 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10037 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10038 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10039
10040 @end table
10041
10042 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10043 convenience functions.
10044
10045 @table @code
10046 @item help function
10047 @kindex help function
10048 @cindex show all convenience functions
10049 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10050 @end table
10051
10052 @node Registers
10053 @section Registers
10054
10055 @cindex registers
10056 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10057 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10058 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10059 your machine.
10060
10061 @table @code
10062 @kindex info registers
10063 @item info registers
10064 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10065 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10066
10067 @kindex info all-registers
10068 @cindex floating point registers
10069 @item info all-registers
10070 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10071 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10072
10073 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10074 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10075 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10076 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10077 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10078 @end table
10079
10080 @cindex stack pointer register
10081 @cindex program counter register
10082 @cindex process status register
10083 @cindex frame pointer register
10084 @cindex standard registers
10085 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10086 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10087 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10088 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10089 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10090 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10091 register that contains the processor status. For example,
10092 you could print the program counter in hex with
10093
10094 @smallexample
10095 p/x $pc
10096 @end smallexample
10097
10098 @noindent
10099 or print the instruction to be executed next with
10100
10101 @smallexample
10102 x/i $pc
10103 @end smallexample
10104
10105 @noindent
10106 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10107 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10108 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
10109 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10110 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
10111 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10112 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10113
10114 @smallexample
10115 set $sp += 4
10116 @end smallexample
10117
10118 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10119 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10120 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
10121 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10122 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10123 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10124 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
10125
10126 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
10127 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
10128 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
10129 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
10130 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
10131 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
10132 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
10133
10134 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
10135 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
10136 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
10137 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
10138 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
10139 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
10140 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
10141 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
10142 prints the data in both formats.
10143
10144 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
10145 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
10146 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
10147 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
10148 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
10149 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
10150 registers in @code{struct} notation:
10151
10152 @smallexample
10153 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
10154 $1 = @{
10155 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
10156 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
10157 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
10158 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
10159 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
10160 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
10161 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
10162 @}
10163 @end smallexample
10164
10165 @noindent
10166 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
10167 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
10168 value to a @code{struct} member:
10169
10170 @smallexample
10171 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
10172 @end smallexample
10173
10174 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
10175 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
10176 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
10177 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
10178 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
10179 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
10180
10181 @cindex caller-saved registers
10182 @cindex call-clobbered registers
10183 @cindex volatile registers
10184 @cindex <not saved> values
10185 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
10186 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
10187 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
10188 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
10189 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
10190 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
10191 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
10192 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
10193 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
10194 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
10195 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
10196 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
10197 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
10198 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
10199 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
10200 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
10201 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
10202 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
10203 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
10204 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
10205 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
10206 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
10207 represent the value the register had just before the call.
10208
10209 @node Floating Point Hardware
10210 @section Floating Point Hardware
10211 @cindex floating point
10212
10213 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
10214 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
10215
10216 @table @code
10217 @kindex info float
10218 @item info float
10219 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
10220 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
10221 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
10222 the ARM and x86 machines.
10223 @end table
10224
10225 @node Vector Unit
10226 @section Vector Unit
10227 @cindex vector unit
10228
10229 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
10230 more information about the status of the vector unit.
10231
10232 @table @code
10233 @kindex info vector
10234 @item info vector
10235 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
10236 layout vary depending on the hardware.
10237 @end table
10238
10239 @node OS Information
10240 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
10241 @cindex OS information
10242
10243 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
10244 you debug your program.
10245
10246 @cindex auxiliary vector
10247 @cindex vector, auxiliary
10248 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
10249 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
10250 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
10251 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
10252 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
10253 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
10254 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
10255 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
10256 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
10257 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
10258 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
10259
10260 @table @code
10261 @kindex info auxv
10262 @item info auxv
10263 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
10264 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
10265 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
10266 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
10267 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
10268 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
10269 an unrecognized tag.
10270 @end table
10271
10272 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
10273 information and show it to you. The types of information available
10274 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
10275 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
10276 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
10277 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
10278 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
10279
10280 @table @code
10281 @kindex info os
10282 @item info os @var{infotype}
10283
10284 Display OS information of the requested type.
10285
10286 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
10287
10288 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
10289 @table @code
10290 @kindex info os processes
10291 @item processes
10292 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
10293 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
10294 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
10295 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
10296 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
10297 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
10298
10299 @kindex info os procgroups
10300 @item procgroups
10301 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
10302 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
10303 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
10304 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
10305 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
10306 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
10307 and the process group leader is listed first.
10308
10309 @kindex info os threads
10310 @item threads
10311 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
10312 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
10313 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
10314 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
10315 process is not listed.
10316
10317 @kindex info os files
10318 @item files
10319 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
10320 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
10321 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
10322 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
10323
10324 @kindex info os sockets
10325 @item sockets
10326 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
10327 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
10328 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
10329 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
10330 connection.
10331
10332 @kindex info os shm
10333 @item shm
10334 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
10335 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
10336 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
10337 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
10338 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
10339 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
10340 attached to, detach from, and changed.
10341
10342 @kindex info os semaphores
10343 @item semaphores
10344 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
10345 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
10346 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
10347 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
10348 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
10349
10350 @kindex info os msg
10351 @item msg
10352 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
10353 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
10354 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
10355 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
10356 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
10357 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
10358 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
10359 the message queue was last changed.
10360
10361 @kindex info os modules
10362 @item modules
10363 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
10364 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
10365 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
10366 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
10367 in memory.
10368 @end table
10369
10370 @item info os
10371 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
10372 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
10373 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
10374 types, this command will report an error.
10375 @end table
10376
10377 @node Memory Region Attributes
10378 @section Memory Region Attributes
10379 @cindex memory region attributes
10380
10381 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
10382 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
10383 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
10384 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
10385 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
10386 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
10387 user can override the fetched regions.
10388
10389 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
10390 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
10391 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
10392 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
10393 all memory.
10394
10395 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
10396 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
10397
10398 @table @code
10399 @kindex mem
10400 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
10401 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
10402 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
10403 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
10404 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
10405 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
10406
10407 @item mem auto
10408 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
10409 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
10410
10411 @kindex delete mem
10412 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10413 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
10414 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
10415
10416 @kindex disable mem
10417 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10418 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10419 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
10420 It may be enabled again later.
10421
10422 @kindex enable mem
10423 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10424 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10425
10426 @kindex info mem
10427 @item info mem
10428 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
10429 for each region:
10430
10431 @table @emph
10432 @item Memory Region Number
10433 @item Enabled or Disabled.
10434 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
10435 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
10436
10437 @item Lo Address
10438 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
10439
10440 @item Hi Address
10441 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
10442
10443 @item Attributes
10444 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
10445 @end table
10446 @end table
10447
10448
10449 @subsection Attributes
10450
10451 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
10452 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
10453 write accesses to a memory region.
10454
10455 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
10456 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
10457 etc.@: from accessing memory.
10458
10459 @table @code
10460 @item ro
10461 Memory is read only.
10462 @item wo
10463 Memory is write only.
10464 @item rw
10465 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
10466 @end table
10467
10468 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
10469 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
10470 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
10471 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
10472 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
10473
10474 @table @code
10475 @item 8
10476 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
10477 @item 16
10478 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
10479 @item 32
10480 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
10481 @item 64
10482 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
10483 @end table
10484
10485 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
10486 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
10487 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
10488 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
10489 @c
10490 @c @table @code
10491 @c @item hwbreak
10492 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
10493 @c @item swbreak (default)
10494 @c @end table
10495
10496 @subsubsection Data Cache
10497 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
10498 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
10499 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
10500 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
10501 registers.
10502
10503 @table @code
10504 @item cache
10505 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
10506 @item nocache
10507 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
10508 @end table
10509
10510 @subsection Memory Access Checking
10511 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
10512 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
10513 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
10514 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
10515
10516 @table @code
10517 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
10518 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
10519 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
10520 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
10521 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
10522 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
10523 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
10524 The default value is @code{on}.
10525 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
10526 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
10527 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
10528 @end table
10529
10530
10531 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
10532 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
10533 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
10534 @c
10535 @c @table @code
10536 @c @item verify
10537 @c @item noverify (default)
10538 @c @end table
10539
10540 @node Dump/Restore Files
10541 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
10542 @cindex dump/restore files
10543 @cindex append data to a file
10544 @cindex dump data to a file
10545 @cindex restore data from a file
10546
10547 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
10548 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
10549 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
10550 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
10551 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
10552 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
10553 files.
10554
10555 @table @code
10556
10557 @kindex dump
10558 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
10559 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
10560 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
10561 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
10562
10563 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
10564 @table @code
10565 @item binary
10566 Raw binary form.
10567 @item ihex
10568 Intel hex format.
10569 @item srec
10570 Motorola S-record format.
10571 @item tekhex
10572 Tektronix Hex format.
10573 @end table
10574
10575 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
10576 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
10577 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
10578 form.
10579
10580 @kindex append
10581 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
10582 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
10583 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
10584 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
10585 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
10586
10587 @kindex restore
10588 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
10589 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
10590 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
10591 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
10592 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
10593
10594 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
10595 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
10596 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
10597 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
10598 from that location.
10599
10600 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
10601 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
10602 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
10603 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
10604
10605 @end table
10606
10607 @node Core File Generation
10608 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
10609 @cindex dump core from inferior
10610
10611 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
10612 image of a running process and its process status (register values
10613 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
10614 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
10615 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
10616 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
10617 the post-mortem debugging mode.
10618
10619 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
10620 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
10621 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
10622
10623 @table @code
10624 @kindex gcore
10625 @kindex generate-core-file
10626 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
10627 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
10628 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
10629 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
10630 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
10631 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
10632
10633 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
10634 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
10635 @end table
10636
10637 @node Character Sets
10638 @section Character Sets
10639 @cindex character sets
10640 @cindex charset
10641 @cindex translating between character sets
10642 @cindex host character set
10643 @cindex target character set
10644
10645 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
10646 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
10647 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
10648 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
10649 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
10650 @dfn{target character set}.
10651
10652 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
10653 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
10654 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
10655 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
10656 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
10657 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
10658 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
10659 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
10660 character and string literals in expressions.
10661
10662 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
10663 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
10664 target-charset} command, described below.
10665
10666 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
10667 support:
10668
10669 @table @code
10670 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
10671 @kindex set target-charset
10672 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
10673 list of supported target character sets, type
10674 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
10675
10676 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
10677 @kindex set host-charset
10678 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
10679
10680 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
10681 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
10682 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
10683 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
10684 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
10685
10686 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
10687 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
10688 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
10689
10690 @item set charset @var{charset}
10691 @kindex set charset
10692 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
10693 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
10694 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
10695 for both host and target.
10696
10697 @item show charset
10698 @kindex show charset
10699 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
10700
10701 @item show host-charset
10702 @kindex show host-charset
10703 Show the name of the current host character set.
10704
10705 @item show target-charset
10706 @kindex show target-charset
10707 Show the name of the current target character set.
10708
10709 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
10710 @kindex set target-wide-charset
10711 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
10712 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
10713 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
10714 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
10715
10716 @item show target-wide-charset
10717 @kindex show target-wide-charset
10718 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
10719 @end table
10720
10721 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
10722 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
10723 @file{charset-test.c}:
10724
10725 @smallexample
10726 #include <stdio.h>
10727
10728 char ascii_hello[]
10729 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
10730 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
10731 char ibm1047_hello[]
10732 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
10733 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
10734
10735 main ()
10736 @{
10737 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
10738 @}
10739 @end smallexample
10740
10741 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
10742 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
10743 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
10744
10745 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
10746
10747 @smallexample
10748 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
10749 $ gdb -nw charset-test
10750 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
10751 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
10752 @dots{}
10753 (@value{GDBP})
10754 @end smallexample
10755
10756 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
10757 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
10758 strings:
10759
10760 @smallexample
10761 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
10762 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
10763 (@value{GDBP})
10764 @end smallexample
10765
10766 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
10767 initial character set:
10768 @smallexample
10769 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
10770 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
10771 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
10772 (@value{GDBP})
10773 @end smallexample
10774
10775 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
10776 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
10777 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
10778 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
10779 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
10780
10781 @smallexample
10782 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
10783 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
10784 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
10785 $2 = 72 'H'
10786 (@value{GDBP})
10787 @end smallexample
10788
10789 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
10790 literals you use in expressions:
10791
10792 @smallexample
10793 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
10794 $3 = 43 '+'
10795 (@value{GDBP})
10796 @end smallexample
10797
10798 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
10799 character.
10800
10801 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
10802 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
10803 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
10804
10805 @smallexample
10806 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
10807 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
10808 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
10809 $5 = 200 '\310'
10810 (@value{GDBP})
10811 @end smallexample
10812
10813 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
10814 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
10815
10816 @smallexample
10817 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
10818 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
10819 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
10820 @end smallexample
10821
10822 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
10823 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
10824 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
10825 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
10826 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
10827
10828 @smallexample
10829 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
10830 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
10831 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
10832 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
10833 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
10834 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
10835 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
10836 $7 = 72 '\110'
10837 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
10838 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
10839 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
10840 $9 = 200 'H'
10841 (@value{GDBP})
10842 @end smallexample
10843
10844 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
10845 string literals you use in expressions:
10846
10847 @smallexample
10848 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
10849 $10 = 78 '+'
10850 (@value{GDBP})
10851 @end smallexample
10852
10853 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
10854 character.
10855
10856 @node Caching Target Data
10857 @section Caching Data of Targets
10858 @cindex caching data of targets
10859
10860 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
10861 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
10862 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
10863 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
10864 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
10865 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
10866 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
10867 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
10868 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
10869 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
10870 is executing.
10871 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
10872 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
10873 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
10874 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
10875 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
10876 in the code segment.
10877 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
10878 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
10879
10880 @table @code
10881 @kindex set remotecache
10882 @item set remotecache on
10883 @itemx set remotecache off
10884 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
10885 with old scripts.
10886
10887 @kindex show remotecache
10888 @item show remotecache
10889 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
10890
10891 @kindex set stack-cache
10892 @item set stack-cache on
10893 @itemx set stack-cache off
10894 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
10895 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
10896
10897 @kindex show stack-cache
10898 @item show stack-cache
10899 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
10900
10901 @kindex set code-cache
10902 @item set code-cache on
10903 @itemx set code-cache off
10904 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
10905 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
10906 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
10907
10908 @kindex show code-cache
10909 @item show code-cache
10910 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
10911 accesses.
10912
10913 @kindex info dcache
10914 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
10915 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
10916 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
10917 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
10918 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
10919 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
10920
10921 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
10922 printed in hex.
10923
10924 @item set dcache size @var{size}
10925 @cindex dcache size
10926 @kindex set dcache size
10927 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
10928
10929 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
10930 @cindex dcache line-size
10931 @kindex set dcache line-size
10932 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
10933 Must be a power of 2.
10934
10935 @item show dcache size
10936 @kindex show dcache size
10937 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
10938
10939 @item show dcache line-size
10940 @kindex show dcache line-size
10941 Show default size of dcache lines.
10942
10943 @end table
10944
10945 @node Searching Memory
10946 @section Search Memory
10947 @cindex searching memory
10948
10949 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
10950 @code{find} command.
10951
10952 @table @code
10953 @kindex find
10954 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
10955 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
10956 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
10957 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
10958 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
10959 @end table
10960
10961 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
10962 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
10963
10964 @table @r
10965 @item @var{s}, search query size
10966 The size of each search query value.
10967
10968 @table @code
10969 @item b
10970 bytes
10971 @item h
10972 halfwords (two bytes)
10973 @item w
10974 words (four bytes)
10975 @item g
10976 giant words (eight bytes)
10977 @end table
10978
10979 All values are interpreted in the current language.
10980 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
10981 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
10982
10983 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
10984 value's type in the current language.
10985 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
10986 pattern as a mixture of types.
10987 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
10988 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
10989 which is typically four bytes.
10990
10991 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
10992 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
10993 @end table
10994
10995 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
10996 (@code{"}).
10997 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
10998 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
10999
11000 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11001 number of matches found.
11002
11003 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11004 @samp{$_}.
11005 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11006
11007 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11008
11009 @smallexample
11010 void
11011 hello ()
11012 @{
11013 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11014 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11015 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11016 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11017 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11018 @}
11019 @end smallexample
11020
11021 @noindent
11022 you get during debugging:
11023
11024 @smallexample
11025 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
11026 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11027 1 pattern found
11028 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
11029 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11030 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11031 2 patterns found
11032 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
11033 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11034 1 pattern found
11035 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
11036 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
11037 1 pattern found
11038 (gdb) print $numfound
11039 $1 = 1
11040 (gdb) print $_
11041 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11042 @end smallexample
11043
11044 @node Optimized Code
11045 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
11046 @cindex optimized code, debugging
11047 @cindex debugging optimized code
11048
11049 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
11050 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
11051 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
11052 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
11053 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
11054 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
11055 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
11056
11057 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
11058 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
11059 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
11060 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
11061
11062 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
11063 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
11064 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
11065 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
11066 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
11067 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
11068
11069 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
11070 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
11071 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
11072 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
11073 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
11074
11075 @menu
11076 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
11077 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
11078 @end menu
11079
11080 @node Inline Functions
11081 @section Inline Functions
11082 @cindex inline functions, debugging
11083
11084 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
11085 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
11086 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
11087 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
11088 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
11089 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
11090 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
11091 @code{info frame} command.
11092
11093 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
11094 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
11095 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
11096 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
11097 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
11098 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
11099 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
11100 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
11101 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
11102 local variables in the caller.
11103
11104 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
11105 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
11106 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
11107 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
11108 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
11109 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
11110 instructions are executed.
11111
11112 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
11113 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
11114 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
11115 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
11116
11117 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
11118 function calls are the same as normal calls:
11119
11120 @itemize @bullet
11121 @item
11122 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
11123 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
11124 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
11125 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
11126 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
11127 or inside the inlined function instead.
11128
11129 @item
11130 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
11131 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
11132 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
11133 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
11134
11135 @end itemize
11136
11137 @node Tail Call Frames
11138 @section Tail Call Frames
11139 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
11140
11141 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
11142 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
11143 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
11144 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
11145 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
11146
11147 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
11148 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
11149 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
11150 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
11151 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
11152 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
11153 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
11154
11155 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
11156 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
11157 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
11158 this information.
11159
11160 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
11161 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
11162
11163 @smallexample
11164 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
11165 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
11166 (gdb) info frame
11167 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
11168 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
11169 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
11170 source language c++.
11171 Arglist at unknown address.
11172 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
11173 @end smallexample
11174
11175 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
11176 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
11177 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
11178 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
11179 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
11180 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
11181
11182 @table @code
11183 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
11184 @item set debug entry-values
11185 @kindex set debug entry-values
11186 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
11187 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
11188 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
11189 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
11190 result.
11191
11192 @item show debug entry-values
11193 @kindex show debug entry-values
11194 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
11195 values at function entry and tail calls.
11196 @end table
11197
11198 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
11199 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
11200 reference by variable @code{x}):
11201
11202 @smallexample
11203 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
11204 void (*x) (void) = c;
11205 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11206 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
11207 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
11208
11209 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving cannot find
11210 DW_TAG_GNU_call_site 0x40039a in main
11211 a () at t.c:3
11212 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11213 (gdb) bt
11214 #0 a () at t.c:3
11215 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
11216 @end smallexample
11217
11218 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
11219
11220 @smallexample
11221 int i;
11222 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
11223 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
11224 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
11225 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
11226 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
11227 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
11228 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
11229 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
11230
11231 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
11232 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
11233 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
11234 (gdb) bt
11235 #0 f () at t.c:2
11236 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
11237 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
11238 @end smallexample
11239
11240 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
11241 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
11242
11243 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
11244 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11245 @set ARROW @click{}
11246 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
11247 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
11248 @end ifset
11249 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11250 @set ARROW ->
11251 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
11252 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
11253 @end ifclear
11254
11255 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
11256 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
11257 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
11258
11259 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
11260 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
11261 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
11262 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
11263 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
11264 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
11265
11266 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
11267 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
11268 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
11269 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
11270 omitted.
11271
11272 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
11273 entry may fail:
11274
11275 @smallexample
11276 int v;
11277 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
11278 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
11279 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
11280 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
11281 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
11282 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
11283
11284 (gdb) bt
11285 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
11286 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving has found
11287 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
11288 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
11289 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
11290 @end smallexample
11291
11292 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
11293 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
11294 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
11295 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
11296 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
11297
11298 @node Macros
11299 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
11300
11301 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
11302 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
11303 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
11304 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
11305 where it was defined.
11306
11307 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
11308 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
11309 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
11310 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
11311
11312 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
11313 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
11314 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
11315 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
11316 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
11317 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
11318 see @ref{List}.
11319
11320 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
11321 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
11322 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
11323
11324 @table @code
11325
11326 @kindex macro expand
11327 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
11328 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
11329 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
11330 @item macro expand @var{expression}
11331 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
11332 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
11333 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
11334 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
11335 it can be any string of tokens.
11336
11337 @kindex macro exp1
11338 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
11339 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
11340 @cindex expand macro once
11341 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
11342 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
11343 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
11344 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
11345 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
11346 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
11347 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
11348 can be any string of tokens.
11349
11350 @kindex info macro
11351 @cindex macro definition, showing
11352 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
11353 @cindex macros, from debug info
11354 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
11355 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
11356 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
11357 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
11358 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
11359 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
11360
11361 @kindex info macros
11362 @item info macros @var{linespec}
11363 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
11364 by @var{linespec}, and describe the source location or compiler
11365 command-line where those definitions were established.
11366
11367 @kindex macro define
11368 @cindex user-defined macros
11369 @cindex defining macros interactively
11370 @cindex macros, user-defined
11371 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
11372 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
11373 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
11374 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
11375 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
11376 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
11377 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
11378 @var{arglist}.
11379
11380 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
11381 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
11382 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
11383 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
11384 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
11385
11386 @kindex macro undef
11387 @item macro undef @var{macro}
11388 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
11389 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
11390 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
11391 in the program being debugged.
11392
11393 @kindex macro list
11394 @item macro list
11395 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
11396 @end table
11397
11398 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
11399 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
11400 show our source files:
11401
11402 @smallexample
11403 $ cat sample.c
11404 #include <stdio.h>
11405 #include "sample.h"
11406
11407 #define M 42
11408 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11409
11410 main ()
11411 @{
11412 #define N 28
11413 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11414 #undef N
11415 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11416 #define N 1729
11417 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11418 @}
11419 $ cat sample.h
11420 #define Q <
11421 $
11422 @end smallexample
11423
11424 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
11425 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
11426 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
11427 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
11428 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
11429 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
11430 information.
11431
11432 @smallexample
11433 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
11434 $
11435 @end smallexample
11436
11437 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
11438
11439 @smallexample
11440 $ gdb -nw sample
11441 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
11442 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11443 GDB is free software, @dots{}
11444 (@value{GDBP})
11445 @end smallexample
11446
11447 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
11448 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
11449 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
11450
11451 @smallexample
11452 (@value{GDBP}) list main
11453 3
11454 4 #define M 42
11455 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11456 6
11457 7 main ()
11458 8 @{
11459 9 #define N 28
11460 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11461 11 #undef N
11462 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11463 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
11464 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
11465 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11466 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
11467 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
11468 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
11469 #define Q <
11470 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
11471 expands to: (42 + 1)
11472 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
11473 expands to: once (M + 1)
11474 (@value{GDBP})
11475 @end smallexample
11476
11477 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
11478 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
11479 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
11480 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
11481
11482 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
11483 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
11484
11485 @smallexample
11486 (@value{GDBP}) break main
11487 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
11488 (@value{GDBP}) run
11489 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
11490
11491 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
11492 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11493 (@value{GDBP})
11494 @end smallexample
11495
11496 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
11497
11498 @smallexample
11499 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11500 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
11501 #define N 28
11502 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
11503 expands to: 28 < 42
11504 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
11505 $1 = 1
11506 (@value{GDBP})
11507 @end smallexample
11508
11509 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
11510 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
11511 thereof) in force at each point:
11512
11513 @smallexample
11514 (@value{GDBP}) next
11515 Hello, world!
11516 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11517 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11518 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
11519 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
11520 (@value{GDBP}) next
11521 We're so creative.
11522 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11523 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11524 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
11525 #define N 1729
11526 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
11527 expands to: 1729 < 42
11528 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
11529 $2 = 0
11530 (@value{GDBP})
11531 @end smallexample
11532
11533 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
11534 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
11535 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
11536 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
11537
11538 @smallexample
11539 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
11540 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
11541 -D__STDC__=1
11542 (@value{GDBP})
11543 @end smallexample
11544
11545
11546 @node Tracepoints
11547 @chapter Tracepoints
11548 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
11549 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
11550
11551 @cindex tracepoints
11552 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
11553 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
11554 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
11555 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
11556 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
11557 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
11558 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
11559
11560 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
11561 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
11562 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
11563 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
11564 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
11565 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
11566 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
11567 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
11568 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
11569 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
11570 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
11571
11572 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
11573 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
11574 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
11575 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
11576 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
11577 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
11578 Packets}.
11579
11580 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
11581 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
11582 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
11583
11584 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
11585
11586 @menu
11587 * Set Tracepoints::
11588 * Analyze Collected Data::
11589 * Tracepoint Variables::
11590 * Trace Files::
11591 @end menu
11592
11593 @node Set Tracepoints
11594 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
11595
11596 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
11597 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
11598 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
11599 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
11600 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
11601 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
11602 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
11603
11604 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
11605 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
11606 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
11607 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
11608 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
11609 tracepoint was hit.
11610
11611 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
11612 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
11613 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
11614 either.
11615
11616 @cindex fast tracepoints
11617 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
11618 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
11619 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
11620
11621 @cindex static tracepoints
11622 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
11623 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
11624 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
11625 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
11626 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
11627 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
11628 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
11629 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
11630 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
11631 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
11632 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
11633 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
11634 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
11635 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
11636 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
11637 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
11638 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
11639 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
11640 static tracepoint marker.
11641
11642 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
11643 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
11644
11645 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
11646 conditions and actions.
11647
11648 @menu
11649 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
11650 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
11651 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
11652 * Tracepoint Conditions::
11653 * Trace State Variables::
11654 * Tracepoint Actions::
11655 * Listing Tracepoints::
11656 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
11657 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
11658 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
11659 @end menu
11660
11661 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
11662 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
11663
11664 @table @code
11665 @cindex set tracepoint
11666 @kindex trace
11667 @item trace @var{location}
11668 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
11669 Its argument @var{location} can be a source line, a function name, or
11670 an address in the target program. @xref{Specify Location}. The
11671 @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the
11672 target program where the debugger will briefly stop, collect some
11673 data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or
11674 changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
11675 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
11676 in tracing}).
11677 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
11678 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
11679 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
11680 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
11681 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
11682 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
11683 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
11684 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
11685 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
11686 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
11687 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
11688 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
11689
11690 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
11691
11692 @smallexample
11693 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
11694
11695 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
11696
11697 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
11698
11699 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
11700
11701 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
11702 @end smallexample
11703
11704 @noindent
11705 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
11706
11707 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
11708 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
11709 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
11710 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
11711 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
11712 information on tracepoint conditions.
11713
11714 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
11715 @cindex set fast tracepoint
11716 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
11717 @kindex ftrace
11718 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
11719 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
11720 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
11721 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
11722 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
11723 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
11724 message.
11725
11726 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
11727 @code{trace}.
11728
11729 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
11730 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
11731 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
11732 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
11733 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
11734 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
11735 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
11736 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
11737
11738 @example
11739 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
11740 @end example
11741
11742 @noindent
11743 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
11744 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
11745
11746 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
11747 @cindex set static tracepoint
11748 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
11749 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
11750 @kindex strace
11751 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
11752 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
11753 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
11754 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
11755 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
11756
11757 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
11758 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
11759 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
11760 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
11761 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
11762 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
11763 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
11764 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
11765 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
11766 tracing engine:
11767
11768 @smallexample
11769 main ()
11770 @{
11771 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
11772 @}
11773 @end smallexample
11774
11775 @noindent
11776 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
11777 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
11778
11779 @smallexample
11780 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
11781 Cnt Enb ID Address What
11782 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
11783 Data: "str %s"
11784 [etc...]
11785 @end smallexample
11786
11787 @noindent
11788 so you may probe the marker above with:
11789
11790 @smallexample
11791 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
11792 @end smallexample
11793
11794 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
11795 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
11796 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
11797 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
11798 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
11799 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
11800 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
11801 the @samp{Data:} field.
11802
11803 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
11804 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
11805 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
11806
11807 @vindex $tpnum
11808 @cindex last tracepoint number
11809 @cindex recent tracepoint number
11810 @cindex tracepoint number
11811 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
11812 of the most recently set tracepoint.
11813
11814 @kindex delete tracepoint
11815 @cindex tracepoint deletion
11816 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11817 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
11818 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
11819 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
11820
11821 Examples:
11822
11823 @smallexample
11824 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
11825
11826 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
11827 @end smallexample
11828
11829 @noindent
11830 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
11831 @end table
11832
11833 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
11834 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
11835
11836 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
11837
11838 @table @code
11839 @kindex disable tracepoint
11840 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11841 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
11842 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
11843 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
11844 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
11845 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
11846 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
11847 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
11848 next trace experiment.
11849
11850 @kindex enable tracepoint
11851 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11852 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
11853 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
11854 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
11855 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
11856 next time a trace experiment is run.
11857 @end table
11858
11859 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
11860 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
11861
11862 @table @code
11863 @kindex passcount
11864 @cindex tracepoint pass count
11865 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
11866 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
11867 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
11868 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
11869 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
11870 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
11871 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
11872 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
11873 user.
11874
11875 Examples:
11876
11877 @smallexample
11878 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
11879 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
11880
11881 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
11882 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
11883 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
11884 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
11885 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
11886 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
11887 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
11888 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
11889 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
11890 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
11891 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
11892 @end smallexample
11893 @end table
11894
11895 @node Tracepoint Conditions
11896 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
11897 @cindex conditional tracepoints
11898 @cindex tracepoint conditions
11899
11900 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
11901 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
11902 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
11903 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
11904 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
11905 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
11906 is true.
11907
11908 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
11909 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
11910 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
11911 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
11912 just as with breakpoints.
11913
11914 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
11915 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
11916 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
11917 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
11918 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
11919 accesses, and so forth.
11920
11921 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
11922 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
11923 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
11924 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
11925 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
11926 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
11927 search through.
11928
11929 @smallexample
11930 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
11931 @end smallexample
11932
11933 @node Trace State Variables
11934 @subsection Trace State Variables
11935 @cindex trace state variables
11936
11937 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
11938 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
11939 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
11940 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
11941 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
11942 integers.
11943
11944 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
11945 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
11946 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
11947 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
11948
11949 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
11950 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
11951 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
11952 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
11953 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
11954 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
11955 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
11956 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
11957 variable with the same name.
11958
11959 @table @code
11960
11961 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
11962 @kindex tvariable
11963 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
11964 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
11965 @var{expression}. @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
11966 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
11967 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
11968 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
11969 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
11970 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
11971 value. The default initial value is 0.
11972
11973 @item info tvariables
11974 @kindex info tvariables
11975 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
11976 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
11977 currently running.
11978
11979 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
11980 @kindex delete tvariable
11981 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
11982 are specified.
11983
11984 @end table
11985
11986 @node Tracepoint Actions
11987 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
11988
11989 @table @code
11990 @kindex actions
11991 @cindex tracepoint actions
11992 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11993 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
11994 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
11995 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
11996 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
11997 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
11998 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
11999 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
12000 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
12001 @code{while-stepping}.
12002
12003 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12004 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12005 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12006
12007 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12008 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12009 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12010
12011 @smallexample
12012 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12013
12014 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12015
12016 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12017 @end smallexample
12018
12019 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12020 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12021 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12022 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12023 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12024 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
12025 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
12026 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12027
12028 @smallexample
12029 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12030 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12031 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12032 > collect bar,baz
12033 > collect $regs
12034 > while-stepping 12
12035 > collect $pc, arr[i]
12036 > end
12037 end
12038 @end smallexample
12039
12040 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12041 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12042 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
12043 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
12044 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
12045 special arguments are supported:
12046
12047 @table @code
12048 @item $regs
12049 Collect all registers.
12050
12051 @item $args
12052 Collect all function arguments.
12053
12054 @item $locals
12055 Collect all local variables.
12056
12057 @item $_ret
12058 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
12059 of a backtrace.
12060
12061 @item $_probe_argc
12062 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
12063 tracepoint is located.
12064 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12065
12066 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
12067 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
12068 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
12069 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12070
12071 @item $_sdata
12072 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
12073 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
12074 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
12075 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
12076 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
12077 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
12078 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
12079 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
12080 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
12081
12082 @smallexample
12083 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
12084 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
12085 @end smallexample
12086
12087 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
12088 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
12089 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
12090 @value{GDBN}.
12091 @end table
12092
12093 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
12094 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
12095 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
12096
12097 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
12098 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
12099 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
12100 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
12101 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
12102 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
12103 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
12104 @samp{mystr}.
12105
12106 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
12107 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
12108
12109 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
12110 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12111 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
12112 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
12113 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
12114 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
12115 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
12116 action were used.
12117
12118 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
12119 @item while-stepping @var{n}
12120 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
12121 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
12122 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
12123 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
12124
12125 @smallexample
12126 > while-stepping 12
12127 > collect $regs, myglobal
12128 > end
12129 >
12130 @end smallexample
12131
12132 @noindent
12133 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
12134 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
12135 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
12136 @code{stepping}.
12137
12138 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12139 @kindex set default-collect
12140 @cindex default collection action
12141 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
12142 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
12143 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
12144 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
12145 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
12146 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
12147
12148 @item show default-collect
12149 @kindex show default-collect
12150 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
12151 tracepoint hit.
12152
12153 @end table
12154
12155 @node Listing Tracepoints
12156 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
12157
12158 @table @code
12159 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12160 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12161 @cindex information about tracepoints
12162 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
12163 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
12164 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
12165 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
12166 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
12167 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
12168
12169 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
12170 tracing:
12171
12172 @itemize @bullet
12173 @item
12174 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
12175
12176 @item
12177 the state about installed on target of each location
12178 @end itemize
12179
12180 @smallexample
12181 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
12182 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
12183 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
12184 while-stepping 20
12185 collect globfoo, $regs
12186 end
12187 collect globfoo2
12188 end
12189 pass count 1200
12190 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
12191 collect $eip
12192 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12193 installed on target
12194 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12195 installed on target
12196 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
12197 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
12198 not installed on target
12199 (@value{GDBP})
12200 @end smallexample
12201
12202 @noindent
12203 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
12204 @end table
12205
12206 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12207 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12208
12209 @table @code
12210 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
12211 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
12212 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
12213 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
12214 program.
12215
12216 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
12217
12218 @table @emph
12219 @item Count
12220 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
12221 stable identifier.
12222 @item ID
12223 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
12224 @item Enabled or Disabled
12225 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
12226 that are not enabled.
12227 @item Address
12228 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
12229 @item What
12230 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
12231 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
12232 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
12233 will be left blank.
12234 @end table
12235
12236 @noindent
12237 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
12238
12239 @table @emph
12240 @item Data
12241 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
12242 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
12243 marker call.
12244 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
12245 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
12246 @end table
12247
12248 @smallexample
12249 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12250 Cnt ID Enb Address What
12251 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
12252 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
12253 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
12254 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
12255 Data: str %s
12256 (@value{GDBP})
12257 @end smallexample
12258 @end table
12259
12260 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12261 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12262
12263 @table @code
12264 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
12265 @cindex start a new trace experiment
12266 @cindex collected data discarded
12267 @item tstart
12268 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
12269 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
12270 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
12271 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
12272 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
12273 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
12274 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
12275 information, and so forth.
12276
12277 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
12278 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
12279 @item tstop
12280 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
12281 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
12282 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
12283 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
12284 needs to be stopped quickly.
12285
12286 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
12287 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
12288 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
12289
12290 @kindex tstatus
12291 @cindex status of trace data collection
12292 @cindex trace experiment, status of
12293 @item tstatus
12294 This command displays the status of the current trace data
12295 collection.
12296 @end table
12297
12298 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
12299
12300 @smallexample
12301 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
12302 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12303 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
12304 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
12305 > while-stepping 11
12306 > collect $regs
12307 > end
12308 > end
12309 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
12310 [time passes @dots{}]
12311 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
12312 @end smallexample
12313
12314 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
12315 @cindex disconnected tracing
12316 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
12317 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
12318 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
12319 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
12320 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
12321 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
12322 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
12323 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
12324
12325 @table @code
12326 @item set disconnected-tracing on
12327 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
12328 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
12329 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
12330 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
12331 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
12332 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
12333 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
12334
12335 @item show disconnected-tracing
12336 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
12337 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
12338
12339 @end table
12340
12341 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
12342 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
12343 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
12344 it will continue after reconnection.
12345
12346 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
12347 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
12348 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
12349 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
12350 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
12351 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
12352 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
12353 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
12354 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
12355 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
12356
12357 @cindex circular trace buffer
12358 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
12359 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
12360 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
12361 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
12362 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
12363 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
12364 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
12365 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
12366 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
12367 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
12368 the next run.
12369
12370 @table @code
12371 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
12372 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
12373 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
12374 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
12375 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
12376 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
12377 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
12378
12379 @item show circular-trace-buffer
12380 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
12381 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
12382 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
12383 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
12384 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
12385
12386 @end table
12387
12388 @table @code
12389 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
12390 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
12391 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
12392 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
12393 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
12394 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
12395 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
12396 likes. This is also the default.
12397
12398 @item show trace-buffer-size
12399 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
12400 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
12401 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
12402 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
12403 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
12404 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
12405 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
12406 @end table
12407
12408 @table @code
12409 @item set trace-user @var{text}
12410 @kindex set trace-user
12411
12412 @item show trace-user
12413 @kindex show trace-user
12414
12415 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
12416 @kindex set trace-notes
12417 Set the trace run's notes.
12418
12419 @item show trace-notes
12420 @kindex show trace-notes
12421 Show the trace run's notes.
12422
12423 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
12424 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
12425 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
12426 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
12427 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
12428
12429 @item show trace-stop-notes
12430 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
12431 Show the trace run's stop notes.
12432
12433 @end table
12434
12435 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
12436 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
12437
12438 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
12439 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
12440 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
12441 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
12442 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
12443 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
12444 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
12445 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
12446 mentioned here.
12447
12448 @itemize @bullet
12449
12450 @item
12451 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
12452 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
12453 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
12454 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
12455 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
12456 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
12457 cannot be collected either.
12458
12459 @item
12460 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
12461 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
12462 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
12463 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
12464 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
12465 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
12466 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
12467 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
12468 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
12469 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
12470
12471 @item
12472 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
12473 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
12474 in a misleading way.
12475
12476 @item
12477 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
12478 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
12479 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
12480 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
12481 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
12482 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
12483 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
12484 by @code{ptr}.
12485
12486 @item
12487 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
12488 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
12489 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
12490 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
12491 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
12492 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
12493 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
12494 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
12495 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
12496 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
12497 invalid address.
12498
12499 @item
12500 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
12501 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
12502 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
12503 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
12504 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
12505 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
12506 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
12507 it to zero.
12508
12509 @end itemize
12510
12511 @node Analyze Collected Data
12512 @section Using the Collected Data
12513
12514 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
12515 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
12516 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
12517 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
12518 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
12519 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
12520 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
12521 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
12522 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
12523 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
12524 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
12525 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
12526 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
12527 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
12528 the buffer will fail.
12529
12530 @menu
12531 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
12532 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
12533 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
12534 @end menu
12535
12536 @node tfind
12537 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
12538
12539 @kindex tfind
12540 @cindex select trace snapshot
12541 @cindex find trace snapshot
12542 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
12543 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
12544 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
12545 snapshot is selected.
12546
12547 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
12548
12549 @table @code
12550 @item tfind start
12551 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
12552 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
12553
12554 @item tfind none
12555 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
12556
12557 @item tfind end
12558 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
12559
12560 @item tfind
12561 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
12562
12563 @item tfind -
12564 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
12565 retracing earlier steps.
12566
12567 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
12568 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
12569 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
12570 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
12571 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
12572
12573 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
12574 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
12575 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
12576 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
12577 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
12578
12579 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
12580 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
12581 addresses (exclusive).
12582
12583 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
12584 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
12585 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
12586
12587 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
12588 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
12589 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
12590 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
12591 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
12592 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
12593 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
12594 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
12595 @end table
12596
12597 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
12598 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
12599 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
12600 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
12601 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
12602 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
12603 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
12604 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
12605 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
12606 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
12607 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
12608 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
12609 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
12610 tracepoint as the current one.
12611
12612 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
12613 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
12614 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
12615 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
12616 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
12617
12618 @smallexample
12619 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12620 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
12621 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
12622 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
12623 > tfind
12624 > end
12625
12626 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
12627 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
12628 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
12629 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
12630 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
12631 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
12632 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
12633 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
12634 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
12635 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
12636 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
12637 @end smallexample
12638
12639 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
12640 the buffer:
12641
12642 @smallexample
12643 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12644 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
12645 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
12646 > tfind line
12647 > end
12648
12649 Frame 0, X = 1
12650 Frame 7, X = 2
12651 Frame 13, X = 255
12652 @end smallexample
12653
12654 @node tdump
12655 @subsection @code{tdump}
12656 @kindex tdump
12657 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
12658 @cindex tracepoint data, display
12659
12660 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
12661 the current trace snapshot.
12662
12663 @smallexample
12664 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
12665 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12666 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
12667 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
12668 > end
12669
12670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
12671
12672 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
12673 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
12674 at gdb_test.c:444
12675 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
12676
12677 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
12678 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
12679 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
12680 d1 0x18 24
12681 d2 0x80 128
12682 d3 0x33 51
12683 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
12684 d5 0x22 34
12685 d6 0xe0 224
12686 d7 0x380035 3670069
12687 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
12688 a1 0x3000668 50333288
12689 a2 0x100 256
12690 a3 0x322000 3284992
12691 a4 0x3000698 50333336
12692 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
12693 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
12694 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
12695 ps 0x0 0
12696 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
12697 fpcontrol 0x0 0
12698 fpstatus 0x0 0
12699 fpiaddr 0x0 0
12700 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
12701 p1 = (void *) 0x11
12702 p2 = (void *) 0x22
12703 p3 = (void *) 0x33
12704 p4 = (void *) 0x44
12705 p5 = (void *) 0x55
12706 p6 = (void *) 0x66
12707 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
12708
12709 (@value{GDBP})
12710 @end smallexample
12711
12712 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
12713 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
12714 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
12715 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
12716
12717 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
12718 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
12719 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
12720 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
12721 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
12722 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
12723 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
12724 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
12725 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
12726 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
12727
12728 @node save tracepoints
12729 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
12730 @kindex save tracepoints
12731 @kindex save-tracepoints
12732 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
12733
12734 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
12735 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
12736 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
12737 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
12738 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
12739 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
12740
12741 @node Tracepoint Variables
12742 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
12743 @cindex tracepoint variables
12744 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
12745
12746 @table @code
12747 @vindex $trace_frame
12748 @item (int) $trace_frame
12749 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
12750 snapshot is selected.
12751
12752 @vindex $tracepoint
12753 @item (int) $tracepoint
12754 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
12755
12756 @vindex $trace_line
12757 @item (int) $trace_line
12758 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
12759
12760 @vindex $trace_file
12761 @item (char []) $trace_file
12762 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
12763
12764 @vindex $trace_func
12765 @item (char []) $trace_func
12766 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
12767 @end table
12768
12769 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
12770 use @code{output} instead.
12771
12772 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
12773 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
12774 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
12775 which are managed by the target.
12776
12777 @smallexample
12778 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12779
12780 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
12781 > output $trace_file
12782 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
12783 > tfind
12784 > end
12785 @end smallexample
12786
12787 @node Trace Files
12788 @section Using Trace Files
12789 @cindex trace files
12790
12791 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
12792 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
12793 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
12794 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
12795 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
12796
12797 @table @code
12798
12799 @kindex tsave
12800 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
12801 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
12802 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
12803 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
12804 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
12805 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
12806 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
12807 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
12808 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
12809 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
12810 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
12811 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save date in CTF
12812 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
12813 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
12814 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
12815
12816 @kindex target tfile
12817 @kindex tfile
12818 @kindex target ctf
12819 @kindex ctf
12820 @item target tfile @var{filename}
12821 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
12822 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
12823 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
12824 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
12825 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
12826 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
12827 @var{filename} or @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
12828 the host.
12829
12830 @smallexample
12831 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
12832 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
12833 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
12834 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
12835 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
12836 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
12837 i = 0
12838 a = 0
12839 b = 1 '\001'
12840 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
12841 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
12842 (@value{GDBP}) p b
12843 $1 = 1
12844 @end smallexample
12845
12846 @end table
12847
12848 @node Overlays
12849 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
12850 @cindex overlays
12851
12852 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
12853 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
12854 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
12855 use overlays.
12856
12857 @menu
12858 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
12859 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
12860 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
12861 mapped by asking the inferior.
12862 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
12863 @end menu
12864
12865 @node How Overlays Work
12866 @section How Overlays Work
12867 @cindex mapped overlays
12868 @cindex unmapped overlays
12869 @cindex load address, overlay's
12870 @cindex mapped address
12871 @cindex overlay area
12872
12873 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
12874 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
12875 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
12876 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
12877 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
12878
12879 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
12880 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
12881 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
12882 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
12883 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
12884 largest overlay as well.
12885
12886 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
12887 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
12888 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
12889 there.
12890
12891 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
12892 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
12893 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
12894
12895 @smallexample
12896 @group
12897 Data Instruction Larger
12898 Address Space Address Space Address Space
12899 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
12900 | | | | | |
12901 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
12902 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
12903 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
12904 | and heap | | | | | |
12905 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
12906 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
12907 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
12908 | | | | | |
12909 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
12910 address | | | | | |
12911 | overlay | <-' | | |
12912 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
12913 | | <---. | | load address
12914 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
12915 | | | |
12916 +-----------+ | |
12917 +-----------+
12918 | |
12919 +-----------+
12920
12921 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
12922 @end group
12923 @end smallexample
12924
12925 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
12926 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
12927 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
12928 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
12929 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
12930 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
12931 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
12932 program and the overlay area.
12933
12934 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
12935 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
12936 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
12937 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
12938 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
12939 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
12940 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
12941
12942 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
12943 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
12944 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
12945
12946 @itemize @bullet
12947
12948 @item
12949 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
12950 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
12951 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
12952 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
12953
12954 @item
12955 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
12956 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
12957 your program's performance.
12958
12959 @item
12960 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
12961 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
12962 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
12963 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
12964 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
12965 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
12966 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
12967
12968 @item
12969 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
12970 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
12971 instruction and data spaces.
12972
12973 @end itemize
12974
12975 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
12976 improved in many ways:
12977
12978 @itemize @bullet
12979
12980 @item
12981 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
12982 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
12983 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
12984 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
12985 area in the usual way.
12986
12987 @item
12988 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
12989 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
12990
12991 @item
12992 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
12993 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
12994 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
12995 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
12996 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
12997 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
12998 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
12999
13000 @end itemize
13001
13002
13003 @node Overlay Commands
13004 @section Overlay Commands
13005
13006 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13007 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13008 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13009 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13010 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13011 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13012
13013 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13014 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
13015
13016 @table @code
13017 @item overlay off
13018 @kindex overlay
13019 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
13020 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13021 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13022 overlay support is disabled.
13023
13024 @item overlay manual
13025 @cindex manual overlay debugging
13026 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13027 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13028 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13029 commands described below.
13030
13031 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13032 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13033 @cindex map an overlay
13034 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
13035 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
13036 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
13037 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
13038 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
13039 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
13040
13041 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
13042 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
13043 @cindex unmap an overlay
13044 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
13045 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
13046 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
13047 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
13048
13049 @item overlay auto
13050 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13051 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
13052 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
13053 Overlay Debugging}.
13054
13055 @item overlay load-target
13056 @itemx overlay load
13057 @cindex reloading the overlay table
13058 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
13059 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
13060 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
13061 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
13062 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
13063
13064 @item overlay list-overlays
13065 @itemx overlay list
13066 @cindex listing mapped overlays
13067 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
13068 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
13069
13070 @end table
13071
13072 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
13073 of the function the address falls in:
13074
13075 @smallexample
13076 (@value{GDBP}) print main
13077 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
13078 @end smallexample
13079 @noindent
13080 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
13081 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
13082 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
13083 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
13084
13085 @smallexample
13086 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13087 No sections are mapped.
13088 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13089 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
13090 @end smallexample
13091 @noindent
13092 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
13093 name normally:
13094
13095 @smallexample
13096 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13097 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
13098 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
13099 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13100 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
13101 @end smallexample
13102
13103 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
13104 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
13105 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
13106 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
13107 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
13108
13109 @itemize @bullet
13110 @item
13111 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
13112 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
13113 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
13114 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
13115 @item
13116 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
13117 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
13118 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
13119 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
13120 breakpoints properly.
13121 @end itemize
13122
13123
13124 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
13125 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
13126 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
13127
13128 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
13129 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
13130 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
13131 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
13132 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
13133 current state of the overlays.
13134
13135 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
13136 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
13137
13138 @table @asis
13139
13140 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
13141 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
13142
13143 @smallexample
13144 struct
13145 @{
13146 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
13147 unsigned long vma;
13148
13149 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
13150 unsigned long size;
13151
13152 /* The overlay's load address. */
13153 unsigned long lma;
13154
13155 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
13156 zero otherwise. */
13157 unsigned long mapped;
13158 @}
13159 @end smallexample
13160
13161 @item @code{_novlys}:
13162 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
13163 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
13164
13165 @end table
13166
13167 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
13168 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
13169 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
13170 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
13171 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
13172 currently mapped.
13173
13174 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
13175 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
13176 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
13177 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
13178 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
13179 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
13180 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
13181 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
13182 are not being executed.
13183
13184 @node Overlay Sample Program
13185 @section Overlay Sample Program
13186 @cindex overlay example program
13187
13188 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
13189 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
13190 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
13191 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
13192 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
13193 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
13194 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
13195
13196 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
13197 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
13198 suite. The program consists of the following files from
13199 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
13200
13201 @table @file
13202 @item overlays.c
13203 The main program file.
13204 @item ovlymgr.c
13205 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
13206 @item foo.c
13207 @itemx bar.c
13208 @itemx baz.c
13209 @itemx grbx.c
13210 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
13211 @item d10v.ld
13212 @itemx m32r.ld
13213 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
13214 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
13215 @end table
13216
13217 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
13218 cross-compiler like this:
13219
13220 @smallexample
13221 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
13222 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
13223 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
13224 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
13225 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
13226 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
13227 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
13228 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
13229 @end smallexample
13230
13231 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
13232 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
13233 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
13234
13235
13236 @node Languages
13237 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
13238 @cindex languages
13239
13240 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
13241 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
13242 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
13243 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
13244 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
13245 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
13246
13247 @cindex working language
13248 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
13249 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
13250 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
13251 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
13252 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
13253 language}.
13254
13255 @menu
13256 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
13257 * Show:: Displaying the language
13258 * Checks:: Type and range checks
13259 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
13260 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
13261 @end menu
13262
13263 @node Setting
13264 @section Switching Between Source Languages
13265
13266 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
13267 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
13268 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
13269 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
13270 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
13271 are printed, etc.
13272
13273 In addition to the working language, every source file that
13274 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
13275 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
13276 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
13277 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
13278 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
13279 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
13280 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
13281 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
13282 Displaying the Language}.
13283
13284 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
13285 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
13286 another language. In that case, make the
13287 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
13288 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
13289 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
13290
13291 @menu
13292 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
13293 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
13294 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
13295 @end menu
13296
13297 @node Filenames
13298 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
13299
13300 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
13301 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
13302
13303 @table @file
13304 @item .ada
13305 @itemx .ads
13306 @itemx .adb
13307 @itemx .a
13308 Ada source file.
13309
13310 @item .c
13311 C source file
13312
13313 @item .C
13314 @itemx .cc
13315 @itemx .cp
13316 @itemx .cpp
13317 @itemx .cxx
13318 @itemx .c++
13319 C@t{++} source file
13320
13321 @item .d
13322 D source file
13323
13324 @item .m
13325 Objective-C source file
13326
13327 @item .f
13328 @itemx .F
13329 Fortran source file
13330
13331 @item .mod
13332 Modula-2 source file
13333
13334 @item .s
13335 @itemx .S
13336 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
13337 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
13338 @end table
13339
13340 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
13341 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
13342
13343 @node Manually
13344 @subsection Setting the Working Language
13345
13346 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
13347 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
13348 your program.
13349
13350 @kindex set language
13351 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
13352 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
13353 a language, such as
13354 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
13355 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
13356
13357 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
13358 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
13359 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
13360 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
13361 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
13362 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
13363 command such as:
13364
13365 @smallexample
13366 print a = b + c
13367 @end smallexample
13368
13369 @noindent
13370 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
13371 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
13372 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
13373 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
13374
13375 @node Automatically
13376 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
13377
13378 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
13379 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
13380 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
13381 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
13382 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
13383 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
13384 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
13385 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
13386 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
13387
13388 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
13389 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
13390 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
13391 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
13392 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
13393
13394 @node Show
13395 @section Displaying the Language
13396
13397 The following commands help you find out which language is the
13398 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
13399
13400 @table @code
13401 @item show language
13402 @anchor{show language}
13403 @kindex show language
13404 Display the current working language. This is the
13405 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
13406 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
13407
13408 @item info frame
13409 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
13410 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
13411 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
13412 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
13413 information listed here.
13414
13415 @item info source
13416 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
13417 Display the source language of this source file.
13418 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
13419 information listed here.
13420 @end table
13421
13422 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
13423 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
13424 with a language explicitly:
13425
13426 @table @code
13427 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
13428 @kindex set extension-language
13429 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
13430 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
13431
13432 @item info extensions
13433 @kindex info extensions
13434 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
13435 @end table
13436
13437 @node Checks
13438 @section Type and Range Checking
13439
13440 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
13441 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
13442 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
13443 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
13444 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
13445 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
13446 errors when your program is running.
13447
13448 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
13449 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
13450 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
13451 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
13452
13453 @menu
13454 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
13455 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
13456 @end menu
13457
13458 @cindex type checking
13459 @cindex checks, type
13460 @node Type Checking
13461 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
13462
13463 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
13464 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
13465 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
13466 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
13467
13468 @smallexample
13469 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
13470
13471 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
13472 $1 = 2
13473 @exdent but
13474 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
13475 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
13476 @end smallexample
13477
13478 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
13479 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
13480
13481 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
13482 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
13483 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
13484 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
13485 expressions like the second example above.
13486
13487 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
13488 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
13489 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
13490 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
13491 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
13492 little sense to evaluate anyway.
13493
13494 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
13495
13496 @kindex set check type
13497 @kindex show check type
13498 @table @code
13499 @item set check type on
13500 @itemx set check type off
13501 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
13502 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
13503 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
13504
13505 @item show check type
13506 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
13507 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
13508 @end table
13509
13510 @cindex range checking
13511 @cindex checks, range
13512 @node Range Checking
13513 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
13514
13515 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
13516 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
13517 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
13518 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
13519 not exceed the bounds of the array.
13520
13521 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
13522 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
13523 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
13524 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
13525
13526 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
13527 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
13528 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
13529 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
13530 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
13531 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
13532
13533 @smallexample
13534 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
13535 @end smallexample
13536
13537 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
13538 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
13539 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
13540
13541 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
13542
13543 @kindex set check range
13544 @kindex show check range
13545 @table @code
13546 @item set check range auto
13547 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
13548 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
13549 each language.
13550
13551 @item set check range on
13552 @itemx set check range off
13553 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
13554 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
13555 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
13556 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
13557
13558 @item set check range warn
13559 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
13560 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
13561 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
13562 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
13563 systems).
13564
13565 @item show range
13566 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
13567 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
13568 @end table
13569
13570 @node Supported Languages
13571 @section Supported Languages
13572
13573 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran, Java,
13574 OpenCL C, Pascal, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
13575 @c This is false ...
13576 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
13577 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
13578 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
13579 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
13580 language.
13581
13582 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
13583 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
13584 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
13585 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
13586 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
13587 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
13588 language reference or tutorial.
13589
13590 @menu
13591 * C:: C and C@t{++}
13592 * D:: D
13593 * Go:: Go
13594 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
13595 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
13596 * Fortran:: Fortran
13597 * Pascal:: Pascal
13598 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
13599 * Ada:: Ada
13600 @end menu
13601
13602 @node C
13603 @subsection C and C@t{++}
13604
13605 @cindex C and C@t{++}
13606 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
13607
13608 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
13609 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
13610 together.
13611
13612 @cindex C@t{++}
13613 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
13614 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
13615 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
13616 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
13617 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
13618 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
13619 compiler (@code{aCC}).
13620
13621 @menu
13622 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
13623 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
13624 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
13625 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
13626 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
13627 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
13628 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
13629 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
13630 @end menu
13631
13632 @node C Operators
13633 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
13634
13635 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
13636
13637 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
13638 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
13639 often defined on groups of types.
13640
13641 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
13642
13643 @itemize @bullet
13644
13645 @item
13646 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
13647 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
13648
13649 @item
13650 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
13651 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
13652
13653 @item
13654 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
13655
13656 @item
13657 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
13658
13659 @end itemize
13660
13661 @noindent
13662 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
13663 in order of increasing precedence:
13664
13665 @table @code
13666 @item ,
13667 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
13668 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
13669 expression being the last expression evaluated.
13670
13671 @item =
13672 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
13673 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
13674
13675 @item @var{op}=
13676 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
13677 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
13678 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
13679 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
13680 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
13681
13682 @item ?:
13683 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
13684 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
13685 integral type.
13686
13687 @item ||
13688 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13689
13690 @item &&
13691 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
13692
13693 @item |
13694 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13695
13696 @item ^
13697 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13698
13699 @item &
13700 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
13701
13702 @item ==@r{, }!=
13703 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
13704 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
13705
13706 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
13707 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
13708 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
13709 and non-zero for true.
13710
13711 @item <<@r{, }>>
13712 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
13713
13714 @item @@
13715 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
13716
13717 @item +@r{, }-
13718 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
13719 pointer types.
13720
13721 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
13722 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
13723 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
13724 integral types.
13725
13726 @item ++@r{, }--
13727 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
13728 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
13729 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
13730 operation takes place.
13731
13732 @item *
13733 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
13734 @code{++}.
13735
13736 @item &
13737 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
13738
13739 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
13740 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
13741 to examine the address
13742 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
13743 stored.
13744
13745 @item -
13746 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
13747 precedence as @code{++}.
13748
13749 @item !
13750 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
13751 @code{++}.
13752
13753 @item ~
13754 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
13755 @code{++}.
13756
13757
13758 @item .@r{, }->
13759 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
13760 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
13761 pointer based on the stored type information.
13762 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
13763
13764 @item .*@r{, }->*
13765 Dereferences of pointers to members.
13766
13767 @item []
13768 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
13769 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
13770
13771 @item ()
13772 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
13773
13774 @item ::
13775 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
13776 and @code{class} types.
13777
13778 @item ::
13779 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
13780 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
13781 above.
13782 @end table
13783
13784 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
13785 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
13786 predefined meaning.
13787
13788 @node C Constants
13789 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
13790
13791 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
13792
13793 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
13794 following ways:
13795
13796 @itemize @bullet
13797 @item
13798 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
13799 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
13800 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
13801 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
13802 @code{long} value.
13803
13804 @item
13805 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
13806 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
13807 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
13808 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
13809 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
13810 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
13811 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
13812 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
13813 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
13814 constant.
13815
13816 @item
13817 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
13818 integral equivalents.
13819
13820 @item
13821 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
13822 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
13823 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
13824 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
13825 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
13826 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
13827 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
13828 @samp{\n} for newline.
13829
13830 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
13831 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
13832 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
13833 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
13834
13835 @item
13836 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
13837 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
13838 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
13839 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
13840 characters.
13841
13842 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
13843 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
13844 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
13845
13846 @item
13847 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
13848 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
13849
13850 @item
13851 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
13852 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
13853 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
13854 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
13855 @end itemize
13856
13857 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
13858 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
13859
13860 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
13861 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
13862
13863 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
13864 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
13865 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
13866 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
13867 @quotation
13868 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
13869 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
13870 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
13871 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
13872 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
13873 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
13874 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
13875 code. @xref{Compilation}.
13876 @end quotation
13877
13878 @enumerate
13879
13880 @cindex member functions
13881 @item
13882 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
13883
13884 @smallexample
13885 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
13886 @end smallexample
13887
13888 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
13889 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
13890 @item
13891 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
13892 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
13893 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
13894 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
13895 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
13896
13897 @cindex call overloaded functions
13898 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
13899 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
13900 @item
13901 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
13902 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
13903 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
13904 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
13905 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
13906 default arguments.
13907
13908 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
13909 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
13910 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
13911 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
13912 number of function arguments.
13913
13914 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
13915 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
13916 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
13917
13918 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
13919 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
13920 @smallexample
13921 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
13922 @end smallexample
13923
13924 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
13925 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
13926
13927 @cindex reference declarations
13928 @item
13929 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
13930 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
13931 dereferenced.
13932
13933 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
13934 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
13935 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
13936 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
13937 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
13938
13939 @item
13940 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
13941 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
13942 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
13943 necessary, for example in an expression like
13944 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
13945 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
13946 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
13947
13948 @item
13949 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
13950 specification.
13951 @end enumerate
13952
13953 @node C Defaults
13954 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
13955
13956 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
13957
13958 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
13959 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
13960 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
13961 selects the working language.
13962
13963 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
13964 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
13965 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
13966 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
13967 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
13968 for further details.
13969
13970 @node C Checks
13971 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
13972
13973 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
13974
13975 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
13976 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
13977 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
13978 constants to pointers.
13979
13980 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
13981 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
13982 that is not itself an array.
13983
13984 @node Debugging C
13985 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
13986
13987 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
13988 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
13989 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
13990 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
13991
13992 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
13993 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
13994 ,Expressions}.
13995
13996 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
13997 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
13998
13999 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
14000
14001 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14002 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
14003
14004 @table @code
14005 @cindex break in overloaded functions
14006 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
14007 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14008 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14009 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14010 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14011
14012 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14013 @item rbreak @var{regex}
14014 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14015 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14016 classes.
14017 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14018
14019 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14020 @item catch throw
14021 @itemx catch rethrow
14022 @itemx catch catch
14023 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
14024 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14025
14026 @cindex inheritance
14027 @item ptype @var{typename}
14028 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14029 @var{typename}.
14030 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14031
14032 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
14033 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
14034 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
14035 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
14036 multiple inheritance is in use.
14037
14038 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
14039 @item set print demangle
14040 @itemx show print demangle
14041 @itemx set print asm-demangle
14042 @itemx show print asm-demangle
14043 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
14044 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
14045 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14046
14047 @item set print object
14048 @itemx show print object
14049 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
14050 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14051
14052 @item set print vtbl
14053 @itemx show print vtbl
14054 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
14055 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14056 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
14057 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
14058
14059 @kindex set overload-resolution
14060 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
14061 @item set overload-resolution on
14062 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
14063 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
14064 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
14065 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
14066 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
14067 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
14068
14069 @item set overload-resolution off
14070 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
14071 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14072 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
14073 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
14074 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14075 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
14076 argument types.
14077
14078 @kindex show overload-resolution
14079 @item show overload-resolution
14080 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
14081
14082 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
14083 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
14084 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
14085 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
14086 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
14087 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
14088 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
14089 @end table
14090
14091 @node Decimal Floating Point
14092 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
14093 @cindex decimal floating point format
14094
14095 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
14096 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
14097 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
14098 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
14099
14100 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
14101 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
14102 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
14103 configured target.
14104
14105 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
14106 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
14107 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
14108
14109 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
14110 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
14111 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
14112
14113 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
14114 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
14115 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
14116
14117 @node D
14118 @subsection D
14119
14120 @cindex D
14121 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
14122 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
14123 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
14124
14125 @node Go
14126 @subsection Go
14127
14128 @cindex Go (programming language)
14129 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
14130 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
14131
14132 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
14133
14134 @table @code
14135 @cindex current Go package
14136 @item The current Go package
14137 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
14138 specifying global variables and functions.
14139
14140 For example, given the program:
14141
14142 @example
14143 package main
14144 var myglob = "Shall we?"
14145 func main () @{
14146 // ...
14147 @}
14148 @end example
14149
14150 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
14151
14152 @example
14153 (gdb) p myglob
14154 (gdb) p main.myglob
14155 @end example
14156
14157 @cindex builtin Go types
14158 @item Builtin Go types
14159 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
14160 as a string.
14161
14162 @cindex builtin Go functions
14163 @item Builtin Go functions
14164 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
14165 function and handles it internally.
14166
14167 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
14168 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
14169 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
14170 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
14171 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
14172 @end table
14173
14174 @node Objective-C
14175 @subsection Objective-C
14176
14177 @cindex Objective-C
14178 This section provides information about some commands and command
14179 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
14180 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
14181 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
14182
14183 @menu
14184 * Method Names in Commands::
14185 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
14186 @end menu
14187
14188 @node Method Names in Commands
14189 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
14190
14191 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
14192 names as line specifications:
14193
14194 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
14195 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
14196 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
14197 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
14198 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
14199 @itemize
14200 @item @code{clear}
14201 @item @code{break}
14202 @item @code{info line}
14203 @item @code{jump}
14204 @item @code{list}
14205 @end itemize
14206
14207 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
14208
14209 @smallexample
14210 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
14211 @end smallexample
14212
14213 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
14214 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
14215 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
14216 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
14217 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
14218 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
14219 debugged, enter:
14220
14221 @smallexample
14222 break -[Fruit create]
14223 @end smallexample
14224
14225 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
14226 enter:
14227
14228 @smallexample
14229 list +[NSText initialize]
14230 @end smallexample
14231
14232 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
14233 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
14234 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
14235 is also possible to specify just a method name:
14236
14237 @smallexample
14238 break create
14239 @end smallexample
14240
14241 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
14242 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
14243 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
14244 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
14245 none apply.
14246
14247 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
14248 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
14249
14250 @smallexample
14251 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
14252 @end smallexample
14253
14254 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
14255 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
14256 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
14257 @kindex print-object
14258 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
14259
14260 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
14261
14262 @smallexample
14263 print -[@var{object} hash]
14264 @end smallexample
14265
14266 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
14267 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
14268 @noindent
14269 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
14270 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
14271 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
14272 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
14273 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
14274 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
14275
14276 @node OpenCL C
14277 @subsection OpenCL C
14278
14279 @cindex OpenCL C
14280 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
14281
14282 @menu
14283 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
14284 * OpenCL C Expressions::
14285 * OpenCL C Operators::
14286 @end menu
14287
14288 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
14289 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
14290
14291 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
14292 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
14293 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
14294 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
14295 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
14296
14297 @node OpenCL C Expressions
14298 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
14299
14300 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
14301 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
14302 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
14303 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
14304
14305 @node OpenCL C Operators
14306 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
14307
14308 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
14309 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
14310 vector data types.
14311
14312 @node Fortran
14313 @subsection Fortran
14314 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
14315
14316 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
14317 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
14318
14319 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
14320 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
14321 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
14322 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
14323 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
14324 underscore.
14325
14326 @menu
14327 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
14328 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
14329 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
14330 @end menu
14331
14332 @node Fortran Operators
14333 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
14334
14335 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
14336
14337 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14338 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
14339 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
14340
14341 @table @code
14342 @item **
14343 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
14344 of the second one.
14345
14346 @item :
14347 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
14348 represent a section of array.
14349
14350 @item %
14351 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
14352 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
14353 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
14354 union type.
14355 @end table
14356
14357 @node Fortran Defaults
14358 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
14359
14360 @cindex Fortran Defaults
14361
14362 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
14363 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
14364 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
14365 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
14366
14367 @node Special Fortran Commands
14368 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
14369
14370 @cindex Special Fortran commands
14371
14372 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
14373 such as displaying common blocks.
14374
14375 @table @code
14376 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
14377 @kindex info common
14378 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
14379 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
14380 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
14381 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
14382 printed.
14383 @end table
14384
14385 @node Pascal
14386 @subsection Pascal
14387
14388 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
14389 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
14390 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
14391 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
14392 syntax.
14393
14394 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
14395 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
14396 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
14397
14398 @node Modula-2
14399 @subsection Modula-2
14400
14401 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
14402
14403 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
14404 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
14405 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
14406 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
14407 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
14408 table.
14409
14410 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
14411 @menu
14412 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
14413 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
14414 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
14415 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
14416 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
14417 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
14418 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
14419 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
14420 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
14421 @end menu
14422
14423 @node M2 Operators
14424 @subsubsection Operators
14425 @cindex Modula-2 operators
14426
14427 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14428 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14429 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
14430 following definitions hold:
14431
14432 @itemize @bullet
14433
14434 @item
14435 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
14436 their subranges.
14437
14438 @item
14439 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
14440
14441 @item
14442 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
14443
14444 @item
14445 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
14446 @var{type}}.
14447
14448 @item
14449 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
14450
14451 @item
14452 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
14453
14454 @item
14455 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
14456 @end itemize
14457
14458 @noindent
14459 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
14460 increasing precedence:
14461
14462 @table @code
14463 @item ,
14464 Function argument or array index separator.
14465
14466 @item :=
14467 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
14468 @var{value}.
14469
14470 @item <@r{, }>
14471 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
14472 types.
14473
14474 @item <=@r{, }>=
14475 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
14476 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
14477 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
14478
14479 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
14480 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
14481 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
14482 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
14483 comment character.
14484
14485 @item IN
14486 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
14487 Same precedence as @code{<}.
14488
14489 @item OR
14490 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
14491
14492 @item AND@r{, }&
14493 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
14494
14495 @item @@
14496 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14497
14498 @item +@r{, }-
14499 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
14500 and difference on set types.
14501
14502 @item *
14503 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
14504 on set types.
14505
14506 @item /
14507 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
14508 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
14509
14510 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
14511 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
14512 precedence as @code{*}.
14513
14514 @item -
14515 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
14516
14517 @item ^
14518 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
14519
14520 @item NOT
14521 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
14522 @code{^}.
14523
14524 @item .
14525 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
14526 precedence as @code{^}.
14527
14528 @item []
14529 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
14530
14531 @item ()
14532 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
14533 as @code{^}.
14534
14535 @item ::@r{, }.
14536 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
14537 @end table
14538
14539 @quotation
14540 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
14541 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
14542 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
14543 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
14544 @end quotation
14545
14546
14547 @node Built-In Func/Proc
14548 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
14549 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
14550
14551 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
14552 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
14553
14554 @table @var
14555
14556 @item a
14557 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
14558
14559 @item c
14560 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
14561
14562 @item i
14563 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
14564
14565 @item m
14566 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
14567 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
14568 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
14569
14570 @item n
14571 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
14572
14573 @item r
14574 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
14575
14576 @item t
14577 represents a type.
14578
14579 @item v
14580 represents a variable.
14581
14582 @item x
14583 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
14584 explanation of the function for details.
14585 @end table
14586
14587 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
14588
14589 @table @code
14590 @item ABS(@var{n})
14591 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
14592
14593 @item CAP(@var{c})
14594 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
14595 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
14596
14597 @item CHR(@var{i})
14598 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
14599
14600 @item DEC(@var{v})
14601 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
14602
14603 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
14604 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
14605 new value.
14606
14607 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
14608 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
14609 set.
14610
14611 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
14612 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
14613
14614 @item HIGH(@var{a})
14615 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
14616
14617 @item INC(@var{v})
14618 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
14619
14620 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
14621 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
14622 new value.
14623
14624 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
14625 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
14626 there. Returns the new set.
14627
14628 @item MAX(@var{t})
14629 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
14630
14631 @item MIN(@var{t})
14632 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
14633
14634 @item ODD(@var{i})
14635 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
14636
14637 @item ORD(@var{x})
14638 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
14639 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
14640 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
14641 integral, character and enumerated types.
14642
14643 @item SIZE(@var{x})
14644 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
14645
14646 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
14647 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
14648
14649 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
14650 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
14651
14652 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
14653 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
14654 @end table
14655
14656 @quotation
14657 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
14658 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
14659 an error.
14660 @end quotation
14661
14662 @cindex Modula-2 constants
14663 @node M2 Constants
14664 @subsubsection Constants
14665
14666 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
14667 ways:
14668
14669 @itemize @bullet
14670
14671 @item
14672 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
14673 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
14674 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
14675 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
14676
14677 @item
14678 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
14679 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
14680 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
14681 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
14682 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
14683 digits.
14684
14685 @item
14686 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
14687 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
14688 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
14689 followed by a @samp{C}.
14690
14691 @item
14692 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
14693 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
14694 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
14695 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
14696 sequences.
14697
14698 @item
14699 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
14700
14701 @item
14702 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
14703 @code{FALSE}.
14704
14705 @item
14706 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
14707
14708 @item
14709 Set constants are not yet supported.
14710 @end itemize
14711
14712 @node M2 Types
14713 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
14714 @cindex Modula-2 types
14715
14716 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
14717 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
14718 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
14719 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
14720 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
14721 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
14722
14723 The first example contains the following section of code:
14724
14725 @smallexample
14726 VAR
14727 s: SET OF CHAR ;
14728 r: [20..40] ;
14729 @end smallexample
14730
14731 @noindent
14732 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
14733 @code{r} and @code{s}.
14734
14735 @smallexample
14736 (@value{GDBP}) print s
14737 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
14738 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14739 SET OF CHAR
14740 (@value{GDBP}) print r
14741 21
14742 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
14743 [20..40]
14744 @end smallexample
14745
14746 @noindent
14747 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
14748
14749 @smallexample
14750 VAR
14751 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
14752 @end smallexample
14753
14754 @noindent
14755 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
14756
14757 @smallexample
14758 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14759 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
14760 @end smallexample
14761
14762 @noindent
14763 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
14764 expressions using the debugger.
14765
14766 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
14767 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
14768
14769 @smallexample
14770 VAR
14771 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
14772 @end smallexample
14773
14774 @smallexample
14775 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14776 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
14777 @end smallexample
14778
14779 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
14780 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
14781 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
14782 above.
14783
14784 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
14785
14786 @smallexample
14787 TYPE
14788 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
14789 t = [blue..yellow] ;
14790 VAR
14791 s: t ;
14792 BEGIN
14793 s := blue ;
14794 @end smallexample
14795
14796 @noindent
14797 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
14798 and value of a variable.
14799
14800 @smallexample
14801 (@value{GDBP}) print s
14802 $1 = blue
14803 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
14804 type = [blue..yellow]
14805 @end smallexample
14806
14807 @noindent
14808 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
14809 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
14810 their @code{C} counterparts.
14811
14812 @smallexample
14813 VAR
14814 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
14815 BEGIN
14816 s[1] := 1 ;
14817 @end smallexample
14818
14819 @smallexample
14820 (@value{GDBP}) print s
14821 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
14822 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14823 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
14824 @end smallexample
14825
14826 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
14827 pointer types as shown in this example:
14828
14829 @smallexample
14830 VAR
14831 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
14832 BEGIN
14833 NEW(s) ;
14834 s^[1] := 1 ;
14835 @end smallexample
14836
14837 @noindent
14838 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
14839
14840 @smallexample
14841 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14842 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
14843 @end smallexample
14844
14845 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
14846 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
14847 types:
14848
14849 @smallexample
14850 TYPE
14851 foo = RECORD
14852 f1: CARDINAL ;
14853 f2: CHAR ;
14854 f3: myarray ;
14855 END ;
14856
14857 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
14858 myrange = [-2..2] ;
14859 VAR
14860 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
14861 @end smallexample
14862
14863 @noindent
14864 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
14865 below.
14866
14867 @smallexample
14868 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14869 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
14870 f1 : CARDINAL;
14871 f2 : CHAR;
14872 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
14873 END
14874 @end smallexample
14875
14876 @node M2 Defaults
14877 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
14878 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
14879
14880 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
14881 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
14882 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14883 selected the working language.
14884
14885 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
14886 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
14887 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
14888 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
14889
14890 @node Deviations
14891 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
14892 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
14893
14894 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
14895 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
14896
14897 @itemize @bullet
14898 @item
14899 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
14900 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
14901 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
14902 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
14903 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
14904 returned a pointer.)
14905
14906 @item
14907 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
14908 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
14909 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
14910 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
14911
14912 @item
14913 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
14914 argument.
14915
14916 @item
14917 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
14918 @end itemize
14919
14920 @node M2 Checks
14921 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
14922 @cindex Modula-2 checks
14923
14924 @quotation
14925 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
14926 range checking.
14927 @end quotation
14928 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
14929
14930 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
14931
14932 @itemize @bullet
14933 @item
14934 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
14935 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
14936
14937 @item
14938 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
14939 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
14940 @end itemize
14941
14942 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
14943 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
14944
14945 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
14946 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
14947
14948 @node M2 Scope
14949 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
14950 @cindex scope
14951 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
14952 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
14953 @ifinfo
14954 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
14955 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
14956 @end ifinfo
14957 @ifnotinfo
14958 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
14959 @end ifnotinfo
14960
14961 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
14962 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
14963 similar syntax:
14964
14965 @smallexample
14966
14967 @var{module} . @var{id}
14968 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
14969 @end smallexample
14970
14971 @noindent
14972 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
14973 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
14974 identifier within your program, except another module.
14975
14976 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
14977 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
14978 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
14979 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
14980
14981 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
14982 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
14983 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
14984 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
14985 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
14986 @var{module}.
14987
14988 @node GDB/M2
14989 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
14990
14991 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
14992 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
14993 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
14994 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
14995 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
14996 analogue in Modula-2.
14997
14998 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
14999 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
15000 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
15001 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
15002 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
15003 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
15004
15005 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
15006 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
15007 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
15008
15009 @node Ada
15010 @subsection Ada
15011 @cindex Ada
15012
15013 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
15014 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
15015 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
15016 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15017 to be difficult.
15018
15019
15020 @cindex expressions in Ada
15021 @menu
15022 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
15023 and semantics supported by Ada mode
15024 in @value{GDBN}.
15025 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
15026 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
15027 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
15028 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
15029 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
15030 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15031 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
15032 Profile
15033 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
15034 @end menu
15035
15036 @node Ada Mode Intro
15037 @subsubsection Introduction
15038 @cindex Ada mode, general
15039
15040 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
15041 syntax, with some extensions.
15042 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
15043
15044 @itemize @bullet
15045 @item
15046 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
15047 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
15048 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
15049 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
15050
15051 @item
15052 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
15053 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15054
15055 @item
15056 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15057 @end itemize
15058
15059 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
15060 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
15061 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
15062 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
15063 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
15064
15065 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
15066 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
15067 was translated from an Ada source file.
15068
15069 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
15070 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
15071 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
15072 middle (to allow based literals).
15073
15074 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
15075 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
15076 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
15077 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
15078 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
15079 functions to procedures elsewhere.
15080
15081 @node Omissions from Ada
15082 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
15083 @cindex Ada, omissions from
15084
15085 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
15086
15087 @itemize @bullet
15088 @item
15089 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
15090
15091 @itemize @minus
15092 @item
15093 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
15094 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
15095
15096 @item
15097 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
15098
15099 @item
15100 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
15101
15102 @item
15103 @t{'Tag}.
15104
15105 @item
15106 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
15107 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
15108
15109 @item
15110 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
15111 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
15112
15113 @item
15114 @t{'Address}.
15115 @end itemize
15116
15117 @item
15118 The names in
15119 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
15120 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
15121 not currently available.
15122
15123 @item
15124 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
15125 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
15126 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
15127 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
15128 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
15129 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
15130 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
15131 indeterminate values.
15132
15133 @item
15134 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
15135 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
15136 are not implemented.
15137
15138 @item
15139 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
15140 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
15141 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
15142 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
15143 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
15144
15145 @smallexample
15146 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
15147 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
15148 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
15149 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
15150 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
15151 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
15152 @end smallexample
15153
15154 Changing a
15155 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
15156 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
15157 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
15158 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
15159 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
15160 declared to have a type such as:
15161
15162 @smallexample
15163 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
15164 Id : Integer;
15165 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
15166 end record;
15167 @end smallexample
15168
15169 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
15170 assignments:
15171
15172 @smallexample
15173 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
15174 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
15175 @end smallexample
15176
15177 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
15178 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
15179 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
15180 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
15181 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
15182 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
15183 redundant component associations, although which component values are
15184 assigned in such cases is not defined.
15185
15186 @item
15187 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
15188
15189 @item
15190 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
15191 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
15192 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
15193 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
15194 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
15195 the proper resolution.
15196
15197 @item
15198 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
15199
15200 @item
15201 Entry calls are not implemented.
15202
15203 @item
15204 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
15205 formats are not supported.
15206
15207 @item
15208 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
15209
15210 @item
15211 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
15212 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
15213 context.
15214 Should your program
15215 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
15216 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
15217 @end itemize
15218
15219 @node Additions to Ada
15220 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
15221 @cindex Ada, deviations from
15222
15223 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
15224 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
15225
15226 @itemize @bullet
15227 @item
15228 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
15229 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
15230 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
15231 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
15232 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
15233 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
15234 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
15235 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
15236
15237 @item
15238 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
15239 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
15240 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
15241
15242 @item
15243 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
15244 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
15245
15246 @item
15247 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
15248 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
15249 @end itemize
15250
15251 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
15252 additions specific to Ada:
15253
15254 @itemize @bullet
15255 @item
15256 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
15257 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
15258
15259 @smallexample
15260 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
15261 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
15262 @end smallexample
15263
15264 @item
15265 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
15266 the value of its right-hand operand.
15267 This allows, for example,
15268 complex conditional breaks:
15269
15270 @smallexample
15271 (@value{GDBP}) break f
15272 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
15273 @end smallexample
15274
15275 @item
15276 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
15277 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
15278 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
15279 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
15280 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
15281 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
15282 in strings. For example,
15283 @smallexample
15284 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
15285 @end smallexample
15286 @noindent
15287 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
15288 after each period.
15289
15290 @item
15291 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
15292 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
15293 to write
15294
15295 @smallexample
15296 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
15297 @end smallexample
15298
15299 @item
15300 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
15301 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
15302 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
15303 of 3 might print as
15304
15305 @smallexample
15306 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
15307 @end smallexample
15308
15309 @noindent
15310 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
15311 clause.
15312
15313 @item
15314 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
15315 multi-character subsequence of
15316 their names (an exact match gets preference).
15317 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
15318 in place of @t{a'length}.
15319
15320 @item
15321 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
15322 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
15323 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
15324 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
15325 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
15326 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
15327 For example,
15328 @smallexample
15329 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
15330 @end smallexample
15331
15332 @item
15333 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
15334 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
15335 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
15336 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
15337 object.
15338
15339 @end itemize
15340
15341 @node Stopping Before Main Program
15342 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
15343
15344 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
15345 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
15346 before reaching the main procedure.
15347 As defined in the Ada Reference
15348 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
15349 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
15350 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
15351 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
15352
15353 @node Ada Exceptions
15354 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
15355
15356 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
15357
15358 @table @code
15359 @kindex info exceptions
15360 @item info exceptions
15361 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
15362 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
15363 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
15364 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
15365 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
15366 @end table
15367
15368 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
15369 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
15370 argument.
15371
15372 @smallexample
15373 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
15374 All defined Ada exceptions:
15375 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15376 program_error: 0x613d20
15377 storage_error: 0x613ce0
15378 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
15379 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15380 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
15381 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
15382 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15383 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15384 @end smallexample
15385
15386 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
15387 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
15388
15389 @node Ada Tasks
15390 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
15391 @cindex Ada, tasking
15392
15393 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
15394 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
15395
15396 @table @code
15397 @kindex info tasks
15398 @item info tasks
15399 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
15400
15401
15402 @smallexample
15403 @iftex
15404 @leftskip=0.5cm
15405 @end iftex
15406 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15407 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15408 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15409 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
15410 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
15411 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
15412
15413 @end smallexample
15414
15415 @noindent
15416 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
15417 task currently being inspected.
15418
15419 @table @asis
15420 @item ID
15421 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
15422
15423 @item TID
15424 The Ada task ID.
15425
15426 @item P-ID
15427 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
15428
15429 @item Pri
15430 The base priority of the task.
15431
15432 @item State
15433 Current state of the task.
15434
15435 @table @code
15436 @item Unactivated
15437 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
15438 executing.
15439
15440 @item Runnable
15441 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
15442 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
15443
15444 @item Terminated
15445 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
15446 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
15447 terminated themselves.
15448
15449 @item Child Activation Wait
15450 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
15451
15452 @item Accept Statement
15453 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
15454
15455 @item Waiting on entry call
15456 The task is waiting on an entry call.
15457
15458 @item Async Select Wait
15459 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
15460 select statement.
15461
15462 @item Delay Sleep
15463 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
15464 alternative open.
15465
15466 @item Child Termination Wait
15467 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
15468 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
15469 waiting on a terminate Phase.
15470
15471 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
15472 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
15473 finish terminating.
15474
15475 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
15476 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
15477 @end table
15478
15479 @item Name
15480 Name of the task in the program.
15481
15482 @end table
15483
15484 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
15485 @item info task @var{taskno}
15486 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
15487 the following example:
15488 @smallexample
15489 @iftex
15490 @leftskip=0.5cm
15491 @end iftex
15492 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15493 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15494 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15495 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
15496 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
15497 Ada Task: 0x807c468
15498 Name: task_1
15499 Thread: 0x807f378
15500 Parent: 1 (main_task)
15501 Base Priority: 15
15502 State: Runnable
15503 @end smallexample
15504
15505 @item task
15506 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
15507 @cindex current Ada task ID
15508 This command prints the ID of the current task.
15509
15510 @smallexample
15511 @iftex
15512 @leftskip=0.5cm
15513 @end iftex
15514 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15515 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15516 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15517 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
15518 (@value{GDBP}) task
15519 [Current task is 2]
15520 @end smallexample
15521
15522 @item task @var{taskno}
15523 @cindex Ada task switching
15524 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
15525 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
15526 from the current task to the given task.
15527
15528 @smallexample
15529 @iftex
15530 @leftskip=0.5cm
15531 @end iftex
15532 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15533 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15534 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15535 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
15536 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
15537 [Switching to task 1]
15538 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
15539 (@value{GDBP}) bt
15540 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
15541 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
15542 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
15543 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
15544 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
15545 @end smallexample
15546
15547 @item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno}
15548 @itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
15549 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
15550 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
15551 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
15552 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
15553 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}).
15554 @var{linespec} specifies source lines, as described
15555 in @ref{Specify Location}.
15556
15557 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
15558 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
15559 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. @var{taskno} is one of the
15560 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
15561 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
15562
15563 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
15564 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
15565 program.
15566
15567 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
15568 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
15569 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
15570
15571 For example,
15572
15573 @smallexample
15574 @iftex
15575 @leftskip=0.5cm
15576 @end iftex
15577 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15578 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15579 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15580 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
15581 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
15582 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
15583 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
15584 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
15585 (@value{GDBP}) cont
15586 Continuing.
15587 task # 1 running
15588 task # 2 running
15589
15590 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
15591 15 flush;
15592 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15593 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15594 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15595 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
15596 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
15597 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
15598 @end smallexample
15599 @end table
15600
15601 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
15602 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15603 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
15604
15605 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
15606 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
15607 the platform being used.
15608 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
15609 switching is not supported. On Tru64, however, task switching will work
15610 as usual.
15611
15612 On certain platforms, including Tru64, the debugger needs to perform some
15613 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
15614 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
15615 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
15616 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
15617 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
15618
15619 @node Ravenscar Profile
15620 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
15621 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
15622
15623 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
15624 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
15625 requirements.
15626
15627 @table @code
15628 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
15629 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
15630 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
15631 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
15632 Profile. This is the default.
15633
15634 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
15635 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
15636 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
15637 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
15638 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
15639 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
15640 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
15641
15642 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
15643 @item show ravenscar task-switching
15644 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
15645 using the Ravenscar Profile.
15646
15647 @end table
15648
15649 @node Ada Glitches
15650 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
15651 @cindex Ada, problems
15652
15653 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
15654 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
15655 @value{GDBN},
15656 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
15657 and the GNU Ada compiler.
15658
15659 @itemize @bullet
15660 @item
15661 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
15662 storage are invisible to the debugger.
15663
15664 @item
15665 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
15666 argument lists are treated as positional).
15667
15668 @item
15669 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
15670
15671 @item
15672 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
15673 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
15674 the host machine.
15675
15676 @item
15677 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
15678 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
15679 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
15680 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
15681 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
15682 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
15683 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
15684 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
15685 you can usually resolve the confusion
15686 by qualifying the problematic names with package
15687 @code{Standard} explicitly.
15688 @end itemize
15689
15690 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
15691 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
15692 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
15693 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
15694 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
15695 enabled.
15696
15697 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
15698 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
15699 @table @code
15700
15701 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
15702 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
15703 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
15704 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
15705 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
15706 This is the default.
15707
15708 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
15709 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
15710 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
15711 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
15712 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
15713 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
15714 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
15715
15716 @end table
15717
15718 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
15719 @cindex GNAT encoding
15720 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
15721 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
15722 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
15723 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
15724 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
15725 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
15726
15727 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
15728 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
15729 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
15730 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
15731 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
15732 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
15733 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
15734 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
15735
15736 @table @code
15737
15738 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
15739 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
15740 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
15741 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
15742
15743 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
15744 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
15745 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
15746
15747 @end table
15748
15749 @node Unsupported Languages
15750 @section Unsupported Languages
15751
15752 @cindex unsupported languages
15753 @cindex minimal language
15754 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
15755 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
15756 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
15757 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
15758 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
15759 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
15760
15761 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
15762 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
15763 language.
15764
15765 @node Symbols
15766 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
15767
15768 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
15769 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
15770 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
15771 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
15772 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
15773 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
15774 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
15775
15776 @cindex symbol names
15777 @cindex names of symbols
15778 @cindex quoting names
15779 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
15780 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
15781 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
15782 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
15783 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
15784 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
15785 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
15786 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
15787
15788 @smallexample
15789 p 'foo.c'::x
15790 @end smallexample
15791
15792 @noindent
15793 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
15794
15795 @table @code
15796 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
15797 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
15798 @kindex set case-sensitive
15799 @item set case-sensitive on
15800 @itemx set case-sensitive off
15801 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
15802 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
15803 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
15804 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
15805 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
15806 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
15807 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
15808 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
15809 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
15810 case-insensitive matches.
15811
15812 @kindex show case-sensitive
15813 @item show case-sensitive
15814 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
15815 lookups.
15816
15817 @kindex set print type methods
15818 @item set print type methods
15819 @itemx set print type methods on
15820 @itemx set print type methods off
15821 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
15822 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
15823 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
15824 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
15825 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
15826 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
15827
15828 @kindex show print type methods
15829 @item show print type methods
15830 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
15831 classes.
15832
15833 @kindex set print type typedefs
15834 @item set print type typedefs
15835 @itemx set print type typedefs on
15836 @itemx set print type typedefs off
15837
15838 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
15839 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
15840 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
15841 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
15842 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
15843 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
15844 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
15845 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
15846 types.
15847
15848 @kindex show print type typedefs
15849 @item show print type typedefs
15850 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
15851 printing classes.
15852
15853 @kindex info address
15854 @cindex address of a symbol
15855 @item info address @var{symbol}
15856 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
15857 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
15858 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
15859 is always stored.
15860
15861 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
15862 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
15863 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
15864
15865 @kindex info symbol
15866 @cindex symbol from address
15867 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
15868 @item info symbol @var{addr}
15869 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
15870 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
15871 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
15872
15873 @smallexample
15874 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
15875 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
15876 @end smallexample
15877
15878 @noindent
15879 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
15880 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
15881
15882 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
15883 library containing the symbol is also printed:
15884
15885 @smallexample
15886 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
15887 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
15888 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
15889 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
15890 @end smallexample
15891
15892 @kindex whatis
15893 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
15894 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
15895 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
15896 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
15897
15898 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
15899 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
15900 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
15901
15902 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
15903 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
15904 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
15905 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
15906 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
15907 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
15908 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
15909 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
15910 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
15911
15912 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
15913 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
15914 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
15915 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
15916 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
15917 unroll it.
15918
15919 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
15920 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
15921 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
15922
15923 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
15924 Available flags are:
15925
15926 @table @code
15927 @item r
15928 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
15929 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
15930 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
15931
15932 @item m
15933 Do not print methods defined in the class.
15934
15935 @item M
15936 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
15937 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
15938
15939 @item t
15940 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
15941 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
15942 names are substituted when printing other types.
15943
15944 @item T
15945 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
15946 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
15947 @end table
15948
15949 @kindex ptype
15950 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
15951 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
15952 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
15953 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
15954
15955 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
15956 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
15957 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
15958 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
15959 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
15960 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
15961 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
15962 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
15963
15964 For example, for this variable declaration:
15965
15966 @smallexample
15967 typedef double real_t;
15968 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
15969 typedef struct complex complex_t;
15970 complex_t var;
15971 real_t *real_pointer_var;
15972 @end smallexample
15973
15974 @noindent
15975 the two commands give this output:
15976
15977 @smallexample
15978 @group
15979 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
15980 type = complex_t
15981 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
15982 type = struct complex @{
15983 real_t real;
15984 double imag;
15985 @}
15986 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
15987 type = struct complex
15988 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
15989 type = struct complex
15990 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
15991 type = struct complex @{
15992 real_t real;
15993 double imag;
15994 @}
15995 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
15996 type = real_t *
15997 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
15998 type = double *
15999 @end group
16000 @end smallexample
16001
16002 @noindent
16003 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
16004 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16005
16006 @cindex incomplete type
16007 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
16008 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
16009 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
16010 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
16011 given these declarations:
16012
16013 @smallexample
16014 struct foo;
16015 struct foo *fooptr;
16016 @end smallexample
16017
16018 @noindent
16019 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
16020
16021 @smallexample
16022 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
16023 $1 = <incomplete type>
16024 @end smallexample
16025
16026 @noindent
16027 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
16028 completely specified.
16029
16030 @kindex info types
16031 @item info types @var{regexp}
16032 @itemx info types
16033 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
16034 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
16035 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
16036 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
16037 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
16038 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
16039 name is @code{value}.
16040
16041 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
16042 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
16043 lists all source files where a type is defined.
16044
16045 @kindex info type-printers
16046 @item info type-printers
16047 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
16048 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
16049 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
16050 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
16051 type printers.
16052
16053 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
16054
16055 @kindex enable type-printer
16056 @kindex disable type-printer
16057 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16058 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16059 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
16060
16061 @kindex info scope
16062 @cindex local variables
16063 @item info scope @var{location}
16064 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
16065 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
16066 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
16067 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
16068 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
16069
16070 @smallexample
16071 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
16072 Scope for command_line_handler:
16073 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
16074 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
16075 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
16076 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
16077 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
16078 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
16079 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
16080 @end smallexample
16081
16082 @noindent
16083 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
16084 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
16085 collect}.
16086
16087 @kindex info source
16088 @item info source
16089 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
16090 the function containing the current point of execution:
16091 @itemize @bullet
16092 @item
16093 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
16094 @item
16095 the directory it was compiled in,
16096 @item
16097 its length, in lines,
16098 @item
16099 which programming language it is written in,
16100 @item
16101 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
16102 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
16103 @item
16104 whether the debugging information includes information about
16105 preprocessor macros.
16106 @end itemize
16107
16108
16109 @kindex info sources
16110 @item info sources
16111 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
16112 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
16113 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
16114
16115 @kindex info functions
16116 @item info functions
16117 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
16118
16119 @item info functions @var{regexp}
16120 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
16121 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
16122 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
16123 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
16124 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
16125 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
16126 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
16127
16128 @kindex info variables
16129 @item info variables
16130 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
16131 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
16132
16133 @item info variables @var{regexp}
16134 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
16135 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
16136 @var{regexp}.
16137
16138 @kindex info classes
16139 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
16140 @item info classes
16141 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
16142 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
16143 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16144 expression.
16145
16146 @kindex info selectors
16147 @item info selectors
16148 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
16149 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
16150 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16151 expression.
16152
16153 @ignore
16154 This was never implemented.
16155 @kindex info methods
16156 @item info methods
16157 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
16158 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
16159 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
16160 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
16161 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
16162 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
16163 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
16164 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
16165 @end ignore
16166
16167 @cindex opaque data types
16168 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
16169 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
16170 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
16171 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
16172 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
16173 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
16174 another source file. The default is on.
16175
16176 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
16177 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
16178
16179 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
16180 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
16181 is printed as follows:
16182 @smallexample
16183 @{<no data fields>@}
16184 @end smallexample
16185
16186 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
16187 @item show opaque-type-resolution
16188 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
16189
16190 @kindex set print symbol-loading
16191 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
16192 @item set print symbol-loading
16193 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
16194 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
16195 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
16196 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
16197 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
16198 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
16199 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
16200 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
16201 can be annoying.
16202 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
16203 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
16204 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
16205 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
16206
16207 @kindex show print symbol-loading
16208 @item show print symbol-loading
16209 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
16210 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
16211
16212 @kindex maint print symbols
16213 @cindex symbol dump
16214 @kindex maint print psymbols
16215 @cindex partial symbol dump
16216 @kindex maint print msymbols
16217 @cindex minimal symbol dump
16218 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
16219 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
16220 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
16221 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
16222 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
16223 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
16224 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
16225 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
16226 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
16227 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
16228 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
16229 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
16230 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
16231 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
16232 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
16233 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
16234 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
16235
16236 @kindex maint info symtabs
16237 @kindex maint info psymtabs
16238 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
16239 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16240 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16241 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16242 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16243 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16244
16245 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
16246 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
16247 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
16248 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
16249 structure in more detail. For example:
16250
16251 @smallexample
16252 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
16253 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16254 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16255 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16256 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
16257 readin no
16258 fullname (null)
16259 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
16260 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
16261 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
16262 dependencies (none)
16263 @}
16264 @}
16265 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16266 (@value{GDBP})
16267 @end smallexample
16268 @noindent
16269 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
16270 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
16271 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
16272 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
16273 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
16274
16275 @smallexample
16276 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
16277 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
16278 line 1574.
16279 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16280 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16281 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16282 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16283 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
16284 dirname (null)
16285 fullname (null)
16286 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
16287 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
16288 debugformat DWARF 2
16289 @}
16290 @}
16291 (@value{GDBP})
16292 @end smallexample
16293 @end table
16294
16295
16296 @node Altering
16297 @chapter Altering Execution
16298
16299 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
16300 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
16301 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
16302 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
16303 program.
16304
16305 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
16306 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
16307 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
16308
16309 @menu
16310 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
16311 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
16312 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
16313 * Returning:: Returning from a function
16314 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
16315 * Patching:: Patching your program
16316 @end menu
16317
16318 @node Assignment
16319 @section Assignment to Variables
16320
16321 @cindex assignment
16322 @cindex setting variables
16323 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
16324 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
16325
16326 @smallexample
16327 print x=4
16328 @end smallexample
16329
16330 @noindent
16331 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
16332 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
16333 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
16334 information on operators in supported languages.
16335
16336 @kindex set variable
16337 @cindex variables, setting
16338 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
16339 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
16340 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
16341 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
16342 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
16343
16344 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
16345 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
16346 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
16347 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
16348 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
16349 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
16350 command @code{set width}:
16351
16352 @smallexample
16353 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
16354 type = double
16355 (@value{GDBP}) p width
16356 $4 = 13
16357 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
16358 Invalid syntax in expression.
16359 @end smallexample
16360
16361 @noindent
16362 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
16363 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
16364
16365 @smallexample
16366 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
16367 @end smallexample
16368
16369 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
16370 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
16371 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
16372 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
16373 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
16374 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
16375
16376 @smallexample
16377 @group
16378 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
16379 type = double
16380 (@value{GDBP}) p g
16381 $1 = 1
16382 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
16383 (@value{GDBP}) p g
16384 $2 = 1
16385 (@value{GDBP}) r
16386 The program being debugged has been started already.
16387 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
16388 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
16389 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
16390 Invalid bfd target.
16391 (@value{GDBP}) show g
16392 The current BFD target is "=4".
16393 @end group
16394 @end smallexample
16395
16396 @noindent
16397 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
16398 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
16399 @code{g}, use
16400
16401 @smallexample
16402 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
16403 @end smallexample
16404
16405 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
16406 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
16407 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
16408 same length or shorter.
16409 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
16410 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
16411
16412 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
16413 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
16414 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
16415 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
16416 and representation in memory), and
16417
16418 @smallexample
16419 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
16420 @end smallexample
16421
16422 @noindent
16423 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
16424
16425 @node Jumping
16426 @section Continuing at a Different Address
16427
16428 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
16429 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
16430 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
16431
16432 @table @code
16433 @kindex jump
16434 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
16435 @item jump @var{linespec}
16436 @itemx j @var{linespec}
16437 @itemx jump @var{location}
16438 @itemx j @var{location}
16439 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
16440 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
16441 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
16442 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
16443 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
16444 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
16445
16446 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
16447 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
16448 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
16449 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
16450 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
16451 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
16452 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
16453 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
16454 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
16455 @end table
16456
16457 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
16458 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
16459 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
16460 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
16461 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
16462 example,
16463
16464 @smallexample
16465 set $pc = 0x485
16466 @end smallexample
16467
16468 @noindent
16469 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
16470 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
16471 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
16472
16473 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
16474 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
16475 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
16476 detail.
16477
16478 @c @group
16479 @node Signaling
16480 @section Giving your Program a Signal
16481 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
16482
16483 @table @code
16484 @kindex signal
16485 @item signal @var{signal}
16486 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
16487 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
16488 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
16489 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
16490
16491 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
16492 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
16493 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
16494 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
16495 signal.
16496
16497 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
16498 after executing the command.
16499 @end table
16500 @c @end group
16501
16502 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
16503 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
16504 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
16505 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
16506 passes the signal directly to your program.
16507
16508
16509 @node Returning
16510 @section Returning from a Function
16511
16512 @table @code
16513 @cindex returning from a function
16514 @kindex return
16515 @item return
16516 @itemx return @var{expression}
16517 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
16518 command. If you give an
16519 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
16520 value.
16521 @end table
16522
16523 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
16524 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
16525 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
16526 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
16527
16528 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
16529 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
16530 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
16531 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
16532 of functions.
16533
16534 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
16535 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
16536 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
16537 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
16538 selected stack frame returns naturally.
16539
16540 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
16541 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
16542 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
16543 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
16544 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
16545 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
16546 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
16547 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
16548 assignment into the right register(s).
16549
16550 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
16551 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
16552 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
16553 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
16554 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
16555 into a @code{long long int}:
16556
16557 @smallexample
16558 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
16559 29 return 31;
16560 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
16561 Make func return now? (y or n) y
16562 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
16563 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
16564 (@value{GDBP})
16565 @end smallexample
16566
16567 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
16568 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
16569 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
16570 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
16571 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
16572 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
16573 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
16574 an appropriate cast explicitly:
16575
16576 @smallexample
16577 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
16578 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
16579 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
16580 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
16581 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
16582 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
16583 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
16584 (@value{GDBP})
16585 @end smallexample
16586
16587 @node Calling
16588 @section Calling Program Functions
16589
16590 @table @code
16591 @cindex calling functions
16592 @cindex inferior functions, calling
16593 @item print @var{expr}
16594 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
16595 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
16596 debugged.
16597
16598 @kindex call
16599 @item call @var{expr}
16600 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
16601 returned values.
16602
16603 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
16604 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
16605 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
16606 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
16607 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
16608 value history.
16609 @end table
16610
16611 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
16612 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
16613 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
16614 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
16615
16616 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
16617 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
16618 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
16619 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
16620 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
16621 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
16622 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
16623 in that case is controlled by the
16624 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
16625
16626 @table @code
16627 @item set unwindonsignal
16628 @kindex set unwindonsignal
16629 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
16630 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
16631 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
16632 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
16633 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
16634 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
16635 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
16636 received.
16637
16638 @item show unwindonsignal
16639 @kindex show unwindonsignal
16640 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
16641 @value{GDBN}.
16642
16643 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
16644 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
16645 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
16646 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
16647 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
16648 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
16649 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
16650 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
16651 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
16652 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
16653
16654 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
16655 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
16656 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
16657 @value{GDBN}.
16658
16659 @end table
16660
16661 @cindex weak alias functions
16662 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
16663 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
16664 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
16665 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
16666 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
16667 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
16668 function instead.
16669
16670 @node Patching
16671 @section Patching Programs
16672
16673 @cindex patching binaries
16674 @cindex writing into executables
16675 @cindex writing into corefiles
16676
16677 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
16678 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
16679 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
16680 patching your program's binary.
16681
16682 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
16683 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
16684 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
16685 repairs.
16686
16687 @table @code
16688 @kindex set write
16689 @item set write on
16690 @itemx set write off
16691 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
16692 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
16693 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
16694
16695 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
16696 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
16697 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
16698
16699 @item show write
16700 @kindex show write
16701 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
16702 as well as reading.
16703 @end table
16704
16705 @node GDB Files
16706 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
16707
16708 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
16709 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
16710 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
16711 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
16712
16713 @menu
16714 * Files:: Commands to specify files
16715 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
16716 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
16717 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
16718 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
16719 * Data Files:: GDB data files
16720 @end menu
16721
16722 @node Files
16723 @section Commands to Specify Files
16724
16725 @cindex symbol table
16726 @cindex core dump file
16727
16728 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
16729 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
16730 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
16731 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
16732
16733 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
16734 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
16735 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
16736 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
16737 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
16738 new files are useful.
16739
16740 @table @code
16741 @cindex executable file
16742 @kindex file
16743 @item file @var{filename}
16744 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
16745 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
16746 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
16747 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
16748 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
16749 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
16750 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
16751 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
16752
16753 @cindex unlinked object files
16754 @cindex patching object files
16755 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
16756 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
16757 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
16758 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
16759 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
16760 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
16761 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
16762 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
16763
16764 @item file
16765 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
16766 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
16767
16768 @kindex exec-file
16769 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
16770 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
16771 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
16772 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
16773 discard information on the executable file.
16774
16775 @kindex symbol-file
16776 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
16777 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
16778 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
16779 table and program to run from the same file.
16780
16781 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
16782 program's symbol table.
16783
16784 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
16785 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
16786 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
16787 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
16788 @value{GDBN}.
16789
16790 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
16791 executing it once.
16792
16793 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
16794 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
16795 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
16796 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
16797 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
16798 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
16799 optimized code.
16800
16801 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
16802 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
16803 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
16804 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
16805 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
16806
16807 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
16808 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
16809 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
16810 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
16811 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
16812 Warnings and Messages}.)
16813
16814 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
16815 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
16816 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
16817 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
16818 in stabs format.
16819
16820 @kindex readnow
16821 @cindex reading symbols immediately
16822 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
16823 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
16824 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
16825 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
16826 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
16827 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
16828 entire symbol table available.
16829
16830 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
16831 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
16832 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
16833 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
16834 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
16835 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
16836 @c files.
16837
16838 @kindex core-file
16839 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
16840 @itemx core
16841 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
16842 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
16843 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
16844 executable file itself for other parts.
16845
16846 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
16847 to be used.
16848
16849 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
16850 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
16851 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
16852 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
16853 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
16854
16855 @kindex add-symbol-file
16856 @cindex dynamic linking
16857 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
16858 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
16859 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
16860 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
16861 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
16862 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
16863 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
16864 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
16865 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
16866 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
16867 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
16868 @var{address} as an expression.
16869
16870 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
16871 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
16872 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
16873 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
16874
16875 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
16876
16877 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
16878 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
16879 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
16880 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
16881 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
16882 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
16883 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
16884 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
16885 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
16886
16887 @itemize @bullet
16888 @item
16889 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
16890 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
16891 @item
16892 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
16893 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
16894 @item
16895 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
16896 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
16897 @end itemize
16898
16899 @noindent
16900 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
16901 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
16902 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
16903 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
16904 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
16905 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
16906 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
16907 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
16908 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
16909 way.
16910
16911 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
16912
16913 @kindex remove-symbol-file
16914 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
16915 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
16916 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
16917 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
16918 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
16919
16920 @smallexample
16921 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
16922 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
16923 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
16924 (y or n) y
16925 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
16926 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
16927 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
16928 (gdb)
16929 @end smallexample
16930
16931
16932 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
16933
16934 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
16935 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
16936 @cindex load symbols from memory
16937 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
16938 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
16939 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
16940 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
16941 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
16942 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
16943 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
16944 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
16945 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
16946
16947 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
16948 @kindex assf
16949 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
16950 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
16951 This command is deprecated and will be removed in future versions
16952 of @value{GDBN}. Use the @code{sharedlibrary} command instead.
16953
16954 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
16955 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
16956 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
16957 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
16958 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
16959 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
16960 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
16961 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
16962
16963 @kindex section
16964 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
16965 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
16966 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
16967 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
16968 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
16969 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
16970 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
16971 their addresses.
16972
16973 @kindex info files
16974 @kindex info target
16975 @item info files
16976 @itemx info target
16977 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
16978 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
16979 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
16980 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
16981 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
16982 current ones.
16983
16984 @kindex maint info sections
16985 @item maint info sections
16986 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
16987 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
16988 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
16989 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
16990 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
16991 may be arbitrarily combined):
16992
16993 @table @code
16994 @item ALLOBJ
16995 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
16996 @item @var{sections}
16997 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
16998 @item @var{section-flags}
16999 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
17000 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
17001 @table @code
17002 @item ALLOC
17003 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
17004 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
17005 @item LOAD
17006 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
17007 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
17008 @item RELOC
17009 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
17010 @item READONLY
17011 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
17012 @item CODE
17013 Section contains executable code only.
17014 @item DATA
17015 Section contains data only (no executable code).
17016 @item ROM
17017 Section will reside in ROM.
17018 @item CONSTRUCTOR
17019 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
17020 @item HAS_CONTENTS
17021 Section is not empty.
17022 @item NEVER_LOAD
17023 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
17024 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
17025 A notification to the linker that the section contains
17026 COFF shared library information.
17027 @item IS_COMMON
17028 Section contains common symbols.
17029 @end table
17030 @end table
17031 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
17032 @cindex read-only sections
17033 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
17034 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
17035 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
17036 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
17037 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
17038 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
17039 enhancement to debugging performance.
17040
17041 The default is off.
17042
17043 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
17044 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
17045 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
17046 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
17047
17048 @item show trust-readonly-sections
17049 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
17050 @end table
17051
17052 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
17053 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
17054 name and remembers it that way.
17055
17056 @cindex shared libraries
17057 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
17058 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
17059 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
17060
17061 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
17062 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
17063
17064 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
17065 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
17066 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
17067 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
17068 debugging a core file).
17069
17070 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
17071 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
17072
17073 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
17074 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
17075 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
17076
17077 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
17078 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
17079 particularly large or there are many of them.
17080
17081 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
17082 commands:
17083
17084 @table @code
17085 @kindex set auto-solib-add
17086 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
17087 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
17088 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
17089 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
17090 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
17091 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
17092 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
17093
17094 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
17095 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
17096 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
17097 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
17098 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
17099 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
17100 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
17101 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
17102 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
17103
17104 @kindex show auto-solib-add
17105 @item show auto-solib-add
17106 Display the current autoloading mode.
17107 @end table
17108
17109 @cindex load shared library
17110 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
17111 command:
17112
17113 @table @code
17114 @kindex info sharedlibrary
17115 @kindex info share
17116 @item info share @var{regex}
17117 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
17118 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
17119 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
17120 all shared libraries that are loaded.
17121
17122 @kindex sharedlibrary
17123 @kindex share
17124 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
17125 @itemx share @var{regex}
17126 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
17127 Unix regular expression.
17128 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
17129 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
17130 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
17131 loaded.
17132
17133 @item nosharedlibrary
17134 @kindex nosharedlibrary
17135 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
17136 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
17137 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
17138 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
17139 discarded.
17140 @end table
17141
17142 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
17143 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
17144 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
17145 Catchpoints}).
17146
17147 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
17148 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
17149 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
17150 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
17151
17152 @table @code
17153 @item set stop-on-solib-events
17154 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
17155 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
17156 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
17157 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
17158 shared library.
17159
17160 @item show stop-on-solib-events
17161 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
17162 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
17163 library events happen.
17164 @end table
17165
17166 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
17167 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
17168 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
17169 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
17170 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
17171 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
17172 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
17173 not.
17174
17175 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
17176 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
17177 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
17178 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
17179 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
17180
17181 @table @code
17182 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
17183 @cindex system root, alternate
17184 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
17185 @kindex set sysroot
17186 @item set sysroot @var{path}
17187 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
17188 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
17189 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
17190 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
17191 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
17192 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
17193 under @var{path}.
17194
17195 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{remote:}, @value{GDBN} will
17196 retrieve the target libraries from the remote system. This is only
17197 supported when using a remote target that supports the @code{remote get}
17198 command (@pxref{File Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}).
17199 The part of @var{path} following the initial @file{remote:}
17200 (if present) is used as system root prefix on the remote file system.
17201 @footnote{If you want to specify a local system root using a directory
17202 that happens to be named @file{remote:}, you need to use some equivalent
17203 variant of the name like @file{./remote:}.}
17204
17205 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
17206 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
17207 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
17208 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
17209 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
17210
17211 @smallexample
17212 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
17213 @end smallexample
17214
17215 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
17216 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
17217 system:
17218
17219 @smallexample
17220 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
17221 @end smallexample
17222
17223 If that does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries removing
17224 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
17225 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
17226 colons:
17227
17228 @smallexample
17229 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
17230 @end smallexample
17231
17232 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
17233 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
17234 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
17235 @samp{z}):
17236
17237 @smallexample
17238 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
17239 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
17240 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
17241 @end smallexample
17242
17243 @noindent
17244 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
17245 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
17246 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
17247
17248 If that still does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries
17249 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
17250
17251 @smallexample
17252 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
17253 @end smallexample
17254
17255 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
17256 if you don't want or need to.
17257
17258 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
17259 sysroot}.
17260
17261 @cindex default system root
17262 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
17263 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
17264 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
17265 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
17266 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
17267 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
17268 location.
17269
17270 @kindex show sysroot
17271 @item show sysroot
17272 Display the current shared library prefix.
17273
17274 @kindex set solib-search-path
17275 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
17276 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
17277 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
17278 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
17279 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
17280 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
17281 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
17282 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
17283 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
17284 of shared library symbols.
17285
17286 @kindex show solib-search-path
17287 @item show solib-search-path
17288 Display the current shared library search path.
17289
17290 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
17291 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
17292 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
17293 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
17294 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
17295
17296 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
17297 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
17298 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
17299 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
17300 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
17301 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
17302 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
17303 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
17304 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
17305 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
17306 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
17307 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
17308 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
17309 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
17310 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
17311 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
17312 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
17313 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
17314 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
17315 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
17316 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
17317 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
17318
17319 @table @code
17320 @item unix
17321 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
17322 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
17323 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
17324 the forward slash.
17325
17326 @item dos-based
17327 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
17328 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
17329 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
17330 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
17331 considered directory separators.
17332
17333 @item auto
17334 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
17335 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
17336 This is the default.
17337 @end table
17338 @end table
17339
17340 @cindex file name canonicalization
17341 @cindex base name differences
17342 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
17343 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
17344 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
17345 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
17346 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
17347 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
17348 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
17349 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
17350 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
17351 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
17352 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
17353 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
17354 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
17355 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
17356 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
17357
17358 @table @code
17359 @item set basenames-may-differ
17360 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
17361 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
17362
17363 @item show basenames-may-differ
17364 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
17365 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
17366 @end table
17367
17368 @node Separate Debug Files
17369 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
17370 @cindex separate debugging information files
17371 @cindex debugging information in separate files
17372 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
17373 @cindex debugging information directory, global
17374 @cindex global debugging information directories
17375 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
17376 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
17377
17378 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
17379 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
17380 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
17381 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
17382 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
17383 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
17384 install only when they need to debug a problem.
17385
17386 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
17387 file:
17388
17389 @itemize @bullet
17390 @item
17391 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
17392 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
17393 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
17394 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
17395 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
17396 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
17397 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
17398 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
17399
17400 @item
17401 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
17402 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
17403 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
17404 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
17405 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
17406 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
17407 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
17408 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
17409 below.
17410 @end itemize
17411
17412 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
17413 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
17414
17415 @itemize @bullet
17416 @item
17417 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
17418 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
17419 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
17420 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
17421 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
17422
17423 @item
17424 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
17425 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
17426 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
17427 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
17428 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
17429 hex characters, not 10.)
17430 @end itemize
17431
17432 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
17433 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
17434 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
17435 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
17436 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
17437 debug information files, in the indicated order:
17438
17439 @itemize @minus
17440 @item
17441 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
17442 @item
17443 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
17444 @item
17445 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
17446 @item
17447 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
17448 @end itemize
17449
17450 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
17451 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
17452 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
17453 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
17454 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
17455
17456 @table @code
17457
17458 @kindex set debug-file-directory
17459 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
17460 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
17461 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
17462 concatenating them by a path separator.
17463
17464 @kindex show debug-file-directory
17465 @item show debug-file-directory
17466 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
17467 information files.
17468
17469 @end table
17470
17471 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
17472 @cindex debug link sections
17473 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
17474 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
17475
17476 @itemize
17477 @item
17478 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
17479 a zero byte,
17480 @item
17481 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
17482 boundary within the section, and
17483 @item
17484 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
17485 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
17486 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
17487 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
17488 @end itemize
17489
17490 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
17491 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
17492 described above.
17493
17494 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
17495 @cindex build ID sections
17496 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
17497 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
17498 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
17499 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
17500 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
17501 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
17502 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
17503 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
17504 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
17505
17506 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
17507 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
17508 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
17509 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
17510 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
17511 in an ordinary executable.
17512
17513 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
17514 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
17515 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
17516 following commands:
17517
17518 @smallexample
17519 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
17520 @kbd{strip -g foo}
17521 @end smallexample
17522
17523 @noindent
17524 These commands remove the debugging
17525 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
17526 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
17527 two files:
17528
17529 @itemize @bullet
17530 @item
17531 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
17532 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
17533
17534 @smallexample
17535 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
17536 @end smallexample
17537
17538 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
17539 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
17540 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
17541 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
17542
17543 @item
17544 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
17545 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
17546 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
17547 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
17548 @end itemize
17549
17550 @noindent
17551
17552 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
17553 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
17554 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
17555
17556 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
17557 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
17558 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
17559 @c different ways!
17560 @ifhtml
17561 @display
17562 @html
17563 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
17564 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
17565 @end html
17566 @end display
17567 @end ifhtml
17568 @ifnothtml
17569 @display
17570 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
17571 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
17572 @end display
17573 @end ifnothtml
17574
17575 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
17576 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
17577 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
17578 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
17579 CRC.
17580
17581 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
17582 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{Remote Protocol,
17583 , @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol}). However in the
17584 case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed @emph{most}
17585 significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so trailing
17586 zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
17587
17588 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
17589 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
17590 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
17591 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
17592 @code{0xffffffff}.
17593
17594 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
17595 @smallexample
17596 unsigned long
17597 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
17598 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
17599 @{
17600 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
17601 @{
17602 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
17603 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
17604 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
17605 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
17606 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
17607 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
17608 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
17609 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
17610 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
17611 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
17612 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
17613 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
17614 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
17615 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
17616 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
17617 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
17618 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
17619 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
17620 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
17621 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
17622 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
17623 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
17624 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
17625 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
17626 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
17627 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
17628 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
17629 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
17630 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
17631 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
17632 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
17633 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
17634 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
17635 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
17636 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
17637 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
17638 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
17639 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
17640 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
17641 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
17642 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
17643 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
17644 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
17645 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
17646 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
17647 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
17648 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
17649 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
17650 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
17651 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
17652 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
17653 0x2d02ef8d
17654 @};
17655 unsigned char *end;
17656
17657 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
17658 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
17659 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
17660 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
17661 @}
17662 @end smallexample
17663
17664 @noindent
17665 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
17666
17667 @node MiniDebugInfo
17668 @section Debugging information in a special section
17669 @cindex separate debug sections
17670 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
17671
17672 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
17673 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
17674 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
17675 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
17676
17677 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
17678 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
17679 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
17680 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
17681 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
17682 debugging information might be included in the section.
17683
17684 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
17685 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
17686 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
17687
17688 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
17689 standard utilities:
17690
17691 @smallexample
17692 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
17693 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
17694 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
17695 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
17696
17697 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
17698 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
17699 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
17700 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
17701 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
17702 | sort > funcsyms
17703
17704 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
17705 # table.
17706 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
17707
17708 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
17709 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
17710
17711 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
17712 # removing some unnecessary sections.
17713 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
17714 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
17715
17716 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
17717 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
17718
17719 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
17720 # original binary.
17721 xz mini_debuginfo
17722 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
17723 @end smallexample
17724
17725 @node Index Files
17726 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
17727 @cindex index files
17728 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
17729
17730 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
17731 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
17732 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
17733 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
17734 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
17735 startup.
17736
17737 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
17738 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
17739 using @command{objcopy}.
17740
17741 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
17742
17743 @table @code
17744 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
17745 @kindex save gdb-index
17746 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
17747 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
17748 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
17749 @var{directory}.
17750 @end table
17751
17752 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
17753 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
17754
17755 @smallexample
17756 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
17757 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
17758 @end smallexample
17759
17760 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
17761 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
17762 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
17763 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
17764 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
17765 The default is @code{off}.
17766 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
17767 @xref{Index Section Format}.
17768
17769 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
17770 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
17771
17772 @smallexample
17773 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
17774 @end smallexample
17775
17776 Instead you must do, for example,
17777
17778 @smallexample
17779 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
17780 @end smallexample
17781
17782 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
17783 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
17784 currently work for programs using Ada.
17785
17786 @node Symbol Errors
17787 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
17788
17789 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
17790 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
17791 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
17792 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
17793 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
17794 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
17795 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
17796 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
17797 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
17798 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
17799 Messages}).
17800
17801 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
17802
17803 @table @code
17804 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
17805
17806 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
17807 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
17808 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
17809 in its outer scope blocks.
17810
17811 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
17812 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
17813 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
17814 function.
17815
17816 @item block at @var{address} out of order
17817
17818 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
17819 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
17820 do so.
17821
17822 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
17823 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
17824 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
17825 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
17826 Messages}.)
17827
17828 @item bad block start address patched
17829
17830 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
17831 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
17832 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
17833
17834 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
17835 starting on the previous source line.
17836
17837 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
17838
17839 @cindex foo
17840 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
17841 larger than the size of the string table.
17842
17843 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
17844 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
17845 with this name.
17846
17847 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
17848
17849 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
17850 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
17851 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
17852
17853 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
17854 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
17855 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
17856 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
17857 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
17858 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
17859
17860 @item stub type has NULL name
17861
17862 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
17863
17864 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
17865 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
17866 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
17867 it.
17868
17869 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
17870
17871 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
17872
17873 @end table
17874
17875 @node Data Files
17876 @section GDB Data Files
17877
17878 @cindex prefix for data files
17879 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
17880 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
17881
17882 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
17883 is currently using.
17884
17885 @table @code
17886 @kindex set data-directory
17887 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
17888 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
17889 to @var{directory}.
17890
17891 @kindex show data-directory
17892 @item show data-directory
17893 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
17894 @end table
17895
17896 @cindex default data directory
17897 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
17898 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
17899 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
17900 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
17901 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
17902 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
17903 location.
17904
17905 The data directory may also be specified with the
17906 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
17907 @xref{Mode Options}.
17908
17909 @node Targets
17910 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
17911
17912 @cindex debugging target
17913 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
17914
17915 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
17916 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
17917 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
17918 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
17919 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
17920 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
17921 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
17922 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
17923
17924 @cindex target architecture
17925 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
17926 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
17927 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
17928 command.
17929
17930 @table @code
17931 @kindex set architecture
17932 @kindex show architecture
17933 @item set architecture @var{arch}
17934 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
17935 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
17936 supported architectures.
17937
17938 @item show architecture
17939 Show the current target architecture.
17940
17941 @item set processor
17942 @itemx processor
17943 @kindex set processor
17944 @kindex show processor
17945 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
17946 and @code{show architecture}.
17947 @end table
17948
17949 @menu
17950 * Active Targets:: Active targets
17951 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
17952 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
17953 @end menu
17954
17955 @node Active Targets
17956 @section Active Targets
17957
17958 @cindex stacking targets
17959 @cindex active targets
17960 @cindex multiple targets
17961
17962 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
17963 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
17964 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
17965 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
17966 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
17967 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
17968 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
17969 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
17970 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
17971
17972 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
17973 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
17974 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
17975 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
17976
17977 @node Target Commands
17978 @section Commands for Managing Targets
17979
17980 @table @code
17981 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
17982 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
17983 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
17984 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
17985 protocol of the target machine.
17986
17987 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
17988 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
17989 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
17990
17991 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
17992 after executing the command.
17993
17994 @kindex help target
17995 @item help target
17996 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
17997 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
17998 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
17999
18000 @item help target @var{name}
18001 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
18002 select it.
18003
18004 @kindex set gnutarget
18005 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
18006 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
18007 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
18008 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
18009 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
18010 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
18011
18012 @quotation
18013 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
18014 you must know the actual BFD name.
18015 @end quotation
18016
18017 @noindent
18018 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
18019
18020 @kindex show gnutarget
18021 @item show gnutarget
18022 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
18023 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
18024 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
18025 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
18026 @end table
18027
18028 @cindex common targets
18029 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
18030 configuration):
18031
18032 @table @code
18033 @kindex target
18034 @item target exec @var{program}
18035 @cindex executable file target
18036 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
18037 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
18038
18039 @item target core @var{filename}
18040 @cindex core dump file target
18041 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
18042 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
18043
18044 @item target remote @var{medium}
18045 @cindex remote target
18046 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
18047 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
18048 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
18049
18050 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
18051 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
18052
18053 @smallexample
18054 target remote /dev/ttya
18055 @end smallexample
18056
18057 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
18058 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
18059 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
18060 clobbered by the download.
18061
18062 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
18063 @cindex built-in simulator target
18064 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
18065 In general,
18066 @smallexample
18067 target sim
18068 load
18069 run
18070 @end smallexample
18071 @noindent
18072 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
18073 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
18074 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
18075 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
18076 Processors}.
18077
18078 @end table
18079
18080 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
18081 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
18082
18083 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
18084 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
18085 various aspects of this process.
18086
18087 @table @code
18088
18089 @item set hash
18090 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
18091 @cindex hash mark while downloading
18092 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
18093 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
18094 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
18095 monitor.
18096
18097 @item show hash
18098 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
18099 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
18100
18101 @item set debug monitor
18102 @kindex set debug monitor
18103 @cindex display remote monitor communications
18104 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
18105 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
18106
18107 @item show debug monitor
18108 @kindex show debug monitor
18109 Show the current status of displaying communications between
18110 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
18111 @end table
18112
18113 @table @code
18114
18115 @kindex load @var{filename}
18116 @item load @var{filename}
18117 @anchor{load}
18118 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
18119 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
18120 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
18121 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
18122 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
18123 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18124
18125 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
18126 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
18127 target is @dots{}}''
18128
18129 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
18130 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
18131 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
18132 specifies a fixed address.
18133 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
18134
18135 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
18136 load programs into flash memory.
18137
18138 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
18139 @end table
18140
18141 @node Byte Order
18142 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
18143
18144 @cindex choosing target byte order
18145 @cindex target byte order
18146
18147 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
18148 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
18149 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
18150 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
18151 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
18152 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
18153
18154 @table @code
18155 @kindex set endian
18156 @item set endian big
18157 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
18158
18159 @item set endian little
18160 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
18161
18162 @item set endian auto
18163 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
18164 executable.
18165
18166 @item show endian
18167 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
18168
18169 @end table
18170
18171 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
18172 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
18173 target system.
18174
18175
18176 @node Remote Debugging
18177 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
18178 @cindex remote debugging
18179
18180 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
18181 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
18182 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
18183 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
18184 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
18185
18186 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
18187 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
18188 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
18189 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
18190 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
18191 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
18192
18193 Other remote targets may be available in your
18194 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
18195
18196 @menu
18197 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
18198 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
18199 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
18200 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
18201 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
18202 @end menu
18203
18204 @node Connecting
18205 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
18206
18207 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
18208 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
18209 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
18210 program as the first argument.
18211
18212 @cindex @code{target remote}
18213 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
18214 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
18215 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
18216 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
18217 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
18218 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
18219
18220 @table @code
18221
18222 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
18223 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
18224 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
18225 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
18226
18227 @smallexample
18228 target remote /dev/ttyb
18229 @end smallexample
18230
18231 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
18232 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
18233 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
18234 @code{target} command.
18235
18236 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
18237 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
18238 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
18239 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
18240 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
18241 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
18242 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
18243 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
18244 target.
18245
18246 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
18247 @code{manyfarms}:
18248
18249 @smallexample
18250 target remote manyfarms:2828
18251 @end smallexample
18252
18253 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
18254 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
18255 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
18256 port 1234 on your local machine:
18257
18258 @smallexample
18259 target remote :1234
18260 @end smallexample
18261 @noindent
18262
18263 Note that the colon is still required here.
18264
18265 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
18266 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
18267 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
18268 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
18269
18270 @smallexample
18271 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
18272 @end smallexample
18273
18274 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
18275 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
18276 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
18277 cause havoc with your debugging session.
18278
18279 @item target remote | @var{command}
18280 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
18281 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
18282 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
18283 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
18284 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
18285 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
18286 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
18287 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
18288
18289 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
18290 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
18291 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
18292
18293 @end table
18294
18295 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
18296 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
18297 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
18298 need to use @kbd{run}.
18299
18300 @cindex interrupting remote programs
18301 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
18302 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
18303 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
18304 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
18305 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
18306 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
18307
18308 @smallexample
18309 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
18310 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
18311 @end smallexample
18312
18313 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
18314 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
18315 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
18316 goes back to waiting.
18317
18318 @table @code
18319 @kindex detach (remote)
18320 @item detach
18321 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
18322 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
18323 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
18324 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
18325 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
18326
18327 @kindex disconnect
18328 @item disconnect
18329 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
18330 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
18331 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
18332 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
18333 another target.
18334
18335 @cindex send command to remote monitor
18336 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
18337 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
18338 @kindex monitor
18339 @item monitor @var{cmd}
18340 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
18341 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
18342 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
18343 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
18344 and implement.
18345 @end table
18346
18347 @node File Transfer
18348 @section Sending files to a remote system
18349 @cindex remote target, file transfer
18350 @cindex file transfer
18351 @cindex sending files to remote systems
18352
18353 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
18354 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
18355 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
18356 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
18357 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
18358 the only way to upload or download files.
18359
18360 Not all remote targets support these commands.
18361
18362 @table @code
18363 @kindex remote put
18364 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
18365 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
18366 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
18367
18368 @kindex remote get
18369 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
18370 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
18371 on the host system.
18372
18373 @kindex remote delete
18374 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
18375 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
18376
18377 @end table
18378
18379 @node Server
18380 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
18381
18382 @kindex gdbserver
18383 @cindex remote connection without stubs
18384 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
18385 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
18386 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
18387
18388 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
18389 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
18390 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
18391 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
18392 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
18393 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
18394 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
18395 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
18396 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
18397 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
18398 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
18399 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
18400 choice for debugging.
18401
18402 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
18403 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
18404 protocol.
18405
18406 @quotation
18407 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
18408 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
18409 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
18410 target system with the same privileges as the user running
18411 @code{gdbserver}.
18412 @end quotation
18413
18414 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
18415 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
18416 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
18417
18418 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
18419 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
18420 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
18421 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
18422 system does all the symbol handling.
18423
18424 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
18425 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
18426 syntax is:
18427
18428 @smallexample
18429 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
18430 @end smallexample
18431
18432 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
18433 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
18434 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
18435 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
18436 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
18437 @file{/dev/com1}:
18438
18439 @smallexample
18440 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
18441 @end smallexample
18442
18443 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
18444 with it.
18445
18446 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
18447
18448 @smallexample
18449 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
18450 @end smallexample
18451
18452 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
18453 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
18454 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
18455 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
18456 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
18457 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
18458 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
18459 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
18460 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
18461 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
18462 @code{target remote} command.
18463
18464 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
18465 with ssh:
18466
18467 @smallexample
18468 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
18469 @end smallexample
18470
18471 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
18472 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
18473 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
18474 You could elide it if you want to.
18475
18476 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
18477 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
18478 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
18479 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
18480
18481 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
18482 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
18483 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
18484
18485 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
18486 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
18487
18488 @smallexample
18489 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
18490 @end smallexample
18491
18492 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
18493 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
18494
18495 @pindex pidof
18496 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
18497 @code{pidof} utility:
18498
18499 @smallexample
18500 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
18501 @end smallexample
18502
18503 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
18504 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
18505 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
18506
18507 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
18508 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, multiple processes
18509 @cindex multiple processes with @code{gdbserver}
18510
18511 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
18512 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
18513 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
18514 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
18515
18516 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
18517 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
18518 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
18519 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
18520 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
18521 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
18522 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
18523 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
18524 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
18525
18526 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
18527 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
18528 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
18529 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
18530 the program you want to debug.
18531
18532 In multi-process mode @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit unless you
18533 use the option @option{--once}. You can terminate it by using
18534 @code{monitor exit} (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}). Note that the
18535 conditions under which @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN}
18536 connects to it (@kbd{target remote} or @kbd{target extended-remote}). The
18537 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
18538
18539 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
18540
18541 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP port.
18542
18543 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
18544 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
18545 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
18546 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
18547 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
18548 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
18549 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
18550 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
18551
18552 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
18553 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
18554 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
18555
18556 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
18557 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
18558 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
18559 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
18560 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
18561 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
18562 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
18563 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
18564 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
18565 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
18566 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
18567 instance closes its port after the first connection.
18568
18569 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
18570 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
18571
18572 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
18573 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
18574 status information about the debugging process.
18575 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
18576 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
18577 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
18578 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
18579
18580 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
18581 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
18582 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
18583 Possible options are:
18584
18585 @table @code
18586 @item none
18587 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
18588 @item all
18589 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
18590 @item timestamps
18591 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
18592 @end table
18593
18594 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
18595 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
18596
18597 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
18598 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
18599 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
18600 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
18601 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
18602
18603 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
18604 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
18605 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
18606 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
18607
18608 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
18609 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
18610 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
18611 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
18612
18613 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
18614 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
18615 environment:
18616
18617 @smallexample
18618 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
18619 @end smallexample
18620
18621 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
18622
18623 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
18624
18625 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
18626 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
18627 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
18628 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
18629
18630 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
18631 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
18632 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
18633 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
18634 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
18635 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
18636 programs.
18637
18638 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
18639 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
18640 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
18641 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
18642 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
18643 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
18644 already on the target.
18645
18646 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
18647 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
18648 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
18649
18650 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
18651 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
18652 Here are the available commands.
18653
18654 @table @code
18655 @item monitor help
18656 List the available monitor commands.
18657
18658 @item monitor set debug 0
18659 @itemx monitor set debug 1
18660 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
18661
18662 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
18663 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
18664 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
18665 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
18666
18667 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
18668 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
18669 Possible options are:
18670
18671 @table @code
18672 @item none
18673 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
18674 @item all
18675 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
18676 @item timestamps
18677 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
18678 @end table
18679
18680 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
18681 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
18682
18683 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
18684 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
18685 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18686 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
18687 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
18688 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
18689
18690 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
18691 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
18692
18693 @item monitor exit
18694 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
18695 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
18696 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
18697 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
18698 of a multi-process mode debug session.
18699
18700 @end table
18701
18702 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
18703 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
18704
18705 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
18706 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
18707
18708 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
18709 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
18710 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
18711 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
18712 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
18713 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
18714 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
18715 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
18716 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
18717 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
18718 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
18719 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
18720
18721 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
18722
18723 @table @code
18724 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
18725
18726 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
18727 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
18728 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
18729
18730 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
18731
18732 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
18733 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
18734 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
18735 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
18736 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
18737 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
18738
18739 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
18740
18741 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
18742 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
18743 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
18744 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
18745 command for that. For example:
18746
18747 @smallexample
18748 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
18749 @end smallexample
18750
18751 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
18752 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
18753 @end table
18754
18755 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
18756 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
18757 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
18758 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
18759 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
18760 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
18761 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
18762 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
18763 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
18764 @code{gdbserver} like so:
18765
18766 @smallexample
18767 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
18768 @end smallexample
18769
18770 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
18771
18772 @smallexample
18773 $ gdb myprogram
18774 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
18775 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
18776 (@value{GDBP}) b main
18777 (@value{GDBP}) continue
18778 @end smallexample
18779
18780 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
18781 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
18782 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
18783 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
18784 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
18785 tracing.
18786
18787 @node Remote Configuration
18788 @section Remote Configuration
18789
18790 @kindex set remote
18791 @kindex show remote
18792 This section documents the configuration options available when
18793 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
18794 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
18795 system-call-allowed}.
18796
18797 @table @code
18798 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
18799 @cindex address size for remote targets
18800 @cindex bits in remote address
18801 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
18802 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
18803 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
18804 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
18805
18806 @item show remoteaddresssize
18807 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
18808
18809 @item set serial baud @var{n}
18810 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
18811 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
18812 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
18813 remote targets.
18814
18815 @item show serial baud
18816 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
18817
18818 @item set remotebreak
18819 @cindex interrupt remote programs
18820 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
18821 @anchor{set remotebreak}
18822 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
18823 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
18824 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
18825 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
18826 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
18827
18828 @item show remotebreak
18829 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
18830 interrupt the remote program.
18831
18832 @item set remoteflow on
18833 @itemx set remoteflow off
18834 @kindex set remoteflow
18835 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
18836 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
18837
18838 @item show remoteflow
18839 @kindex show remoteflow
18840 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
18841
18842 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
18843 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
18844 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
18845 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
18846 @code{ascii}.
18847
18848 @item show remotelogbase
18849 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
18850 protocol.
18851
18852 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
18853 @cindex record serial communications on file
18854 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
18855 default is not to record at all.
18856
18857 @item show remotelogfile.
18858 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
18859 serial communications.
18860
18861 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
18862 @cindex timeout for serial communications
18863 @cindex remote timeout
18864 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
18865 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
18866
18867 @item show remotetimeout
18868 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
18869 responses.
18870
18871 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
18872 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
18873 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
18874 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
18875 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
18876 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
18877 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
18878 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
18879
18880 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
18881 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
18882 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
18883 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
18884 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
18885 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
18886 as unlimited.
18887
18888 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
18889 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
18890 a remote hardware watchpoint.
18891
18892 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
18893 @itemx show remote exec-file
18894 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
18895 @cindex executable file, for remote target
18896 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
18897 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
18898 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
18899 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
18900
18901 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
18902 @cindex interrupt remote programs
18903 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
18904 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
18905 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
18906 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
18907 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
18908 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
18909 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
18910 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
18911
18912 @item show interrupt-sequence
18913 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
18914 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
18915 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
18916 also known as Magic SysRq g.
18917
18918 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
18919 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
18920 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
18921 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
18922 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
18923 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
18924
18925 @item show interrupt-on-connect
18926 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
18927 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
18928
18929 @kindex set tcp
18930 @kindex show tcp
18931 @item set tcp auto-retry on
18932 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
18933 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
18934 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
18935 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
18936 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
18937 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
18938 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
18939 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
18940
18941 @item set tcp auto-retry off
18942 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
18943
18944 @item show tcp auto-retry
18945 Show the current auto-retry setting.
18946
18947 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
18948 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
18949 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
18950 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
18951 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
18952 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
18953 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
18954 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
18955 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
18956 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
18957 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
18958
18959 @item show tcp connect-timeout
18960 Show the current connection timeout setting.
18961 @end table
18962
18963 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
18964 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
18965 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
18966 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
18967 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
18968 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
18969 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
18970 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
18971 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
18972
18973 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
18974 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
18975 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
18976 @value{GDBN} developers.
18977
18978 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
18979 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
18980 are:
18981
18982 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
18983 @item Command Name
18984 @tab Remote Packet
18985 @tab Related Features
18986
18987 @item @code{fetch-register}
18988 @tab @code{p}
18989 @tab @code{info registers}
18990
18991 @item @code{set-register}
18992 @tab @code{P}
18993 @tab @code{set}
18994
18995 @item @code{binary-download}
18996 @tab @code{X}
18997 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
18998
18999 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
19000 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
19001 @tab @code{info auxv}
19002
19003 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
19004 @tab @code{qSymbol}
19005 @tab Detecting multiple threads
19006
19007 @item @code{attach}
19008 @tab @code{vAttach}
19009 @tab @code{attach}
19010
19011 @item @code{verbose-resume}
19012 @tab @code{vCont}
19013 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
19014
19015 @item @code{run}
19016 @tab @code{vRun}
19017 @tab @code{run}
19018
19019 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
19020 @tab @code{Z0}
19021 @tab @code{break}
19022
19023 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
19024 @tab @code{Z1}
19025 @tab @code{hbreak}
19026
19027 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
19028 @tab @code{Z2}
19029 @tab @code{watch}
19030
19031 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
19032 @tab @code{Z3}
19033 @tab @code{rwatch}
19034
19035 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
19036 @tab @code{Z4}
19037 @tab @code{awatch}
19038
19039 @item @code{target-features}
19040 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
19041 @tab @code{set architecture}
19042
19043 @item @code{library-info}
19044 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
19045 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
19046
19047 @item @code{memory-map}
19048 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
19049 @tab @code{info mem}
19050
19051 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
19052 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
19053 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
19054
19055 @item @code{read-spu-object}
19056 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
19057 @tab @code{info spu}
19058
19059 @item @code{write-spu-object}
19060 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
19061 @tab @code{info spu}
19062
19063 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
19064 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
19065 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
19066
19067 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
19068 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
19069 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
19070
19071 @item @code{threads}
19072 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
19073 @tab @code{info threads}
19074
19075 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
19076 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
19077 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
19078
19079 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
19080 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
19081 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
19082
19083 @item @code{search-memory}
19084 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
19085 @tab @code{find}
19086
19087 @item @code{supported-packets}
19088 @tab @code{qSupported}
19089 @tab Remote communications parameters
19090
19091 @item @code{pass-signals}
19092 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
19093 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
19094
19095 @item @code{program-signals}
19096 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
19097 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
19098
19099 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
19100 @tab @code{vFile:close}
19101 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19102
19103 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
19104 @tab @code{vFile:open}
19105 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19106
19107 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
19108 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
19109 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19110
19111 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
19112 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
19113 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19114
19115 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
19116 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
19117 @tab @code{remote delete}
19118
19119 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
19120 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
19121 @tab Host I/O
19122
19123 @item @code{noack-packet}
19124 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
19125 @tab Packet acknowledgment
19126
19127 @item @code{osdata}
19128 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
19129 @tab @code{info os}
19130
19131 @item @code{query-attached}
19132 @tab @code{qAttached}
19133 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
19134
19135 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
19136 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
19137 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
19138
19139 @item @code{trace-status}
19140 @tab @code{qTStatus}
19141 @tab @code{tstatus}
19142
19143 @item @code{traceframe-info}
19144 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
19145 @tab Traceframe info
19146
19147 @item @code{install-in-trace}
19148 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
19149 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
19150
19151 @item @code{disable-randomization}
19152 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
19153 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
19154
19155 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
19156 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
19157 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
19158 @end multitable
19159
19160 @node Remote Stub
19161 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
19162
19163 @cindex debugging stub, example
19164 @cindex remote stub, example
19165 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
19166 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
19167 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
19168 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
19169 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
19170 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
19171 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
19172 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
19173
19174 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
19175 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
19176 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
19177 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
19178 program, you need:
19179
19180 @enumerate
19181 @item
19182 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
19183 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
19184 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
19185
19186 @item
19187 A C subroutine library to support your program's
19188 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
19189
19190 @item
19191 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
19192 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
19193 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
19194 documentation.
19195 @end enumerate
19196
19197 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
19198 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
19199 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
19200
19201 @table @emph
19202 @item On the host,
19203 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
19204 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
19205 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
19206
19207 @item On the target,
19208 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
19209 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
19210 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
19211
19212 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
19213 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
19214 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
19215 @end table
19216
19217 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
19218 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
19219 @sc{sparc} boards.
19220
19221 @cindex remote serial stub list
19222 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
19223
19224 @table @code
19225
19226 @item i386-stub.c
19227 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
19228 @cindex Intel
19229 @cindex i386
19230 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
19231
19232 @item m68k-stub.c
19233 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
19234 @cindex Motorola 680x0
19235 @cindex m680x0
19236 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
19237
19238 @item sh-stub.c
19239 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
19240 @cindex Renesas
19241 @cindex SH
19242 For Renesas SH architectures.
19243
19244 @item sparc-stub.c
19245 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
19246 @cindex Sparc
19247 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
19248
19249 @item sparcl-stub.c
19250 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
19251 @cindex Fujitsu
19252 @cindex SparcLite
19253 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
19254
19255 @end table
19256
19257 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
19258 recently added stubs.
19259
19260 @menu
19261 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
19262 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
19263 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
19264 @end menu
19265
19266 @node Stub Contents
19267 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
19268
19269 @cindex remote serial stub
19270 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
19271 subroutines:
19272
19273 @table @code
19274 @item set_debug_traps
19275 @findex set_debug_traps
19276 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
19277 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
19278 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
19279 program's startup code.
19280
19281 @item handle_exception
19282 @findex handle_exception
19283 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
19284 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
19285 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
19286 run when a trap is triggered.
19287
19288 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
19289 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
19290 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
19291 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
19292 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
19293 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
19294 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
19295 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
19296 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
19297 machine.
19298
19299 @item breakpoint
19300 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
19301 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
19302 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
19303 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
19304 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
19305 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
19306 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
19307 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
19308 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
19309 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
19310 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
19311
19312 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
19313 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
19314 start of your debugging session.
19315 @end table
19316
19317 @node Bootstrapping
19318 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
19319
19320 @cindex remote stub, support routines
19321 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
19322 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
19323 debugging target machine.
19324
19325 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
19326 serial port.
19327
19328 @table @code
19329 @item int getDebugChar()
19330 @findex getDebugChar
19331 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
19332 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
19333 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
19334
19335 @item void putDebugChar(int)
19336 @findex putDebugChar
19337 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
19338 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
19339 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
19340 @end table
19341
19342 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
19343 @cindex interrupting remote targets
19344 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
19345 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
19346 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
19347 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
19348 remote system to stop.
19349
19350 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
19351 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
19352 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
19353 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
19354
19355 Other routines you need to supply are:
19356
19357 @table @code
19358 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
19359 @findex exceptionHandler
19360 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
19361 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
19362 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
19363 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
19364 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
19365 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
19366 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
19367 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
19368 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
19369 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
19370 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
19371 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
19372 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
19373
19374 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
19375 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
19376 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
19377 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
19378 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
19379
19380 @item void flush_i_cache()
19381 @findex flush_i_cache
19382 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
19383 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
19384 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
19385
19386 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
19387 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
19388 @end table
19389
19390 @noindent
19391 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
19392
19393 @table @code
19394 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
19395 @findex memset
19396 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
19397 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
19398 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
19399 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
19400 @end table
19401
19402 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
19403 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
19404 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
19405 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
19406
19407
19408 @node Debug Session
19409 @subsection Putting it All Together
19410
19411 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
19412 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
19413 steps.
19414
19415 @enumerate
19416 @item
19417 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
19418 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
19419 @display
19420 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
19421 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
19422 @end display
19423
19424 @item
19425 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
19426 procedure is called:
19427
19428 @smallexample
19429 set_debug_traps();
19430 breakpoint();
19431 @end smallexample
19432
19433 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
19434 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
19435 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
19436 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
19437 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
19438 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
19439 progress.
19440
19441 @item
19442 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
19443 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
19444
19445 @smallexample
19446 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
19447 @end smallexample
19448
19449 @noindent
19450 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
19451 function in your program, that function is called when
19452 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
19453 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
19454 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
19455
19456 @item
19457 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
19458 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
19459
19460 @item
19461 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
19462 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
19463
19464 @item
19465 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
19466 @c document that. FIXME.
19467 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
19468 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
19469
19470 @item
19471 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
19472 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
19473
19474 @end enumerate
19475
19476 @node Configurations
19477 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
19478
19479 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
19480 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
19481 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
19482
19483 There are three major categories of configurations: native
19484 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
19485 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
19486 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
19487 are quite different from each other.
19488
19489 @menu
19490 * Native::
19491 * Embedded OS::
19492 * Embedded Processors::
19493 * Architectures::
19494 @end menu
19495
19496 @node Native
19497 @section Native
19498
19499 This section describes details specific to particular native
19500 configurations.
19501
19502 @menu
19503 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
19504 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
19505 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
19506 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
19507 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
19508 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
19509 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
19510 @end menu
19511
19512 @node HP-UX
19513 @subsection HP-UX
19514
19515 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
19516 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
19517 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
19518
19519
19520 @node BSD libkvm Interface
19521 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
19522
19523 @cindex libkvm
19524 @cindex kernel memory image
19525 @cindex kernel crash dump
19526
19527 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
19528 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
19529 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
19530 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
19531 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
19532 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
19533 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
19534 @code{kvm} target:
19535
19536 @smallexample
19537 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
19538 @end smallexample
19539
19540 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
19541 argument:
19542
19543 @smallexample
19544 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
19545 @end smallexample
19546
19547 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
19548 available:
19549
19550 @table @code
19551 @kindex kvm
19552 @item kvm pcb
19553 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
19554
19555 @item kvm proc
19556 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
19557 modern FreeBSD systems.
19558 @end table
19559
19560 @node SVR4 Process Information
19561 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
19562 @cindex /proc
19563 @cindex examine process image
19564 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
19565
19566 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
19567 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
19568 process using file-system subroutines.
19569
19570 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
19571 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
19572 information about the process running your program, or about any
19573 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
19574 @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, and Irix, but
19575 not HP-UX, for example.
19576
19577 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
19578 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
19579
19580 @table @code
19581 @kindex info proc
19582 @cindex process ID
19583 @item info proc
19584 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
19585 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
19586 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
19587 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
19588 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
19589 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
19590 executable file's absolute file name.
19591
19592 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
19593 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
19594 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
19595 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
19596 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
19597 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
19598
19599 @item info proc cmdline
19600 @cindex info proc cmdline
19601 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
19602 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
19603
19604 @item info proc cwd
19605 @cindex info proc cwd
19606 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
19607 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
19608
19609 @item info proc exe
19610 @cindex info proc exe
19611 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
19612 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
19613
19614 @item info proc mappings
19615 @cindex memory address space mappings
19616 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
19617 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
19618 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
19619 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
19620 memory access rights to that range.
19621
19622 @item info proc stat
19623 @itemx info proc status
19624 @cindex process detailed status information
19625 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
19626 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
19627 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
19628 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
19629 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
19630 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
19631 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
19632
19633 @item info proc all
19634 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
19635 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
19636
19637 @ignore
19638 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
19639 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
19640 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
19641 @kindex info proc times
19642 @item info proc times
19643 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
19644 its children.
19645
19646 @kindex info proc id
19647 @item info proc id
19648 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
19649 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
19650 @end ignore
19651
19652 @item set procfs-trace
19653 @kindex set procfs-trace
19654 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
19655 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
19656
19657 @item show procfs-trace
19658 @kindex show procfs-trace
19659 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
19660
19661 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
19662 @kindex set procfs-file
19663 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
19664 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
19665 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
19666 standard output.
19667
19668 @item show procfs-file
19669 @kindex show procfs-file
19670 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
19671
19672 @item proc-trace-entry
19673 @itemx proc-trace-exit
19674 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
19675 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
19676 @kindex proc-trace-entry
19677 @kindex proc-trace-exit
19678 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
19679 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
19680 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
19681 from the @code{syscall} interface.
19682
19683 @item info pidlist
19684 @kindex info pidlist
19685 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
19686 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
19687 processes and all the threads within each process.
19688
19689 @item info meminfo
19690 @kindex info meminfo
19691 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
19692 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
19693 @end table
19694
19695 @node DJGPP Native
19696 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
19697 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
19698 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
19699 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
19700
19701 @cindex DPMI
19702 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
19703 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
19704 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
19705 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
19706
19707 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
19708 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
19709 subsection describes those commands.
19710
19711 @table @code
19712 @kindex info dos
19713 @item info dos
19714 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
19715 information about the target system and important OS structures.
19716
19717 @kindex sysinfo
19718 @cindex MS-DOS system info
19719 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
19720 @item info dos sysinfo
19721 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
19722 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
19723 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
19724
19725 @cindex GDT
19726 @cindex LDT
19727 @cindex IDT
19728 @cindex segment descriptor tables
19729 @cindex descriptor tables display
19730 @item info dos gdt
19731 @itemx info dos ldt
19732 @itemx info dos idt
19733 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
19734 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
19735 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
19736 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
19737 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
19738 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
19739 rights.
19740
19741 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
19742 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
19743 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
19744 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
19745 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
19746
19747 @cindex garbled pointers
19748 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
19749 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
19750 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
19751 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
19752 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
19753 debugged program's data segment:
19754
19755 @smallexample
19756 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
19757 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
19758 @end smallexample
19759
19760 @noindent
19761 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
19762 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
19763
19764 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
19765 @item info dos pde
19766 @itemx info dos pte
19767 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
19768 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
19769 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
19770 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
19771 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
19772 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
19773 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
19774 that is currently in use.
19775
19776 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
19777 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
19778 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
19779 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
19780 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
19781 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
19782 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
19783
19784 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
19785 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
19786 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
19787 controller.
19788
19789 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
19790
19791 @cindex physical address from linear address
19792 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
19793 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
19794 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
19795 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
19796 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
19797 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
19798 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
19799
19800 @smallexample
19801 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
19802 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
19803 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
19804 @end smallexample
19805
19806 @noindent
19807 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
19808 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
19809 attributes of that page.
19810
19811 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
19812 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
19813 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
19814 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
19815 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
19816 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
19817
19818 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
19819 transfer buffer:
19820
19821 @smallexample
19822 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
19823 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
19824 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
19825 @end smallexample
19826
19827 @noindent
19828 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
19829 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
19830 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
19831 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
19832 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
19833
19834 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
19835 @end table
19836
19837 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
19838 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
19839 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
19840 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
19841
19842 @table @code
19843 @kindex set com1base
19844 @kindex set com1irq
19845 @kindex set com2base
19846 @kindex set com2irq
19847 @kindex set com3base
19848 @kindex set com3irq
19849 @kindex set com4base
19850 @kindex set com4irq
19851 @item set com1base @var{addr}
19852 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
19853 port.
19854
19855 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
19856 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
19857 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
19858
19859 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
19860 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
19861 other 3 COM ports.
19862
19863 @kindex show com1base
19864 @kindex show com1irq
19865 @kindex show com2base
19866 @kindex show com2irq
19867 @kindex show com3base
19868 @kindex show com3irq
19869 @kindex show com4base
19870 @kindex show com4irq
19871 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
19872 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
19873 lines used by the COM ports.
19874
19875 @item info serial
19876 @kindex info serial
19877 @cindex DOS serial port status
19878 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
19879 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
19880 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
19881 counts of various errors encountered so far.
19882 @end table
19883
19884
19885 @node Cygwin Native
19886 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
19887 @cindex MS Windows debugging
19888 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
19889 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
19890
19891 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
19892 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
19893
19894 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
19895 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
19896 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
19897 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
19898 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
19899 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
19900 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
19901 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
19902
19903 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
19904 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
19905 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
19906
19907 @table @code
19908 @kindex info w32
19909 @item info w32
19910 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
19911 information about the target system and important OS structures.
19912
19913 @item info w32 selector
19914 This command displays information returned by
19915 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
19916 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
19917 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
19918 Without argument, this command displays information
19919 about the six segment registers.
19920
19921 @item info w32 thread-information-block
19922 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
19923 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
19924 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
19925
19926 @kindex info dll
19927 @item info dll
19928 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
19929
19930 @kindex dll-symbols
19931 @item dll-symbols
19932 This command is deprecated and will be removed in future versions
19933 of @value{GDBN}. Use the @code{sharedlibrary} command instead.
19934
19935 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
19936 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
19937
19938 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
19939 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
19940 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
19941 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
19942 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
19943 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
19944 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
19945 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
19946 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
19947 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
19948 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
19949
19950 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
19951 @item show cygwin-exceptions
19952 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
19953 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
19954
19955 @kindex set new-console
19956 @item set new-console @var{mode}
19957 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
19958 be started in a new console on next start.
19959 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
19960 be started in the same console as the debugger.
19961
19962 @kindex show new-console
19963 @item show new-console
19964 Displays whether a new console is used
19965 when the debuggee is started.
19966
19967 @kindex set new-group
19968 @item set new-group @var{mode}
19969 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
19970 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
19971 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
19972 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
19973
19974 @kindex show new-group
19975 @item show new-group
19976 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
19977
19978 @kindex set debugevents
19979 @item set debugevents
19980 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
19981 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
19982 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
19983 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
19984 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
19985
19986 @kindex set debugexec
19987 @item set debugexec
19988 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
19989 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
19990
19991 @kindex set debugexceptions
19992 @item set debugexceptions
19993 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
19994 debuggee seen by the debugger.
19995
19996 @kindex set debugmemory
19997 @item set debugmemory
19998 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
19999 and writes by the debugger.
20000
20001 @kindex set shell
20002 @item set shell
20003 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
20004 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
20005
20006 @kindex show shell
20007 @item show shell
20008 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
20009
20010 @end table
20011
20012 @menu
20013 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
20014 @end menu
20015
20016 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
20017 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
20018 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
20019 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
20020
20021 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
20022 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
20023 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
20024 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
20025 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
20026 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
20027 ``minimal symbols''.
20028
20029 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
20030 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
20031 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
20032 program run once to completion.
20033
20034 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
20035
20036 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
20037 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
20038 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
20039 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
20040 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
20041 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
20042 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
20043 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
20044 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
20045
20046 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
20047 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
20048 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
20049 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
20050 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
20051 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
20052
20053 @smallexample
20054 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
20055 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
20056
20057 Non-debugging symbols:
20058 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
20059 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
20060 @end smallexample
20061
20062 @smallexample
20063 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
20064 All functions matching regular expression "!":
20065
20066 Non-debugging symbols:
20067 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
20068 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
20069 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
20070 [etc...]
20071 @end smallexample
20072
20073 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
20074
20075 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
20076 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
20077 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
20078 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
20079 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
20080 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
20081 a function within a DLL without a running program.
20082
20083 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
20084 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
20085 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
20086 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
20087 problem:
20088
20089 @smallexample
20090 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
20091 $1 = 268572168
20092 @end smallexample
20093
20094 @smallexample
20095 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
20096 0x10021610: "\230y\""
20097 @end smallexample
20098
20099 And two possible solutions:
20100
20101 @smallexample
20102 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
20103 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
20104 @end smallexample
20105
20106 @smallexample
20107 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
20108 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
20109 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
20110 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
20111 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
20112 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
20113 @end smallexample
20114
20115 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
20116 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
20117 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
20118 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
20119 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
20120
20121 @smallexample
20122 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
20123 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
20124 @end smallexample
20125
20126 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
20127 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
20128 safe.
20129
20130 @node Hurd Native
20131 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
20132 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
20133
20134 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
20135 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
20136
20137 @table @code
20138 @item set signals
20139 @itemx set sigs
20140 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
20141 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
20142 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
20143 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
20144 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
20145 @code{signals}.
20146
20147 @item show signals
20148 @itemx show sigs
20149 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
20150 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
20151 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
20152
20153 @item set signal-thread
20154 @itemx set sigthread
20155 @kindex set signal-thread
20156 @kindex set sigthread
20157 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
20158 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
20159 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
20160 signal-thread}.
20161
20162 @item show signal-thread
20163 @itemx show sigthread
20164 @kindex show signal-thread
20165 @kindex show sigthread
20166 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
20167 delivered a signal.
20168
20169 @item set stopped
20170 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
20171 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
20172 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
20173 continued by delivering a signal to it.
20174
20175 @item show stopped
20176 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
20177 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
20178 stopped.
20179
20180 @item set exceptions
20181 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
20182 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
20183 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
20184 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
20185 trapping on.
20186
20187 @item show exceptions
20188 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
20189 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
20190
20191 @item set task pause
20192 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
20193 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20194 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20195 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
20196 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
20197 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
20198 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
20199 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
20200 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
20201
20202 @item show task pause
20203 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
20204 Show the current state of task suspension.
20205
20206 @item set task detach-suspend-count
20207 @cindex task suspend count
20208 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20209 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
20210 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
20211
20212 @item show task detach-suspend-count
20213 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
20214
20215 @item set task exception-port
20216 @itemx set task excp
20217 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20218 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
20219 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
20220 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
20221
20222 @item set noninvasive
20223 @cindex noninvasive task options
20224 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
20225 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
20226 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
20227 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
20228
20229 @item info send-rights
20230 @itemx info receive-rights
20231 @itemx info port-rights
20232 @itemx info port-sets
20233 @itemx info dead-names
20234 @itemx info ports
20235 @itemx info psets
20236 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20237 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20238 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20239 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20240 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20241 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
20242 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
20243 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
20244 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
20245
20246 @item set thread pause
20247 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
20248 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20249 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20250 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
20251 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
20252 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
20253 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
20254 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
20255 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
20256 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
20257 only the current thread.
20258
20259 @item show thread pause
20260 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
20261 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
20262
20263 @item set thread run
20264 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
20265
20266 @item show thread run
20267 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
20268
20269 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
20270 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20271 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20272 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
20273 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
20274 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
20275 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
20276
20277 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
20278 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
20279 detaching.
20280
20281 @item set thread exception-port
20282 @itemx set thread excp
20283 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
20284 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
20285 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
20286
20287 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
20288 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
20289 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
20290 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
20291
20292 @item set thread default
20293 @itemx show thread default
20294 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20295 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
20296 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
20297 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
20298 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
20299 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
20300 the non-default commands.
20301 @end table
20302
20303 @node Darwin
20304 @subsection Darwin
20305 @cindex Darwin
20306
20307 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
20308
20309 @table @code
20310 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
20311 @kindex set debug darwin
20312 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
20313 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
20314
20315 @item show debug darwin
20316 @kindex show debug darwin
20317 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
20318
20319 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
20320 @kindex set debug mach-o
20321 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
20322 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
20323 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
20324 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
20325 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
20326 usage.
20327
20328 @item show debug mach-o
20329 @kindex show debug mach-o
20330 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
20331
20332 @item set mach-exceptions on
20333 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
20334 @kindex set mach-exceptions
20335 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
20336 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
20337 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
20338 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
20339
20340 @item show mach-exceptions
20341 @kindex show mach-exceptions
20342 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
20343 @end table
20344
20345
20346 @node Embedded OS
20347 @section Embedded Operating Systems
20348
20349 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
20350 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
20351 architectures.
20352
20353 @menu
20354 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
20355 @end menu
20356
20357 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
20358 various real-time operating systems.
20359
20360 @node VxWorks
20361 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
20362
20363 @cindex VxWorks
20364
20365 @table @code
20366
20367 @kindex target vxworks
20368 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
20369 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
20370 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
20371
20372 @end table
20373
20374 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
20375 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
20376
20377 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
20378 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
20379 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
20380 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
20381 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
20382 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
20383 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
20384
20385 @table @code
20386 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
20387 @kindex vxworks-timeout
20388 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
20389 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
20390 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
20391 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
20392 of a thin network line.
20393 @end table
20394
20395 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
20396 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
20397 procedures.
20398
20399 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
20400 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
20401 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
20402 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
20403 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
20404 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
20405 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
20406 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
20407 manual.
20408 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
20409
20410 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
20411 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
20412 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
20413 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
20414
20415 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
20416
20417 @smallexample
20418 (vxgdb)
20419 @end smallexample
20420
20421 @menu
20422 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
20423 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
20424 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
20425 @end menu
20426
20427 @node VxWorks Connection
20428 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
20429
20430 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
20431 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
20432
20433 @smallexample
20434 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
20435 @end smallexample
20436
20437 @need 750
20438 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
20439
20440 @smallexample
20441 Attaching remote machine across net...
20442 Connected to tt.
20443 @end smallexample
20444
20445 @need 1000
20446 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
20447 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
20448 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
20449 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
20450 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
20451
20452 @smallexample
20453 prog.o: No such file or directory.
20454 @end smallexample
20455
20456 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
20457 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
20458 command again.
20459
20460 @node VxWorks Download
20461 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
20462
20463 @cindex download to VxWorks
20464 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
20465 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
20466 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
20467 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
20468 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
20469 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
20470 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
20471 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
20472 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
20473 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
20474 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
20475 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
20476 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
20477 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
20478 program, type this on VxWorks:
20479
20480 @smallexample
20481 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
20482 @end smallexample
20483
20484 @noindent
20485 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
20486
20487 @smallexample
20488 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
20489 (vxgdb) load prog.o
20490 @end smallexample
20491
20492 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
20493
20494 @smallexample
20495 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
20496 @end smallexample
20497
20498 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
20499 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
20500 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
20501 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
20502 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
20503 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
20504 table.)
20505
20506 @node VxWorks Attach
20507 @subsubsection Running Tasks
20508
20509 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
20510 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
20511 follows:
20512
20513 @smallexample
20514 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
20515 @end smallexample
20516
20517 @noindent
20518 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
20519 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
20520 the time of attachment.
20521
20522 @node Embedded Processors
20523 @section Embedded Processors
20524
20525 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
20526 configurations.
20527
20528 @cindex send command to simulator
20529 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
20530 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
20531
20532 @table @code
20533 @item sim @var{command}
20534 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
20535 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
20536 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
20537 acceptable commands.
20538 @end table
20539
20540
20541 @menu
20542 * ARM:: ARM RDI
20543 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
20544 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
20545 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
20546 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
20547 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
20548 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
20549 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
20550 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
20551 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
20552 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
20553 * CRIS:: CRIS
20554 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
20555 @end menu
20556
20557 @node ARM
20558 @subsection ARM
20559 @cindex ARM RDI
20560
20561 @table @code
20562 @kindex target rdi
20563 @item target rdi @var{dev}
20564 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
20565 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
20566 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
20567
20568 @kindex target rdp
20569 @item target rdp @var{dev}
20570 ARM Demon monitor.
20571
20572 @end table
20573
20574 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
20575
20576 @table @code
20577 @item set arm disassembler
20578 @kindex set arm
20579 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
20580 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
20581
20582 @item show arm disassembler
20583 @kindex show arm
20584 Show the current disassembly style.
20585
20586 @item set arm apcs32
20587 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
20588 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
20589
20590 @item show arm apcs32
20591 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
20592
20593 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
20594 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
20595 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
20596
20597 @table @code
20598 @item auto
20599 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
20600 @item softfpa
20601 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
20602 processors.
20603 @item fpa
20604 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
20605 @item softvfp
20606 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
20607 @item vfp
20608 VFP co-processor.
20609 @end table
20610
20611 @item show arm fpu
20612 Show the current type of the FPU.
20613
20614 @item set arm abi
20615 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
20616
20617 @item show arm abi
20618 Show the currently used ABI.
20619
20620 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
20621 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
20622 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
20623 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
20624 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
20625 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
20626 register).
20627
20628 @item show arm fallback-mode
20629 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
20630
20631 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
20632 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
20633 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
20634 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
20635 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
20636
20637 @item show arm force-mode
20638 Show the current forced instruction mode.
20639
20640 @item set debug arm
20641 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
20642 target support subsystem.
20643
20644 @item show debug arm
20645 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
20646 @end table
20647
20648 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
20649 using the RDI interface:
20650
20651 @table @code
20652 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
20653 @kindex rdilogfile
20654 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
20655 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
20656 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
20657 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
20658 @file{rdi.log}.
20659
20660 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
20661 @kindex rdilogenable
20662 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
20663 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
20664 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
20665 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
20666 are logged to a file.
20667
20668 @item set rdiromatzero
20669 @kindex set rdiromatzero
20670 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
20671 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
20672 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
20673 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
20674 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
20675
20676 @item show rdiromatzero
20677 @kindex show rdiromatzero
20678 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
20679
20680 @item set rdiheartbeat
20681 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
20682 @cindex RDI heartbeat
20683 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
20684 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
20685 well as the Angel monitor.
20686
20687 @item show rdiheartbeat
20688 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
20689 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
20690 @end table
20691
20692 @table @code
20693 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
20694 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
20695
20696 @table @code
20697 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
20698 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support.
20699 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
20700 The default value is @code{all}.
20701
20702 @table @code
20703 @item none
20704 @item demon
20705 @item angel
20706 @item redboot
20707 @item all
20708 @end table
20709 @end table
20710 @end table
20711
20712 @node M32R/D
20713 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
20714
20715 @table @code
20716 @kindex target m32r
20717 @item target m32r @var{dev}
20718 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
20719
20720 @kindex target m32rsdi
20721 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
20722 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
20723 @end table
20724
20725 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
20726
20727 @table @code
20728 @item set download-path @var{path}
20729 @kindex set download-path
20730 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
20731 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
20732
20733 @item show download-path
20734 @kindex show download-path
20735 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
20736
20737 @item set board-address @var{addr}
20738 @kindex set board-address
20739 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
20740 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
20741
20742 @item show board-address
20743 @kindex show board-address
20744 Show the current IP address of the target board.
20745
20746 @item set server-address @var{addr}
20747 @kindex set server-address
20748 @cindex download server address (M32R)
20749 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
20750 host machine.
20751
20752 @item show server-address
20753 @kindex show server-address
20754 Display the IP address of the download server.
20755
20756 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
20757 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
20758 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
20759 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
20760 executable file is uploaded.
20761
20762 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
20763 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
20764 Test the @code{upload} command.
20765 @end table
20766
20767 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
20768
20769 @table @code
20770 @item sdireset
20771 @kindex sdireset
20772 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
20773 This command resets the SDI connection.
20774
20775 @item sdistatus
20776 @kindex sdistatus
20777 This command shows the SDI connection status.
20778
20779 @item debug_chaos
20780 @kindex debug_chaos
20781 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
20782 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
20783
20784 @item use_debug_dma
20785 @kindex use_debug_dma
20786 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
20787
20788 @item use_mon_code
20789 @kindex use_mon_code
20790 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
20791
20792 @item use_ib_break
20793 @kindex use_ib_break
20794 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
20795
20796 @item use_dbt_break
20797 @kindex use_dbt_break
20798 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
20799 @end table
20800
20801 @node M68K
20802 @subsection M68k
20803
20804 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
20805 target command for the following ROM monitor.
20806
20807 @table @code
20808
20809 @kindex target dbug
20810 @item target dbug @var{dev}
20811 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
20812
20813 @end table
20814
20815 @node MicroBlaze
20816 @subsection MicroBlaze
20817 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
20818 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
20819
20820 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
20821 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
20822 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
20823 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
20824 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
20825 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
20826 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
20827 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
20828 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
20829 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
20830 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
20831
20832 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
20833
20834 @table @code
20835 @item target remote :1234
20836 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
20837 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
20838
20839 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
20840 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
20841 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
20842
20843 @item load
20844 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
20845
20846 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
20847 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
20848
20849 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
20850 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
20851 @end table
20852
20853 @node MIPS Embedded
20854 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
20855
20856 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} boards
20857 @value{GDBN} can use the @acronym{MIPS} remote debugging protocol to talk to a
20858 @acronym{MIPS} board attached to a serial line. This is available when
20859 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-elf}.
20860
20861 @need 1000
20862 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
20863
20864 @table @code
20865 @item target mips @var{port}
20866 @kindex target mips @var{port}
20867 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
20868 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
20869 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
20870 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
20871 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
20872 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
20873
20874 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
20875 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
20876 debugger:
20877
20878 @smallexample
20879 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
20880 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
20881 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
20882 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
20883 (@value{GDBP}) run
20884 @end smallexample
20885
20886 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
20887 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
20888 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
20889 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
20890 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
20891
20892 @item target pmon @var{port}
20893 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
20894 PMON ROM monitor.
20895
20896 @item target ddb @var{port}
20897 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
20898 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
20899
20900 @item target lsi @var{port}
20901 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
20902 LSI variant of PMON.
20903
20904 @kindex target r3900
20905 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
20906 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
20907
20908 @kindex target array
20909 @item target array @var{dev}
20910 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
20911
20912 @end table
20913
20914
20915 @noindent
20916 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
20917
20918 @table @code
20919 @item set mipsfpu double
20920 @itemx set mipsfpu single
20921 @itemx set mipsfpu none
20922 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
20923 @itemx show mipsfpu
20924 @kindex set mipsfpu
20925 @kindex show mipsfpu
20926 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
20927 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
20928 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
20929 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
20930 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
20931 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
20932 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
20933 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
20934 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
20935 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
20936 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
20937 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
20938 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
20939
20940 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
20941 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
20942 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
20943
20944 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
20945 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
20946
20947 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
20948 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
20949 @itemx show timeout
20950 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
20951 @cindex @code{timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
20952 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
20953 @kindex set timeout
20954 @kindex show timeout
20955 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
20956 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
20957 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the @acronym{MIPS}
20958 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
20959 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
20960 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
20961 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
20962 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
20963 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
20964 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-elf}.)
20965
20966 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
20967 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
20968 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
20969 to run before stopping.
20970
20971 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
20972 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20973 @cindex synchronize with remote @acronym{MIPS} target
20974 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
20975 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
20976 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
20977
20978 @item show syn-garbage-limit
20979 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20980 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
20981 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
20982
20983 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
20984 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20985 @cindex remote monitor prompt
20986 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
20987 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
20988 @table @asis
20989 @item pmon target
20990 @samp{PMON}
20991 @item ddb target
20992 @samp{NEC010}
20993 @item lsi target
20994 @samp{PMON>}
20995 @end table
20996
20997 @item show monitor-prompt
20998 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20999 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
21000 remote monitor.
21001
21002 @item set monitor-warnings
21003 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21004 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
21005 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
21006 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
21007 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
21008
21009 @item show monitor-warnings
21010 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21011 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
21012
21013 @item pmon @var{command}
21014 @kindex pmon@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21015 @cindex send PMON command
21016 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
21017 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
21018 @end table
21019
21020 @node PowerPC Embedded
21021 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
21022
21023 @cindex DVC register
21024 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
21025 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
21026
21027 @smallexample
21028 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
21029 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
21030 @end smallexample
21031
21032 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
21033 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
21034 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
21035 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
21036 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
21037 or newer.
21038
21039 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
21040 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
21041 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
21042 watching variables of scalar types.
21043
21044 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
21045 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
21046
21047 @smallexample
21048 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
21049 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
21050 @end smallexample
21051
21052 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
21053 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
21054
21055 @cindex ranged breakpoint
21056 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
21057 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
21058 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
21059 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
21060 use the @code{break-range} command.
21061
21062 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
21063
21064 @table @code
21065 @kindex break-range
21066 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
21067 Set a breakpoint for an address range.
21068 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location} can specify a function name,
21069 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
21070 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
21071 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
21072 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
21073 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
21074 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
21075
21076 @kindex set powerpc
21077 @item set powerpc soft-float
21078 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
21079 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
21080 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
21081 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21082
21083 @item set powerpc vector-abi
21084 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
21085 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
21086 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
21087 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
21088 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
21089 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
21090 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21091
21092 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
21093 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
21094 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
21095 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
21096 address of its first byte.
21097
21098 @kindex target dink32
21099 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
21100 DINK32 ROM monitor.
21101
21102 @kindex target ppcbug
21103 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
21104 @kindex target ppcbug1
21105 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
21106 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
21107
21108 @kindex target sds
21109 @item target sds @var{dev}
21110 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
21111 @end table
21112
21113 @cindex SDS protocol
21114 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
21115 by @value{GDBN}:
21116
21117 @table @code
21118 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
21119 @kindex set sdstimeout
21120 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
21121 default is 2 seconds.
21122
21123 @item show sdstimeout
21124 @kindex show sdstimeout
21125 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
21126
21127 @item sds @var{command}
21128 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
21129 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
21130 @end table
21131
21132
21133 @node PA
21134 @subsection HP PA Embedded
21135
21136 @table @code
21137
21138 @kindex target op50n
21139 @item target op50n @var{dev}
21140 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
21141
21142 @kindex target w89k
21143 @item target w89k @var{dev}
21144 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
21145
21146 @end table
21147
21148 @node Sparclet
21149 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
21150
21151 @cindex Sparclet
21152
21153 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
21154 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
21155 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
21156 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
21157 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
21158
21159 @table @code
21160 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
21161 @kindex remotetimeout
21162 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
21163 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
21164 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
21165 @end table
21166
21167 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
21168 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
21169 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
21170 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
21171 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
21172
21173 @smallexample
21174 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
21175 @end smallexample
21176
21177 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
21178
21179 @smallexample
21180 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
21181 @end smallexample
21182
21183 @cindex running, on Sparclet
21184 Once you have set
21185 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
21186 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
21187 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
21188
21189 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
21190
21191 @smallexample
21192 (gdbslet)
21193 @end smallexample
21194
21195 @menu
21196 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
21197 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
21198 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
21199 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
21200 @end menu
21201
21202 @node Sparclet File
21203 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
21204
21205 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
21206
21207 @smallexample
21208 (gdbslet) file prog
21209 @end smallexample
21210
21211 @need 1000
21212 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
21213 @value{GDBN} locates
21214 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
21215 path.
21216 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
21217 files will be searched as well.
21218 @value{GDBN} locates
21219 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
21220 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
21221 If it fails
21222 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
21223
21224 @smallexample
21225 prog: No such file or directory.
21226 @end smallexample
21227
21228 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
21229 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
21230 @code{target} command again.
21231
21232 @node Sparclet Connection
21233 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
21234
21235 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
21236 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
21237
21238 @smallexample
21239 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
21240 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
21241 main () at ../prog.c:3
21242 @end smallexample
21243
21244 @need 750
21245 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
21246
21247 @smallexample
21248 Connected to ttya.
21249 @end smallexample
21250
21251 @node Sparclet Download
21252 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
21253
21254 @cindex download to Sparclet
21255 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
21256 you can use the @value{GDBN}
21257 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
21258 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
21259 command.
21260 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
21261 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
21262 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
21263 of each of the file's sections.
21264 For instance, if the program
21265 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
21266 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
21267
21268 @smallexample
21269 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
21270 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
21271 @end smallexample
21272
21273 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
21274 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
21275 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
21276
21277 @node Sparclet Execution
21278 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
21279
21280 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
21281 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
21282 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
21283 manual for the list of commands.
21284
21285 @smallexample
21286 (gdbslet) b main
21287 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
21288 (gdbslet) run
21289 Starting program: prog
21290 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
21291 3 char *symarg = 0;
21292 (gdbslet) step
21293 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
21294 (gdbslet)
21295 @end smallexample
21296
21297 @node Sparclite
21298 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
21299
21300 @table @code
21301
21302 @kindex target sparclite
21303 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
21304 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
21305 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
21306 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
21307 remote protocol.
21308
21309 @end table
21310
21311 @node Z8000
21312 @subsection Zilog Z8000
21313
21314 @cindex Z8000
21315 @cindex simulator, Z8000
21316 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
21317
21318 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
21319 a Z8000 simulator.
21320
21321 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
21322 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
21323 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
21324 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
21325
21326 @table @code
21327 @item target sim @var{args}
21328 @kindex sim
21329 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
21330 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
21331 options, specify them via @var{args}.
21332 @end table
21333
21334 @noindent
21335 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
21336 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
21337 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
21338 to run your program, and so on.
21339
21340 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
21341 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
21342 additional items of information as specially named registers:
21343
21344 @table @code
21345
21346 @item cycles
21347 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
21348
21349 @item insts
21350 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
21351
21352 @item time
21353 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
21354
21355 @end table
21356
21357 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
21358 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
21359 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
21360 simulated clock ticks.
21361
21362 @node AVR
21363 @subsection Atmel AVR
21364 @cindex AVR
21365
21366 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
21367 following AVR-specific commands:
21368
21369 @table @code
21370 @item info io_registers
21371 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
21372 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
21373 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
21374 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
21375 @end table
21376
21377 @node CRIS
21378 @subsection CRIS
21379 @cindex CRIS
21380
21381 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
21382 following CRIS-specific commands:
21383
21384 @table @code
21385 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
21386 @cindex CRIS version
21387 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
21388 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
21389 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
21390
21391 @item show cris-version
21392 Show the current CRIS version.
21393
21394 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
21395 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
21396 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
21397 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
21398 @code{R59}.
21399
21400 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
21401 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
21402
21403 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
21404 @cindex CRIS mode
21405 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
21406 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
21407 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
21408
21409 @item show cris-mode
21410 Show the current CRIS mode.
21411 @end table
21412
21413 @node Super-H
21414 @subsection Renesas Super-H
21415 @cindex Super-H
21416
21417 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
21418 commands:
21419
21420 @table @code
21421 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
21422 @kindex set sh calling-convention
21423 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
21424 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
21425 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
21426 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
21427 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
21428 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
21429 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
21430 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
21431 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
21432 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
21433
21434 @item show sh calling-convention
21435 @kindex show sh calling-convention
21436 Show the current calling convention setting.
21437
21438 @end table
21439
21440
21441 @node Architectures
21442 @section Architectures
21443
21444 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
21445 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
21446
21447 @menu
21448 * AArch64::
21449 * i386::
21450 * Alpha::
21451 * MIPS::
21452 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
21453 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
21454 * PowerPC::
21455 * Nios II::
21456 @end menu
21457
21458 @node AArch64
21459 @subsection AArch64
21460 @cindex AArch64 support
21461
21462 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
21463 following special commands:
21464
21465 @table @code
21466 @item set debug aarch64
21467 @kindex set debug aarch64
21468 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
21469 messages are to be displayed.
21470
21471 @item show debug aarch64
21472 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
21473
21474 @end table
21475
21476 @node i386
21477 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
21478
21479 @table @code
21480 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
21481 @kindex set struct-convention
21482 @cindex struct return convention
21483 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
21484 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
21485 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
21486 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
21487 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
21488 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
21489 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
21490 be returned in a register.
21491
21492 @item show struct-convention
21493 @kindex show struct-convention
21494 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
21495 from functions.
21496 @end table
21497
21498 @subsubsection Intel(R) @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
21499 @cindex Intel(R) Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
21500
21501 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
21502 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
21503 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
21504 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
21505 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
21506 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
21507 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
21508
21509 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
21510 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
21511 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
21512 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
21513 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
21514 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
21515
21516 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
21517 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
21518 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
21519
21520 @smallexample
21521 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
21522 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
21523 @end smallexample
21524
21525 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
21526 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
21527 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
21528 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
21529 the pointer.
21530
21531 @node Alpha
21532 @subsection Alpha
21533
21534 See the following section.
21535
21536 @node MIPS
21537 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
21538
21539 @cindex stack on Alpha
21540 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
21541 @cindex Alpha stack
21542 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
21543 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
21544 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
21545 find the beginning of a function.
21546
21547 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
21548 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
21549 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
21550 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
21551 commands:
21552
21553 @table @code
21554 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
21555 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
21556 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
21557 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
21558 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
21559 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
21560 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
21561 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
21562
21563 @item show heuristic-fence-post
21564 Display the current limit.
21565 @end table
21566
21567 @noindent
21568 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
21569 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
21570
21571 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
21572 programs:
21573
21574 @table @code
21575 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
21576 @kindex set mips abi
21577 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
21578 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
21579 values of @var{arg} are:
21580
21581 @table @samp
21582 @item auto
21583 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
21584 default).
21585 @item o32
21586 @item o64
21587 @item n32
21588 @item n64
21589 @item eabi32
21590 @item eabi64
21591 @end table
21592
21593 @item show mips abi
21594 @kindex show mips abi
21595 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
21596
21597 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
21598 @kindex set mips compression
21599 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
21600 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
21601 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
21602 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
21603 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
21604 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
21605 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
21606 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
21607 provided by the executable.
21608
21609 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
21610 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
21611 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
21612 identified as such.
21613
21614 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
21615 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
21616 implicitly from an executable.
21617
21618 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
21619 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
21620 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
21621 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
21622 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
21623
21624 @item show mips compression
21625 @kindex show mips compression
21626 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
21627 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
21628
21629 @item set mipsfpu
21630 @itemx show mipsfpu
21631 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
21632
21633 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
21634 @kindex set mips mask-address
21635 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
21636 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
21637 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
21638 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
21639 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
21640
21641 @item show mips mask-address
21642 @kindex show mips mask-address
21643 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
21644 not.
21645
21646 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21647 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21648 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
21649 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
21650 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
21651 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
21652
21653 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21654 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21655 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
21656
21657 @item set debug mips
21658 @kindex set debug mips
21659 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
21660 target code in @value{GDBN}.
21661
21662 @item show debug mips
21663 @kindex show debug mips
21664 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
21665 @end table
21666
21667
21668 @node HPPA
21669 @subsection HPPA
21670 @cindex HPPA support
21671
21672 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
21673 following special commands:
21674
21675 @table @code
21676 @item set debug hppa
21677 @kindex set debug hppa
21678 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
21679 messages are to be displayed.
21680
21681 @item show debug hppa
21682 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
21683
21684 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
21685 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
21686 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
21687 given @var{address}.
21688
21689 @end table
21690
21691
21692 @node SPU
21693 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
21694 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
21695 @cindex SPU
21696
21697 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
21698 it provides the following special commands:
21699
21700 @table @code
21701 @item info spu event
21702 @kindex info spu
21703 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
21704 and pending event status.
21705
21706 @item info spu signal
21707 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
21708 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
21709 notification channels.
21710
21711 @item info spu mailbox
21712 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
21713 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
21714 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
21715
21716 @item info spu dma
21717 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
21718 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
21719 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
21720
21721 @item info spu proxydma
21722 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
21723 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
21724 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
21725
21726 @end table
21727
21728 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
21729 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
21730 special commands:
21731
21732 @table @code
21733 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
21734 @kindex set spu
21735 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
21736 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
21737 function. The default is @code{off}.
21738
21739 @item show spu stop-on-load
21740 @kindex show spu
21741 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
21742
21743 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
21744 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
21745 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
21746 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
21747 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
21748 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
21749
21750 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
21751 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
21752
21753 @end table
21754
21755 @node PowerPC
21756 @subsection PowerPC
21757 @cindex PowerPC architecture
21758
21759 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
21760 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
21761 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
21762 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
21763 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
21764
21765 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
21766 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
21767 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
21768
21769 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
21770 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
21771
21772 @node Nios II
21773 @subsection Nios II
21774 @cindex Nios II architecture
21775
21776 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
21777 it provides the following special commands:
21778
21779 @table @code
21780
21781 @item set debug nios2
21782 @kindex set debug nios2
21783 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
21784 target code in @value{GDBN}.
21785
21786 @item show debug nios2
21787 @kindex show debug nios2
21788 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
21789 @end table
21790
21791 @node Controlling GDB
21792 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
21793
21794 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
21795 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
21796 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
21797 described here.
21798
21799 @menu
21800 * Prompt:: Prompt
21801 * Editing:: Command editing
21802 * Command History:: Command history
21803 * Screen Size:: Screen size
21804 * Numbers:: Numbers
21805 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
21806 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
21807 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
21808 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
21809 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
21810 @end menu
21811
21812 @node Prompt
21813 @section Prompt
21814
21815 @cindex prompt
21816
21817 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
21818 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
21819 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
21820 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
21821 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
21822 which one you are talking to.
21823
21824 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
21825 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
21826 or a prompt that does not.
21827
21828 @table @code
21829 @kindex set prompt
21830 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
21831 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
21832
21833 @kindex show prompt
21834 @item show prompt
21835 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
21836 @end table
21837
21838 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
21839 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
21840 are:
21841
21842 @table @code
21843 @kindex set extended-prompt
21844 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
21845 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
21846 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
21847 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
21848 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
21849 is displayed.
21850
21851 For example:
21852
21853 @smallexample
21854 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
21855 @end smallexample
21856
21857 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
21858 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
21859
21860 @kindex show extended-prompt
21861 @item show extended-prompt
21862 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
21863 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
21864 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
21865 @end table
21866
21867 @node Editing
21868 @section Command Editing
21869 @cindex readline
21870 @cindex command line editing
21871
21872 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
21873 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
21874 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
21875 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
21876 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
21877 debugging sessions.
21878
21879 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
21880 command @code{set}.
21881
21882 @table @code
21883 @kindex set editing
21884 @cindex editing
21885 @item set editing
21886 @itemx set editing on
21887 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
21888
21889 @item set editing off
21890 Disable command line editing.
21891
21892 @kindex show editing
21893 @item show editing
21894 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
21895 @end table
21896
21897 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
21898 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
21899 @end ifset
21900 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
21901 @xref{Command Line Editing},
21902 @end ifclear
21903 for more details about the Readline
21904 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
21905 encouraged to read that chapter.
21906
21907 @node Command History
21908 @section Command History
21909 @cindex command history
21910
21911 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
21912 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
21913 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
21914 history facility.
21915
21916 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
21917 package, to provide the history facility.
21918 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
21919 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
21920 @end ifset
21921 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
21922 @xref{Using History Interactively},
21923 @end ifclear
21924 for the detailed description of the History library.
21925
21926 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
21927 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
21928 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
21929 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
21930 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
21931 pressed on a line by itself.
21932
21933 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
21934 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
21935 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
21936 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
21937
21938 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
21939 history.
21940
21941 @table @code
21942 @cindex history substitution
21943 @cindex history file
21944 @kindex set history filename
21945 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
21946 @item set history filename @var{fname}
21947 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
21948 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
21949 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
21950 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
21951 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
21952 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
21953 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
21954 is not set.
21955
21956 @cindex save command history
21957 @kindex set history save
21958 @item set history save
21959 @itemx set history save on
21960 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
21961 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
21962
21963 @item set history save off
21964 Stop recording command history in a file.
21965
21966 @cindex history size
21967 @kindex set history size
21968 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
21969 @item set history size @var{size}
21970 @itemx set history size unlimited
21971 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
21972 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
21973 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set. If @var{size}
21974 is @code{unlimited}, the number of commands @value{GDBN} keeps in the
21975 history list is unlimited.
21976 @end table
21977
21978 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
21979 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
21980 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
21981 @end ifset
21982 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
21983 @xref{Event Designators},
21984 @end ifclear
21985 for more details.
21986
21987 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
21988 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
21989 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
21990 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
21991 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
21992 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
21993 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
21994 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
21995
21996 The commands to control history expansion are:
21997
21998 @table @code
21999 @item set history expansion on
22000 @itemx set history expansion
22001 @kindex set history expansion
22002 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
22003
22004 @item set history expansion off
22005 Disable history expansion.
22006
22007 @c @group
22008 @kindex show history
22009 @item show history
22010 @itemx show history filename
22011 @itemx show history save
22012 @itemx show history size
22013 @itemx show history expansion
22014 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
22015 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
22016 @c @end group
22017 @end table
22018
22019 @table @code
22020 @kindex show commands
22021 @cindex show last commands
22022 @cindex display command history
22023 @item show commands
22024 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
22025
22026 @item show commands @var{n}
22027 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
22028
22029 @item show commands +
22030 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
22031 @end table
22032
22033 @node Screen Size
22034 @section Screen Size
22035 @cindex size of screen
22036 @cindex pauses in output
22037
22038 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
22039 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
22040 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
22041 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
22042 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
22043 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
22044 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
22045 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
22046
22047 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
22048 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
22049 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
22050 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
22051 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
22052 width} commands:
22053
22054 @table @code
22055 @kindex set height
22056 @kindex set width
22057 @kindex show width
22058 @kindex show height
22059 @item set height @var{lpp}
22060 @itemx set height unlimited
22061 @itemx show height
22062 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
22063 @itemx set width unlimited
22064 @itemx show width
22065 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
22066 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
22067 commands display the current settings.
22068
22069 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
22070 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
22071 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
22072 buffer.
22073
22074 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
22075 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
22076
22077 @item set pagination on
22078 @itemx set pagination off
22079 @kindex set pagination
22080 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
22081 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
22082 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
22083 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
22084
22085 @item show pagination
22086 @kindex show pagination
22087 Show the current pagination mode.
22088 @end table
22089
22090 @node Numbers
22091 @section Numbers
22092 @cindex number representation
22093 @cindex entering numbers
22094
22095 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
22096 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
22097 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
22098 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
22099 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
22100 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
22101 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
22102 both input and output with the commands described below.
22103
22104 @table @code
22105 @kindex set input-radix
22106 @item set input-radix @var{base}
22107 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
22108 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
22109 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
22110 example, any of
22111
22112 @smallexample
22113 set input-radix 012
22114 set input-radix 10.
22115 set input-radix 0xa
22116 @end smallexample
22117
22118 @noindent
22119 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
22120 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
22121 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
22122 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
22123 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
22124 change the radix.
22125
22126 @kindex set output-radix
22127 @item set output-radix @var{base}
22128 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
22129 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
22130 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
22131
22132 @kindex show input-radix
22133 @item show input-radix
22134 Display the current default base for numeric input.
22135
22136 @kindex show output-radix
22137 @item show output-radix
22138 Display the current default base for numeric display.
22139
22140 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
22141 @itemx show radix
22142 @kindex set radix
22143 @kindex show radix
22144 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
22145 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
22146 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
22147 default value of 10.
22148
22149 @end table
22150
22151 @node ABI
22152 @section Configuring the Current ABI
22153
22154 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
22155 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
22156 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
22157 current ABI.
22158
22159 @cindex OS ABI
22160 @kindex set osabi
22161 @kindex show osabi
22162 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
22163
22164 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
22165 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
22166 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
22167 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
22168 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
22169 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
22170 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
22171 platform provides.
22172
22173 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
22174 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
22175 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
22176 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
22177
22178 @table @code
22179 @item show osabi
22180 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
22181
22182 @item set osabi
22183 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
22184
22185 @item set osabi @var{abi}
22186 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
22187 @end table
22188
22189 @cindex float promotion
22190
22191 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
22192 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
22193 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
22194 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
22195 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
22196 @code{double} and then passed.
22197
22198 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
22199 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
22200 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
22201
22202 @table @code
22203 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
22204 @item set coerce-float-to-double
22205 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
22206 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
22207 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
22208
22209 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
22210 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
22211 functions.
22212
22213 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
22214 @item show coerce-float-to-double
22215 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
22216 @end table
22217
22218 @kindex set cp-abi
22219 @kindex show cp-abi
22220 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
22221 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
22222 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
22223 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
22224 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
22225 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
22226 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
22227 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
22228 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
22229 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
22230 ``auto''.
22231
22232 @table @code
22233 @item show cp-abi
22234 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
22235
22236 @item set cp-abi
22237 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
22238
22239 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
22240 @itemx set cp-abi auto
22241 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
22242 @end table
22243
22244 @node Auto-loading
22245 @section Automatically loading associated files
22246 @cindex auto-loading
22247
22248 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
22249 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
22250 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
22251 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
22252 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
22253 sources).
22254
22255 @menu
22256 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
22257 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
22258
22259 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
22260 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
22261 @end menu
22262
22263 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
22264 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
22265 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
22266
22267 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
22268 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
22269 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22270
22271 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
22272 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
22273
22274 @table @code
22275 @anchor{set auto-load off}
22276 @kindex set auto-load off
22277 @item set auto-load off
22278 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
22279 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
22280 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
22281 @smallexample
22282 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
22283 @end smallexample
22284
22285 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
22286 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
22287 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
22288 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
22289 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
22290 @code{set auto-load no}.
22291
22292 @anchor{show auto-load}
22293 @kindex show auto-load
22294 @item show auto-load
22295 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
22296 or disabled.
22297
22298 @smallexample
22299 (gdb) show auto-load
22300 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
22301 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
22302 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
22303 is on.
22304 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
22305 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
22306 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
22307 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
22308 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
22309 @end smallexample
22310
22311 @anchor{info auto-load}
22312 @kindex info auto-load
22313 @item info auto-load
22314 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
22315 not.
22316
22317 @smallexample
22318 (gdb) info auto-load
22319 gdb-scripts:
22320 Loaded Script
22321 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
22322 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
22323 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
22324 loaded.
22325 python-scripts:
22326 Loaded Script
22327 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
22328 @end smallexample
22329 @end table
22330
22331 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
22332
22333 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
22334 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
22335 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
22336 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
22337 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
22338 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
22339 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
22340 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22341 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22342 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22343 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22344 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22345 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22346 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
22347 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22348 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
22349 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22350 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
22351 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22352 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
22353 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22354 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
22355 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22356 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
22357 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22358 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
22359 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
22360 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
22361 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
22362 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22363 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
22364 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22365 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
22366 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22367 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
22368 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
22369 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
22370 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
22371 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
22372 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
22373 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
22374 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
22375 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
22376 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
22377 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
22378 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
22379 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
22380 @end multitable
22381
22382 @node Init File in the Current Directory
22383 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
22384 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
22385
22386 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
22387 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
22388 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
22389
22390 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
22391 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22392
22393 @table @code
22394 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
22395 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
22396 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
22397 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
22398 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
22399
22400 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
22401 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
22402 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
22403 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
22404 current directory is enabled or disabled.
22405
22406 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
22407 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
22408 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
22409 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
22410 current directory have been auto-loaded.
22411 @end table
22412
22413 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
22414 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
22415 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
22416
22417 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
22418
22419 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
22420 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
22421
22422 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
22423 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
22424 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
22425 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
22426 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
22427 library.
22428
22429 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
22430 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22431
22432 @table @code
22433 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
22434 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
22435 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
22436 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
22437
22438 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
22439 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
22440 @item show auto-load libthread-db
22441 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
22442 enabled or disabled.
22443
22444 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
22445 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
22446 @item info auto-load libthread-db
22447 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
22448 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
22449 @end table
22450
22451 @node Auto-loading safe path
22452 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
22453 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
22454
22455 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
22456 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
22457 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
22458 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
22459 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
22460
22461 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
22462 get loaded:
22463
22464 @smallexample
22465 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
22466 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
22467 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
22468 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
22469 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
22470 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
22471 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
22472 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
22473 @end smallexample
22474
22475 @noindent
22476 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
22477 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
22478
22479 @smallexample
22480 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
22481 @end smallexample
22482
22483 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
22484
22485 @table @code
22486 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
22487 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
22488 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
22489 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
22490 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
22491 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
22492 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
22493 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
22494 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
22495 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
22496
22497 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
22498 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
22499 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
22500
22501 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
22502 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
22503 @item show auto-load safe-path
22504 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
22505 scripts.
22506
22507 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
22508 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
22509 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
22510 Add an entry (or list of entries) the list of directories trusted for automatic
22511 loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited by the
22512 host platform path separator in use.
22513 @end table
22514
22515 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
22516 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
22517 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
22518 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
22519 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
22520
22521 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
22522 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
22523 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
22524 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
22525 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
22526 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
22527 init file in the current directory
22528 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
22529
22530 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
22531 example, you could use one of the following ways:
22532
22533 @table @asis
22534 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
22535 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
22536 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
22537 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
22538
22539 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
22540 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
22541 @value{GDBN} session.
22542
22543 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
22544 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
22545 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
22546 from trusted sources.
22547
22548 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
22549 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
22550 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
22551 trusted sources.
22552 @end table
22553
22554 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
22555 also suppresses any such warning messages:
22556
22557 @table @asis
22558 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
22559 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
22560
22561 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
22562 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
22563 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
22564 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
22565 @end table
22566
22567 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
22568 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
22569 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
22570 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
22571 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
22572 recommended to be entered.
22573
22574 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
22575 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
22576 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
22577
22578 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
22579 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
22580 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
22581 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
22582 be printed.
22583
22584 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
22585 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
22586 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
22587
22588 @smallexample
22589 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
22590 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
22591 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
22592 for objfile "/tmp/true".
22593 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
22594 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
22595 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
22596 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
22597 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
22598 @end smallexample
22599
22600 @table @code
22601 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
22602 @kindex set debug auto-load
22603 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
22604 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
22605
22606 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
22607 @kindex show debug auto-load
22608 @item show debug auto-load
22609 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
22610 on or off.
22611 @end table
22612
22613 @node Messages/Warnings
22614 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
22615
22616 @cindex verbose operation
22617 @cindex optional warnings
22618 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
22619 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
22620 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
22621 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
22622
22623 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
22624 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
22625 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
22626
22627 @table @code
22628 @kindex set verbose
22629 @item set verbose on
22630 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
22631
22632 @item set verbose off
22633 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
22634
22635 @kindex show verbose
22636 @item show verbose
22637 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
22638 @end table
22639
22640 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
22641 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
22642 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
22643 Symbol Files}).
22644
22645 @table @code
22646
22647 @kindex set complaints
22648 @item set complaints @var{limit}
22649 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
22650 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
22651 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
22652 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
22653
22654 @kindex show complaints
22655 @item show complaints
22656 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
22657
22658 @end table
22659
22660 @anchor{confirmation requests}
22661 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
22662 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
22663 you try to run a program which is already running:
22664
22665 @smallexample
22666 (@value{GDBP}) run
22667 The program being debugged has been started already.
22668 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
22669 @end smallexample
22670
22671 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
22672 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
22673
22674 @table @code
22675
22676 @kindex set confirm
22677 @cindex flinching
22678 @cindex confirmation
22679 @cindex stupid questions
22680 @item set confirm off
22681 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
22682 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
22683 automatically disables confirmation requests.
22684
22685 @item set confirm on
22686 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
22687
22688 @kindex show confirm
22689 @item show confirm
22690 Displays state of confirmation requests.
22691
22692 @end table
22693
22694 @cindex command tracing
22695 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
22696 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
22697 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
22698 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
22699
22700 @table @code
22701 @kindex set trace-commands
22702 @cindex command scripts, debugging
22703 @item set trace-commands on
22704 Enable command tracing.
22705 @item set trace-commands off
22706 Disable command tracing.
22707 @item show trace-commands
22708 Display the current state of command tracing.
22709 @end table
22710
22711 @node Debugging Output
22712 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
22713 @cindex optional debugging messages
22714
22715 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
22716 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
22717 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
22718 section documents those commands.
22719
22720 @table @code
22721 @kindex set exec-done-display
22722 @item set exec-done-display
22723 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
22724 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
22725 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
22726 @kindex show exec-done-display
22727 @item show exec-done-display
22728 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
22729 notification.
22730 @kindex set debug
22731 @cindex ARM AArch64
22732 @item set debug aarch64
22733 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
22734 The default is off.
22735 @kindex show debug
22736 @item show debug aarch64
22737 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
22738 ARM AArch64.
22739 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
22740 @cindex architecture debugging info
22741 @item set debug arch
22742 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
22743 @item show debug arch
22744 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
22745 @item set debug aix-solib
22746 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
22747 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
22748 support module. The default is off.
22749 @item show debug aix-thread
22750 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
22751 @item set debug aix-thread
22752 @cindex AIX threads
22753 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
22754 module.
22755 @item show debug aix-thread
22756 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
22757 @item set debug check-physname
22758 @cindex physname
22759 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
22760 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
22761 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
22762 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
22763 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
22764 both ways and display any discrepancies.
22765 @item show debug check-physname
22766 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
22767 @item set debug coff-pe-read
22768 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
22769 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
22770 exported symbols. The default is off.
22771 @item show debug coff-pe-read
22772 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
22773 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
22774 @item set debug dwarf2-die
22775 @cindex DWARF2 DIEs
22776 Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
22777 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
22778 A value of zero turns off the display.
22779 @item show debug dwarf2-die
22780 Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
22781 @item set debug dwarf2-read
22782 @cindex DWARF2 Reading
22783 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
22784 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
22785 A value of 1 provides basic information.
22786 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
22787 @item show debug dwarf2-read
22788 Show the current state of DWARF2 reader debugging.
22789 @item set debug displaced
22790 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
22791 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
22792 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
22793 @item show debug displaced
22794 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
22795 related to displaced stepping.
22796 @item set debug event
22797 @cindex event debugging info
22798 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
22799 default is off.
22800 @item show debug event
22801 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
22802 info.
22803 @item set debug expression
22804 @cindex expression debugging info
22805 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
22806 expression parsing. The default is off.
22807 @item show debug expression
22808 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
22809 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
22810 @item set debug frame
22811 @cindex frame debugging info
22812 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
22813 default is off.
22814 @item show debug frame
22815 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
22816 info.
22817 @item set debug gnu-nat
22818 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
22819 Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
22820 @item show debug gnu-nat
22821 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
22822 @item set debug infrun
22823 @cindex inferior debugging info
22824 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
22825 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
22826 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
22827 @item show debug infrun
22828 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
22829 @item set debug jit
22830 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
22831 Turns on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
22832 @item show debug jit
22833 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
22834 @item set debug lin-lwp
22835 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
22836 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
22837 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
22838 @item show debug lin-lwp
22839 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
22840 @item set debug mach-o
22841 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
22842 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
22843 processing. The default is off.
22844 @item show debug mach-o
22845 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
22846 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
22847 @item set debug notification
22848 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
22849 Turns on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
22850 The default is off.
22851 @item show debug notification
22852 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
22853 @item set debug observer
22854 @cindex observer debugging info
22855 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
22856 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
22857 @item show debug observer
22858 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
22859 @item set debug overload
22860 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
22861 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
22862 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
22863 is off.
22864 @item show debug overload
22865 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
22866 debugging info.
22867 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
22868 @cindex debug expression parser
22869 @item set debug parser
22870 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
22871 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
22872 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
22873 details. The default is off.
22874 @item show debug parser
22875 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
22876 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
22877 @cindex serial connections, debugging
22878 @cindex debug remote protocol
22879 @cindex remote protocol debugging
22880 @cindex display remote packets
22881 @item set debug remote
22882 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
22883 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
22884 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
22885 @item show debug remote
22886 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
22887 @item set debug serial
22888 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
22889 default is off.
22890 @item show debug serial
22891 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
22892 info.
22893 @item set debug solib-frv
22894 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
22895 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
22896 @item show debug solib-frv
22897 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
22898 messages.
22899 @item set debug symfile
22900 @cindex symbol file functions
22901 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
22902 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
22903 @item show debug symfile
22904 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
22905 @item set debug symtab-create
22906 @cindex symbol table creation
22907 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
22908 The default is 0 (off).
22909 A value of 1 provides basic information.
22910 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
22911 @item show debug symtab-create
22912 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
22913 @item set debug target
22914 @cindex target debugging info
22915 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
22916 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
22917 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
22918 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
22919 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
22920 @item show debug target
22921 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
22922 info.
22923 @item set debug timestamp
22924 @cindex timestampping debugging info
22925 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
22926 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
22927 message.
22928 @item show debug timestamp
22929 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
22930 debugging info.
22931 @item set debug varobj
22932 @cindex variable object debugging info
22933 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
22934 info. The default is off.
22935 @item show debug varobj
22936 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
22937 debugging info.
22938 @item set debug xml
22939 @cindex XML parser debugging
22940 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
22941 @item show debug xml
22942 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
22943 @end table
22944
22945 @node Other Misc Settings
22946 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
22947 @cindex miscellaneous settings
22948
22949 @table @code
22950 @kindex set interactive-mode
22951 @item set interactive-mode
22952 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
22953 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
22954 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
22955 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
22956 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
22957 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
22958 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
22959 is, non-interactively otherwise.
22960
22961 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
22962 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
22963 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
22964 inside a cygwin window.
22965
22966 @kindex show interactive-mode
22967 @item show interactive-mode
22968 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
22969 @end table
22970
22971 @node Extending GDB
22972 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
22973 @cindex extending GDB
22974
22975 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
22976 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
22977 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
22978 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
22979 being debugged.
22980
22981 @menu
22982 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
22983 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
22984 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
22985 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
22986 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
22987 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
22988 @end menu
22989
22990 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
22991 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
22992 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
22993 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
22994 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
22995 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
22996
22997 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
22998 setting:
22999
23000 @table @code
23001 @kindex set script-extension
23002 @kindex show script-extension
23003 @item set script-extension off
23004 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23005
23006 @item set script-extension soft
23007 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23008 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
23009 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
23010 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
23011
23012 @item set script-extension strict
23013 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23014 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
23015 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
23016
23017 @item show script-extension
23018 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
23019
23020 @end table
23021
23022 @node Sequences
23023 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
23024
23025 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
23026 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
23027 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
23028 files.
23029
23030 @menu
23031 * Define:: How to define your own commands
23032 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
23033 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
23034 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
23035 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
23036 @end menu
23037
23038 @node Define
23039 @subsection User-defined Commands
23040
23041 @cindex user-defined command
23042 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
23043 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
23044 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
23045 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
23046 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
23047 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
23048
23049 @smallexample
23050 define adder
23051 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23052 end
23053 @end smallexample
23054
23055 @noindent
23056 To execute the command use:
23057
23058 @smallexample
23059 adder 1 2 3
23060 @end smallexample
23061
23062 @noindent
23063 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
23064 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
23065 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
23066 functions calls.
23067
23068 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
23069 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
23070 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
23071 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
23072
23073 @smallexample
23074 define adder
23075 if $argc == 2
23076 print $arg0 + $arg1
23077 end
23078 if $argc == 3
23079 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23080 end
23081 end
23082 @end smallexample
23083
23084 @table @code
23085
23086 @kindex define
23087 @item define @var{commandname}
23088 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
23089 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
23090 @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
23091 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
23092 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
23093 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
23094
23095 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
23096 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
23097 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23098
23099 @kindex document
23100 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
23101 @item document @var{commandname}
23102 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
23103 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
23104 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
23105 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
23106 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
23107 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
23108
23109 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
23110 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
23111 does not change the documentation.
23112
23113 @kindex dont-repeat
23114 @cindex don't repeat command
23115 @item dont-repeat
23116 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
23117 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
23118 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
23119
23120 @kindex help user-defined
23121 @item help user-defined
23122 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
23123 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
23124 included (if any).
23125
23126 @kindex show user
23127 @item show user
23128 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
23129 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
23130 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
23131 definitions for all user-defined commands.
23132 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
23133
23134 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
23135 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
23136 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
23137 @item show max-user-call-depth
23138 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
23139 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
23140 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
23141 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
23142 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
23143 @end table
23144
23145 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
23146 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
23147
23148 When user-defined commands are executed, the
23149 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
23150 stops execution of the user-defined command.
23151
23152 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
23153 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
23154 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
23155 messages when used in a user-defined command.
23156
23157 @node Hooks
23158 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
23159 @cindex command hooks
23160 @cindex hooks, for commands
23161 @cindex hooks, pre-command
23162
23163 @kindex hook
23164 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
23165 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
23166 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
23167 before that command.
23168
23169 @cindex hooks, post-command
23170 @kindex hookpost
23171 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
23172 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
23173 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
23174 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
23175 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
23176
23177 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
23178 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
23179
23180 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
23181 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
23182
23183 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
23184 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
23185 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
23186 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
23187 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
23188
23189 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
23190 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
23191 you could define:
23192
23193 @smallexample
23194 define hook-stop
23195 handle SIGALRM nopass
23196 end
23197
23198 define hook-run
23199 handle SIGALRM pass
23200 end
23201
23202 define hook-continue
23203 handle SIGALRM pass
23204 end
23205 @end smallexample
23206
23207 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
23208 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
23209 you could define:
23210
23211 @smallexample
23212 define hook-echo
23213 echo <<<---
23214 end
23215
23216 define hookpost-echo
23217 echo --->>>\n
23218 end
23219
23220 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
23221 <<<---Hello World--->>>
23222 (@value{GDBP})
23223
23224 @end smallexample
23225
23226 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
23227 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
23228 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
23229 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
23230 @c or not?
23231 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
23232 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
23233 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
23234
23235 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
23236 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
23237 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
23238
23239 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
23240 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
23241
23242 @node Command Files
23243 @subsection Command Files
23244
23245 @cindex command files
23246 @cindex scripting commands
23247 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
23248 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
23249 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
23250 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
23251 terminal.
23252
23253 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
23254 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
23255 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
23256 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
23257 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
23258
23259 @table @code
23260 @kindex source
23261 @cindex execute commands from a file
23262 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
23263 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
23264 @end table
23265
23266 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
23267 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
23268 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
23269 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
23270 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
23271
23272 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
23273 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
23274 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
23275 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
23276 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
23277 is not relevant to scripts.
23278
23279 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
23280 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
23281 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
23282 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
23283 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
23284 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
23285 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
23286 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
23287 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
23288 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
23289 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
23290 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
23291 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
23292 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
23293
23294 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
23295 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
23296 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
23297
23298 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
23299 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
23300 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
23301 when called from command files.
23302
23303 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
23304 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
23305 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
23306 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
23307 the next command.
23308
23309 @smallexample
23310 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
23311 @end smallexample
23312
23313 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
23314 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
23315 would be directed to @file{log}.
23316
23317 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
23318 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
23319 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
23320 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
23321 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
23322 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
23323 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
23324 conditionally, etc.
23325
23326 @table @code
23327 @kindex if
23328 @kindex else
23329 @item if
23330 @itemx else
23331 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
23332 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
23333 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
23334 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
23335 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
23336 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
23337 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23338
23339 @kindex while
23340 @item while
23341 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
23342 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
23343 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
23344 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
23345 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
23346 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
23347
23348 @kindex loop_break
23349 @item loop_break
23350 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
23351 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
23352 line.
23353
23354 @kindex loop_continue
23355 @item loop_continue
23356 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
23357 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
23358 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
23359 the controlling expression.
23360
23361 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
23362 @item end
23363 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
23364 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
23365 @end table
23366
23367
23368 @node Output
23369 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
23370
23371 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
23372 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
23373 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
23374 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
23375 want.
23376
23377 @table @code
23378 @kindex echo
23379 @item echo @var{text}
23380 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
23381 @c because it is not in ANSI.
23382 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
23383 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
23384 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
23385 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
23386 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
23387 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
23388 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
23389 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
23390 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
23391
23392 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
23393 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
23394
23395 @smallexample
23396 echo This is some text\n\
23397 which is continued\n\
23398 onto several lines.\n
23399 @end smallexample
23400
23401 produces the same output as
23402
23403 @smallexample
23404 echo This is some text\n
23405 echo which is continued\n
23406 echo onto several lines.\n
23407 @end smallexample
23408
23409 @kindex output
23410 @item output @var{expression}
23411 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
23412 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
23413 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
23414 on expressions.
23415
23416 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
23417 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
23418 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
23419 Formats}, for more information.
23420
23421 @kindex printf
23422 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
23423 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
23424 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
23425 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
23426 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
23427 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
23428 executing the code below:
23429
23430 @smallexample
23431 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
23432 @end smallexample
23433
23434 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
23435 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
23436 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
23437 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
23438 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
23439 printed.
23440
23441 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
23442
23443 @smallexample
23444 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
23445 @end smallexample
23446
23447 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
23448 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
23449 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
23450
23451 @itemize @bullet
23452 @item
23453 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
23454
23455 @item
23456 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
23457 width.
23458
23459 @item
23460 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
23461 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
23462
23463 @item
23464 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
23465 supported.
23466
23467 @item
23468 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
23469
23470 @item
23471 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
23472 @end itemize
23473
23474 @noindent
23475 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
23476 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
23477 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
23478 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
23479
23480 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
23481 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
23482 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
23483 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
23484 supported.
23485
23486 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
23487 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
23488 together with a floating point specifier.
23489 letters:
23490
23491 @itemize @bullet
23492 @item
23493 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
23494
23495 @item
23496 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
23497
23498 @item
23499 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
23500 @end itemize
23501
23502 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
23503 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
23504 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
23505
23506 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
23507 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
23508
23509 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
23510 @smallexample
23511 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
23512 @end smallexample
23513
23514 @kindex eval
23515 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
23516 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
23517 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
23518
23519 @end table
23520
23521 @node Auto-loading sequences
23522 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
23523 @cindex native script auto-loading
23524
23525 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
23526 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
23527 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
23528 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
23529
23530 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
23531 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
23532
23533 @table @code
23534 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
23535 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
23536 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
23537 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
23538
23539 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
23540 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
23541 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
23542 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
23543 disabled.
23544
23545 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
23546 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
23547 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
23548 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
23549 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
23550 auto-loaded.
23551 @end table
23552
23553 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
23554 matching names are printed.
23555
23556 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
23557 @include python.texi
23558
23559 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
23560 @include guile.texi
23561
23562 @node Auto-loading extensions
23563 @section Auto-loading extensions
23564 @cindex auto-loading extensions
23565
23566 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
23567 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
23568 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
23569 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
23570 section of modern file formats like ELF.
23571
23572 @menu
23573 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
23574 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23575 * Which flavor to choose?::
23576 @end menu
23577
23578 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
23579 debugging commands and features.
23580
23581 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
23582 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
23583 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
23584 for more information.
23585 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
23586 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
23587
23588 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
23589 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23590
23591 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
23592 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
23593 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
23594 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
23595 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
23596
23597 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
23598 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
23599 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
23600 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
23601
23602 @table @code
23603 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
23604 GDB's own command language
23605 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
23606 Python
23607 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
23608 Guile
23609 @end table
23610
23611 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
23612 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
23613 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
23614 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
23615 script in the specified extension language.
23616
23617 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
23618 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
23619
23620 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
23621 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23622
23623 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
23624 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
23625 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
23626 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
23627 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
23628 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
23629
23630 @table @code
23631 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
23632 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
23633 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23634 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
23635 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
23636 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
23637
23638 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
23639 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
23640
23641 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
23642 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
23643 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
23644 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
23645
23646 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
23647 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
23648 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
23649 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
23650 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
23651 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
23652 platform.
23653
23654 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23655 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23656 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23657
23658 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
23659 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
23660 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
23661 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23662 @end table
23663
23664 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
23665 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
23666 @var{objfile} is opened.
23667 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
23668 is evaluated more than once.
23669
23670 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
23671 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23672 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23673
23674 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
23675 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
23676 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
23677 If this section exists, its contents is a list of NUL-terminated names
23678 of scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-NULL prefix byte that
23679 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language.
23680
23681 @value{GDBN} will look for each specified script file first in the
23682 current directory and then along the source search path
23683 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
23684 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
23685 directory is not relevant to scripts.
23686
23687 Entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
23688 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
23689
23690 @example
23691 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
23692 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
23693 asm("\
23694 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
23695 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
23696 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
23697 .popsection \n\
23698 ");
23699 @end example
23700
23701 @noindent
23702 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
23703 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
23704
23705 @example
23706 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
23707 @end example
23708
23709 The script name may include directories if desired.
23710
23711 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
23712 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23713
23714 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
23715 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
23716 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
23717 will remove duplicates.
23718
23719 @node Which flavor to choose?
23720 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
23721
23722 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
23723 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
23724
23725 @noindent
23726 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
23727
23728 @itemize @bullet
23729 @item
23730 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
23731
23732 @item
23733 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
23734
23735 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
23736 in the source search path.
23737 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
23738 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
23739
23740 @item
23741 Doesn't require source code additions.
23742 @end itemize
23743
23744 @noindent
23745 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
23746
23747 @itemize @bullet
23748 @item
23749 Works with static linking.
23750
23751 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
23752 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
23753 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
23754 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
23755 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
23756
23757 @item
23758 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
23759
23760 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
23761 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
23762
23763 @item
23764 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
23765
23766 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
23767 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
23768 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
23769 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
23770 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
23771 top of the source tree to the source search path.
23772 @end itemize
23773
23774 @node Multiple Extension Languages
23775 @section Multiple Extension Languages
23776
23777 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
23778 and generally do not interfere with each other.
23779 There are some things to be aware of, however.
23780
23781 @subsection Python comes first
23782
23783 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
23784 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
23785 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
23786 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
23787 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
23788 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
23789 pretty-printed form of a value).
23790 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
23791 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
23792 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
23793
23794 @node Aliases
23795 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
23796 @cindex aliases for commands
23797
23798 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
23799 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
23800 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
23801 that involves less typing.
23802
23803 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
23804 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
23805 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
23806
23807 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
23808 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
23809 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
23810
23811 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
23812
23813 @table @code
23814
23815 @kindex alias
23816 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
23817
23818 @end table
23819
23820 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
23821 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
23822 underscores.
23823
23824 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
23825 that is being aliased.
23826
23827 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
23828 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
23829 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
23830
23831 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
23832 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
23833
23834 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
23835 of a command so that there is less to type.
23836 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
23837 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
23838 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
23839 The following will accomplish this.
23840
23841 @smallexample
23842 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
23843 @end smallexample
23844
23845 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
23846 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
23847 for it with the @samp{document} command.
23848 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
23849
23850 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
23851 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
23852 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
23853 of a command.
23854
23855 @smallexample
23856 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
23857 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
23858 (gdb) set p elms 20
23859 (gdb) show p elms
23860 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
23861 @end smallexample
23862
23863 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
23864 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
23865 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
23866
23867 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
23868 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
23869
23870 @smallexample
23871 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
23872 @end smallexample
23873
23874 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
23875 alias for a more complex command.
23876 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
23877
23878 @smallexample
23879 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
23880 (gdb) spe 20
23881 @end smallexample
23882
23883 @node Interpreters
23884 @chapter Command Interpreters
23885 @cindex command interpreters
23886
23887 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
23888 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
23889 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
23890
23891 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
23892 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
23893 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
23894 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
23895
23896 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
23897 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
23898 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
23899 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
23900
23901 @table @code
23902 @item console
23903 @cindex console interpreter
23904 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
23905 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
23906 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
23907
23908 @item mi
23909 @cindex mi interpreter
23910 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
23911 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
23912 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
23913 Interface}.
23914
23915 @item mi2
23916 @cindex mi2 interpreter
23917 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
23918
23919 @item mi1
23920 @cindex mi1 interpreter
23921 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
23922
23923 @end table
23924
23925 @cindex invoke another interpreter
23926 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
23927 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
23928 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
23929 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
23930 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
23931 the IDE inoperable!
23932
23933 @kindex interpreter-exec
23934 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
23935 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
23936 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
23937 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
23938
23939 @smallexample
23940 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
23941 @end smallexample
23942
23943 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
23944 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
23945
23946 @node TUI
23947 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
23948 @cindex TUI
23949 @cindex Text User Interface
23950
23951 @menu
23952 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
23953 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
23954 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
23955 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
23956 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
23957 @end menu
23958
23959 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
23960 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
23961 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
23962 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
23963 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
23964 is available.
23965
23966 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
23967 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
23968 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
23969 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
23970 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
23971
23972 @node TUI Overview
23973 @section TUI Overview
23974
23975 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
23976
23977 @table @emph
23978 @item command
23979 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
23980 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
23981 managed using readline.
23982
23983 @item source
23984 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
23985 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
23986
23987 @item assembly
23988 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
23989
23990 @item register
23991 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
23992 when their values change.
23993 @end table
23994
23995 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
23996 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
23997 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
23998 indicates the breakpoint type:
23999
24000 @table @code
24001 @item B
24002 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24003
24004 @item b
24005 Breakpoint which was never hit.
24006
24007 @item H
24008 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24009
24010 @item h
24011 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
24012 @end table
24013
24014 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
24015
24016 @table @code
24017 @item +
24018 Breakpoint is enabled.
24019
24020 @item -
24021 Breakpoint is disabled.
24022 @end table
24023
24024 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
24025 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
24026 changes.
24027
24028 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
24029 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
24030 layouts:
24031
24032 @itemize @bullet
24033 @item
24034 source only,
24035
24036 @item
24037 assembly only,
24038
24039 @item
24040 source and assembly,
24041
24042 @item
24043 source and registers, or
24044
24045 @item
24046 assembly and registers.
24047 @end itemize
24048
24049 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
24050
24051 @table @emph
24052 @item target
24053 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
24054 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
24055
24056 @item process
24057 Gives the current process or thread number.
24058 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
24059
24060 @item function
24061 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
24062 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
24063 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
24064 the string @code{??} is displayed.
24065
24066 @item line
24067 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
24068 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
24069
24070 @item pc
24071 Indicates the current program counter address.
24072 @end table
24073
24074 @node TUI Keys
24075 @section TUI Key Bindings
24076 @cindex TUI key bindings
24077
24078 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
24079 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24080 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
24081 @end ifset
24082 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24083 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
24084 @end ifclear
24085 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
24086 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
24087
24088 @table @kbd
24089 @kindex C-x C-a
24090 @item C-x C-a
24091 @kindex C-x a
24092 @itemx C-x a
24093 @kindex C-x A
24094 @itemx C-x A
24095 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
24096 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
24097 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
24098 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
24099 The screen is then refreshed.
24100
24101 @kindex C-x 1
24102 @item C-x 1
24103 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
24104 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
24105 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
24106
24107 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
24108
24109 @kindex C-x 2
24110 @item C-x 2
24111 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
24112 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
24113 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
24114 previous layout and the new one.
24115
24116 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
24117
24118 @kindex C-x o
24119 @item C-x o
24120 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
24121 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
24122 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
24123
24124 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
24125
24126 @kindex C-x s
24127 @item C-x s
24128 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
24129 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
24130 @end table
24131
24132 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
24133
24134 @table @asis
24135 @kindex PgUp
24136 @item @key{PgUp}
24137 Scroll the active window one page up.
24138
24139 @kindex PgDn
24140 @item @key{PgDn}
24141 Scroll the active window one page down.
24142
24143 @kindex Up
24144 @item @key{Up}
24145 Scroll the active window one line up.
24146
24147 @kindex Down
24148 @item @key{Down}
24149 Scroll the active window one line down.
24150
24151 @kindex Left
24152 @item @key{Left}
24153 Scroll the active window one column left.
24154
24155 @kindex Right
24156 @item @key{Right}
24157 Scroll the active window one column right.
24158
24159 @kindex C-L
24160 @item @kbd{C-L}
24161 Refresh the screen.
24162 @end table
24163
24164 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
24165 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
24166 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
24167 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
24168 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
24169
24170 @node TUI Single Key Mode
24171 @section TUI Single Key Mode
24172 @cindex TUI single key mode
24173
24174 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
24175 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
24176 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
24177
24178 @table @kbd
24179 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24180 @item c
24181 continue
24182
24183 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24184 @item d
24185 down
24186
24187 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24188 @item f
24189 finish
24190
24191 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24192 @item n
24193 next
24194
24195 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24196 @item q
24197 exit the SingleKey mode.
24198
24199 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24200 @item r
24201 run
24202
24203 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24204 @item s
24205 step
24206
24207 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24208 @item u
24209 up
24210
24211 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24212 @item v
24213 info locals
24214
24215 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24216 @item w
24217 where
24218 @end table
24219
24220 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
24221 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
24222 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
24223 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
24224 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
24225 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
24226
24227
24228 @node TUI Commands
24229 @section TUI-specific Commands
24230 @cindex TUI commands
24231
24232 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
24233 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
24234 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
24235 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
24236
24237 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
24238 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
24239 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
24240 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
24241 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
24242
24243 @table @code
24244 @item info win
24245 @kindex info win
24246 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
24247
24248 @item layout next
24249 @kindex layout
24250 Display the next layout.
24251
24252 @item layout prev
24253 Display the previous layout.
24254
24255 @item layout src
24256 Display the source window only.
24257
24258 @item layout asm
24259 Display the assembly window only.
24260
24261 @item layout split
24262 Display the source and assembly window.
24263
24264 @item layout regs
24265 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
24266
24267 @item focus next
24268 @kindex focus
24269 Make the next window active for scrolling.
24270
24271 @item focus prev
24272 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
24273
24274 @item focus src
24275 Make the source window active for scrolling.
24276
24277 @item focus asm
24278 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
24279
24280 @item focus regs
24281 Make the register window active for scrolling.
24282
24283 @item focus cmd
24284 Make the command window active for scrolling.
24285
24286 @item refresh
24287 @kindex refresh
24288 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
24289
24290 @item tui reg float
24291 @kindex tui reg
24292 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
24293
24294 @item tui reg general
24295 Show the general registers in the register window.
24296
24297 @item tui reg next
24298 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
24299 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
24300 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
24301 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
24302
24303 @item tui reg system
24304 Show the system registers in the register window.
24305
24306 @item update
24307 @kindex update
24308 Update the source window and the current execution point.
24309
24310 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
24311 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
24312 @kindex winheight
24313 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
24314 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
24315 decrease it.
24316
24317 @item tabset @var{nchars}
24318 @kindex tabset
24319 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
24320 @end table
24321
24322 @node TUI Configuration
24323 @section TUI Configuration Variables
24324 @cindex TUI configuration variables
24325
24326 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
24327
24328 @table @code
24329 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
24330 @kindex set tui border-kind
24331 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
24332 The possible values are the following:
24333 @table @code
24334 @item space
24335 Use a space character to draw the border.
24336
24337 @item ascii
24338 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
24339
24340 @item acs
24341 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
24342 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
24343 @end table
24344
24345 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
24346 @kindex set tui border-mode
24347 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
24348 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
24349 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
24350 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
24351 @table @code
24352 @item normal
24353 Use normal attributes to display the border.
24354
24355 @item standout
24356 Use standout mode.
24357
24358 @item reverse
24359 Use reverse video mode.
24360
24361 @item half
24362 Use half bright mode.
24363
24364 @item half-standout
24365 Use half bright and standout mode.
24366
24367 @item bold
24368 Use extra bright or bold mode.
24369
24370 @item bold-standout
24371 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
24372 @end table
24373 @end table
24374
24375 @node Emacs
24376 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
24377
24378 @cindex Emacs
24379 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
24380 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
24381 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
24382 @value{GDBN}.
24383
24384 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
24385 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
24386 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
24387 created Emacs buffer.
24388 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
24389
24390 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
24391 things:
24392
24393 @itemize @bullet
24394 @item
24395 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
24396 the GUD buffer.
24397
24398 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
24399 and output done by the program you are debugging.
24400
24401 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
24402 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
24403 in this way.
24404
24405 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
24406 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
24407 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
24408 stop.
24409
24410 @item
24411 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
24412
24413 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
24414 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
24415 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
24416 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
24417 and the source.
24418
24419 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
24420 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
24421 @end itemize
24422
24423 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
24424 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
24425 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
24426 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
24427
24428 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
24429 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
24430 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
24431 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
24432 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
24433 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
24434 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
24435 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
24436 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
24437
24438 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
24439 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
24440 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
24441 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
24442
24443 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
24444 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
24445 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
24446 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
24447 one you want.
24448
24449 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
24450 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
24451
24452 @table @kbd
24453 @item C-h m
24454 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
24455
24456 @item C-c C-s
24457 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
24458 update the display window to show the current file and location.
24459
24460 @item C-c C-n
24461 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
24462 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
24463 to show the current file and location.
24464
24465 @item C-c C-i
24466 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
24467 display window accordingly.
24468
24469 @item C-c C-f
24470 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
24471 @code{finish} command.
24472
24473 @item C-c C-r
24474 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
24475 command.
24476
24477 @item C-c <
24478 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
24479 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
24480 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
24481
24482 @item C-c >
24483 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
24484 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
24485 @end table
24486
24487 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
24488 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
24489
24490 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
24491 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
24492 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
24493 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
24494 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
24495 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
24496 speedbar displays watch expressions.
24497
24498 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
24499 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
24500 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
24501 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
24502 frame.
24503
24504 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
24505 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
24506 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
24507 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
24508 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
24509 to correspond properly with the code.
24510
24511 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
24512 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
24513 Emacs Manual}).
24514
24515 @node GDB/MI
24516 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
24517
24518 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
24519
24520 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
24521 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
24522 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
24523 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
24524 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
24525 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
24526
24527 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
24528 in the form of a reference manual.
24529
24530 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
24531 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
24532 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
24533
24534 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
24535
24536 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
24537 This chapter uses the following notation:
24538
24539 @itemize @bullet
24540 @item
24541 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
24542
24543 @item
24544 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
24545 it may or may not be given.
24546
24547 @item
24548 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
24549 may repeat zero or more times.
24550
24551 @item
24552 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
24553 may repeat one or more times.
24554
24555 @item
24556 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
24557 @end itemize
24558
24559 @ignore
24560 @heading Dependencies
24561 @end ignore
24562
24563 @menu
24564 * GDB/MI General Design::
24565 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
24566 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
24567 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
24568 * GDB/MI Output Records::
24569 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
24570 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
24571 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
24572 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
24573 * GDB/MI Program Context::
24574 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
24575 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
24576 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
24577 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
24578 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
24579 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
24580 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
24581 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
24582 * GDB/MI File Commands::
24583 @ignore
24584 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
24585 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
24586 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
24587 @end ignore
24588 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
24589 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
24590 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
24591 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
24592 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
24593 @end menu
24594
24595 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24596 @node GDB/MI General Design
24597 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
24598 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
24599
24600 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
24601 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
24602 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
24603 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
24604 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
24605 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
24606 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
24607 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
24608 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
24609 a command and reported as part of that command response.
24610
24611 The important examples of notifications are:
24612 @itemize @bullet
24613
24614 @item
24615 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
24616 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
24617 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
24618 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
24619 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
24620 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
24621 command itself was successfully executed.
24622
24623 @item
24624 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
24625 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
24626 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
24627 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
24628 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
24629 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
24630
24631 @item
24632 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
24633 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
24634 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
24635 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
24636 orthogonal frontend design.
24637
24638 @end itemize
24639
24640 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
24641 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
24642 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
24643 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
24644 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
24645 the user interface.
24646
24647
24648 @menu
24649 * Context management::
24650 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
24651 * Thread groups::
24652 @end menu
24653
24654 @node Context management
24655 @subsection Context management
24656
24657 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
24658
24659 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
24660 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
24661 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
24662 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
24663 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
24664 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
24665 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
24666 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
24667 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
24668
24669 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
24670 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
24671 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
24672 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
24673 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
24674 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
24675 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
24676 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
24677 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
24678 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
24679 for thread and frame to operate on.
24680
24681 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
24682 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
24683 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
24684 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
24685 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
24686 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
24687 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
24688 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
24689 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
24690 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
24691
24692 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
24693 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
24694 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
24695 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
24696 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
24697 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
24698 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
24699 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
24700 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
24701 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
24702 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
24703 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
24704 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
24705 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
24706 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
24707 @samp{--frame} options.
24708
24709 @subsubsection Language
24710
24711 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
24712 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
24713 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
24714 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
24715 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
24716 For instance:
24717
24718 @smallexample
24719 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
24720 ^done,value="4"
24721 (gdb)
24722 @end smallexample
24723
24724 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
24725 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
24726 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
24727
24728 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
24729 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
24730
24731 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
24732 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
24733 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
24734 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
24735 @code{-gdb-set target-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
24736 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
24737 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
24738 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
24739 @code{-list-target-features} command.
24740
24741 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
24742 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
24743 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
24744 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
24745 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
24746 are running.
24747
24748 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
24749 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
24750 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
24751 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
24752 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
24753 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
24754 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
24755 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
24756 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
24757 @samp{--thread} option).
24758
24759 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
24760 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
24761 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
24762 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
24763
24764 @node Thread groups
24765 @subsection Thread groups
24766 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
24767 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
24768 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
24769 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
24770 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
24771
24772 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
24773 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
24774 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
24775 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
24776 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
24777 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
24778 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
24779 into processes.
24780
24781 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
24782 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
24783 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
24784 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
24785 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
24786 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
24787 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
24788 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
24789 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
24790 the members of specific thread group.
24791
24792 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
24793 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
24794 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
24795 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
24796 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
24797 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
24798 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
24799 after attaching to that thread group.
24800
24801 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
24802 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
24803 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
24804 such thread groups.
24805
24806 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24807 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
24808 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
24809
24810 @menu
24811 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
24812 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
24813 @end menu
24814
24815 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
24816 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
24817
24818 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
24819 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
24820 @table @code
24821 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
24822 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
24823
24824 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
24825 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
24826 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
24827
24828 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
24829 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
24830 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
24831
24832 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
24833 "any sequence of digits"
24834
24835 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
24836 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
24837
24838 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
24839 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
24840
24841 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
24842 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
24843
24844 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
24845 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
24846 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
24847
24848 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
24849 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
24850
24851 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
24852 @code{CR | CR-LF}
24853 @end table
24854
24855 @noindent
24856 Notes:
24857
24858 @itemize @bullet
24859 @item
24860 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
24861 output is described below.
24862
24863 @item
24864 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
24865 finishes.
24866
24867 @item
24868 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
24869 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
24870 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
24871 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
24872 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
24873 @end itemize
24874
24875 Pragmatics:
24876
24877 @itemize @bullet
24878 @item
24879 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
24880
24881 @item
24882 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
24883 @end itemize
24884
24885 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
24886 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
24887
24888 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
24889 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
24890 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
24891 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
24892 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
24893 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
24894
24895 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
24896 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
24897 @var{token}.
24898
24899 @table @code
24900 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
24901 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
24902
24903 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
24904 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
24905
24906 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
24907 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
24908
24909 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
24910 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
24911
24912 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
24913 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
24914
24915 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
24916 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
24917
24918 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
24919 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
24920
24921 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
24922 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
24923
24924 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
24925 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
24926
24927 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
24928 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
24929 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
24930
24931 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
24932 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
24933
24934 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
24935 @code{ @var{string} }
24936
24937 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
24938 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
24939
24940 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
24941 @code{@var{c-string}}
24942
24943 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
24944 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
24945
24946 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
24947 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
24948 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
24949
24950 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
24951 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
24952
24953 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
24954 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
24955
24956 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
24957 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
24958
24959 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
24960 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
24961
24962 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
24963 @code{CR | CR-LF}
24964
24965 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
24966 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
24967 @end table
24968
24969 @noindent
24970 Notes:
24971
24972 @itemize @bullet
24973 @item
24974 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
24975
24976 @item
24977 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
24978 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
24979 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
24980 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
24981 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
24982 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
24983 prior command.
24984
24985 @item
24986 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24987 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
24988 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
24989 prefixed by @samp{+}.
24990
24991 @item
24992 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24993 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
24994 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
24995 @samp{*}.
24996
24997 @item
24998 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24999 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
25000 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
25001 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
25002
25003 @item
25004 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25005 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
25006 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
25007 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
25008
25009 @item
25010 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25011 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
25012 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
25013
25014 @item
25015 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25016 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
25017 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
25018 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
25019
25020 @item
25021 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25022 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
25023 @var{values}.
25024
25025
25026 @end itemize
25027
25028 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
25029 details about the various output records.
25030
25031 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25032 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
25033 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
25034
25035 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
25036 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
25037
25038 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
25039 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
25040 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
25041 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
25042 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
25043 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
25044
25045 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
25046 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
25047 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
25048
25049 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25050 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
25051 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
25052 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
25053
25054 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
25055 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
25056
25057 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
25058 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
25059 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
25060 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
25061 might change.
25062
25063 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
25064 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
25065 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
25066 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
25067
25068 @itemize @bullet
25069 @item
25070 New MI commands may be added.
25071
25072 @item
25073 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
25074
25075 @item
25076 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
25077 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
25078
25079 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
25080 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
25081
25082 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
25083 @c resolve inconsistencies.
25084 @end itemize
25085
25086 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
25087 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
25088 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
25089 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
25090 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
25091
25092 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
25093 @c version?
25094
25095 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
25096 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
25097 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
25098 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
25099 @cindex mailing lists
25100
25101 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25102 @node GDB/MI Output Records
25103 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
25104
25105 @menu
25106 * GDB/MI Result Records::
25107 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
25108 * GDB/MI Async Records::
25109 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
25110 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
25111 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
25112 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
25113 @end menu
25114
25115 @node GDB/MI Result Records
25116 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
25117
25118 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25119 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
25120 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
25121 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
25122
25123 @table @code
25124 @findex ^done
25125 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
25126 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
25127 values.
25128
25129 @item "^running"
25130 @findex ^running
25131 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
25132 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
25133 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
25134 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
25135 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
25136 which threads are resumed.
25137
25138 @item "^connected"
25139 @findex ^connected
25140 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
25141
25142 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
25143 @findex ^error
25144 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
25145 the corresponding error message.
25146
25147 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
25148 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
25149 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
25150
25151 @table @samp
25152 @item "undefined-command"
25153 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
25154 @end table
25155
25156 @item "^exit"
25157 @findex ^exit
25158 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
25159
25160 @end table
25161
25162 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
25163 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
25164
25165 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
25166 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25167 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
25168 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
25169 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
25170
25171 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
25172 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
25173 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
25174 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
25175 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
25176
25177 @table @code
25178 @item "~" @var{string-output}
25179 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
25180 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
25181
25182 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
25183 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
25184 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
25185 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
25186
25187 @item "&" @var{string-output}
25188 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
25189 internals.
25190 @end table
25191
25192 @node GDB/MI Async Records
25193 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
25194
25195 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25196 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
25197 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
25198 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
25199 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
25200 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
25201
25202 The following is the list of possible async records:
25203
25204 @table @code
25205
25206 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
25207 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
25208 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
25209 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
25210 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
25211 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
25212 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
25213 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
25214 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
25215 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
25216
25217 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
25218 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
25219 following values:
25220
25221 @table @code
25222 @item breakpoint-hit
25223 A breakpoint was reached.
25224 @item watchpoint-trigger
25225 A watchpoint was triggered.
25226 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
25227 A read watchpoint was triggered.
25228 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
25229 An access watchpoint was triggered.
25230 @item function-finished
25231 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
25232 @item location-reached
25233 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
25234 @item watchpoint-scope
25235 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
25236 @item end-stepping-range
25237 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
25238 similar CLI command was accomplished.
25239 @item exited-signalled
25240 The inferior exited because of a signal.
25241 @item exited
25242 The inferior exited.
25243 @item exited-normally
25244 The inferior exited normally.
25245 @item signal-received
25246 A signal was received by the inferior.
25247 @item solib-event
25248 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
25249 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
25250 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
25251 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
25252 @item fork
25253 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
25254 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25255 @item vfork
25256 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
25257 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25258 @item syscall-entry
25259 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
25260 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25261 @item syscall-entry
25262 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
25263 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25264 @item exec
25265 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
25266 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25267 @end table
25268
25269 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
25270 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
25271 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
25272 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
25273 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
25274 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
25275 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
25276 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
25277 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
25278 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
25279 if such information is not available.
25280
25281 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
25282 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
25283 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
25284 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
25285 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
25286 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
25287 cannot be used in any way.
25288
25289 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
25290 A thread group became associated with a running program,
25291 either because the program was just started or the thread group
25292 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
25293 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
25294 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
25295
25296 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
25297 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
25298 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
25299 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
25300 thread group. @var{code} is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
25301 only when the inferior exited with some code.
25302
25303 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
25304 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
25305 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
25306 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
25307 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
25308
25309 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
25310 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
25311 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
25312 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
25313 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
25314 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
25315 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
25316
25317 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
25318 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
25319 that thread.
25320
25321 @item =library-loaded,...
25322 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
25323 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
25324 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
25325 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
25326 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
25327 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
25328 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
25329 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
25330 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
25331 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
25332 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
25333 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
25334 thread groups.
25335
25336 @item =library-unloaded,...
25337 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
25338 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
25339 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
25340 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
25341 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
25342 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
25343 thread groups.
25344
25345 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
25346 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
25347 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
25348 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
25349 frame is @var{tpnum}.
25350
25351 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
25352 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
25353 initial value @var{initial}.
25354
25355 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
25356 @itemx =tsv-deleted
25357 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
25358 trace state variables are deleted.
25359
25360 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
25361 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
25362 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
25363 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
25364 value of trace state variable is known.
25365
25366 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
25367 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
25368 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
25369 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
25370 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
25371 user.
25372
25373 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
25374 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
25375 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
25376
25377 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
25378 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
25379
25380 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}"
25381 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
25382 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
25383 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
25384 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
25385
25386 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
25387 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
25388 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
25389 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
25390 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
25391 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
25392
25393 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
25394 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
25395 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
25396 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
25397 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
25398 executable code.
25399 @end table
25400
25401 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
25402 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
25403
25404 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
25405 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
25406 following fields:
25407
25408 @table @code
25409 @item number
25410 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
25411 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
25412 @samp{1.2}.
25413
25414 @item type
25415 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
25416 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
25417
25418 @item catch-type
25419 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
25420 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
25421
25422 @item disp
25423 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
25424 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
25425 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
25426
25427 @item enabled
25428 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
25429 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
25430 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
25431
25432 @item addr
25433 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
25434 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
25435 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
25436 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
25437 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
25438
25439 @item func
25440 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
25441 If not known, this field is not present.
25442
25443 @item filename
25444 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
25445 If not known, this field is not present.
25446
25447 @item fullname
25448 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
25449 known. If not known, this field is not present.
25450
25451 @item line
25452 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
25453 If not known, this field is not present.
25454
25455 @item at
25456 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
25457 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
25458 by a symbol name.
25459
25460 @item pending
25461 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
25462 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
25463
25464 @item evaluated-by
25465 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
25466 @samp{target}.
25467
25468 @item thread
25469 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
25470 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
25471
25472 @item task
25473 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
25474 field will hold the task identifier.
25475
25476 @item cond
25477 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
25478
25479 @item ignore
25480 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
25481
25482 @item enable
25483 The enable count of the breakpoint.
25484
25485 @item traceframe-usage
25486 FIXME.
25487
25488 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
25489 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
25490
25491 @item mask
25492 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
25493
25494 @item pass
25495 A tracepoint's pass count.
25496
25497 @item original-location
25498 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
25499 This field is optional.
25500
25501 @item times
25502 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
25503
25504 @item installed
25505 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
25506 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
25507 is not.
25508
25509 @item what
25510 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
25511
25512 @end table
25513
25514 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
25515 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
25516
25517 @smallexample
25518 -> -break-insert main
25519 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25520 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
25521 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
25522 times="0"@}
25523 <- (gdb)
25524 @end smallexample
25525
25526 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
25527 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
25528
25529 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
25530 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
25531 fields:
25532
25533 @table @code
25534 @item level
25535 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
25536 zero. This field is always present.
25537
25538 @item func
25539 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
25540 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
25541
25542 @item addr
25543 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
25544
25545 @item file
25546 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
25547 address. This field may be absent.
25548
25549 @item line
25550 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
25551 may be absent.
25552
25553 @item from
25554 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
25555 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
25556
25557 @end table
25558
25559 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
25560 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
25561
25562 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
25563 uses a tuple with the following fields:
25564
25565 @table @code
25566 @item id
25567 The numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
25568 always present.
25569
25570 @item target-id
25571 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
25572
25573 @item details
25574 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
25575 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
25576 frontend. This field is optional.
25577
25578 @item state
25579 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
25580 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
25581
25582 @item core
25583 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
25584 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
25585 @end table
25586
25587 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
25588 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
25589
25590 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
25591 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
25592 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
25593 the @code{exception-name} field.
25594
25595 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25596 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
25597 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
25598 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
25599
25600 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
25601 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
25602 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
25603 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
25604
25605 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
25606 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
25607
25608 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
25609
25610 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
25611 information of the breakpoint.
25612
25613 @smallexample
25614 -> -break-insert main
25615 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25616 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
25617 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
25618 times="0"@}
25619 <- (gdb)
25620 @end smallexample
25621
25622 @subheading Program Execution
25623
25624 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
25625 reason that execution stopped.
25626
25627 @smallexample
25628 -> -exec-run
25629 <- ^running
25630 <- (gdb)
25631 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
25632 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
25633 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
25634 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
25635 <- (gdb)
25636 -> -exec-continue
25637 <- ^running
25638 <- (gdb)
25639 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
25640 <- (gdb)
25641 @end smallexample
25642
25643 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
25644
25645 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
25646
25647 @smallexample
25648 -> (gdb)
25649 <- -gdb-exit
25650 <- ^exit
25651 @end smallexample
25652
25653 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
25654 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
25655 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
25656 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
25657 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
25658 fails to exit in reasonable time.
25659
25660 @subheading A Bad Command
25661
25662 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
25663
25664 @smallexample
25665 -> -rubbish
25666 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
25667 <- (gdb)
25668 @end smallexample
25669
25670
25671 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25672 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
25673 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
25674
25675 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
25676 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
25677
25678 @subheading Motivation
25679
25680 The motivation for this collection of commands.
25681
25682 @subheading Introduction
25683
25684 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
25685
25686 @subheading Commands
25687
25688 For each command in the block, the following is described:
25689
25690 @subsubheading Synopsis
25691
25692 @smallexample
25693 -command @var{args}@dots{}
25694 @end smallexample
25695
25696 @subsubheading Result
25697
25698 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25699
25700 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
25701
25702 @subsubheading Example
25703
25704 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
25705 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
25706
25707
25708 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25709 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
25710 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
25711
25712 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
25713 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
25714 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
25715 breakpoints.
25716
25717 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
25718 @findex -break-after
25719
25720 @subsubheading Synopsis
25721
25722 @smallexample
25723 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
25724 @end smallexample
25725
25726 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
25727 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
25728 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
25729 @samp{-break-list} command below.
25730
25731 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25732
25733 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
25734
25735 @subsubheading Example
25736
25737 @smallexample
25738 (gdb)
25739 -break-insert main
25740 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25741 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
25742 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
25743 times="0"@}
25744 (gdb)
25745 -break-after 1 3
25746 ~
25747 ^done
25748 (gdb)
25749 -break-list
25750 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25751 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25752 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25753 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25754 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25755 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25756 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25757 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25758 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25759 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
25760 (gdb)
25761 @end smallexample
25762
25763 @ignore
25764 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
25765 @findex -break-catch
25766 @end ignore
25767
25768 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
25769 @findex -break-commands
25770
25771 @subsubheading Synopsis
25772
25773 @smallexample
25774 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
25775 @end smallexample
25776
25777 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
25778 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
25779 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
25780 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
25781 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
25782 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
25783
25784 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25785
25786 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
25787
25788 @subsubheading Example
25789
25790 @smallexample
25791 (gdb)
25792 -break-insert main
25793 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25794 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
25795 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
25796 times="0"@}
25797 (gdb)
25798 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
25799 ^done
25800 (gdb)
25801 @end smallexample
25802
25803 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
25804 @findex -break-condition
25805
25806 @subsubheading Synopsis
25807
25808 @smallexample
25809 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
25810 @end smallexample
25811
25812 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
25813 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
25814 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
25815 command below).
25816
25817 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25818
25819 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
25820
25821 @subsubheading Example
25822
25823 @smallexample
25824 (gdb)
25825 -break-condition 1 1
25826 ^done
25827 (gdb)
25828 -break-list
25829 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25830 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25831 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25832 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25833 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25834 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25835 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25836 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25837 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25838 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
25839 (gdb)
25840 @end smallexample
25841
25842 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
25843 @findex -break-delete
25844
25845 @subsubheading Synopsis
25846
25847 @smallexample
25848 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
25849 @end smallexample
25850
25851 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
25852 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
25853
25854 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25855
25856 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
25857
25858 @subsubheading Example
25859
25860 @smallexample
25861 (gdb)
25862 -break-delete 1
25863 ^done
25864 (gdb)
25865 -break-list
25866 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
25867 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25868 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25869 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25870 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25871 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25872 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25873 body=[]@}
25874 (gdb)
25875 @end smallexample
25876
25877 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
25878 @findex -break-disable
25879
25880 @subsubheading Synopsis
25881
25882 @smallexample
25883 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
25884 @end smallexample
25885
25886 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
25887 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
25888
25889 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25890
25891 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
25892
25893 @subsubheading Example
25894
25895 @smallexample
25896 (gdb)
25897 -break-disable 2
25898 ^done
25899 (gdb)
25900 -break-list
25901 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25902 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25903 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25904 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25905 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25906 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25907 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25908 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
25909 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25910 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
25911 (gdb)
25912 @end smallexample
25913
25914 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
25915 @findex -break-enable
25916
25917 @subsubheading Synopsis
25918
25919 @smallexample
25920 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
25921 @end smallexample
25922
25923 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
25924
25925 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25926
25927 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
25928
25929 @subsubheading Example
25930
25931 @smallexample
25932 (gdb)
25933 -break-enable 2
25934 ^done
25935 (gdb)
25936 -break-list
25937 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25938 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25939 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25940 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25941 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25942 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25943 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25944 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25945 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25946 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
25947 (gdb)
25948 @end smallexample
25949
25950 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
25951 @findex -break-info
25952
25953 @subsubheading Synopsis
25954
25955 @smallexample
25956 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
25957 @end smallexample
25958
25959 @c REDUNDANT???
25960 Get information about a single breakpoint.
25961
25962 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
25963 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
25964 table.
25965
25966 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25967
25968 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
25969
25970 @subsubheading Example
25971 N.A.
25972
25973 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
25974 @findex -break-insert
25975
25976 @subsubheading Synopsis
25977
25978 @smallexample
25979 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
25980 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
25981 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
25982 @end smallexample
25983
25984 @noindent
25985 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
25986
25987 @itemize @bullet
25988 @item function
25989 @c @item +offset
25990 @c @item -offset
25991 @c @item linenum
25992 @item filename:linenum
25993 @item filename:function
25994 @item *address
25995 @end itemize
25996
25997 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
25998
25999 @table @samp
26000 @item -t
26001 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26002 @item -h
26003 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
26004 @item -f
26005 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
26006 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26007 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26008 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26009 cannot be parsed.
26010 @item -d
26011 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26012 @item -a
26013 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
26014 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
26015 @item -c @var{condition}
26016 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26017 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26018 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
26019 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26020 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
26021 @end table
26022
26023 @subsubheading Result
26024
26025 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26026 resulting breakpoint.
26027
26028 Note: this format is open to change.
26029 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26030
26031 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26032
26033 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
26034 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
26035
26036 @subsubheading Example
26037
26038 @smallexample
26039 (gdb)
26040 -break-insert main
26041 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
26042 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26043 times="0"@}
26044 (gdb)
26045 -break-insert -t foo
26046 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
26047 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26048 times="0"@}
26049 (gdb)
26050 -break-list
26051 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26052 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26053 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26054 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26055 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26056 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26057 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26058 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26059 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
26060 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26061 times="0"@},
26062 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
26063 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
26064 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26065 times="0"@}]@}
26066 (gdb)
26067 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
26068 @c ~int foo(int, int);
26069 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
26070 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26071 @c times="0"@}
26072 @c (gdb)
26073 @end smallexample
26074
26075 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
26076 @findex -dprintf-insert
26077
26078 @subsubheading Synopsis
26079
26080 @smallexample
26081 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
26082 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
26083 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
26084 [ @var{argument} ]
26085 @end smallexample
26086
26087 @noindent
26088 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
26089
26090 @itemize @bullet
26091 @item @var{function}
26092 @c @item +offset
26093 @c @item -offset
26094 @c @item @var{linenum}
26095 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
26096 @item @var{filename}:function
26097 @item *@var{address}
26098 @end itemize
26099
26100 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26101
26102 @table @samp
26103 @item -t
26104 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26105 @item -f
26106 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
26107 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26108 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26109 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26110 cannot be parsed.
26111 @item -d
26112 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26113 @item -c @var{condition}
26114 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26115 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26116 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
26117 to @var{ignore-count}.
26118 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26119 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
26120 @end table
26121
26122 @subsubheading Result
26123
26124 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26125 resulting breakpoint.
26126
26127 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26128
26129 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26130
26131 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
26132
26133 @subsubheading Example
26134
26135 @smallexample
26136 (gdb)
26137 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
26138 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26139 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
26140 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
26141 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
26142 original-location="foo"@}
26143 (gdb)
26144 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
26145 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26146 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
26147 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
26148 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
26149 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
26150 (gdb)
26151 @end smallexample
26152
26153 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
26154 @findex -break-list
26155
26156 @subsubheading Synopsis
26157
26158 @smallexample
26159 -break-list
26160 @end smallexample
26161
26162 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
26163
26164 @table @samp
26165 @item Number
26166 number of the breakpoint
26167 @item Type
26168 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
26169 @item Disposition
26170 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
26171 or @samp{nokeep}
26172 @item Enabled
26173 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
26174 @item Address
26175 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
26176 @item What
26177 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
26178 name, line number
26179 @item Thread-groups
26180 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
26181 @item Times
26182 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
26183 @end table
26184
26185 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
26186 @code{body} field is an empty list.
26187
26188 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26189
26190 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
26191
26192 @subsubheading Example
26193
26194 @smallexample
26195 (gdb)
26196 -break-list
26197 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26198 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26199 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26200 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26201 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26202 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26203 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26204 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26205 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26206 times="0"@},
26207 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26208 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26209 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26210 (gdb)
26211 @end smallexample
26212
26213 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
26214
26215 @smallexample
26216 (gdb)
26217 -break-list
26218 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
26219 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26220 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26221 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26222 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26223 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26224 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26225 body=[]@}
26226 (gdb)
26227 @end smallexample
26228
26229 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
26230 @findex -break-passcount
26231
26232 @subsubheading Synopsis
26233
26234 @smallexample
26235 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
26236 @end smallexample
26237
26238 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
26239 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
26240 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
26241 command @samp{passcount}.
26242
26243 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
26244 @findex -break-watch
26245
26246 @subsubheading Synopsis
26247
26248 @smallexample
26249 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
26250 @end smallexample
26251
26252 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
26253 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
26254 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
26255 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
26256 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
26257 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
26258 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
26259 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
26260
26261 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
26262 breakpoints inserted.
26263
26264 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26265
26266 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
26267 @samp{rwatch}.
26268
26269 @subsubheading Example
26270
26271 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
26272
26273 @smallexample
26274 (gdb)
26275 -break-watch x
26276 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
26277 (gdb)
26278 -exec-continue
26279 ^running
26280 (gdb)
26281 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
26282 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
26283 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
26284 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
26285 (gdb)
26286 @end smallexample
26287
26288 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
26289 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
26290 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
26291
26292 @smallexample
26293 (gdb)
26294 -break-watch C
26295 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
26296 (gdb)
26297 -exec-continue
26298 ^running
26299 (gdb)
26300 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
26301 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
26302 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
26303 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26304 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
26305 (gdb)
26306 -exec-continue
26307 ^running
26308 (gdb)
26309 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
26310 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
26311 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
26312 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26313 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
26314 (gdb)
26315 @end smallexample
26316
26317 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
26318 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
26319 deleted.
26320
26321 @smallexample
26322 (gdb)
26323 -break-watch C
26324 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
26325 (gdb)
26326 -break-list
26327 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26328 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26329 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26330 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26331 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26332 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26333 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26334 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26335 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26336 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26337 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
26338 times="1"@},
26339 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
26340 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26341 (gdb)
26342 -exec-continue
26343 ^running
26344 (gdb)
26345 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
26346 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
26347 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
26348 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26349 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
26350 (gdb)
26351 -break-list
26352 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26353 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26354 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26355 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26356 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26357 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26358 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26359 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26360 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26361 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26362 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
26363 times="1"@},
26364 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
26365 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
26366 (gdb)
26367 -exec-continue
26368 ^running
26369 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
26370 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
26371 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
26372 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26373 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
26374 (gdb)
26375 -break-list
26376 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26377 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26378 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26379 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26380 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26381 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26382 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26383 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26384 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26385 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26386 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
26387 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
26388 (gdb)
26389 @end smallexample
26390
26391
26392 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26393 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
26394 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
26395
26396 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
26397 catchpoints.
26398
26399 @menu
26400 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
26401 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
26402 @end menu
26403
26404 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
26405 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
26406
26407 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
26408 @findex -catch-load
26409
26410 @subsubheading Synopsis
26411
26412 @smallexample
26413 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
26414 @end smallexample
26415
26416 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
26417 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
26418 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
26419 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
26420 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
26421
26422
26423 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26424
26425 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
26426
26427 @subsubheading Example
26428
26429 @smallexample
26430 -catch-load -t foo.so
26431 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
26432 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
26433 (gdb)
26434 @end smallexample
26435
26436
26437 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
26438 @findex -catch-unload
26439
26440 @subsubheading Synopsis
26441
26442 @smallexample
26443 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
26444 @end smallexample
26445
26446 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
26447 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
26448 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
26449 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
26450 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
26451
26452 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26453
26454 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
26455
26456 @subsubheading Example
26457
26458 @smallexample
26459 -catch-unload -d bar.so
26460 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
26461 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
26462 (gdb)
26463 @end smallexample
26464
26465 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
26466 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
26467
26468 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
26469 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
26470
26471 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
26472 @findex -catch-assert
26473
26474 @subsubheading Synopsis
26475
26476 @smallexample
26477 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
26478 @end smallexample
26479
26480 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
26481
26482 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
26483
26484 @table @samp
26485 @item -c @var{condition}
26486 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26487 @item -d
26488 Create a disabled catchpoint.
26489 @item -t
26490 Create a temporary catchpoint.
26491 @end table
26492
26493 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26494
26495 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
26496
26497 @subsubheading Example
26498
26499 @smallexample
26500 -catch-assert
26501 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26502 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
26503 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
26504 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
26505 (gdb)
26506 @end smallexample
26507
26508 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
26509 @findex -catch-exception
26510
26511 @subsubheading Synopsis
26512
26513 @smallexample
26514 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
26515 [ -t ] [ -u ]
26516 @end smallexample
26517
26518 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
26519 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
26520 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
26521 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
26522 catchpoints.
26523
26524 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
26525
26526 @table @samp
26527 @item -c @var{condition}
26528 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26529 @item -d
26530 Create a disabled catchpoint.
26531 @item -e @var{exception-name}
26532 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
26533 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
26534 @item -t
26535 Create a temporary catchpoint.
26536 @item -u
26537 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
26538 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
26539 @end table
26540
26541 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26542
26543 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
26544 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
26545
26546 @subsubheading Example
26547
26548 @smallexample
26549 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
26550 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26551 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
26552 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
26553 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
26554 (gdb)
26555 @end smallexample
26556
26557 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26558 @node GDB/MI Program Context
26559 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
26560
26561 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
26562 @findex -exec-arguments
26563
26564
26565 @subsubheading Synopsis
26566
26567 @smallexample
26568 -exec-arguments @var{args}
26569 @end smallexample
26570
26571 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
26572 @samp{-exec-run}.
26573
26574 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26575
26576 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
26577
26578 @subsubheading Example
26579
26580 @smallexample
26581 (gdb)
26582 -exec-arguments -v word
26583 ^done
26584 (gdb)
26585 @end smallexample
26586
26587
26588 @ignore
26589 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
26590 @findex -exec-show-arguments
26591
26592 @subsubheading Synopsis
26593
26594 @smallexample
26595 -exec-show-arguments
26596 @end smallexample
26597
26598 Print the arguments of the program.
26599
26600 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26601
26602 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
26603
26604 @subsubheading Example
26605 N.A.
26606 @end ignore
26607
26608
26609 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
26610 @findex -environment-cd
26611
26612 @subsubheading Synopsis
26613
26614 @smallexample
26615 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
26616 @end smallexample
26617
26618 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
26619
26620 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26621
26622 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
26623
26624 @subsubheading Example
26625
26626 @smallexample
26627 (gdb)
26628 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
26629 ^done
26630 (gdb)
26631 @end smallexample
26632
26633
26634 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
26635 @findex -environment-directory
26636
26637 @subsubheading Synopsis
26638
26639 @smallexample
26640 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
26641 @end smallexample
26642
26643 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
26644 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
26645 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
26646 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
26647 occurs as normal.
26648 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
26649 multiple directories in a single command
26650 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
26651 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
26652 If blanks are needed as
26653 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
26654 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
26655 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
26656 character must not be used
26657 in any directory name.
26658 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
26659
26660 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26661
26662 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
26663
26664 @subsubheading Example
26665
26666 @smallexample
26667 (gdb)
26668 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
26669 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
26670 (gdb)
26671 -environment-directory ""
26672 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
26673 (gdb)
26674 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
26675 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
26676 (gdb)
26677 -environment-directory -r
26678 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
26679 (gdb)
26680 @end smallexample
26681
26682
26683 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
26684 @findex -environment-path
26685
26686 @subsubheading Synopsis
26687
26688 @smallexample
26689 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
26690 @end smallexample
26691
26692 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
26693 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
26694 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
26695 supplied in addition to the
26696 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
26697 occurs as normal.
26698 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
26699 multiple directories in a single command
26700 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
26701 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
26702 If blanks are needed as
26703 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
26704 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
26705 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
26706 character must not be used
26707 in any directory name.
26708 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
26709
26710
26711 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26712
26713 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
26714
26715 @subsubheading Example
26716
26717 @smallexample
26718 (gdb)
26719 -environment-path
26720 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
26721 (gdb)
26722 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
26723 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
26724 (gdb)
26725 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
26726 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
26727 (gdb)
26728 @end smallexample
26729
26730
26731 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
26732 @findex -environment-pwd
26733
26734 @subsubheading Synopsis
26735
26736 @smallexample
26737 -environment-pwd
26738 @end smallexample
26739
26740 Show the current working directory.
26741
26742 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26743
26744 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
26745
26746 @subsubheading Example
26747
26748 @smallexample
26749 (gdb)
26750 -environment-pwd
26751 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
26752 (gdb)
26753 @end smallexample
26754
26755 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26756 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
26757 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
26758
26759
26760 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
26761 @findex -thread-info
26762
26763 @subsubheading Synopsis
26764
26765 @smallexample
26766 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
26767 @end smallexample
26768
26769 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
26770 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
26771 threads. When printing information about all threads,
26772 also reports the current thread.
26773
26774 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26775
26776 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
26777 about all threads.
26778
26779 @subsubheading Result
26780
26781 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
26782 defined for a given thread:
26783
26784 @table @samp
26785 @item current
26786 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
26787
26788 @item id
26789 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
26790
26791 @item target-id
26792 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
26793
26794 @item details
26795 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
26796 field is optional.
26797
26798 @item name
26799 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
26800 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
26801 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
26802 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
26803 field is omitted.
26804
26805 @item frame
26806 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
26807
26808 @item state
26809 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
26810 values:
26811
26812 @table @code
26813 @item stopped
26814 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
26815 threads.
26816
26817 @item running
26818 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
26819 threads.
26820
26821 @end table
26822
26823 @item core
26824 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
26825 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
26826
26827 @end table
26828
26829 @subsubheading Example
26830
26831 @smallexample
26832 -thread-info
26833 ^done,threads=[
26834 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
26835 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
26836 args=[]@},state="running"@},
26837 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
26838 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
26839 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
26840 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
26841 state="running"@}],
26842 current-thread-id="1"
26843 (gdb)
26844 @end smallexample
26845
26846 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
26847 @findex -thread-list-ids
26848
26849 @subsubheading Synopsis
26850
26851 @smallexample
26852 -thread-list-ids
26853 @end smallexample
26854
26855 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
26856 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
26857
26858 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
26859 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
26860
26861 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26862
26863 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
26864
26865 @subsubheading Example
26866
26867 @smallexample
26868 (gdb)
26869 -thread-list-ids
26870 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
26871 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
26872 (gdb)
26873 @end smallexample
26874
26875
26876 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
26877 @findex -thread-select
26878
26879 @subsubheading Synopsis
26880
26881 @smallexample
26882 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
26883 @end smallexample
26884
26885 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
26886 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
26887
26888 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
26889 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
26890
26891 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26892
26893 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
26894
26895 @subsubheading Example
26896
26897 @smallexample
26898 (gdb)
26899 -exec-next
26900 ^running
26901 (gdb)
26902 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
26903 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
26904 (gdb)
26905 -thread-list-ids
26906 ^done,
26907 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
26908 number-of-threads="3"
26909 (gdb)
26910 -thread-select 3
26911 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
26912 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
26913 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
26914 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
26915 (gdb)
26916 @end smallexample
26917
26918 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26919 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
26920 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
26921
26922 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
26923 @findex -ada-task-info
26924
26925 @subsubheading Synopsis
26926
26927 @smallexample
26928 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
26929 @end smallexample
26930
26931 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
26932 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
26933
26934 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26935
26936 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
26937 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
26938
26939 @subsubheading Result
26940
26941 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
26942 defined for each Ada task:
26943
26944 @table @samp
26945 @item current
26946 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
26947
26948 @item id
26949 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
26950
26951 @item task-id
26952 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
26953
26954 @item thread-id
26955 The identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada task.
26956
26957 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
26958 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
26959 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
26960
26961 @item parent-id
26962 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
26963 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
26964
26965 @item priority
26966 The base priority of the task.
26967
26968 @item state
26969 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
26970 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
26971
26972 @item name
26973 The name of the task.
26974
26975 @end table
26976
26977 @subsubheading Example
26978
26979 @smallexample
26980 -ada-task-info
26981 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
26982 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
26983 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
26984 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
26985 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
26986 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
26987 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
26988 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
26989 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
26990 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
26991 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
26992 (gdb)
26993 @end smallexample
26994
26995 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26996 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
26997 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
26998
26999 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
27000 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
27001 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
27002 other cases.
27003
27004 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
27005 @findex -exec-continue
27006
27007 @subsubheading Synopsis
27008
27009 @smallexample
27010 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
27011 @end smallexample
27012
27013 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
27014 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
27015 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
27016 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
27017 @itemize @bullet
27018 @item
27019 breakpoints or watchpoints
27020 @item
27021 signals or exceptions
27022 @item
27023 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
27024 @item
27025 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
27026 @end itemize
27027 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
27028 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
27029 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
27030 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
27031 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
27032 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
27033
27034 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27035
27036 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
27037
27038 @subsubheading Example
27039
27040 @smallexample
27041 -exec-continue
27042 ^running
27043 (gdb)
27044 @@Hello world
27045 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
27046 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
27047 line="13"@}
27048 (gdb)
27049 @end smallexample
27050
27051
27052 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
27053 @findex -exec-finish
27054
27055 @subsubheading Synopsis
27056
27057 @smallexample
27058 -exec-finish [--reverse]
27059 @end smallexample
27060
27061 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
27062 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
27063 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
27064 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
27065 function was called.
27066
27067 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27068
27069 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
27070
27071 @subsubheading Example
27072
27073 Function returning @code{void}.
27074
27075 @smallexample
27076 -exec-finish
27077 ^running
27078 (gdb)
27079 @@hello from foo
27080 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
27081 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
27082 (gdb)
27083 @end smallexample
27084
27085 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
27086 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
27087 value itself.
27088
27089 @smallexample
27090 -exec-finish
27091 ^running
27092 (gdb)
27093 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
27094 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
27095 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27096 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
27097 (gdb)
27098 @end smallexample
27099
27100
27101 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
27102 @findex -exec-interrupt
27103
27104 @subsubheading Synopsis
27105
27106 @smallexample
27107 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
27108 @end smallexample
27109
27110 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
27111 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
27112 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
27113 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
27114 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
27115
27116 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
27117 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
27118 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
27119 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
27120
27121 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
27122 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
27123 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
27124 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
27125
27126 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27127
27128 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
27129
27130 @subsubheading Example
27131
27132 @smallexample
27133 (gdb)
27134 111-exec-continue
27135 111^running
27136
27137 (gdb)
27138 222-exec-interrupt
27139 222^done
27140 (gdb)
27141 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
27142 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27143 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
27144 (gdb)
27145
27146 (gdb)
27147 -exec-interrupt
27148 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
27149 (gdb)
27150 @end smallexample
27151
27152 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
27153 @findex -exec-jump
27154
27155 @subsubheading Synopsis
27156
27157 @smallexample
27158 -exec-jump @var{location}
27159 @end smallexample
27160
27161 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
27162 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
27163 different forms of @var{location}.
27164
27165 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27166
27167 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
27168
27169 @subsubheading Example
27170
27171 @smallexample
27172 -exec-jump foo.c:10
27173 *running,thread-id="all"
27174 ^running
27175 @end smallexample
27176
27177
27178 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
27179 @findex -exec-next
27180
27181 @subsubheading Synopsis
27182
27183 @smallexample
27184 -exec-next [--reverse]
27185 @end smallexample
27186
27187 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
27188 of the next source line is reached.
27189
27190 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
27191 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
27192 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
27193 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
27194 source line where the function was called.
27195
27196
27197 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27198
27199 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
27200
27201 @subsubheading Example
27202
27203 @smallexample
27204 -exec-next
27205 ^running
27206 (gdb)
27207 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
27208 (gdb)
27209 @end smallexample
27210
27211
27212 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
27213 @findex -exec-next-instruction
27214
27215 @subsubheading Synopsis
27216
27217 @smallexample
27218 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
27219 @end smallexample
27220
27221 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
27222 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
27223 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
27224 printed as well.
27225
27226 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
27227 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
27228 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
27229 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
27230 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
27231
27232 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27233
27234 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
27235
27236 @subsubheading Example
27237
27238 @smallexample
27239 (gdb)
27240 -exec-next-instruction
27241 ^running
27242
27243 (gdb)
27244 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27245 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
27246 (gdb)
27247 @end smallexample
27248
27249
27250 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
27251 @findex -exec-return
27252
27253 @subsubheading Synopsis
27254
27255 @smallexample
27256 -exec-return
27257 @end smallexample
27258
27259 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
27260 Displays the new current frame.
27261
27262 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27263
27264 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
27265
27266 @subsubheading Example
27267
27268 @smallexample
27269 (gdb)
27270 200-break-insert callee4
27271 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
27272 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
27273 (gdb)
27274 000-exec-run
27275 000^running
27276 (gdb)
27277 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
27278 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27279 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27280 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
27281 (gdb)
27282 205-break-delete
27283 205^done
27284 (gdb)
27285 111-exec-return
27286 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
27287 args=[@{name="strarg",
27288 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27289 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27290 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27291 (gdb)
27292 @end smallexample
27293
27294
27295 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
27296 @findex -exec-run
27297
27298 @subsubheading Synopsis
27299
27300 @smallexample
27301 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
27302 @end smallexample
27303
27304 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
27305 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
27306 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
27307 the program has exited exceptionally.
27308
27309 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
27310 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
27311 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
27312 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
27313 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
27314
27315 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
27316 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
27317 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
27318 (@pxref{Starting}).
27319
27320 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27321
27322 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
27323
27324 @subsubheading Examples
27325
27326 @smallexample
27327 (gdb)
27328 -break-insert main
27329 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
27330 (gdb)
27331 -exec-run
27332 ^running
27333 (gdb)
27334 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
27335 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27336 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
27337 (gdb)
27338 @end smallexample
27339
27340 @noindent
27341 Program exited normally:
27342
27343 @smallexample
27344 (gdb)
27345 -exec-run
27346 ^running
27347 (gdb)
27348 x = 55
27349 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
27350 (gdb)
27351 @end smallexample
27352
27353 @noindent
27354 Program exited exceptionally:
27355
27356 @smallexample
27357 (gdb)
27358 -exec-run
27359 ^running
27360 (gdb)
27361 x = 55
27362 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
27363 (gdb)
27364 @end smallexample
27365
27366 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
27367 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
27368
27369 @smallexample
27370 (gdb)
27371 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
27372 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
27373 @end smallexample
27374
27375
27376 @c @subheading -exec-signal
27377
27378
27379 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
27380 @findex -exec-step
27381
27382 @subsubheading Synopsis
27383
27384 @smallexample
27385 -exec-step [--reverse]
27386 @end smallexample
27387
27388 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
27389 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
27390 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
27391 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
27392 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
27393 previously executed source line.
27394
27395 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27396
27397 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
27398
27399 @subsubheading Example
27400
27401 Stepping into a function:
27402
27403 @smallexample
27404 -exec-step
27405 ^running
27406 (gdb)
27407 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27408 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
27409 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
27410 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
27411 (gdb)
27412 @end smallexample
27413
27414 Regular stepping:
27415
27416 @smallexample
27417 -exec-step
27418 ^running
27419 (gdb)
27420 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
27421 (gdb)
27422 @end smallexample
27423
27424
27425 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
27426 @findex -exec-step-instruction
27427
27428 @subsubheading Synopsis
27429
27430 @smallexample
27431 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
27432 @end smallexample
27433
27434 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
27435 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
27436 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
27437 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
27438 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
27439 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
27440 as well.
27441
27442 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27443
27444 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
27445
27446 @subsubheading Example
27447
27448 @smallexample
27449 (gdb)
27450 -exec-step-instruction
27451 ^running
27452
27453 (gdb)
27454 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27455 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27456 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
27457 (gdb)
27458 -exec-step-instruction
27459 ^running
27460
27461 (gdb)
27462 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27463 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27464 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
27465 (gdb)
27466 @end smallexample
27467
27468
27469 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
27470 @findex -exec-until
27471
27472 @subsubheading Synopsis
27473
27474 @smallexample
27475 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
27476 @end smallexample
27477
27478 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
27479 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
27480 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
27481 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
27482
27483 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27484
27485 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
27486
27487 @subsubheading Example
27488
27489 @smallexample
27490 (gdb)
27491 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
27492 ^running
27493 (gdb)
27494 x = 55
27495 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
27496 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
27497 (gdb)
27498 @end smallexample
27499
27500 @ignore
27501 @subheading -file-clear
27502 Is this going away????
27503 @end ignore
27504
27505 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27506 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
27507 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
27508
27509 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
27510 @findex -enable-frame-filters
27511
27512 @smallexample
27513 -enable-frame-filters
27514 @end smallexample
27515
27516 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
27517 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
27518 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
27519 request that this functionality be enabled.
27520
27521 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
27522
27523 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
27524 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
27525
27526 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
27527 @findex -stack-info-frame
27528
27529 @subsubheading Synopsis
27530
27531 @smallexample
27532 -stack-info-frame
27533 @end smallexample
27534
27535 Get info on the selected frame.
27536
27537 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27538
27539 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
27540 (without arguments).
27541
27542 @subsubheading Example
27543
27544 @smallexample
27545 (gdb)
27546 -stack-info-frame
27547 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
27548 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27549 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
27550 (gdb)
27551 @end smallexample
27552
27553 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
27554 @findex -stack-info-depth
27555
27556 @subsubheading Synopsis
27557
27558 @smallexample
27559 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
27560 @end smallexample
27561
27562 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
27563 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
27564
27565 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27566
27567 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
27568
27569 @subsubheading Example
27570
27571 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
27572
27573 @smallexample
27574 (gdb)
27575 -stack-info-depth
27576 ^done,depth="12"
27577 (gdb)
27578 -stack-info-depth 4
27579 ^done,depth="4"
27580 (gdb)
27581 -stack-info-depth 12
27582 ^done,depth="12"
27583 (gdb)
27584 -stack-info-depth 11
27585 ^done,depth="11"
27586 (gdb)
27587 -stack-info-depth 13
27588 ^done,depth="12"
27589 (gdb)
27590 @end smallexample
27591
27592 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
27593 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
27594 @findex -stack-list-arguments
27595
27596 @subsubheading Synopsis
27597
27598 @smallexample
27599 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
27600 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
27601 @end smallexample
27602
27603 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
27604 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
27605 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
27606 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
27607 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
27608 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
27609 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
27610 which case only existing frames will be returned.
27611
27612 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
27613 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
27614 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
27615 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
27616 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
27617 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
27618
27619 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
27620 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
27621 are still displayed, however.
27622
27623 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
27624 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
27625
27626 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27627
27628 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
27629 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
27630 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
27631
27632 @subsubheading Example
27633
27634 @smallexample
27635 (gdb)
27636 -stack-list-frames
27637 ^done,
27638 stack=[
27639 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27640 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27641 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
27642 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
27643 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27644 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
27645 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
27646 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27647 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
27648 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
27649 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27650 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
27651 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
27652 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27653 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
27654 (gdb)
27655 -stack-list-arguments 0
27656 ^done,
27657 stack-args=[
27658 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
27659 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
27660 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
27661 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
27662 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
27663 (gdb)
27664 -stack-list-arguments 1
27665 ^done,
27666 stack-args=[
27667 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
27668 frame=@{level="1",
27669 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
27670 frame=@{level="2",args=[
27671 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
27672 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
27673 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
27674 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
27675 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
27676 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
27677 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
27678 (gdb)
27679 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
27680 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
27681 (gdb)
27682 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
27683 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
27684 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
27685 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
27686 (gdb)
27687 @end smallexample
27688
27689 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
27690
27691
27692 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
27693 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
27694 @findex -stack-list-frames
27695
27696 @subsubheading Synopsis
27697
27698 @smallexample
27699 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
27700 @end smallexample
27701
27702 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
27703 following info:
27704
27705 @table @samp
27706 @item @var{level}
27707 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
27708 @item @var{addr}
27709 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
27710 @item @var{func}
27711 Function name.
27712 @item @var{file}
27713 File name of the source file where the function lives.
27714 @item @var{fullname}
27715 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
27716 @item @var{line}
27717 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
27718 @item @var{from}
27719 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
27720 if the frame's function is not known.
27721 @end table
27722
27723 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
27724 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
27725 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
27726 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
27727 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
27728 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
27729 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
27730 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
27731 Python frame filters will not be executed.
27732
27733 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27734
27735 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
27736
27737 @subsubheading Example
27738
27739 Full stack backtrace:
27740
27741 @smallexample
27742 (gdb)
27743 -stack-list-frames
27744 ^done,stack=
27745 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
27746 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
27747 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27748 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27749 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27750 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27751 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27752 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27753 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27754 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27755 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27756 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27757 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27758 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27759 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27760 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27761 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27762 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27763 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27764 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27765 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27766 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27767 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
27768 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
27769 (gdb)
27770 @end smallexample
27771
27772 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
27773
27774 @smallexample
27775 (gdb)
27776 -stack-list-frames 3 5
27777 ^done,stack=
27778 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27779 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27780 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27781 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27782 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27783 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
27784 (gdb)
27785 @end smallexample
27786
27787 Show a single frame:
27788
27789 @smallexample
27790 (gdb)
27791 -stack-list-frames 3 3
27792 ^done,stack=
27793 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27794 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
27795 (gdb)
27796 @end smallexample
27797
27798
27799 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
27800 @findex -stack-list-locals
27801 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
27802
27803 @subsubheading Synopsis
27804
27805 @smallexample
27806 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
27807 @end smallexample
27808
27809 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
27810 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
27811 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
27812 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
27813 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
27814 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
27815 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
27816 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
27817 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
27818 Python frame filters will not be executed.
27819
27820 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
27821 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
27822 variables are still displayed, however.
27823
27824 This command is deprecated in favor of the
27825 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
27826
27827 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27828
27829 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
27830
27831 @subsubheading Example
27832
27833 @smallexample
27834 (gdb)
27835 -stack-list-locals 0
27836 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
27837 (gdb)
27838 -stack-list-locals --all-values
27839 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
27840 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
27841 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
27842 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
27843 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
27844 (gdb)
27845 @end smallexample
27846
27847 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
27848 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
27849 @findex -stack-list-variables
27850
27851 @subsubheading Synopsis
27852
27853 @smallexample
27854 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
27855 @end smallexample
27856
27857 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
27858 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
27859 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
27860 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
27861 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
27862 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
27863 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
27864
27865 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
27866 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
27867 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
27868
27869 @subsubheading Example
27870
27871 @smallexample
27872 (gdb)
27873 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
27874 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
27875 (gdb)
27876 @end smallexample
27877
27878
27879 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
27880 @findex -stack-select-frame
27881
27882 @subsubheading Synopsis
27883
27884 @smallexample
27885 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
27886 @end smallexample
27887
27888 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
27889 the stack.
27890
27891 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
27892 option to every command.
27893
27894 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27895
27896 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
27897 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
27898
27899 @subsubheading Example
27900
27901 @smallexample
27902 (gdb)
27903 -stack-select-frame 2
27904 ^done
27905 (gdb)
27906 @end smallexample
27907
27908 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27909 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
27910 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
27911
27912 @ignore
27913
27914 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
27915
27916 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
27917 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
27918 used by @code{Insight}.
27919
27920 The two main reasons for that are:
27921
27922 @enumerate 1
27923 @item
27924 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
27925
27926 @item
27927 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
27928 now).
27929 @end enumerate
27930
27931 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
27932 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
27933 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
27934 hints about their use.
27935
27936 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
27937 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
27938 least, the following operations:
27939
27940 @itemize @bullet
27941 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
27942 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
27943 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
27944 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
27945 @end itemize
27946
27947 @end ignore
27948
27949 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
27950
27951 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
27952
27953 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
27954 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
27955 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
27956 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
27957 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
27958 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
27959 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
27960 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
27961 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
27962 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
27963 object, or to change display format.
27964
27965 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
27966 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
27967 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
27968 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
27969 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
27970 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
27971 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
27972 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
27973 child will be created.
27974
27975 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
27976 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
27977 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
27978 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
27979 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
27980
27981 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
27982 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
27983 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
27984 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
27985 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
27986 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
27987 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
27988 variables that frontend has created.
27989
27990 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
27991 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
27992 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
27993 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
27994 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
27995 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
27996 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
27997 implicitly updated.
27998
27999 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
28000 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
28001 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
28002 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
28003 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
28004 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
28005 frame. Consider this example:
28006
28007 @smallexample
28008 void do_work(...)
28009 @{
28010 struct work_state state;
28011
28012 if (...)
28013 do_work(...);
28014 @}
28015 @end smallexample
28016
28017 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
28018 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
28019 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
28020 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
28021 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
28022
28023 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
28024 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
28025 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
28026 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
28027 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
28028 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
28029
28030 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
28031 access this functionality:
28032
28033 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
28034 @item @strong{Operation}
28035 @tab @strong{Description}
28036
28037 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
28038 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
28039 @item @code{-var-create}
28040 @tab create a variable object
28041 @item @code{-var-delete}
28042 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
28043 @item @code{-var-set-format}
28044 @tab set the display format of this variable
28045 @item @code{-var-show-format}
28046 @tab show the display format of this variable
28047 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
28048 @tab tells how many children this object has
28049 @item @code{-var-list-children}
28050 @tab return a list of the object's children
28051 @item @code{-var-info-type}
28052 @tab show the type of this variable object
28053 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
28054 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
28055 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
28056 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
28057 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
28058 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
28059 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
28060 @tab get the value of this variable
28061 @item @code{-var-assign}
28062 @tab set the value of this variable
28063 @item @code{-var-update}
28064 @tab update the variable and its children
28065 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
28066 @tab set frozeness attribute
28067 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
28068 @tab set range of children to display on update
28069 @end multitable
28070
28071 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
28072 how it can be used.
28073
28074 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
28075
28076 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
28077 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
28078
28079 @smallexample
28080 -enable-pretty-printing
28081 @end smallexample
28082
28083 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
28084 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
28085 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28086 request that this functionality be enabled.
28087
28088 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28089
28090 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28091 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28092
28093 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
28094 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
28095
28096 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
28097 @findex -var-create
28098
28099 @subsubheading Synopsis
28100
28101 @smallexample
28102 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
28103 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
28104 @end smallexample
28105
28106 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
28107 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
28108 register.
28109
28110 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
28111 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
28112 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
28113 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
28114 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
28115
28116 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
28117 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
28118 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
28119 object must be created.
28120
28121 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
28122 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
28123
28124 @itemize @bullet
28125 @item
28126 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
28127
28128 @item
28129 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
28130
28131 @item
28132 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
28133 @end itemize
28134
28135 @cindex dynamic varobj
28136 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
28137 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
28138 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
28139 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
28140 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
28141 compatibility for existing clients.
28142
28143 @subsubheading Result
28144
28145 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
28146 are:
28147
28148 @table @samp
28149 @item name
28150 The name of the varobj.
28151
28152 @item numchild
28153 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
28154 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
28155 @samp{has_more} attribute.
28156
28157 @item value
28158 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
28159 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
28160 will not be interesting.
28161
28162 @item type
28163 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
28164 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
28165 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
28166 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
28167 @emph{declared} one.
28168
28169 @item thread-id
28170 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
28171 thread's identifier.
28172
28173 @item has_more
28174 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
28175 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
28176
28177 @item dynamic
28178 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28179 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28180 then this attribute will not be present.
28181
28182 @item displayhint
28183 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28184 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28185 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28186 @end table
28187
28188 Typical output will look like this:
28189
28190 @smallexample
28191 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
28192 has_more="@var{has_more}"
28193 @end smallexample
28194
28195
28196 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
28197 @findex -var-delete
28198
28199 @subsubheading Synopsis
28200
28201 @smallexample
28202 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
28203 @end smallexample
28204
28205 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
28206 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
28207
28208 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
28209
28210
28211 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
28212 @findex -var-set-format
28213
28214 @subsubheading Synopsis
28215
28216 @smallexample
28217 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
28218 @end smallexample
28219
28220 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
28221 @var{format-spec}.
28222
28223 @anchor{-var-set-format}
28224 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
28225
28226 @smallexample
28227 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
28228 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
28229 @end smallexample
28230
28231 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
28232 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
28233 for pointers, etc.).
28234
28235 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
28236 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
28237
28238 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
28239 @findex -var-show-format
28240
28241 @subsubheading Synopsis
28242
28243 @smallexample
28244 -var-show-format @var{name}
28245 @end smallexample
28246
28247 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
28248
28249 @smallexample
28250 @var{format} @expansion{}
28251 @var{format-spec}
28252 @end smallexample
28253
28254
28255 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
28256 @findex -var-info-num-children
28257
28258 @subsubheading Synopsis
28259
28260 @smallexample
28261 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
28262 @end smallexample
28263
28264 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
28265
28266 @smallexample
28267 numchild=@var{n}
28268 @end smallexample
28269
28270 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
28271 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
28272 be available.
28273
28274
28275 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
28276 @findex -var-list-children
28277
28278 @subsubheading Synopsis
28279
28280 @smallexample
28281 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
28282 @end smallexample
28283 @anchor{-var-list-children}
28284
28285 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
28286 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
28287 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
28288 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
28289 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
28290 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
28291 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
28292 and unions.
28293
28294 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
28295 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
28296 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
28297 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
28298 reported.
28299
28300 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
28301 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
28302 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
28303 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
28304 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
28305 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
28306 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
28307 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
28308 the visible items.
28309
28310 For each child the following results are returned:
28311
28312 @table @var
28313
28314 @item name
28315 Name of the variable object created for this child.
28316
28317 @item exp
28318 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
28319 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
28320
28321 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
28322 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
28323
28324 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
28325 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
28326 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
28327 type and value are not present.
28328
28329 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
28330 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
28331 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
28332
28333 @item numchild
28334 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
28335 0.
28336
28337 @item type
28338 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
28339 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
28340 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
28341 @emph{declared} one.
28342
28343 @item value
28344 If values were requested, this is the value.
28345
28346 @item thread-id
28347 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread id.
28348 Otherwise this result is not present.
28349
28350 @item frozen
28351 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
28352
28353 @item displayhint
28354 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28355 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28356 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28357
28358 @item dynamic
28359 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28360 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28361 then this attribute will not be present.
28362
28363 @end table
28364
28365 The result may have its own attributes:
28366
28367 @table @samp
28368 @item displayhint
28369 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28370 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28371 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28372
28373 @item has_more
28374 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
28375 remaining after the end of the selected range.
28376 @end table
28377
28378 @subsubheading Example
28379
28380 @smallexample
28381 (gdb)
28382 -var-list-children n
28383 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
28384 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
28385 (gdb)
28386 -var-list-children --all-values n
28387 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
28388 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
28389 @end smallexample
28390
28391
28392 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
28393 @findex -var-info-type
28394
28395 @subsubheading Synopsis
28396
28397 @smallexample
28398 -var-info-type @var{name}
28399 @end smallexample
28400
28401 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
28402 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
28403 @value{GDBN} CLI:
28404
28405 @smallexample
28406 type=@var{typename}
28407 @end smallexample
28408
28409
28410 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
28411 @findex -var-info-expression
28412
28413 @subsubheading Synopsis
28414
28415 @smallexample
28416 -var-info-expression @var{name}
28417 @end smallexample
28418
28419 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
28420 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
28421 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
28422
28423 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
28424 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
28425
28426 @smallexample
28427 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
28428 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
28429 @end smallexample
28430
28431 @noindent
28432 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
28433 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
28434
28435 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
28436 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
28437 is of limited use.
28438
28439 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
28440 @findex -var-info-path-expression
28441
28442 @subsubheading Synopsis
28443
28444 @smallexample
28445 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
28446 @end smallexample
28447
28448 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
28449 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
28450 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
28451 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
28452 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
28453 watchpoint from a variable object.
28454
28455 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
28456 and will give an error when invoked on one.
28457
28458 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
28459 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
28460 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
28461 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
28462 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
28463 @smallexample
28464 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
28465 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
28466 @end smallexample
28467
28468 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
28469 @findex -var-show-attributes
28470
28471 @subsubheading Synopsis
28472
28473 @smallexample
28474 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
28475 @end smallexample
28476
28477 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
28478
28479 @smallexample
28480 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
28481 @end smallexample
28482
28483 @noindent
28484 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
28485
28486 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
28487 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
28488
28489 @subsubheading Synopsis
28490
28491 @smallexample
28492 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
28493 @end smallexample
28494
28495 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
28496 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
28497 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
28498 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
28499 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
28500 the current display format will be used. The current display format
28501 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
28502
28503 @smallexample
28504 value=@var{value}
28505 @end smallexample
28506
28507 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
28508 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
28509
28510 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
28511 @findex -var-assign
28512
28513 @subsubheading Synopsis
28514
28515 @smallexample
28516 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
28517 @end smallexample
28518
28519 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
28520 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
28521 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
28522 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
28523
28524 @subsubheading Example
28525
28526 @smallexample
28527 (gdb)
28528 -var-assign var1 3
28529 ^done,value="3"
28530 (gdb)
28531 -var-update *
28532 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
28533 (gdb)
28534 @end smallexample
28535
28536 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
28537 @findex -var-update
28538
28539 @subsubheading Synopsis
28540
28541 @smallexample
28542 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
28543 @end smallexample
28544
28545 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
28546 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
28547 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
28548 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
28549 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
28550 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
28551 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
28552 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
28553 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
28554 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
28555 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
28556 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
28557 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
28558
28559 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
28560 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
28561 diagnostic.
28562
28563 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
28564 only the selected range of children will be reported.
28565
28566 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
28567 @samp{changelist}.
28568
28569 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
28570
28571 @table @samp
28572 @item name
28573 The name of the varobj.
28574
28575 @item value
28576 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
28577 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
28578
28579 @item in_scope
28580 @anchor{-var-update}
28581 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
28582
28583 @table @code
28584 @item "true"
28585 The variable object's current value is valid.
28586
28587 @item "false"
28588 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
28589 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
28590 scope.
28591
28592 @item "invalid"
28593 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
28594 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
28595 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
28596 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
28597 objects.
28598 @end table
28599
28600 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
28601 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
28602
28603 @item type_changed
28604 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
28605 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
28606 be @samp{false}.
28607
28608 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
28609 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
28610 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
28611 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
28612 unset.
28613
28614 @item new_type
28615 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
28616 hold the new type.
28617
28618 @item new_num_children
28619 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
28620 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
28621
28622 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
28623 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
28624 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
28625 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
28626 children which may be available.
28627
28628 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
28629 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
28630 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
28631 only happen at the end of the update range).
28632
28633 @item displayhint
28634 The display hint, if any.
28635
28636 @item has_more
28637 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
28638 available outside the varobj's update range.
28639
28640 @item dynamic
28641 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28642 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28643 then this attribute will not be present.
28644
28645 @item new_children
28646 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
28647 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
28648 be listed in this attribute.
28649 @end table
28650
28651 @subsubheading Example
28652
28653 @smallexample
28654 (gdb)
28655 -var-assign var1 3
28656 ^done,value="3"
28657 (gdb)
28658 -var-update --all-values var1
28659 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
28660 type_changed="false"@}]
28661 (gdb)
28662 @end smallexample
28663
28664 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
28665 @findex -var-set-frozen
28666 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
28667
28668 @subsubheading Synopsis
28669
28670 @smallexample
28671 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
28672 @end smallexample
28673
28674 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
28675 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
28676 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
28677 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
28678 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
28679 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
28680 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
28681 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
28682 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
28683 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
28684 @code{-var-update} does.
28685
28686 @subsubheading Example
28687
28688 @smallexample
28689 (gdb)
28690 -var-set-frozen V 1
28691 ^done
28692 (gdb)
28693 @end smallexample
28694
28695 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
28696 @findex -var-set-update-range
28697 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
28698
28699 @subsubheading Synopsis
28700
28701 @smallexample
28702 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
28703 @end smallexample
28704
28705 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
28706 @code{-var-update}.
28707
28708 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
28709 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
28710 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
28711 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
28712
28713 @subsubheading Example
28714
28715 @smallexample
28716 (gdb)
28717 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
28718 ^done
28719 @end smallexample
28720
28721 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
28722 @findex -var-set-visualizer
28723 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
28724
28725 @subsubheading Synopsis
28726
28727 @smallexample
28728 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
28729 @end smallexample
28730
28731 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
28732
28733 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
28734 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
28735
28736 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
28737 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
28738 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
28739 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
28740 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
28741 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
28742 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
28743
28744 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
28745 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
28746 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
28747 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
28748
28749 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
28750 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
28751 can be used to check this.
28752
28753 @subsubheading Example
28754
28755 Resetting the visualizer:
28756
28757 @smallexample
28758 (gdb)
28759 -var-set-visualizer V None
28760 ^done
28761 @end smallexample
28762
28763 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
28764
28765 @smallexample
28766 (gdb)
28767 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
28768 ^done
28769 @end smallexample
28770
28771 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
28772 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
28773
28774 @smallexample
28775 (gdb)
28776 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
28777 ^done
28778 @end smallexample
28779
28780 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28781 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
28782 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
28783
28784 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
28785 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
28786 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
28787 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
28788
28789 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
28790 @c @subheading -data-assign
28791 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
28792 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
28793 @c set variable
28794 @c @subsubheading Example
28795 @c N.A.
28796
28797 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
28798 @findex -data-disassemble
28799
28800 @subsubheading Synopsis
28801
28802 @smallexample
28803 -data-disassemble
28804 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
28805 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
28806 -- @var{mode}
28807 @end smallexample
28808
28809 @noindent
28810 Where:
28811
28812 @table @samp
28813 @item @var{start-addr}
28814 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
28815 @item @var{end-addr}
28816 is the end address
28817 @item @var{filename}
28818 is the name of the file to disassemble
28819 @item @var{linenum}
28820 is the line number to disassemble around
28821 @item @var{lines}
28822 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
28823 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
28824 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
28825 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
28826 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
28827 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
28828 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
28829 are displayed.
28830 @item @var{mode}
28831 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly), 1 (meaning mixed source and
28832 disassembly), 2 (meaning disassembly with raw opcodes), or 3 (meaning
28833 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes).
28834 @end table
28835
28836 @subsubheading Result
28837
28838 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
28839 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
28840 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
28841
28842 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
28843 following fields:
28844
28845 @table @code
28846 @item address
28847 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
28848
28849 @item func-name
28850 The name of the function this instruction is within.
28851
28852 @item offset
28853 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
28854
28855 @item inst
28856 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
28857
28858 @item opcodes
28859 This field is only present for mode 2. This contains the raw opcode
28860 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
28861
28862 @end table
28863
28864 For modes 1 and 3 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
28865 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
28866
28867 @table @code
28868 @item line
28869 The line number within @samp{file}.
28870
28871 @item file
28872 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
28873 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
28874 used.
28875
28876 @item fullname
28877 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
28878 using the source file search path
28879 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
28880 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
28881
28882 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
28883 present in the debug information.
28884
28885 @item line_asm_insn
28886 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
28887 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
28888 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
28889 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
28890 @samp{opcodes}.
28891
28892 @end table
28893
28894 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
28895 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
28896 adjust its format.
28897
28898 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28899
28900 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
28901
28902 @subsubheading Example
28903
28904 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
28905
28906 @smallexample
28907 (gdb)
28908 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
28909 ^done,
28910 asm_insns=[
28911 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
28912 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
28913 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
28914 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
28915 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
28916 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
28917 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
28918 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
28919 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
28920 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
28921 (gdb)
28922 @end smallexample
28923
28924 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
28925 @code{main}.
28926
28927 @smallexample
28928 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
28929 ^done,asm_insns=[
28930 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
28931 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
28932 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
28933 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
28934 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
28935 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
28936 [@dots{}]
28937 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
28938 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
28939 (gdb)
28940 @end smallexample
28941
28942 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
28943
28944 @smallexample
28945 (gdb)
28946 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
28947 ^done,asm_insns=[
28948 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
28949 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
28950 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
28951 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
28952 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
28953 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
28954 (gdb)
28955 @end smallexample
28956
28957 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
28958
28959 @smallexample
28960 (gdb)
28961 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
28962 ^done,asm_insns=[
28963 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
28964 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28965 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28966 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
28967 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
28968 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
28969 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28970 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28971 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
28972 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
28973 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
28974 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
28975 (gdb)
28976 @end smallexample
28977
28978
28979 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
28980 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
28981
28982 @subsubheading Synopsis
28983
28984 @smallexample
28985 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
28986 @end smallexample
28987
28988 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
28989 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
28990 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
28991
28992 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28993
28994 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
28995 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
28996 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
28997
28998 @subsubheading Example
28999
29000 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
29001 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
29002 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
29003 output.
29004
29005 @smallexample
29006 211-data-evaluate-expression A
29007 211^done,value="1"
29008 (gdb)
29009 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
29010 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
29011 (gdb)
29012 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
29013 411^done,value="4"
29014 (gdb)
29015 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
29016 511^done,value="4"
29017 (gdb)
29018 @end smallexample
29019
29020
29021 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
29022 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
29023
29024 @subsubheading Synopsis
29025
29026 @smallexample
29027 -data-list-changed-registers
29028 @end smallexample
29029
29030 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
29031
29032 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29033
29034 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
29035 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
29036
29037 @subsubheading Example
29038
29039 On a PPC MBX board:
29040
29041 @smallexample
29042 (gdb)
29043 -exec-continue
29044 ^running
29045
29046 (gdb)
29047 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
29048 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
29049 line="5"@}
29050 (gdb)
29051 -data-list-changed-registers
29052 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
29053 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
29054 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
29055 (gdb)
29056 @end smallexample
29057
29058
29059 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
29060 @findex -data-list-register-names
29061
29062 @subsubheading Synopsis
29063
29064 @smallexample
29065 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
29066 @end smallexample
29067
29068 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
29069 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
29070 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
29071 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
29072 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
29073 include empty register names.
29074
29075 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29076
29077 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
29078 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
29079 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
29080
29081 @subsubheading Example
29082
29083 For the PPC MBX board:
29084 @smallexample
29085 (gdb)
29086 -data-list-register-names
29087 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
29088 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
29089 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
29090 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
29091 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
29092 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
29093 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
29094 (gdb)
29095 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
29096 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
29097 (gdb)
29098 @end smallexample
29099
29100 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
29101 @findex -data-list-register-values
29102
29103 @subsubheading Synopsis
29104
29105 @smallexample
29106 -data-list-register-values
29107 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
29108 @end smallexample
29109
29110 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
29111 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
29112 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
29113 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be
29114 returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option indicates that only
29115 the available registers are to be returned.
29116
29117 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
29118
29119 @table @code
29120 @item x
29121 Hexadecimal
29122 @item o
29123 Octal
29124 @item t
29125 Binary
29126 @item d
29127 Decimal
29128 @item r
29129 Raw
29130 @item N
29131 Natural
29132 @end table
29133
29134 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29135
29136 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
29137 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
29138
29139 @subsubheading Example
29140
29141 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
29142 don't appear in the actual output):
29143
29144 @smallexample
29145 (gdb)
29146 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
29147 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
29148 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
29149 (gdb)
29150 -data-list-register-values x
29151 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
29152 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
29153 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
29154 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
29155 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
29156 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
29157 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
29158 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
29159 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
29160 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
29161 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
29162 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
29163 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
29164 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
29165 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
29166 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
29167 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
29168 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
29169 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
29170 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
29171 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
29172 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
29173 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
29174 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
29175 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
29176 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
29177 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
29178 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
29179 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
29180 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
29181 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
29182 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
29183 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
29184 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
29185 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
29186 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
29187 (gdb)
29188 @end smallexample
29189
29190
29191 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
29192 @findex -data-read-memory
29193
29194 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
29195
29196 @subsubheading Synopsis
29197
29198 @smallexample
29199 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
29200 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
29201 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
29202 @end smallexample
29203
29204 @noindent
29205 where:
29206
29207 @table @samp
29208 @item @var{address}
29209 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29210 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29211 quoted using the C convention.
29212
29213 @item @var{word-format}
29214 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
29215 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
29216 ,Output Formats}).
29217
29218 @item @var{word-size}
29219 The size of each memory word in bytes.
29220
29221 @item @var{nr-rows}
29222 The number of rows in the output table.
29223
29224 @item @var{nr-cols}
29225 The number of columns in the output table.
29226
29227 @item @var{aschar}
29228 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
29229 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
29230 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
29231 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
29232
29233 @item @var{byte-offset}
29234 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
29235 @end table
29236
29237 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
29238 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
29239 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
29240 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
29241 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
29242 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
29243 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
29244 @samp{addr}.
29245
29246 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
29247 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
29248 @samp{prev-page}.
29249
29250 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29251
29252 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
29253 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
29254
29255 @subsubheading Example
29256
29257 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
29258 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
29259 word. Display each word in hex.
29260
29261 @smallexample
29262 (gdb)
29263 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
29264 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
29265 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
29266 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
29267 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
29268 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
29269 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
29270 (gdb)
29271 @end smallexample
29272
29273 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
29274 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
29275
29276 @smallexample
29277 (gdb)
29278 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
29279 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
29280 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
29281 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
29282 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
29283 (gdb)
29284 @end smallexample
29285
29286 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
29287 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
29288 used as the non-printable character.
29289
29290 @smallexample
29291 (gdb)
29292 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
29293 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
29294 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
29295 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
29296 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29297 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29298 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29299 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29300 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
29301 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
29302 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
29303 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
29304 (gdb)
29305 @end smallexample
29306
29307 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
29308 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
29309
29310 @subsubheading Synopsis
29311
29312 @smallexample
29313 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
29314 @var{address} @var{count}
29315 @end smallexample
29316
29317 @noindent
29318 where:
29319
29320 @table @samp
29321 @item @var{address}
29322 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29323 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29324 quoted using the C convention.
29325
29326 @item @var{count}
29327 The number of bytes to read. This should be an integer literal.
29328
29329 @item @var{byte-offset}
29330 The offsets in bytes relative to @var{address} at which to start
29331 reading. This should be an integer literal. This option is provided
29332 so that a frontend is not required to first evaluate address and then
29333 perform address arithmetics itself.
29334
29335 @end table
29336
29337 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
29338 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
29339 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
29340 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
29341 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
29342 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
29343
29344 In general, every single byte in the region may be readable or not,
29345 and the only way to read every readable byte is to try a read at
29346 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
29347 attempt to read all accessible bytes at either beginning or the end
29348 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
29349 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
29350 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
29351 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
29352
29353 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
29354 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
29355 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
29356 and has the following fields:
29357
29358 @table @code
29359 @item begin
29360 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
29361
29362 @item end
29363 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
29364
29365 @item offset
29366 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
29367 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
29368
29369 @item contents
29370 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
29371
29372 @end table
29373
29374
29375
29376 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29377
29378 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
29379
29380 @subsubheading Example
29381
29382 @smallexample
29383 (gdb)
29384 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
29385 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
29386 end="0xbffff15e",
29387 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
29388 (gdb)
29389 @end smallexample
29390
29391
29392 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
29393 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
29394
29395 @subsubheading Synopsis
29396
29397 @smallexample
29398 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
29399 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
29400 @end smallexample
29401
29402 @noindent
29403 where:
29404
29405 @table @samp
29406 @item @var{address}
29407 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29408 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29409 quoted using the C convention.
29410
29411 @item @var{contents}
29412 The hex-encoded bytes to write.
29413
29414 @item @var{count}
29415 Optional argument indicating the number of bytes to be written. If @var{count}
29416 is greater than @var{contents}' length, @value{GDBN} will repeatedly
29417 write @var{contents} until it fills @var{count} bytes.
29418
29419 @end table
29420
29421 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29422
29423 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
29424
29425 @subsubheading Example
29426
29427 @smallexample
29428 (gdb)
29429 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
29430 ^done
29431 (gdb)
29432 @end smallexample
29433
29434 @smallexample
29435 (gdb)
29436 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
29437 ^done
29438 (gdb)
29439 @end smallexample
29440
29441 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29442 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
29443 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
29444
29445 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
29446 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
29447
29448 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
29449 @findex -trace-find
29450
29451 @subsubheading Synopsis
29452
29453 @smallexample
29454 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
29455 @end smallexample
29456
29457 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
29458 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
29459 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
29460
29461 @table @samp
29462
29463 @item none
29464 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
29465
29466 @item frame-number
29467 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
29468 that index.
29469
29470 @item tracepoint-number
29471 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
29472 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
29473
29474 @item pc
29475 An address is required as parameter. Finds
29476 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
29477 address.
29478
29479 @item pc-inside-range
29480 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
29481 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
29482 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
29483
29484 @item pc-outside-range
29485 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
29486 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
29487 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
29488
29489 @item line
29490 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
29491 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
29492 the specified location.
29493
29494 @end table
29495
29496 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
29497 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
29498
29499 @table @samp
29500 @item found
29501 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
29502 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
29503
29504 @item traceframe
29505 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
29506 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
29507
29508 @item tracepoint
29509 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
29510 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
29511
29512 @item frame
29513 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
29514 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
29515 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
29516
29517 @end table
29518
29519 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29520
29521 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
29522
29523 @subheading -trace-define-variable
29524 @findex -trace-define-variable
29525
29526 @subsubheading Synopsis
29527
29528 @smallexample
29529 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
29530 @end smallexample
29531
29532 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
29533 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
29534 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
29535 with the @samp{$} character.
29536
29537 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29538
29539 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
29540
29541 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
29542 @findex -trace-frame-collected
29543
29544 @subsubheading Synopsis
29545
29546 @smallexample
29547 -trace-frame-collected
29548 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
29549 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
29550 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
29551 [--memory-contents]
29552 @end smallexample
29553
29554 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
29555 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
29556 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
29557 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
29558 See the output description table below for more details.
29559
29560 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
29561 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
29562 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
29563 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
29564 memory range and which is a computed expression.
29565
29566 For instance, if the actions were
29567 @smallexample
29568 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
29569 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
29570 @end smallexample
29571
29572 @noindent
29573 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
29574 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
29575 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
29576 objects would be computed expressions.
29577
29578 An example output would be:
29579
29580 @smallexample
29581 (gdb)
29582 -trace-frame-collected
29583 ^done,
29584 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
29585 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
29586 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
29587 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
29588 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
29589 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
29590 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
29591 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
29592 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
29593 ...
29594 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
29595 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
29596 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
29597 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
29598 (gdb)
29599 @end smallexample
29600
29601 Where:
29602
29603 @table @code
29604 @item explicit-variables
29605 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
29606 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
29607 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
29608 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
29609 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
29610 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
29611 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
29612 arrays, structures and unions.
29613
29614 @item computed-expressions
29615 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
29616 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
29617 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
29618 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
29619
29620 @item registers
29621 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
29622 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
29623 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
29624 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
29625 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
29626
29627 @item tvars
29628 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
29629 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
29630 current value are returned.
29631
29632 @item memory
29633 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
29634 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
29635 collected memory range and has the following fields:
29636
29637 @table @code
29638 @item address
29639 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
29640
29641 @item length
29642 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
29643
29644 @item contents
29645 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
29646 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
29647
29648 @end table
29649
29650 @end table
29651
29652 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29653
29654 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
29655
29656 @subsubheading Example
29657
29658 @subheading -trace-list-variables
29659 @findex -trace-list-variables
29660
29661 @subsubheading Synopsis
29662
29663 @smallexample
29664 -trace-list-variables
29665 @end smallexample
29666
29667 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
29668 table has the following fields:
29669
29670 @table @samp
29671 @item name
29672 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
29673
29674 @item initial
29675 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
29676 field is always present.
29677
29678 @item current
29679 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
29680 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
29681 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
29682 presently running.
29683
29684 @end table
29685
29686 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29687
29688 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
29689
29690 @subsubheading Example
29691
29692 @smallexample
29693 (gdb)
29694 -trace-list-variables
29695 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
29696 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
29697 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
29698 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
29699 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
29700 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
29701 (gdb)
29702 @end smallexample
29703
29704 @subheading -trace-save
29705 @findex -trace-save
29706
29707 @subsubheading Synopsis
29708
29709 @smallexample
29710 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
29711 @end smallexample
29712
29713 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
29714 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
29715 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
29716 to perform the save.
29717
29718 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29719
29720 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
29721
29722
29723 @subheading -trace-start
29724 @findex -trace-start
29725
29726 @subsubheading Synopsis
29727
29728 @smallexample
29729 -trace-start
29730 @end smallexample
29731
29732 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
29733 have any fields.
29734
29735 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29736
29737 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
29738
29739 @subheading -trace-status
29740 @findex -trace-status
29741
29742 @subsubheading Synopsis
29743
29744 @smallexample
29745 -trace-status
29746 @end smallexample
29747
29748 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
29749 the following fields:
29750
29751 @table @samp
29752
29753 @item supported
29754 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
29755 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
29756 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
29757 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
29758 started. This field is always present.
29759
29760 @item running
29761 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
29762 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
29763 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
29764
29765 @item stop-reason
29766 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
29767 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
29768 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
29769 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
29770 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
29771 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
29772 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
29773 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
29774 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
29775
29776 @item stopping-tracepoint
29777 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
29778 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
29779 @samp{passcount}.
29780
29781 @item frames
29782 @itemx frames-created
29783 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
29784 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
29785 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
29786 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
29787
29788 @item buffer-size
29789 @itemx buffer-free
29790 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
29791 remaining space. These fields are optional.
29792
29793 @item circular
29794 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
29795 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
29796 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
29797 and may fill up.
29798
29799 @item disconnected
29800 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
29801 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
29802 that the trace run will stop.
29803
29804 @item trace-file
29805 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
29806 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
29807
29808 @end table
29809
29810 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29811
29812 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
29813
29814 @subheading -trace-stop
29815 @findex -trace-stop
29816
29817 @subsubheading Synopsis
29818
29819 @smallexample
29820 -trace-stop
29821 @end smallexample
29822
29823 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
29824 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
29825 @samp{running} fields are not output.
29826
29827 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29828
29829 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
29830
29831
29832 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29833 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
29834 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
29835
29836
29837 @ignore
29838 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
29839 @findex -symbol-info-address
29840
29841 @subsubheading Synopsis
29842
29843 @smallexample
29844 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
29845 @end smallexample
29846
29847 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
29848
29849 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29850
29851 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
29852
29853 @subsubheading Example
29854 N.A.
29855
29856
29857 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
29858 @findex -symbol-info-file
29859
29860 @subsubheading Synopsis
29861
29862 @smallexample
29863 -symbol-info-file
29864 @end smallexample
29865
29866 Show the file for the symbol.
29867
29868 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29869
29870 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
29871 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
29872
29873 @subsubheading Example
29874 N.A.
29875
29876
29877 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
29878 @findex -symbol-info-function
29879
29880 @subsubheading Synopsis
29881
29882 @smallexample
29883 -symbol-info-function
29884 @end smallexample
29885
29886 Show which function the symbol lives in.
29887
29888 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29889
29890 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
29891
29892 @subsubheading Example
29893 N.A.
29894
29895
29896 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
29897 @findex -symbol-info-line
29898
29899 @subsubheading Synopsis
29900
29901 @smallexample
29902 -symbol-info-line
29903 @end smallexample
29904
29905 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
29906
29907 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29908
29909 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
29910 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
29911
29912 @subsubheading Example
29913 N.A.
29914
29915
29916 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
29917 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
29918
29919 @subsubheading Synopsis
29920
29921 @smallexample
29922 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
29923 @end smallexample
29924
29925 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
29926
29927 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29928
29929 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
29930
29931 @subsubheading Example
29932 N.A.
29933
29934
29935 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
29936 @findex -symbol-list-functions
29937
29938 @subsubheading Synopsis
29939
29940 @smallexample
29941 -symbol-list-functions
29942 @end smallexample
29943
29944 List the functions in the executable.
29945
29946 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29947
29948 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
29949 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
29950
29951 @subsubheading Example
29952 N.A.
29953 @end ignore
29954
29955
29956 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
29957 @findex -symbol-list-lines
29958
29959 @subsubheading Synopsis
29960
29961 @smallexample
29962 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
29963 @end smallexample
29964
29965 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
29966 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
29967 ascending PC order.
29968
29969 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29970
29971 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
29972
29973 @subsubheading Example
29974 @smallexample
29975 (gdb)
29976 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
29977 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
29978 (gdb)
29979 @end smallexample
29980
29981
29982 @ignore
29983 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
29984 @findex -symbol-list-types
29985
29986 @subsubheading Synopsis
29987
29988 @smallexample
29989 -symbol-list-types
29990 @end smallexample
29991
29992 List all the type names.
29993
29994 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29995
29996 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
29997 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
29998
29999 @subsubheading Example
30000 N.A.
30001
30002
30003 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
30004 @findex -symbol-list-variables
30005
30006 @subsubheading Synopsis
30007
30008 @smallexample
30009 -symbol-list-variables
30010 @end smallexample
30011
30012 List all the global and static variable names.
30013
30014 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30015
30016 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30017
30018 @subsubheading Example
30019 N.A.
30020
30021
30022 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
30023 @findex -symbol-locate
30024
30025 @subsubheading Synopsis
30026
30027 @smallexample
30028 -symbol-locate
30029 @end smallexample
30030
30031 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30032
30033 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
30034
30035 @subsubheading Example
30036 N.A.
30037
30038
30039 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
30040 @findex -symbol-type
30041
30042 @subsubheading Synopsis
30043
30044 @smallexample
30045 -symbol-type @var{variable}
30046 @end smallexample
30047
30048 Show type of @var{variable}.
30049
30050 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30051
30052 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
30053 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
30054
30055 @subsubheading Example
30056 N.A.
30057 @end ignore
30058
30059
30060 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30061 @node GDB/MI File Commands
30062 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
30063
30064 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
30065 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
30066
30067 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
30068 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
30069
30070 @subsubheading Synopsis
30071
30072 @smallexample
30073 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
30074 @end smallexample
30075
30076 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
30077 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
30078 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
30079 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
30080 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
30081 notification.
30082
30083 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30084
30085 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
30086
30087 @subsubheading Example
30088
30089 @smallexample
30090 (gdb)
30091 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30092 ^done
30093 (gdb)
30094 @end smallexample
30095
30096
30097 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
30098 @findex -file-exec-file
30099
30100 @subsubheading Synopsis
30101
30102 @smallexample
30103 -file-exec-file @var{file}
30104 @end smallexample
30105
30106 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
30107 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
30108 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
30109 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
30110 notification.
30111
30112 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30113
30114 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
30115
30116 @subsubheading Example
30117
30118 @smallexample
30119 (gdb)
30120 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30121 ^done
30122 (gdb)
30123 @end smallexample
30124
30125
30126 @ignore
30127 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
30128 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
30129
30130 @subsubheading Synopsis
30131
30132 @smallexample
30133 -file-list-exec-sections
30134 @end smallexample
30135
30136 List the sections of the current executable file.
30137
30138 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30139
30140 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
30141 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
30142 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
30143
30144 @subsubheading Example
30145 N.A.
30146 @end ignore
30147
30148
30149 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
30150 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
30151
30152 @subsubheading Synopsis
30153
30154 @smallexample
30155 -file-list-exec-source-file
30156 @end smallexample
30157
30158 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
30159 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
30160 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
30161 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
30162
30163 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30164
30165 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
30166
30167 @subsubheading Example
30168
30169 @smallexample
30170 (gdb)
30171 123-file-list-exec-source-file
30172 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
30173 (gdb)
30174 @end smallexample
30175
30176
30177 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
30178 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
30179
30180 @subsubheading Synopsis
30181
30182 @smallexample
30183 -file-list-exec-source-files
30184 @end smallexample
30185
30186 List the source files for the current executable.
30187
30188 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
30189 name) of a source file.
30190
30191 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30192
30193 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
30194 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
30195
30196 @subsubheading Example
30197 @smallexample
30198 (gdb)
30199 -file-list-exec-source-files
30200 ^done,files=[
30201 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
30202 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
30203 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
30204 (gdb)
30205 @end smallexample
30206
30207 @ignore
30208 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
30209 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
30210
30211 @subsubheading Synopsis
30212
30213 @smallexample
30214 -file-list-shared-libraries
30215 @end smallexample
30216
30217 List the shared libraries in the program.
30218
30219 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30220
30221 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
30222
30223 @subsubheading Example
30224 N.A.
30225
30226
30227 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
30228 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
30229
30230 @subsubheading Synopsis
30231
30232 @smallexample
30233 -file-list-symbol-files
30234 @end smallexample
30235
30236 List symbol files.
30237
30238 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30239
30240 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
30241
30242 @subsubheading Example
30243 N.A.
30244 @end ignore
30245
30246
30247 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
30248 @findex -file-symbol-file
30249
30250 @subsubheading Synopsis
30251
30252 @smallexample
30253 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
30254 @end smallexample
30255
30256 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
30257 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
30258 produced, except for a completion notification.
30259
30260 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30261
30262 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
30263
30264 @subsubheading Example
30265
30266 @smallexample
30267 (gdb)
30268 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30269 ^done
30270 (gdb)
30271 @end smallexample
30272
30273 @ignore
30274 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30275 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
30276 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
30277
30278 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
30279
30280 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
30281
30282 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
30283
30284 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
30285
30286 @c @subheading -overlay-map
30287
30288 @c @subheading -overlay-off
30289
30290 @c @subheading -overlay-on
30291
30292 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
30293
30294 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30295 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
30296 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
30297
30298 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
30299
30300 @c @subheading -signal-handle
30301
30302 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
30303
30304 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
30305 @end ignore
30306
30307
30308 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30309 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
30310 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
30311
30312
30313 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
30314 @findex -target-attach
30315
30316 @subsubheading Synopsis
30317
30318 @smallexample
30319 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
30320 @end smallexample
30321
30322 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
30323 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
30324 group, the id previously returned by
30325 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
30326
30327 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30328
30329 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
30330
30331 @subsubheading Example
30332 @smallexample
30333 (gdb)
30334 -target-attach 34
30335 =thread-created,id="1"
30336 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
30337 ^done
30338 (gdb)
30339 @end smallexample
30340
30341 @ignore
30342 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
30343 @findex -target-compare-sections
30344
30345 @subsubheading Synopsis
30346
30347 @smallexample
30348 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
30349 @end smallexample
30350
30351 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
30352 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
30353
30354 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30355
30356 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
30357
30358 @subsubheading Example
30359 N.A.
30360 @end ignore
30361
30362
30363 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
30364 @findex -target-detach
30365
30366 @subsubheading Synopsis
30367
30368 @smallexample
30369 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
30370 @end smallexample
30371
30372 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
30373 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
30374 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
30375
30376 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30377
30378 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
30379
30380 @subsubheading Example
30381
30382 @smallexample
30383 (gdb)
30384 -target-detach
30385 ^done
30386 (gdb)
30387 @end smallexample
30388
30389
30390 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
30391 @findex -target-disconnect
30392
30393 @subsubheading Synopsis
30394
30395 @smallexample
30396 -target-disconnect
30397 @end smallexample
30398
30399 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
30400 generally not resumed.
30401
30402 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30403
30404 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
30405
30406 @subsubheading Example
30407
30408 @smallexample
30409 (gdb)
30410 -target-disconnect
30411 ^done
30412 (gdb)
30413 @end smallexample
30414
30415
30416 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
30417 @findex -target-download
30418
30419 @subsubheading Synopsis
30420
30421 @smallexample
30422 -target-download
30423 @end smallexample
30424
30425 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
30426 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
30427
30428 @table @samp
30429 @item section
30430 The name of the section.
30431 @item section-sent
30432 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
30433 @item section-size
30434 The size of the section.
30435 @item total-sent
30436 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
30437 @item total-size
30438 The size of the overall executable to download.
30439 @end table
30440
30441 @noindent
30442 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
30443 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
30444
30445 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
30446 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
30447
30448 @table @samp
30449 @item section
30450 The name of the section.
30451 @item section-size
30452 The size of the section.
30453 @item total-size
30454 The size of the overall executable to download.
30455 @end table
30456
30457 @noindent
30458 At the end, a summary is printed.
30459
30460 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30461
30462 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
30463
30464 @subsubheading Example
30465
30466 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
30467 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
30468
30469 @smallexample
30470 (gdb)
30471 -target-download
30472 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
30473 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
30474 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
30475 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
30476 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
30477 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
30478 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
30479 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
30480 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
30481 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
30482 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
30483 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
30484 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
30485 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
30486 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
30487 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
30488 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
30489 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
30490 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
30491 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
30492 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
30493 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
30494 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
30495 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
30496 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
30497 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
30498 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
30499 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
30500 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
30501 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
30502 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
30503 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
30504 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
30505 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
30506 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
30507 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
30508 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
30509 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
30510 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
30511 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
30512 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
30513 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
30514 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
30515 write-rate="429"
30516 (gdb)
30517 @end smallexample
30518
30519
30520 @ignore
30521 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
30522 @findex -target-exec-status
30523
30524 @subsubheading Synopsis
30525
30526 @smallexample
30527 -target-exec-status
30528 @end smallexample
30529
30530 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
30531 not, for instance).
30532
30533 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30534
30535 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
30536
30537 @subsubheading Example
30538 N.A.
30539
30540
30541 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
30542 @findex -target-list-available-targets
30543
30544 @subsubheading Synopsis
30545
30546 @smallexample
30547 -target-list-available-targets
30548 @end smallexample
30549
30550 List the possible targets to connect to.
30551
30552 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30553
30554 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
30555
30556 @subsubheading Example
30557 N.A.
30558
30559
30560 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
30561 @findex -target-list-current-targets
30562
30563 @subsubheading Synopsis
30564
30565 @smallexample
30566 -target-list-current-targets
30567 @end smallexample
30568
30569 Describe the current target.
30570
30571 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30572
30573 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
30574 other things).
30575
30576 @subsubheading Example
30577 N.A.
30578
30579
30580 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
30581 @findex -target-list-parameters
30582
30583 @subsubheading Synopsis
30584
30585 @smallexample
30586 -target-list-parameters
30587 @end smallexample
30588
30589 @c ????
30590 @end ignore
30591
30592 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30593
30594 No equivalent.
30595
30596 @subsubheading Example
30597 N.A.
30598
30599
30600 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
30601 @findex -target-select
30602
30603 @subsubheading Synopsis
30604
30605 @smallexample
30606 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
30607 @end smallexample
30608
30609 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
30610
30611 @table @samp
30612 @item @var{type}
30613 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
30614 @item @var{parameters}
30615 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
30616 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
30617 @end table
30618
30619 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
30620 which the target program is, in the following form:
30621
30622 @smallexample
30623 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
30624 args=[@var{arg list}]
30625 @end smallexample
30626
30627 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30628
30629 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
30630
30631 @subsubheading Example
30632
30633 @smallexample
30634 (gdb)
30635 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
30636 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
30637 (gdb)
30638 @end smallexample
30639
30640 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30641 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
30642 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
30643
30644
30645 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
30646 @findex -target-file-put
30647
30648 @subsubheading Synopsis
30649
30650 @smallexample
30651 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
30652 @end smallexample
30653
30654 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
30655 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
30656
30657 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30658
30659 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
30660
30661 @subsubheading Example
30662
30663 @smallexample
30664 (gdb)
30665 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
30666 ^done
30667 (gdb)
30668 @end smallexample
30669
30670
30671 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
30672 @findex -target-file-get
30673
30674 @subsubheading Synopsis
30675
30676 @smallexample
30677 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
30678 @end smallexample
30679
30680 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
30681 on the host system.
30682
30683 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30684
30685 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
30686
30687 @subsubheading Example
30688
30689 @smallexample
30690 (gdb)
30691 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
30692 ^done
30693 (gdb)
30694 @end smallexample
30695
30696
30697 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
30698 @findex -target-file-delete
30699
30700 @subsubheading Synopsis
30701
30702 @smallexample
30703 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
30704 @end smallexample
30705
30706 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
30707
30708 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30709
30710 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
30711
30712 @subsubheading Example
30713
30714 @smallexample
30715 (gdb)
30716 -target-file-delete remotefile
30717 ^done
30718 (gdb)
30719 @end smallexample
30720
30721
30722 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30723 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
30724 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
30725
30726 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
30727 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
30728
30729 @subsubheading Synopsis
30730
30731 @smallexample
30732 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
30733 @end smallexample
30734
30735 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
30736 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
30737 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
30738
30739 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30740
30741 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
30742
30743 @subsubheading Result
30744
30745 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
30746 defined for each exception:
30747
30748 @table @samp
30749 @item name
30750 The name of the exception.
30751
30752 @item address
30753 The address of the exception.
30754
30755 @end table
30756
30757 @subsubheading Example
30758
30759 @smallexample
30760 -info-ada-exceptions aint
30761 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
30762 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
30763 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
30764 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
30765 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
30766 @end smallexample
30767
30768 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
30769
30770 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
30771 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
30772 Catchpoint Commands}.
30773
30774
30775 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30776 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
30777 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
30778
30779 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
30780 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
30781 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
30782 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
30783
30784 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
30785 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
30786 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
30787
30788 @subsubheading Synopsis
30789
30790 @smallexample
30791 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
30792 @end smallexample
30793
30794 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
30795
30796 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
30797 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
30798 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
30799 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
30800 dash.
30801
30802 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30803
30804 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30805
30806 @subsubheading Result
30807
30808 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
30809
30810 @table @samp
30811 @item exists
30812 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
30813 @code{"false"} otherwise.
30814
30815 @end table
30816
30817 @subsubheading Example
30818
30819 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
30820
30821 @smallexample
30822 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
30823 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
30824 @end smallexample
30825
30826 @noindent
30827 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
30828 to the debugger:
30829
30830 @smallexample
30831 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
30832 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
30833 @end smallexample
30834
30835 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
30836 @findex -list-features
30837 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
30838
30839 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
30840 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
30841 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
30842 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
30843 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
30844 startup.
30845
30846 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
30847 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
30848 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
30849 is given below.
30850
30851 Example output:
30852
30853 @smallexample
30854 (gdb) -list-features
30855 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
30856 @end smallexample
30857
30858 The current list of features is:
30859
30860 @ftable @samp
30861 @item frozen-varobjs
30862 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
30863 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
30864 of @code{-varobj-create}.
30865 @item pending-breakpoints
30866 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
30867 command.
30868 @item python
30869 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
30870 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
30871 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
30872 @item thread-info
30873 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
30874 @item data-read-memory-bytes
30875 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
30876 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
30877 @item breakpoint-notifications
30878 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
30879 CLI will be announced via async records.
30880 @item ada-task-info
30881 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
30882 @item language-option
30883 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
30884 option (@pxref{Context management}).
30885 @item info-gdb-mi-command
30886 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
30887 @item undefined-command-error-code
30888 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
30889 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
30890 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
30891 @item exec-run-start-option
30892 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
30893 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
30894 @end ftable
30895
30896 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
30897 @findex -list-target-features
30898
30899 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
30900 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
30901 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
30902 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
30903 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
30904 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
30905 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
30906 Example output:
30907
30908 @smallexample
30909 (gdb) -list-target-features
30910 ^done,result=["async"]
30911 @end smallexample
30912
30913 The current list of features is:
30914
30915 @table @samp
30916 @item async
30917 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
30918 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
30919 while the target is running.
30920
30921 @item reverse
30922 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
30923 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
30924
30925 @end table
30926
30927 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30928 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
30929 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
30930
30931 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
30932
30933 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
30934 @findex -gdb-exit
30935
30936 @subsubheading Synopsis
30937
30938 @smallexample
30939 -gdb-exit
30940 @end smallexample
30941
30942 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
30943
30944 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30945
30946 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
30947
30948 @subsubheading Example
30949
30950 @smallexample
30951 (gdb)
30952 -gdb-exit
30953 ^exit
30954 @end smallexample
30955
30956
30957 @ignore
30958 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
30959 @findex -exec-abort
30960
30961 @subsubheading Synopsis
30962
30963 @smallexample
30964 -exec-abort
30965 @end smallexample
30966
30967 Kill the inferior running program.
30968
30969 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30970
30971 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
30972
30973 @subsubheading Example
30974 N.A.
30975 @end ignore
30976
30977
30978 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
30979 @findex -gdb-set
30980
30981 @subsubheading Synopsis
30982
30983 @smallexample
30984 -gdb-set
30985 @end smallexample
30986
30987 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
30988 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
30989
30990 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30991
30992 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
30993
30994 @subsubheading Example
30995
30996 @smallexample
30997 (gdb)
30998 -gdb-set $foo=3
30999 ^done
31000 (gdb)
31001 @end smallexample
31002
31003
31004 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
31005 @findex -gdb-show
31006
31007 @subsubheading Synopsis
31008
31009 @smallexample
31010 -gdb-show
31011 @end smallexample
31012
31013 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
31014
31015 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31016
31017 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
31018
31019 @subsubheading Example
31020
31021 @smallexample
31022 (gdb)
31023 -gdb-show annotate
31024 ^done,value="0"
31025 (gdb)
31026 @end smallexample
31027
31028 @c @subheading -gdb-source
31029
31030
31031 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
31032 @findex -gdb-version
31033
31034 @subsubheading Synopsis
31035
31036 @smallexample
31037 -gdb-version
31038 @end smallexample
31039
31040 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
31041
31042 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31043
31044 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
31045 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
31046
31047 @subsubheading Example
31048
31049 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
31050 @c box in TeX.
31051 @smallexample
31052 (gdb)
31053 -gdb-version
31054 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
31055 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
31056 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
31057 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
31058 ~ certain conditions.
31059 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
31060 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
31061 ~ details.
31062 ~This GDB was configured as
31063 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
31064 ^done
31065 (gdb)
31066 @end smallexample
31067
31068 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
31069 @findex -list-thread-groups
31070
31071 @subheading Synopsis
31072
31073 @smallexample
31074 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
31075 @end smallexample
31076
31077 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
31078 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
31079 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
31080 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
31081 top-level thread groups.
31082
31083 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
31084 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
31085 available on the target.
31086
31087 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
31088 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
31089 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
31090 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
31091 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
31092 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
31093 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
31094 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
31095
31096 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
31097 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
31098 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
31099 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
31100 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
31101 @samp{threads} field.
31102
31103 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
31104 the following caveats:
31105
31106 @itemize @bullet
31107 @item
31108 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
31109 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
31110 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
31111
31112 @item
31113 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
31114 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
31115 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
31116 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
31117 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
31118 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
31119
31120 @end itemize
31121
31122 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
31123 have the following fields:
31124
31125 @table @code
31126 @item id
31127 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
31128 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
31129 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
31130
31131 @item type
31132 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
31133 valid type.
31134
31135 @item pid
31136 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
31137 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
31138
31139 @item num_children
31140 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
31141 absent for an available thread group.
31142
31143 @item threads
31144 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
31145 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
31146 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
31147
31148 @item cores
31149 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
31150 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
31151 such information is not available.
31152
31153 @item executable
31154 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
31155 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
31156 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
31157
31158 @end table
31159
31160 @subheading Example
31161
31162 @smallexample
31163 @value{GDBP}
31164 -list-thread-groups
31165 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
31166 -list-thread-groups 17
31167 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
31168 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
31169 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
31170 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
31171 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
31172 -list-thread-groups --available
31173 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
31174 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
31175 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
31176 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
31177 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
31178 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
31179 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
31180 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
31181 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
31182 @end smallexample
31183
31184 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
31185 @findex -info-os
31186
31187 @subsubheading Synopsis
31188
31189 @smallexample
31190 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
31191 @end smallexample
31192
31193 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
31194 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
31195 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
31196 of data of that type.
31197
31198 The types of information available depend on the target operating
31199 system.
31200
31201 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31202
31203 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
31204
31205 @subsubheading Example
31206
31207 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
31208 like this:
31209
31210 @smallexample
31211 @value{GDBP}
31212 -info-os
31213 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="9",nr_cols="3",
31214 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
31215 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
31216 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
31217 body=[item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
31218 col2="Processes"@},
31219 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
31220 col2="Process groups"@},
31221 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
31222 col2="Threads"@},
31223 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
31224 col2="File descriptors"@},
31225 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
31226 col2="Sockets"@},
31227 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
31228 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
31229 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
31230 col2="Semaphores"@},
31231 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
31232 col2="Message queues"@},
31233 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
31234 col2="Kernel modules"@}]@}
31235 @value{GDBP}
31236 -info-os processes
31237 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
31238 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
31239 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
31240 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
31241 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
31242 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
31243 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
31244 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
31245 ...
31246 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
31247 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
31248 (gdb)
31249 @end smallexample
31250
31251 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
31252 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
31253 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
31254 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
31255 @code{info os} omits it.)
31256
31257 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
31258 @findex -add-inferior
31259
31260 @subheading Synopsis
31261
31262 @smallexample
31263 -add-inferior
31264 @end smallexample
31265
31266 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
31267 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
31268 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
31269 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
31270 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
31271 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
31272
31273 @subheading Example
31274
31275 @smallexample
31276 @value{GDBP}
31277 -add-inferior
31278 ^done,inferior="i3"
31279 @end smallexample
31280
31281 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
31282 @findex -interpreter-exec
31283
31284 @subheading Synopsis
31285
31286 @smallexample
31287 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
31288 @end smallexample
31289 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
31290
31291 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
31292
31293 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31294
31295 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
31296
31297 @subheading Example
31298
31299 @smallexample
31300 (gdb)
31301 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
31302 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
31303 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
31304 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
31305 ^done
31306 (gdb)
31307 @end smallexample
31308
31309 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
31310 @findex -inferior-tty-set
31311
31312 @subheading Synopsis
31313
31314 @smallexample
31315 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31316 @end smallexample
31317
31318 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
31319
31320 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31321
31322 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
31323
31324 @subheading Example
31325
31326 @smallexample
31327 (gdb)
31328 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31329 ^done
31330 (gdb)
31331 @end smallexample
31332
31333 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
31334 @findex -inferior-tty-show
31335
31336 @subheading Synopsis
31337
31338 @smallexample
31339 -inferior-tty-show
31340 @end smallexample
31341
31342 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
31343
31344 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31345
31346 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
31347
31348 @subheading Example
31349
31350 @smallexample
31351 (gdb)
31352 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31353 ^done
31354 (gdb)
31355 -inferior-tty-show
31356 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
31357 (gdb)
31358 @end smallexample
31359
31360 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
31361 @findex -enable-timings
31362
31363 @subheading Synopsis
31364
31365 @smallexample
31366 -enable-timings [yes | no]
31367 @end smallexample
31368
31369 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
31370 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
31371 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
31372 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
31373
31374 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31375
31376 No equivalent.
31377
31378 @subheading Example
31379
31380 @smallexample
31381 (gdb)
31382 -enable-timings
31383 ^done
31384 (gdb)
31385 -break-insert main
31386 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
31387 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
31388 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
31389 times="0"@},
31390 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
31391 (gdb)
31392 -enable-timings no
31393 ^done
31394 (gdb)
31395 -exec-run
31396 ^running
31397 (gdb)
31398 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
31399 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
31400 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
31401 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
31402 (gdb)
31403 @end smallexample
31404
31405 @node Annotations
31406 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
31407
31408 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
31409 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
31410 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
31411 relatively high level.
31412
31413 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
31414 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
31415
31416 @ignore
31417 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
31418 @end ignore
31419
31420 @menu
31421 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
31422 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
31423 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
31424 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
31425 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
31426 * Annotations for Running::
31427 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
31428 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
31429 @end menu
31430
31431 @node Annotations Overview
31432 @section What is an Annotation?
31433 @cindex annotations
31434
31435 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
31436 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
31437 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
31438 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
31439 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
31440 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
31441 cannot contain newline characters.
31442
31443 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
31444 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
31445 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
31446 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
31447 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
31448 means those three characters as output.
31449
31450 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
31451 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
31452 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
31453 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
31454 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
31455 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
31456 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
31457 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
31458 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
31459
31460 @table @code
31461 @kindex set annotate
31462 @item set annotate @var{level}
31463 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
31464 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
31465
31466 @item show annotate
31467 @kindex show annotate
31468 Show the current annotation level.
31469 @end table
31470
31471 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
31472
31473 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
31474
31475 @smallexample
31476 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
31477 GNU gdb 6.0
31478 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
31479 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
31480 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
31481 under certain conditions.
31482 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
31483 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
31484 for details.
31485 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
31486
31487 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
31488 (@value{GDBP})
31489 ^Z^Zprompt
31490 @kbd{quit}
31491
31492 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
31493 $
31494 @end smallexample
31495
31496 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
31497 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
31498 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
31499 output from @value{GDBN}.
31500
31501 @node Server Prefix
31502 @section The Server Prefix
31503 @cindex server prefix
31504
31505 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
31506 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
31507 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
31508 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
31509 a transparent manner.
31510
31511 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
31512 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
31513 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
31514 @code{print} command.
31515
31516 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
31517 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
31518
31519 @node Prompting
31520 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
31521
31522 @cindex annotations for prompts
31523 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
31524 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
31525 over, etc.
31526
31527 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
31528 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
31529 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
31530 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
31531 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
31532 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
31533 features the following annotations:
31534
31535 @smallexample
31536 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
31537 ^Z^Zprompt
31538 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
31539 @end smallexample
31540
31541 The input types are
31542
31543 @table @code
31544 @findex pre-prompt annotation
31545 @findex prompt annotation
31546 @findex post-prompt annotation
31547 @item prompt
31548 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
31549
31550 @findex pre-commands annotation
31551 @findex commands annotation
31552 @findex post-commands annotation
31553 @item commands
31554 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
31555 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
31556
31557 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
31558 @findex overload-choice annotation
31559 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
31560 @item overload-choice
31561 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
31562
31563 @findex pre-query annotation
31564 @findex query annotation
31565 @findex post-query annotation
31566 @item query
31567 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
31568
31569 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
31570 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
31571 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
31572 @item prompt-for-continue
31573 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
31574 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
31575 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
31576 presence of annotations.
31577 @end table
31578
31579 @node Errors
31580 @section Errors
31581 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
31582
31583 @findex quit annotation
31584 @smallexample
31585 ^Z^Zquit
31586 @end smallexample
31587
31588 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
31589
31590 @findex error annotation
31591 @smallexample
31592 ^Z^Zerror
31593 @end smallexample
31594
31595 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
31596
31597 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
31598 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
31599 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
31600 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
31601 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
31602 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
31603 to the top level.
31604
31605 @findex error-begin annotation
31606 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
31607
31608 @smallexample
31609 ^Z^Zerror-begin
31610 @end smallexample
31611
31612 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
31613 message.
31614
31615 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
31616 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
31617 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
31618
31619 @node Invalidation
31620 @section Invalidation Notices
31621
31622 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
31623 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
31624 changed.
31625
31626 @table @code
31627 @findex frames-invalid annotation
31628 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
31629
31630 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
31631 have changed.
31632
31633 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
31634 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
31635
31636 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
31637 deleted a breakpoint.
31638 @end table
31639
31640 @node Annotations for Running
31641 @section Running the Program
31642 @cindex annotations for running programs
31643
31644 @findex starting annotation
31645 @findex stopping annotation
31646 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
31647 @code{step} or @code{continue},
31648
31649 @smallexample
31650 ^Z^Zstarting
31651 @end smallexample
31652
31653 is output. When the program stops,
31654
31655 @smallexample
31656 ^Z^Zstopped
31657 @end smallexample
31658
31659 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
31660 annotations describe how the program stopped.
31661
31662 @table @code
31663 @findex exited annotation
31664 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
31665 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
31666 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
31667
31668 @findex signalled annotation
31669 @findex signal-name annotation
31670 @findex signal-name-end annotation
31671 @findex signal-string annotation
31672 @findex signal-string-end annotation
31673 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
31674 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
31675 annotation continues:
31676
31677 @smallexample
31678 @var{intro-text}
31679 ^Z^Zsignal-name
31680 @var{name}
31681 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
31682 @var{middle-text}
31683 ^Z^Zsignal-string
31684 @var{string}
31685 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
31686 @var{end-text}
31687 @end smallexample
31688
31689 @noindent
31690 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
31691 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
31692 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
31693 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
31694 user's benefit and have no particular format.
31695
31696 @findex signal annotation
31697 @item ^Z^Zsignal
31698 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
31699 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
31700 terminated with it.
31701
31702 @findex breakpoint annotation
31703 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
31704 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
31705
31706 @findex watchpoint annotation
31707 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
31708 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
31709 @end table
31710
31711 @node Source Annotations
31712 @section Displaying Source
31713 @cindex annotations for source display
31714
31715 @findex source annotation
31716 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
31717
31718 @smallexample
31719 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
31720 @end smallexample
31721
31722 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
31723 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
31724 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
31725 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
31726 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
31727 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
31728 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
31729 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
31730 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
31731 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
31732 depend on the language).
31733
31734 @node JIT Interface
31735 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
31736 @cindex just-in-time compilation
31737 @cindex JIT compilation interface
31738
31739 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
31740 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
31741 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
31742 performance while maintaining platform independence.
31743
31744 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
31745 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
31746 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
31747 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
31748 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
31749 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
31750
31751 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
31752 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
31753 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
31754 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
31755 LLVM JIT.
31756
31757 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
31758 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
31759 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
31760 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
31761 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
31762 out about additional code.
31763
31764 @menu
31765 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
31766 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
31767 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
31768 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
31769 @end menu
31770
31771 @node Declarations
31772 @section JIT Declarations
31773
31774 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
31775 implement the interface:
31776
31777 @smallexample
31778 typedef enum
31779 @{
31780 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
31781 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
31782 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
31783 @} jit_actions_t;
31784
31785 struct jit_code_entry
31786 @{
31787 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
31788 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
31789 const char *symfile_addr;
31790 uint64_t symfile_size;
31791 @};
31792
31793 struct jit_descriptor
31794 @{
31795 uint32_t version;
31796 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
31797 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
31798 uint32_t action_flag;
31799 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
31800 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
31801 @};
31802
31803 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
31804 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
31805
31806 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
31807 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
31808 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
31809 @end smallexample
31810
31811 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
31812 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
31813 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
31814
31815 @node Registering Code
31816 @section Registering Code
31817
31818 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
31819
31820 @itemize @bullet
31821 @item
31822 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
31823 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
31824
31825 @item
31826 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
31827 file.
31828
31829 @item
31830 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
31831
31832 @item
31833 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
31834
31835 @item
31836 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
31837 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
31838 @end itemize
31839
31840 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
31841 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
31842 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
31843 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
31844
31845 @node Unregistering Code
31846 @section Unregistering Code
31847
31848 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
31849
31850 @itemize @bullet
31851 @item
31852 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
31853
31854 @item
31855 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
31856
31857 @item
31858 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
31859 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
31860 @end itemize
31861
31862 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
31863 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
31864
31865 @node Custom Debug Info
31866 @section Custom Debug Info
31867 @cindex custom JIT debug info
31868 @cindex JIT debug info reader
31869
31870 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
31871 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
31872 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
31873 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
31874 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
31875 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
31876 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
31877 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
31878 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
31879
31880 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
31881 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
31882 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
31883 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
31884 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
31885 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
31886 compiler.
31887
31888 @menu
31889 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
31890 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
31891 @end menu
31892
31893 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
31894 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
31895 @kindex jit-reader-load
31896 @kindex jit-reader-unload
31897
31898 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
31899 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
31900
31901 @table @code
31902 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
31903 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}. @var{reader} is a shared
31904 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
31905 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
31906 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
31907 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
31908 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
31909
31910 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
31911 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
31912 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
31913 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
31914 @code{jit-reader-load}.
31915
31916 @item jit-reader-unload
31917 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
31918
31919 @end table
31920
31921 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
31922 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
31923 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
31924
31925 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
31926 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
31927
31928 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
31929 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
31930 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
31931 the system include directory.
31932
31933 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
31934 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
31935 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
31936
31937 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
31938 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
31939
31940 @findex gdb_init_reader
31941 @smallexample
31942 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
31943 @end smallexample
31944
31945 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
31946
31947 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
31948 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
31949 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
31950 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
31951 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
31952 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
31953
31954 @smallexample
31955 struct gdb_reader_funcs
31956 @{
31957 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
31958 int reader_version;
31959
31960 /* For use by the reader. */
31961 void *priv_data;
31962
31963 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
31964 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
31965 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
31966 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
31967 @};
31968 @end smallexample
31969
31970 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
31971 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
31972
31973 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
31974 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
31975 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
31976 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
31977 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
31978 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
31979 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
31980 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
31981 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
31982 target's address space.
31983
31984 @node In-Process Agent
31985 @chapter In-Process Agent
31986 @cindex debugging agent
31987 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
31988 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
31989 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
31990 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
31991 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
31992 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
31993 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
31994 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
31995 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
31996 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
31997 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
31998 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
31999 behavior without interrupting it.
32000
32001 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
32002 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
32003 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
32004 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
32005 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
32006 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
32007 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
32008 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
32009 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
32010
32011 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
32012 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
32013 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
32014 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
32015
32016 @anchor{Control Agent}
32017 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
32018 debugging with the following commands:
32019
32020 @table @code
32021 @kindex set agent on
32022 @item set agent on
32023 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
32024 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
32025 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
32026 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
32027 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
32028 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
32029
32030 @kindex set agent off
32031 @item set agent off
32032 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
32033 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
32034
32035 @kindex show agent
32036 @item show agent
32037 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
32038 the in-process agent.
32039 @end table
32040
32041 @menu
32042 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
32043 @end menu
32044
32045 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
32046 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
32047 @cindex in-process agent protocol
32048
32049 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
32050 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
32051 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
32052 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
32053 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
32054 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
32055 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
32056 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
32057 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
32058
32059 @menu
32060 * IPA Protocol Objects::
32061 * IPA Protocol Commands::
32062 @end menu
32063
32064 @node IPA Protocol Objects
32065 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
32066 @cindex ipa protocol objects
32067
32068 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
32069 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
32070
32071 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
32072 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
32073 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
32074 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
32075
32076 @enumerate
32077 @item
32078 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
32079 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
32080 @item
32081 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
32082 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
32083 the other one.
32084 @end enumerate
32085
32086 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
32087
32088 @enumerate
32089 @item
32090 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
32091 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
32092 @anchor{agent expression object}
32093 @item
32094 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
32095 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
32096 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
32097 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
32098 @item
32099 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
32100 @anchor{tracepoint object}
32101
32102 @end enumerate
32103
32104 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
32105 object:
32106
32107 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
32108 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
32109 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
32110 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
32111 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
32112 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
32113 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32114 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
32115 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
32116 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
32117 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
32118 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
32119 memory address for collecting.
32120 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
32121 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32122 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
32123 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32124 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
32125 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32126 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
32127 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
32128 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
32129 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
32130 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
32131 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
32132 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
32133 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
32134 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
32135 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
32136 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
32137 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
32138 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
32139 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
32140 @ref{agent expression object}
32141 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
32142 @ref{agent expression object}
32143 @item actions @tab variable
32144 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
32145 @end multitable
32146
32147 @node IPA Protocol Commands
32148 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
32149 @cindex ipa protocol commands
32150
32151 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
32152 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
32153
32154 @table @samp
32155
32156 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
32157 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
32158 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
32159 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
32160 in IPA finally.
32161
32162 Replies:
32163 @table @samp
32164 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
32165 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
32166 @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
32167 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
32168 @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
32169 @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
32170 @item E @var{NN}
32171 for an error
32172
32173 @end table
32174
32175 @item close
32176 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
32177 is about to kill inferiors.
32178
32179 @item qTfSTM
32180 @xref{qTfSTM}.
32181 @item qTsSTM
32182 @xref{qTsSTM}.
32183 @item qTSTMat
32184 @xref{qTSTMat}.
32185 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
32186 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
32187
32188 Replies:
32189 @table @samp
32190 @item E @var{NN}
32191 for an error
32192 @end table
32193 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
32194 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
32195 @end table
32196
32197 @node GDB Bugs
32198 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
32199 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
32200 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
32201
32202 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
32203
32204 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
32205 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
32206 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
32207 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
32208
32209 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
32210 information that enables us to fix the bug.
32211
32212 @menu
32213 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
32214 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
32215 @end menu
32216
32217 @node Bug Criteria
32218 @section Have You Found a Bug?
32219 @cindex bug criteria
32220
32221 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
32222
32223 @itemize @bullet
32224 @cindex fatal signal
32225 @cindex debugger crash
32226 @cindex crash of debugger
32227 @item
32228 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
32229 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
32230
32231 @cindex error on valid input
32232 @item
32233 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
32234 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
32235 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
32236
32237 @cindex invalid input
32238 @item
32239 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
32240 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
32241 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
32242 for traditional practice''.
32243
32244 @item
32245 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
32246 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
32247 @end itemize
32248
32249 @node Bug Reporting
32250 @section How to Report Bugs
32251 @cindex bug reports
32252 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
32253
32254 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
32255 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
32256 contact that organization first.
32257
32258 You can find contact information for many support companies and
32259 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
32260 distribution.
32261 @c should add a web page ref...
32262
32263 @ifset BUGURL
32264 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
32265 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
32266 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
32267 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
32268 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
32269 be used.
32270
32271 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
32272 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
32273 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
32274 @samp{bug-gdb}.
32275
32276 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
32277 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
32278 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
32279 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
32280 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
32281 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
32282 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
32283 bug reports to the mailing list.
32284 @end ifset
32285 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
32286 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
32287 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
32288 @end ifclear
32289 @end ifset
32290
32291 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
32292 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
32293 fact or leave it out, state it!
32294
32295 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
32296 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
32297 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
32298 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
32299 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
32300 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
32301 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
32302 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
32303 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
32304
32305 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
32306 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
32307 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
32308 self-contained.
32309
32310 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
32311 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
32312 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
32313 bugs properly.
32314
32315 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
32316
32317 @itemize @bullet
32318 @item
32319 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
32320 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
32321 version}.
32322
32323 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
32324 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
32325
32326 @item
32327 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
32328 version number.
32329
32330 @item
32331 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
32332 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
32333 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
32334 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
32335
32336 @item
32337 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
32338 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
32339
32340 @item
32341 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
32342 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
32343 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
32344 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
32345 those compilers.
32346
32347 @item
32348 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
32349 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
32350 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
32351 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
32352
32353 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
32354 and then we might not encounter the bug.
32355
32356 @item
32357 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
32358 reproduce the bug.
32359
32360 @item
32361 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
32362 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
32363
32364 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
32365 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
32366 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
32367 a chance to make a mistake.
32368
32369 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
32370 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
32371 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
32372 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
32373 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
32374 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
32375 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
32376 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
32377
32378 @pindex script
32379 @cindex recording a session script
32380 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
32381 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
32382 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
32383 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
32384
32385 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
32386 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
32387
32388 @item
32389 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
32390 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
32391 it by context, not by line number.
32392
32393 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
32394 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
32395
32396 @end itemize
32397
32398 Here are some things that are not necessary:
32399
32400 @itemize @bullet
32401 @item
32402 A description of the envelope of the bug.
32403
32404 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
32405 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
32406 changes will not affect it.
32407
32408 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
32409 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
32410 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
32411 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
32412
32413 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
32414 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
32415 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
32416 less time, and so on.
32417
32418 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
32419 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
32420
32421 @item
32422 A patch for the bug.
32423
32424 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
32425 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
32426 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
32427 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
32428
32429 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
32430 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
32431 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
32432 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
32433
32434 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
32435 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
32436 help us to understand.
32437
32438 @item
32439 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
32440
32441 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
32442 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
32443 @end itemize
32444
32445 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
32446 @c and consists of the two following files:
32447 @c rluser.texi
32448 @c hsuser.texi
32449 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
32450 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
32451 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
32452 @include rluser.texi
32453 @include hsuser.texi
32454 @end ifclear
32455
32456 @node In Memoriam
32457 @appendix In Memoriam
32458
32459 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
32460 contributors:
32461
32462 @table @code
32463 @item Fred Fish
32464 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
32465 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
32466 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
32467
32468 @item Michael Snyder
32469 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
32470 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
32471 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
32472 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
32473 @end table
32474
32475 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
32476 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
32477
32478 @node Formatting Documentation
32479 @appendix Formatting Documentation
32480
32481 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
32482 @cindex reference card
32483 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
32484 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
32485 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
32486 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
32487 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
32488 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
32489
32490 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
32491 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
32492
32493 @smallexample
32494 make refcard.dvi
32495 @end smallexample
32496
32497 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
32498 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
32499 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
32500 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
32501 your @sc{dvi} output program.
32502
32503 @cindex documentation
32504
32505 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
32506 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
32507 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
32508 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
32509 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
32510 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
32511
32512 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
32513 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
32514 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
32515 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
32516 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
32517 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
32518 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
32519 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
32520
32521 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
32522 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
32523 @code{makeinfo}.
32524
32525 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
32526 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
32527 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
32528
32529 @smallexample
32530 cd gdb
32531 make gdb.info
32532 @end smallexample
32533
32534 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
32535 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
32536 Texinfo definitions file.
32537
32538 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
32539 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
32540 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
32541 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
32542 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
32543 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
32544 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
32545
32546 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
32547 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
32548 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
32549 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
32550 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
32551 directory.
32552
32553 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
32554 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
32555 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
32556 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
32557
32558 @smallexample
32559 make gdb.dvi
32560 @end smallexample
32561
32562 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
32563
32564 @node Installing GDB
32565 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
32566 @cindex installation
32567
32568 @menu
32569 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
32570 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
32571 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
32572 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
32573 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
32574 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
32575 @end menu
32576
32577 @node Requirements
32578 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
32579 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
32580
32581 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
32582 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
32583
32584 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
32585 @table @asis
32586 @item ISO C90 compiler
32587 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
32588 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
32589
32590 @end table
32591
32592 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
32593 @table @asis
32594 @item Expat
32595 @anchor{Expat}
32596 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
32597 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
32598 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
32599 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
32600 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
32601 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
32602
32603 Expat is used for:
32604
32605 @itemize @bullet
32606 @item
32607 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
32608 @item
32609 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
32610 @item
32611 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
32612 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
32613 @item
32614 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
32615 @item
32616 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
32617 @item
32618 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format})
32619 @end itemize
32620
32621 @item zlib
32622 @cindex compressed debug sections
32623 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
32624 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
32625 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
32626 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
32627 information in such binaries.
32628
32629 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
32630 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
32631 @url{http://zlib.net}.
32632
32633 @item iconv
32634 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
32635 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
32636 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
32637 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
32638
32639 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
32640 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
32641 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
32642 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
32643
32644 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
32645 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
32646 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
32647
32648 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
32649 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
32650 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
32651 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
32652 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
32653 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
32654 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
32655 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
32656 @end table
32657
32658 @node Running Configure
32659 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
32660 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
32661 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
32662 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
32663 build the @code{gdb} program.
32664 @iftex
32665 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
32666 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
32667 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
32668 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
32669 @end iftex
32670
32671 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
32672 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
32673 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
32674
32675 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
32676 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
32677
32678 @table @code
32679 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
32680 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
32681
32682 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
32683 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
32684
32685 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
32686 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
32687
32688 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
32689 @sc{gnu} include files
32690
32691 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
32692 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
32693
32694 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
32695 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
32696
32697 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
32698 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
32699
32700 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
32701 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
32702
32703 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
32704 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
32705 @end table
32706
32707 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
32708 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
32709 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
32710
32711 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
32712 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
32713 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
32714 argument.
32715
32716 For example:
32717
32718 @smallexample
32719 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
32720 ./configure @var{host}
32721 make
32722 @end smallexample
32723
32724 @noindent
32725 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
32726 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
32727 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
32728 correct value by examining your system.)
32729
32730 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
32731 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
32732 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
32733 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
32734
32735 @need 750
32736 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
32737 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
32738 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
32739
32740 @smallexample
32741 sh configure @var{host}
32742 @end smallexample
32743
32744 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
32745 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
32746 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
32747 @file{configure}
32748 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
32749 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
32750
32751 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
32752 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
32753 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
32754 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
32755 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
32756 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
32757 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
32758 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
32759 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
32760
32761 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
32762 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
32763 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
32764 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
32765 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
32766
32767 @node Separate Objdir
32768 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
32769
32770 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
32771 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
32772 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
32773 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
32774 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
32775 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
32776 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
32777 program specified there.
32778
32779 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
32780 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
32781 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
32782 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
32783 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
32784 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
32785
32786 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
32787 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
32788
32789 @smallexample
32790 @group
32791 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
32792 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
32793 cd ../gdb-sun4
32794 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
32795 make
32796 @end group
32797 @end smallexample
32798
32799 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
32800 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
32801 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
32802 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
32803 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
32804 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
32805
32806 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
32807 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
32808 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
32809 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
32810 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
32811
32812 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
32813 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
32814 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
32815 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
32816 You specify a cross-debugging target by
32817 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
32818
32819 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
32820 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
32821 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
32822
32823 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
32824 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
32825 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
32826 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
32827 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
32828
32829 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
32830 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
32831 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
32832 with each other.
32833
32834 @node Config Names
32835 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
32836
32837 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
32838 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
32839 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
32840 of information in the following pattern:
32841
32842 @smallexample
32843 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
32844 @end smallexample
32845
32846 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
32847 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
32848 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
32849
32850 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
32851 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
32852 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
32853 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
32854 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
32855 abbreviations---for example:
32856
32857 @smallexample
32858 % sh config.sub i386-linux
32859 i386-pc-linux-gnu
32860 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
32861 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
32862 % sh config.sub hp9k700
32863 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
32864 % sh config.sub sun4
32865 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
32866 % sh config.sub sun3
32867 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
32868 % sh config.sub i986v
32869 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
32870 @end smallexample
32871
32872 @noindent
32873 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
32874 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
32875
32876 @node Configure Options
32877 @section @file{configure} Options
32878
32879 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
32880 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
32881 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
32882 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
32883
32884 @smallexample
32885 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
32886 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
32887 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
32888 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
32889 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
32890 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
32891 @var{host}
32892 @end smallexample
32893
32894 @noindent
32895 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
32896 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
32897 @samp{--}.
32898
32899 @table @code
32900 @item --help
32901 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
32902
32903 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
32904 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
32905 @file{@var{dir}}.
32906
32907 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
32908 Configure the source to install programs under directory
32909 @file{@var{dir}}.
32910
32911 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
32912 @need 2000
32913 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
32914 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
32915 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
32916 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
32917 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
32918 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
32919 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
32920 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
32921 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
32922 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
32923 @var{dirname}.
32924
32925 @item --norecursion
32926 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
32927 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
32928
32929 @item --target=@var{target}
32930 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
32931 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
32932 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
32933
32934 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
32935
32936 @item @var{host} @dots{}
32937 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
32938
32939 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
32940 @end table
32941
32942 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
32943 needed for special purposes only.
32944
32945 @node System-wide configuration
32946 @section System-wide configuration and settings
32947 @cindex system-wide init file
32948
32949 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
32950 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
32951 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
32952
32953 Here is the corresponding configure option:
32954
32955 @table @code
32956 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
32957 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
32958 @var{file}.
32959 @end table
32960
32961 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
32962 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
32963
32964 @itemize @bullet
32965 @item
32966 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
32967 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
32968 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
32969 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
32970 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
32971 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
32972
32973 @item
32974 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
32975 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
32976 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
32977 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
32978 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
32979 @end itemize
32980
32981 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
32982 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
32983 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
32984 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
32985 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
32986 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
32987 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
32988 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
32989 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
32990 reread.
32991
32992 @menu
32993 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
32994 @end menu
32995
32996 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
32997 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
32998 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
32999
33000 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
33001 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
33002 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
33003 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
33004 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
33005 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
33006
33007 The following scripts are currently available:
33008 @itemize @bullet
33009
33010 @item @file{elinos.py}
33011 @pindex elinos.py
33012 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
33013 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
33014 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
33015 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
33016 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
33017 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
33018
33019 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
33020 @pindex wrs-linux.py
33021 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
33022 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
33023 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
33024 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
33025
33026 @end itemize
33027
33028 @node Maintenance Commands
33029 @appendix Maintenance Commands
33030 @cindex maintenance commands
33031 @cindex internal commands
33032
33033 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
33034 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
33035 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
33036 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
33037 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
33038
33039 @table @code
33040 @kindex maint agent
33041 @kindex maint agent-eval
33042 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
33043 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
33044 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
33045 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
33046 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
33047 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
33048 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
33049 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
33050 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
33051 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
33052 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
33053 addition and return the sum.
33054 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
33055 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
33056
33057 @kindex maint agent-printf
33058 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
33059 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
33060 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
33061 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
33062 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
33063
33064 @kindex maint info breakpoints
33065 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
33066 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
33067 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
33068 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
33069 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
33070 is shown:
33071
33072 @table @code
33073 @item breakpoint
33074 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
33075
33076 @item watchpoint
33077 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
33078
33079 @item longjmp
33080 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
33081 @code{longjmp} calls.
33082
33083 @item longjmp resume
33084 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
33085
33086 @item until
33087 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
33088
33089 @item finish
33090 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
33091
33092 @item shlib events
33093 Shared library events.
33094
33095 @end table
33096
33097 @kindex maint info bfds
33098 @item maint info bfds
33099 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
33100 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Top, , BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}.
33101
33102 @kindex set displaced-stepping
33103 @kindex show displaced-stepping
33104 @cindex displaced stepping support
33105 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
33106 @item set displaced-stepping
33107 @itemx show displaced-stepping
33108 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
33109 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
33110 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
33111 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
33112 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
33113
33114 @table @code
33115 @item set displaced-stepping on
33116 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
33117 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
33118
33119 @item set displaced-stepping off
33120 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
33121 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
33122
33123 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
33124 @item set displaced-stepping auto
33125 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
33126 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
33127 architecture supports displaced stepping.
33128 @end table
33129
33130 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
33131 @item maint check-psymtabs
33132 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
33133 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
33134
33135 @kindex maint check-symtabs
33136 @item maint check-symtabs
33137 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
33138
33139 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
33140 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
33141 Expand symbol tables.
33142 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
33143 names matching @var{regexp}.
33144
33145 @kindex maint cplus first_component
33146 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
33147 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
33148
33149 @kindex maint cplus namespace
33150 @item maint cplus namespace
33151 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
33152
33153 @kindex maint demangle
33154 @item maint demangle @var{name}
33155 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
33156
33157 @kindex maint deprecate
33158 @kindex maint undeprecate
33159 @cindex deprecated commands
33160 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
33161 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
33162 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
33163 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
33164 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
33165 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
33166 the replacement as part of the warning.
33167
33168 @kindex maint dump-me
33169 @item maint dump-me
33170 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
33171 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
33172 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
33173 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
33174
33175 @kindex maint internal-error
33176 @kindex maint internal-warning
33177 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33178 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33179 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
33180 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
33181 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
33182 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
33183 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
33184 @value{GDBN} session.
33185
33186 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
33187 used as the text of the error or warning message.
33188
33189 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
33190
33191 @smallexample
33192 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
33193 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
33194 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
33195 debugging may prove unreliable.
33196 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
33197 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
33198 (@value{GDBP})
33199 @end smallexample
33200
33201 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
33202 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
33203
33204 @kindex maint set internal-error
33205 @kindex maint show internal-error
33206 @kindex maint set internal-warning
33207 @kindex maint show internal-warning
33208 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33209 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
33210 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33211 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
33212 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
33213 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
33214 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
33215 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
33216 described in the table below.
33217
33218 @table @samp
33219 @item quit
33220 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
33221 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
33222
33223 @item corefile
33224 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
33225 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do.
33226 @end table
33227
33228 @kindex maint packet
33229 @item maint packet @var{text}
33230 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
33231 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
33232 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
33233 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
33234 checksum.
33235
33236 @kindex maint print architecture
33237 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33238 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
33239 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
33240
33241 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
33242 @item maint print c-tdesc
33243 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
33244 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
33245 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
33246
33247 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
33248 @item maint print dummy-frames
33249 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
33250
33251 @smallexample
33252 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
33253 @dots{}
33254 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
33255 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
33256 58 return (a + b);
33257 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
33258 @dots{}
33259 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
33260 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
33261 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
33262 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
33263 (@value{GDBP})
33264 @end smallexample
33265
33266 Takes an optional file parameter.
33267
33268 @kindex maint print registers
33269 @kindex maint print raw-registers
33270 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
33271 @kindex maint print register-groups
33272 @kindex maint print remote-registers
33273 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33274 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33275 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33276 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33277 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33278 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
33279
33280 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
33281 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
33282 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
33283 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
33284 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
33285 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
33286 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
33287 and offsets in the `G' packets.
33288
33289 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
33290 write the information.
33291
33292 @kindex maint print reggroups
33293 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33294 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
33295 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
33296 information.
33297
33298 The register groups info looks like this:
33299
33300 @smallexample
33301 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
33302 Group Type
33303 general user
33304 float user
33305 all user
33306 vector user
33307 system user
33308 save internal
33309 restore internal
33310 @end smallexample
33311
33312 @kindex flushregs
33313 @item flushregs
33314 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
33315
33316 @kindex maint print objfiles
33317 @cindex info for known object files
33318 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
33319 Print a dump of all known object files.
33320 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
33321 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
33322 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
33323
33324 @kindex maint print section-scripts
33325 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
33326 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
33327 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
33328 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
33329 matching @var{regexp}.
33330 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
33331 and the full path if known.
33332 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
33333
33334 @kindex maint print statistics
33335 @cindex bcache statistics
33336 @item maint print statistics
33337 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
33338 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
33339 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
33340 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
33341 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
33342 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
33343 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
33344 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
33345 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
33346 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
33347 lengths.
33348
33349 @kindex maint print target-stack
33350 @cindex target stack description
33351 @item maint print target-stack
33352 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
33353 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
33354 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
33355 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
33356 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
33357 address.
33358
33359 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
33360 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
33361
33362 @kindex maint print type
33363 @cindex type chain of a data type
33364 @item maint print type @var{expr}
33365 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
33366 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
33367 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
33368 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
33369 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
33370
33371 @kindex maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
33372 @kindex maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
33373 @item maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
33374 @item maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
33375 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
33376 information.
33377
33378 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
33379 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
33380 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
33381 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
33382 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
33383 always see the disassembly form.
33384
33385 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
33386
33387 @smallexample
33388 (gdb) info addr argc
33389 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
33390 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
33391 @end smallexample
33392
33393 For more information on these expressions, see
33394 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
33395
33396 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
33397 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
33398 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
33399 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
33400 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
33401
33402 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
33403 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
33404 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
33405 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
33406 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
33407 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
33408 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
33409 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
33410 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
33411
33412 @kindex maint set profile
33413 @kindex maint show profile
33414 @cindex profiling GDB
33415 @item maint set profile
33416 @itemx maint show profile
33417 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
33418
33419 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
33420 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
33421 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
33422 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
33423 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
33424 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
33425 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
33426
33427 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
33428 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
33429
33430 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
33431 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
33432 @cindex hardware debug registers
33433 @item maint set show-debug-regs
33434 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
33435 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
33436 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
33437 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
33438 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
33439 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
33440
33441 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
33442 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
33443 @item maint set show-all-tib
33444 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
33445 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
33446 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
33447 command.
33448
33449 @kindex maint set per-command
33450 @kindex maint show per-command
33451 @item maint set per-command
33452 @itemx maint show per-command
33453 @cindex resources used by commands
33454
33455 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
33456 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
33457
33458 @table @code
33459 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
33460 @itemx maint show per-command space
33461 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
33462 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
33463 took, following the command's own output.
33464 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
33465 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
33466
33467 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
33468 @itemx maint show per-command time
33469 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
33470 for each command.
33471 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
33472 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
33473 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
33474 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
33475 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
33476 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
33477 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
33478 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
33479 spent by the program been debugged.
33480 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
33481 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
33482
33483 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
33484 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
33485 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
33486 for each command.
33487 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
33488
33489 @enumerate a
33490 @item
33491 number of symbol tables
33492 @item
33493 number of primary symbol tables
33494 @item
33495 number of blocks in the blockvector
33496 @end enumerate
33497 @end table
33498
33499 @kindex maint space
33500 @cindex memory used by commands
33501 @item maint space @var{value}
33502 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
33503 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
33504
33505 @kindex maint time
33506 @cindex time of command execution
33507 @item maint time @var{value}
33508 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
33509 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
33510
33511 @kindex maint translate-address
33512 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
33513 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
33514 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
33515 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
33516 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
33517 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
33518 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
33519
33520 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
33521 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
33522 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
33523
33524 @end table
33525
33526 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
33527 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
33528
33529 @table @code
33530 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
33531 @kindex set watchdog
33532 @cindex watchdog timer
33533 @cindex timeout for commands
33534 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
33535 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
33536 reports and error and the command is aborted.
33537
33538 @item show watchdog
33539 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
33540 @end table
33541
33542 @node Remote Protocol
33543 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
33544
33545 @menu
33546 * Overview::
33547 * Packets::
33548 * Stop Reply Packets::
33549 * General Query Packets::
33550 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
33551 * Tracepoint Packets::
33552 * Host I/O Packets::
33553 * Interrupts::
33554 * Notification Packets::
33555 * Remote Non-Stop::
33556 * Packet Acknowledgment::
33557 * Examples::
33558 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
33559 * Library List Format::
33560 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
33561 * Memory Map Format::
33562 * Thread List Format::
33563 * Traceframe Info Format::
33564 * Branch Trace Format::
33565 @end menu
33566
33567 @node Overview
33568 @section Overview
33569
33570 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
33571 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
33572 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
33573 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
33574
33575 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
33576 transmitted and received data, respectively.
33577
33578 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
33579 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
33580 @cindex remote serial protocol
33581 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
33582 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
33583 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
33584 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
33585 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
33586
33587 @smallexample
33588 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
33589 @end smallexample
33590 @noindent
33591
33592 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
33593 @noindent
33594 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
33595 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
33596 eight bit unsigned checksum).
33597
33598 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
33599 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
33600
33601 @smallexample
33602 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
33603 @end smallexample
33604
33605 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
33606 @noindent
33607 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
33608 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
33609 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
33610
33611 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
33612 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
33613 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
33614 retransmission):
33615
33616 @smallexample
33617 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
33618 <- @code{+}
33619 @end smallexample
33620 @noindent
33621
33622 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
33623 once a connection is established.
33624 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
33625
33626 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
33627 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
33628 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
33629 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
33630 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
33631 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
33632 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
33633
33634 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
33635 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
33636 exceptions).
33637
33638 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
33639 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
33640 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
33641 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
33642
33643 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
33644 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
33645 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
33646
33647 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
33648 @anchor{Binary Data}
33649 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
33650 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
33651 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
33652 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
33653 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
33654 binary data.
33655
33656 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
33657 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
33658 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
33659 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
33660 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
33661 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
33662 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
33663 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
33664 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
33665 (described next).
33666
33667 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
33668 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
33669 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
33670 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
33671 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
33672 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
33673 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
33674 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
33675 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
33676 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
33677 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
33678 3}} more times.
33679
33680 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
33681 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
33682 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
33683 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
33684 @samp{0*"00}.
33685
33686 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
33687 error number. That number is not well defined.
33688
33689 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
33690 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
33691 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
33692 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
33693 on that response.
33694
33695 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
33696 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
33697 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
33698 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
33699 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
33700 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
33701
33702 @node Packets
33703 @section Packets
33704
33705 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
33706 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
33707 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
33708 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
33709
33710 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
33711 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
33712 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
33713 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
33714 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
33715 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
33716 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
33717 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
33718 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
33719 @var{baz}.
33720
33721 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
33722 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
33723 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
33724 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
33725 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
33726 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
33727 pick any thread.
33728
33729 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
33730 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
33731 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
33732 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
33733 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
33734 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
33735 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
33736 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
33737 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
33738 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
33739 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
33740 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
33741 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
33742
33743 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
33744 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
33745 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
33746 more information.
33747
33748 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
33749 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
33750
33751 Here are the packet descriptions.
33752
33753 @table @samp
33754
33755 @item !
33756 @cindex @samp{!} packet
33757 @anchor{extended mode}
33758 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
33759 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
33760 debugged.
33761
33762 Reply:
33763 @table @samp
33764 @item OK
33765 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
33766 @end table
33767
33768 @item ?
33769 @cindex @samp{?} packet
33770 @anchor{? packet}
33771 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
33772 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
33773 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
33774
33775 Reply:
33776 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33777
33778 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
33779 @cindex @samp{A} packet
33780 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
33781 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
33782 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
33783
33784 Reply:
33785 @table @samp
33786 @item OK
33787 The arguments were set.
33788 @item E @var{NN}
33789 An error occurred.
33790 @end table
33791
33792 @item b @var{baud}
33793 @cindex @samp{b} packet
33794 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
33795 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
33796
33797 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
33798 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
33799 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
33800
33801 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
33802 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
33803 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
33804 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
33805 of view, nothing actually happened.}
33806
33807 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
33808 @cindex @samp{B} packet
33809 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
33810 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
33811
33812 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
33813 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
33814
33815 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
33816 @anchor{bc}
33817 @item bc
33818 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
33819 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
33820
33821 Reply:
33822 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33823
33824 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
33825 @anchor{bs}
33826 @item bs
33827 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
33828 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
33829
33830 Reply:
33831 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33832
33833 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
33834 @cindex @samp{c} packet
33835 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
33836 resume at current address.
33837
33838 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
33839 packet}.
33840
33841 Reply:
33842 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33843
33844 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
33845 @cindex @samp{C} packet
33846 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
33847 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
33848
33849 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
33850 packet}.
33851
33852 Reply:
33853 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33854
33855 @item d
33856 @cindex @samp{d} packet
33857 Toggle debug flag.
33858
33859 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
33860 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
33861
33862 @item D
33863 @itemx D;@var{pid}
33864 @cindex @samp{D} packet
33865 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
33866 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
33867 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
33868
33869 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
33870 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
33871 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
33872 big-endian hex string.
33873
33874 Reply:
33875 @table @samp
33876 @item OK
33877 for success
33878 @item E @var{NN}
33879 for an error
33880 @end table
33881
33882 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
33883 @cindex @samp{F} packet
33884 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
33885 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
33886 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
33887
33888 @item g
33889 @anchor{read registers packet}
33890 @cindex @samp{g} packet
33891 Read general registers.
33892
33893 Reply:
33894 @table @samp
33895 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
33896 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
33897 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
33898 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
33899 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
33900 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
33901 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
33902
33903 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
33904 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
33905 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
33906 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
33907 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
33908 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
33909 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
33910 have been collected, and both have zero value:
33911
33912 @smallexample
33913 -> @code{g}
33914 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
33915 @end smallexample
33916
33917 @item E @var{NN}
33918 for an error.
33919 @end table
33920
33921 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
33922 @cindex @samp{G} packet
33923 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
33924 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
33925
33926 Reply:
33927 @table @samp
33928 @item OK
33929 for success
33930 @item E @var{NN}
33931 for an error
33932 @end table
33933
33934 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
33935 @cindex @samp{H} packet
33936 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
33937 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{op} depends on the operation to be performed:
33938 it should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
33939 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
33940 option), @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
33941 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
33942 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
33943
33944 Reply:
33945 @table @samp
33946 @item OK
33947 for success
33948 @item E @var{NN}
33949 for an error
33950 @end table
33951
33952 @c FIXME: JTC:
33953 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
33954 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
33955 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
33956 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
33957 @c described. For example:
33958 @c
33959 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
33960 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
33961 @c otherwise returns current registers.
33962 @c
33963 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
33964 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
33965 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
33966
33967 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
33968 @anchor{cycle step packet}
33969 @cindex @samp{i} packet
33970 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
33971 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
33972 step starting at that address.
33973
33974 @item I
33975 @cindex @samp{I} packet
33976 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
33977 step packet}.
33978
33979 @item k
33980 @cindex @samp{k} packet
33981 Kill request.
33982
33983 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
33984
33985 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
33986 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
33987
33988 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
33989
33990 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
33991 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
33992 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
33993
33994 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
33995 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
33996 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
33997
33998 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
33999 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
34000 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
34001 (@pxref{? packet}).
34002
34003 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
34004 @cindex @samp{m} packet
34005 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
34006 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
34007
34008 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
34009 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
34010 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
34011 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
34012 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
34013 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
34014 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
34015 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
34016
34017 Reply:
34018 @table @samp
34019 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34020 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
34021 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
34022 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
34023 @item E @var{NN}
34024 @var{NN} is errno
34025 @end table
34026
34027 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34028 @cindex @samp{M} packet
34029 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
34030 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
34031 hexadecimal number.
34032
34033 Reply:
34034 @table @samp
34035 @item OK
34036 for success
34037 @item E @var{NN}
34038 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
34039 written).
34040 @end table
34041
34042 @item p @var{n}
34043 @cindex @samp{p} packet
34044 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
34045 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
34046 register value is encoded.
34047
34048 Reply:
34049 @table @samp
34050 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34051 the register's value
34052 @item E @var{NN}
34053 for an error
34054 @item @w{}
34055 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
34056 @end table
34057
34058 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
34059 @anchor{write register packet}
34060 @cindex @samp{P} packet
34061 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
34062 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
34063 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
34064
34065 Reply:
34066 @table @samp
34067 @item OK
34068 for success
34069 @item E @var{NN}
34070 for an error
34071 @end table
34072
34073 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
34074 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
34075 @cindex @samp{q} packet
34076 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
34077 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
34078 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
34079
34080 @item r
34081 @cindex @samp{r} packet
34082 Reset the entire system.
34083
34084 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
34085
34086 @item R @var{XX}
34087 @cindex @samp{R} packet
34088 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
34089 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34090
34091 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
34092
34093 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
34094 @cindex @samp{s} packet
34095 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
34096 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
34097
34098 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34099 packet}.
34100
34101 Reply:
34102 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34103
34104 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
34105 @anchor{step with signal packet}
34106 @cindex @samp{S} packet
34107 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
34108 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
34109
34110 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34111 packet}.
34112
34113 Reply:
34114 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34115
34116 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
34117 @cindex @samp{t} packet
34118 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
34119 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
34120 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
34121
34122 @item T @var{thread-id}
34123 @cindex @samp{T} packet
34124 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
34125
34126 Reply:
34127 @table @samp
34128 @item OK
34129 thread is still alive
34130 @item E @var{NN}
34131 thread is dead
34132 @end table
34133
34134 @item v
34135 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
34136 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
34137
34138 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
34139 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
34140 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
34141 The process ID is a
34142 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
34143 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
34144 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
34145
34146 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
34147 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
34148 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
34149 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
34150 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
34151 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
34152 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
34153 @c stopping or restarting threads.
34154
34155 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34156
34157 Reply:
34158 @table @samp
34159 @item E @var{nn}
34160 for an error
34161 @item @r{Any stop packet}
34162 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
34163 @item OK
34164 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
34165 @end table
34166
34167 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
34168 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
34169 @anchor{vCont packet}
34170 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
34171 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
34172 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
34173 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
34174 in their current state in non-stop mode.
34175 Specifying multiple
34176 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
34177 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34178
34179 Currently supported actions are:
34180
34181 @table @samp
34182 @item c
34183 Continue.
34184 @item C @var{sig}
34185 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
34186 @item s
34187 Step.
34188 @item S @var{sig}
34189 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
34190 @item t
34191 Stop.
34192 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
34193 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
34194 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
34195 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
34196 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
34197 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
34198
34199 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
34200 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
34201 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
34202 jumps to @var{start}).
34203
34204 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
34205 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
34206 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
34207
34208 @end table
34209
34210 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
34211 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
34212 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
34213
34214 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
34215 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
34216 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
34217 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
34218 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
34219 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
34220 as an implementation detail.
34221
34222 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
34223 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
34224 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
34225 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
34226 @var{thread-id}.
34227
34228 Reply:
34229 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34230
34231 @item vCont?
34232 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
34233 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
34234
34235 Reply:
34236 @table @samp
34237 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
34238 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
34239 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
34240 @item @w{}
34241 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
34242 @end table
34243
34244 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
34245 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
34246 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
34247 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
34248
34249 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
34250 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
34251 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
34252 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
34253 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
34254 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
34255 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
34256 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
34257 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
34258 packet is received.
34259
34260 Reply:
34261 @table @samp
34262 @item OK
34263 for success
34264 @item E @var{NN}
34265 for an error
34266 @end table
34267
34268 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34269 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
34270 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
34271 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
34272 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
34273 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
34274 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
34275 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
34276 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
34277 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
34278 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
34279 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
34280
34281
34282 Reply:
34283 @table @samp
34284 @item OK
34285 for success
34286 @item E.memtype
34287 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
34288 @item E @var{NN}
34289 for an error
34290 @end table
34291
34292 @item vFlashDone
34293 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
34294 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
34295 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
34296 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
34297 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
34298 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
34299 request is completed.
34300
34301 @item vKill;@var{pid}
34302 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
34303 @anchor{vKill packet}
34304 Kill the process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
34305 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
34306 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
34307 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
34308
34309 Reply:
34310 @table @samp
34311 @item E @var{nn}
34312 for an error
34313 @item OK
34314 for success
34315 @end table
34316
34317 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
34318 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
34319 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
34320 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
34321 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
34322 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
34323 state.
34324
34325 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
34326
34327 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34328
34329 Reply:
34330 @table @samp
34331 @item E @var{nn}
34332 for an error
34333 @item @r{Any stop packet}
34334 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
34335 @end table
34336
34337 @item vStopped
34338 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
34339 @xref{Notification Packets}.
34340
34341 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34342 @anchor{X packet}
34343 @cindex @samp{X} packet
34344 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
34345 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
34346 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
34347
34348 Reply:
34349 @table @samp
34350 @item OK
34351 for success
34352 @item E @var{NN}
34353 for an error
34354 @end table
34355
34356 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
34357 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
34358 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
34359 @cindex @samp{z} packet
34360 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
34361 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
34362 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
34363
34364 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
34365 separately.
34366
34367 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
34368 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
34369 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
34370 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
34371 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
34372 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
34373
34374 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34375 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
34376 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
34377 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
34378 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
34379 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
34380
34381 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
34382 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
34383 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
34384 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
34385 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
34386 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
34387 @var{cond_list} is an optional list of conditional expressions in bytecode
34388 form that should be evaluated on the target's side. These are the
34389 conditions that should be taken into consideration when deciding if
34390 the breakpoint trigger should be reported back to @var{GDBN}.
34391
34392 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
34393 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
34394
34395 @table @samp
34396
34397 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
34398 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
34399 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
34400
34401 @end table
34402
34403 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
34404 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
34405 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
34406 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
34407 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
34408 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
34409 separators. Each expression has the following form:
34410
34411 @table @samp
34412
34413 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
34414 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
34415 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
34416
34417 @end table
34418
34419 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
34420
34421 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
34422 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
34423 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
34424 target, is not defined.}
34425
34426 Reply:
34427 @table @samp
34428 @item OK
34429 success
34430 @item @w{}
34431 not supported
34432 @item E @var{NN}
34433 for an error
34434 @end table
34435
34436 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34437 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}
34438 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
34439 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
34440 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
34441 address @var{addr}.
34442
34443 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
34444 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. @var{kind}
34445 and @var{cond_list} have the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
34446
34447 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
34448 movement.}
34449
34450 Reply:
34451 @table @samp
34452 @item OK
34453 success
34454 @item @w{}
34455 not supported
34456 @item E @var{NN}
34457 for an error
34458 @end table
34459
34460 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34461 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34462 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
34463 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
34464 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
34465 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
34466
34467 Reply:
34468 @table @samp
34469 @item OK
34470 success
34471 @item @w{}
34472 not supported
34473 @item E @var{NN}
34474 for an error
34475 @end table
34476
34477 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34478 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34479 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
34480 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
34481 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
34482 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
34483
34484 Reply:
34485 @table @samp
34486 @item OK
34487 success
34488 @item @w{}
34489 not supported
34490 @item E @var{NN}
34491 for an error
34492 @end table
34493
34494 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34495 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34496 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
34497 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
34498 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
34499 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
34500
34501 Reply:
34502 @table @samp
34503 @item OK
34504 success
34505 @item @w{}
34506 not supported
34507 @item E @var{NN}
34508 for an error
34509 @end table
34510
34511 @end table
34512
34513 @node Stop Reply Packets
34514 @section Stop Reply Packets
34515 @cindex stop reply packets
34516
34517 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
34518 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
34519 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
34520 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
34521 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
34522 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
34523 @value{GDBN} source code.
34524
34525 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
34526 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
34527 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
34528 components.
34529
34530 @table @samp
34531
34532 @item S @var{AA}
34533 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
34534 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
34535 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
34536
34537 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
34538 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
34539 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
34540 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
34541 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
34542 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
34543 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
34544 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
34545
34546 @itemize @bullet
34547 @item
34548 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
34549 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
34550 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
34551 two-digit hex number.
34552
34553 @item
34554 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
34555 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34556
34557 @item
34558 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
34559 the core on which the stop event was detected.
34560
34561 @item
34562 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
34563 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
34564 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
34565 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
34566
34567 @item
34568 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
34569 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
34570 future.
34571 @end itemize
34572
34573 The currently defined stop reasons are:
34574
34575 @table @samp
34576 @item watch
34577 @itemx rwatch
34578 @itemx awatch
34579 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
34580 hex.
34581
34582 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
34583 @item library
34584 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
34585 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
34586 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
34587
34588 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
34589 @item replaylog
34590 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
34591 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
34592 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
34593 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
34594 for more information.
34595 @end table
34596
34597 @item W @var{AA}
34598 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
34599 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
34600 applicable to certain targets.
34601
34602 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
34603 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
34604 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
34605 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
34606
34607 @item X @var{AA}
34608 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
34609 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
34610
34611 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
34612 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
34613 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
34614 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
34615
34616 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
34617 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
34618 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
34619 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
34620 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
34621
34622 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
34623 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
34624 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
34625 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
34626 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
34627 system calls.
34628
34629 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
34630 this very system call.
34631
34632 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
34633 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
34634 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
34635 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
34636 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
34637 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
34638
34639 @end table
34640
34641 @node General Query Packets
34642 @section General Query Packets
34643 @cindex remote query requests
34644
34645 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
34646 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
34647 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
34648 sending information to and from the stub.
34649
34650 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
34651 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
34652 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
34653 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
34654 conventions:
34655
34656 @itemize @bullet
34657 @item
34658 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
34659 @item
34660 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
34661 letter.
34662 @item
34663 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
34664 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
34665 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
34666 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
34667 @end itemize
34668
34669 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
34670 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
34671 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
34672 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
34673 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
34674 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
34675 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
34676 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
34677 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
34678 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
34679 packet.}.
34680
34681 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
34682 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
34683 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
34684 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
34685 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
34686
34687 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
34688
34689 @table @samp
34690
34691 @item QAgent:1
34692 @itemx QAgent:0
34693 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
34694 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
34695
34696 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
34697 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
34698 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
34699 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
34700 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
34701 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
34702 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
34703 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
34704 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
34705 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
34706 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
34707
34708 @item qC
34709 @cindex current thread, remote request
34710 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
34711 Return the current thread ID.
34712
34713 Reply:
34714 @table @samp
34715 @item QC @var{thread-id}
34716 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
34717 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34718 @item @r{(anything else)}
34719 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
34720 @end table
34721
34722 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
34723 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
34724 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
34725 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
34726 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
34727 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
34728 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
34729
34730 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
34731 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
34732 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
34733 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
34734 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
34735 detect trailing zeros.
34736
34737 Reply:
34738 @table @samp
34739 @item E @var{NN}
34740 An error (such as memory fault)
34741 @item C @var{crc32}
34742 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
34743 @end table
34744
34745 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
34746 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
34747 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
34748 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
34749 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
34750 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
34751 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
34752 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
34753 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
34754 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
34755 randomization.
34756
34757 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34758
34759 Reply:
34760 @table @samp
34761 @item OK
34762 The request succeeded.
34763
34764 @item E @var{nn}
34765 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
34766
34767 @item @w{}
34768 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
34769 by the stub.
34770 @end table
34771
34772 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
34773 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
34774 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
34775 address space randomization.
34776
34777 @item qfThreadInfo
34778 @itemx qsThreadInfo
34779 @cindex list active threads, remote request
34780 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
34781 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
34782 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
34783 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
34784 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
34785 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
34786 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
34787 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
34788
34789 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
34790
34791 Reply:
34792 @table @samp
34793 @item m @var{thread-id}
34794 A single thread ID
34795 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
34796 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
34797 @item l
34798 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
34799 @end table
34800
34801 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
34802 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
34803 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
34804 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
34805 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
34806 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
34807 fields.
34808
34809 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
34810 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
34811 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
34812 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
34813 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
34814
34815 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
34816 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
34817
34818 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
34819 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
34820 information associated with the variable.)
34821
34822 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
34823 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
34824 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
34825 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
34826 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
34827 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
34828
34829 Reply:
34830 @table @samp
34831 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
34832 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
34833 local storage requested.
34834
34835 @item E @var{nn}
34836 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
34837
34838 @item @w{}
34839 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
34840 @end table
34841
34842 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
34843 @cindex get thread information block address
34844 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
34845 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
34846
34847 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
34848
34849 Reply:
34850 @table @samp
34851 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
34852 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
34853 thread information block.
34854
34855 @item E @var{nn}
34856 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
34857 address could not be retrieved.
34858
34859 @item @w{}
34860 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
34861 @end table
34862
34863 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
34864 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
34865 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
34866 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
34867 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
34868 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
34869 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
34870
34871 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
34872
34873 Reply:
34874 @table @samp
34875 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
34876 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
34877 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
34878 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
34879 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
34880 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
34881 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
34882 @end table
34883
34884 @item qOffsets
34885 @cindex section offsets, remote request
34886 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
34887 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
34888 image.
34889
34890 Reply:
34891 @table @samp
34892 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
34893 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
34894 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
34895 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
34896 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
34897 segments by the supplied offsets.
34898
34899 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
34900 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
34901 to the @code{Bss} section.}
34902
34903 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
34904 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
34905 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
34906 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
34907 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
34908 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
34909 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
34910 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
34911 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
34912 @end table
34913
34914 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
34915 @cindex thread information, remote request
34916 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
34917 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
34918 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
34919 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
34920
34921 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
34922 (see below).
34923
34924 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
34925
34926 @item QNonStop:1
34927 @itemx QNonStop:0
34928 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
34929 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
34930 @anchor{QNonStop}
34931 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
34932 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
34933
34934 Reply:
34935 @table @samp
34936 @item OK
34937 The request succeeded.
34938
34939 @item E @var{nn}
34940 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
34941
34942 @item @w{}
34943 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
34944 the stub.
34945 @end table
34946
34947 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
34948 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
34949 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
34950 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
34951
34952 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
34953 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
34954 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
34955 @anchor{QPassSignals}
34956 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
34957 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
34958 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
34959 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
34960 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
34961 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
34962 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
34963 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
34964 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
34965
34966 Reply:
34967 @table @samp
34968 @item OK
34969 The request succeeded.
34970
34971 @item E @var{nn}
34972 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
34973
34974 @item @w{}
34975 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
34976 the stub.
34977 @end table
34978
34979 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
34980 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
34981 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
34982 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
34983
34984 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
34985 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
34986 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
34987 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
34988 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
34989 Others should be silently discarded.
34990
34991 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
34992 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
34993 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
34994 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
34995 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
34996 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
34997 signals.
34998
34999 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
35000 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
35001
35002 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
35003 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
35004 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
35005 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
35006 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
35007
35008 Reply:
35009 @table @samp
35010 @item OK
35011 The request succeeded.
35012
35013 @item E @var{nn}
35014 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
35015
35016 @item @w{}
35017 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
35018 by the stub.
35019 @end table
35020
35021 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
35022 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
35023 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35024 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35025
35026 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
35027 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
35028 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
35029 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
35030 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
35031 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
35032 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
35033 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
35034 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
35035
35036 Reply:
35037 @table @samp
35038 @item OK
35039 A command response with no output.
35040 @item @var{OUTPUT}
35041 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
35042 @item E @var{NN}
35043 Indicate a badly formed request.
35044 @item @w{}
35045 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
35046 @end table
35047
35048 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
35049 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
35050 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
35051 packets.)
35052
35053 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
35054 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
35055 @ifnotinfo
35056 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
35057 @end ifnotinfo
35058 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
35059 @anchor{qSearch memory}
35060 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
35061 @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex.
35062 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, hex encoded.
35063
35064 Reply:
35065 @table @samp
35066 @item 0
35067 The pattern was not found.
35068 @item 1,address
35069 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
35070 @item E @var{NN}
35071 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
35072 @item @w{}
35073 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
35074 @end table
35075
35076 @item QStartNoAckMode
35077 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
35078 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
35079 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
35080 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
35081
35082 Reply:
35083 @table @samp
35084 @item OK
35085 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
35086 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
35087 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
35088 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
35089 @item @w{}
35090 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
35091 @end table
35092
35093 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
35094 @cindex supported packets, remote query
35095 @cindex features of the remote protocol
35096 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
35097 @anchor{qSupported}
35098 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
35099 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
35100 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
35101 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
35102 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
35103 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
35104 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
35105 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
35106 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
35107 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
35108 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
35109 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
35110 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
35111 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
35112
35113 Reply:
35114 @table @samp
35115 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
35116 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
35117 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
35118 possible forms).
35119 @item @w{}
35120 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
35121 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
35122 @end table
35123
35124 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
35125 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
35126 are:
35127
35128 @table @samp
35129 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
35130 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
35131 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
35132 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
35133 @item @var{name}+
35134 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
35135 need an associated value.
35136 @item @var{name}-
35137 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
35138 @item @var{name}?
35139 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
35140 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
35141 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
35142 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
35143 @end table
35144
35145 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
35146 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
35147 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
35148 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
35149 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
35150
35151 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
35152 are defined:
35153
35154 @table @samp
35155 @item multiprocess
35156 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
35157 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
35158 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
35159 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
35160 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
35161
35162 @item xmlRegisters
35163 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
35164 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
35165 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
35166 description.
35167
35168 @item qRelocInsn
35169 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
35170 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
35171 instruction reply packet}).
35172 @end table
35173
35174 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
35175 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
35176 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
35177 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
35178 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
35179 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
35180 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
35181 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
35182 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
35183 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
35184 all the features it supports.
35185
35186 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
35187 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
35188
35189 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
35190 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
35191 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
35192 form response.
35193
35194 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
35195 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
35196 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
35197 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
35198
35199 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
35200 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
35201 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
35202 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
35203 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
35204
35205 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
35206
35207 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
35208 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
35209 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
35210 @item Feature Name
35211 @tab Value Required
35212 @tab Default
35213 @tab Probe Allowed
35214
35215 @item @samp{PacketSize}
35216 @tab Yes
35217 @tab @samp{-}
35218 @tab No
35219
35220 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
35221 @tab No
35222 @tab @samp{-}
35223 @tab Yes
35224
35225 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
35226 @tab No
35227 @tab @samp{-}
35228 @tab Yes
35229
35230 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
35231 @tab No
35232 @tab @samp{-}
35233 @tab Yes
35234
35235 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
35236 @tab No
35237 @tab @samp{-}
35238 @tab Yes
35239
35240 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
35241 @tab No
35242 @tab @samp{-}
35243 @tab Yes
35244
35245 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
35246 @tab No
35247 @tab @samp{-}
35248 @tab No
35249
35250 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
35251 @tab No
35252 @tab @samp{-}
35253 @tab Yes
35254
35255 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
35256 @tab No
35257 @tab @samp{-}
35258 @tab Yes
35259
35260 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
35261 @tab No
35262 @tab @samp{-}
35263 @tab Yes
35264
35265 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
35266 @tab No
35267 @tab @samp{-}
35268 @tab Yes
35269
35270 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
35271 @tab No
35272 @tab @samp{-}
35273 @tab Yes
35274
35275 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
35276 @tab No
35277 @tab @samp{-}
35278 @tab Yes
35279
35280 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
35281 @tab No
35282 @tab @samp{-}
35283 @tab Yes
35284
35285 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
35286 @tab No
35287 @tab @samp{-}
35288 @tab Yes
35289
35290 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
35291 @tab No
35292 @tab @samp{-}
35293 @tab Yes
35294
35295 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
35296 @tab No
35297 @tab @samp{-}
35298 @tab Yes
35299
35300 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
35301 @tab Yes
35302 @tab @samp{-}
35303 @tab Yes
35304
35305 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
35306 @tab Yes
35307 @tab @samp{-}
35308 @tab Yes
35309
35310 @item @samp{QNonStop}
35311 @tab No
35312 @tab @samp{-}
35313 @tab Yes
35314
35315 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
35316 @tab No
35317 @tab @samp{-}
35318 @tab Yes
35319
35320 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
35321 @tab No
35322 @tab @samp{-}
35323 @tab Yes
35324
35325 @item @samp{multiprocess}
35326 @tab No
35327 @tab @samp{-}
35328 @tab No
35329
35330 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
35331 @tab No
35332 @tab @samp{-}
35333 @tab No
35334
35335 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
35336 @tab No
35337 @tab @samp{-}
35338 @tab No
35339
35340 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
35341 @tab No
35342 @tab @samp{-}
35343 @tab No
35344
35345 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
35346 @tab No
35347 @tab @samp{-}
35348 @tab No
35349
35350 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
35351 @tab No
35352 @tab @samp{-}
35353 @tab No
35354
35355 @item @samp{QAgent}
35356 @tab No
35357 @tab @samp{-}
35358 @tab No
35359
35360 @item @samp{QAllow}
35361 @tab No
35362 @tab @samp{-}
35363 @tab No
35364
35365 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
35366 @tab No
35367 @tab @samp{-}
35368 @tab No
35369
35370 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
35371 @tab No
35372 @tab @samp{-}
35373 @tab No
35374
35375 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
35376 @tab No
35377 @tab @samp{-}
35378 @tab No
35379
35380 @item @samp{tracenz}
35381 @tab No
35382 @tab @samp{-}
35383 @tab No
35384
35385 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
35386 @tab No
35387 @tab @samp{-}
35388 @tab No
35389
35390 @end multitable
35391
35392 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
35393
35394 @table @samp
35395 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
35396 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
35397 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
35398 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
35399 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
35400 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
35401 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
35402 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
35403 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
35404 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
35405
35406 @item qXfer:auxv:read
35407 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
35408 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
35409
35410 @item qXfer:btrace:read
35411 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
35412 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
35413
35414 @item qXfer:features:read
35415 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
35416 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
35417
35418 @item qXfer:libraries:read
35419 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
35420 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
35421
35422 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
35423 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
35424 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
35425
35426 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
35427 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
35428 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
35429 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
35430
35431 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
35432 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
35433 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
35434
35435 @item qXfer:sdata:read
35436 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
35437 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
35438
35439 @item qXfer:spu:read
35440 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
35441 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
35442
35443 @item qXfer:spu:write
35444 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
35445 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
35446
35447 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
35448 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
35449 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
35450
35451 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
35452 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
35453 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
35454
35455 @item qXfer:threads:read
35456 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
35457 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
35458
35459 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
35460 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
35461 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
35462
35463 @item qXfer:uib:read
35464 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
35465 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
35466
35467 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
35468 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
35469 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
35470
35471 @item QNonStop
35472 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
35473 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
35474
35475 @item QPassSignals
35476 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
35477 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
35478
35479 @item QStartNoAckMode
35480 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
35481 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
35482
35483 @item multiprocess
35484 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
35485 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
35486 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
35487 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
35488 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
35489 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
35490 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
35491 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
35492 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
35493 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
35494 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
35495
35496 @item qXfer:osdata:read
35497 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
35498 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
35499
35500 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
35501 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
35502 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
35503 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
35504
35505 @item ConditionalTracepoints
35506 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
35507 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
35508
35509 @item ReverseContinue
35510 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
35511 (@pxref{bc}).
35512
35513 @item ReverseStep
35514 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
35515 (@pxref{bs}).
35516
35517 @item TracepointSource
35518 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
35519 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
35520
35521 @item QAgent
35522 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
35523
35524 @item QAllow
35525 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
35526
35527 @item QDisableRandomization
35528 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
35529
35530 @item StaticTracepoint
35531 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
35532 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
35533
35534 @item InstallInTrace
35535 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
35536 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
35537
35538 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
35539 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
35540 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
35541 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
35542
35543 @item QTBuffer:size
35544 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
35545 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
35546
35547 @item tracenz
35548 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
35549 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
35550 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
35551
35552 @item BreakpointCommands
35553 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
35554 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
35555 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
35556
35557 @item Qbtrace:off
35558 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
35559
35560 @item Qbtrace:bts
35561 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
35562
35563 @end table
35564
35565 @item qSymbol::
35566 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
35567 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
35568 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
35569 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
35570
35571 Reply:
35572 @table @samp
35573 @item OK
35574 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
35575 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
35576 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
35577 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
35578 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
35579 below.
35580 @end table
35581
35582 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
35583 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
35584
35585 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
35586 target has previously requested.
35587
35588 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
35589 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
35590 will be empty.
35591
35592 Reply:
35593 @table @samp
35594 @item OK
35595 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
35596 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
35597 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
35598 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
35599 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
35600 @end table
35601
35602 @item qTBuffer
35603 @itemx QTBuffer
35604 @itemx QTDisconnected
35605 @itemx QTDP
35606 @itemx QTDPsrc
35607 @itemx QTDV
35608 @itemx qTfP
35609 @itemx qTfV
35610 @itemx QTFrame
35611 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
35612
35613 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
35614
35615 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
35616 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
35617 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
35618 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
35619 the target OS. @var{thread-id} is a thread ID;
35620 see @ref{thread-id syntax}. This
35621 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
35622 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
35623 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
35624 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
35625 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
35626
35627 Reply:
35628 @table @samp
35629 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
35630 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
35631 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
35632 the thread's attributes.
35633 @end table
35634
35635 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
35636 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
35637 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
35638 packets.)
35639
35640 @item QTNotes
35641 @itemx qTP
35642 @itemx QTSave
35643 @itemx qTsP
35644 @itemx qTsV
35645 @itemx QTStart
35646 @itemx QTStop
35647 @itemx QTEnable
35648 @itemx QTDisable
35649 @itemx QTinit
35650 @itemx QTro
35651 @itemx qTStatus
35652 @itemx qTV
35653 @itemx qTfSTM
35654 @itemx qTsSTM
35655 @itemx qTSTMat
35656 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
35657
35658 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35659 @cindex read special object, remote request
35660 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
35661 @anchor{qXfer read}
35662 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
35663 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
35664 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
35665 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
35666 additional details about what data to access.
35667
35668 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
35669 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
35670 formats, listed below.
35671
35672 @table @samp
35673 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35674 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
35675 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
35676 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
35677
35678 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35679 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35680
35681 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35682 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
35683
35684 Return a description of the current branch trace.
35685 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
35686 packet may have one of the following values:
35687
35688 @table @code
35689 @item all
35690 Returns all available branch trace.
35691
35692 @item new
35693 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
35694 the last read request.
35695
35696 @item delta
35697 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
35698 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
35699 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
35700 used to stitch traces together.
35701
35702 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
35703 @end table
35704
35705 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
35706 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35707
35708 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35709 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
35710 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
35711 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
35712 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
35713
35714 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35715 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35716
35717 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35718 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
35719 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
35720 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
35721 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35722
35723 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
35724 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
35725 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
35726
35727 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35728 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35729
35730 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35731 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
35732 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
35733 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
35734 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
35735 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
35736 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35737 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
35738
35739 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
35740 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
35741
35742 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35743 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35744
35745 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
35746 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
35747 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
35748 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
35749
35750 @table @code
35751 @item start=@var{address}
35752 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
35753 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
35754 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
35755 chosen as the starting point.
35756
35757 @item prev=@var{address}
35758 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
35759 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
35760 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
35761 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
35762 exists prior to the starting point.
35763
35764 @end table
35765
35766 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
35767 ignored.
35768
35769 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35770 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
35771 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
35772 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
35773 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35774
35775 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35776 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35777
35778 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35779 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
35780
35781 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
35782 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
35783 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
35784 Action Lists}.
35785
35786 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35787 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35788 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35789
35790 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35791 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
35792 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
35793 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
35794 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35795
35796 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35797 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35798 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35799
35800 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35801 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
35802 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
35803 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
35804 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
35805 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
35806 in that context to be accessed.
35807
35808 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35809 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35810 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35811
35812 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35813 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
35814 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
35815 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
35816 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35817
35818 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35819 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35820
35821 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35822 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
35823
35824 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
35825 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
35826 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35827
35828 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35829 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35830
35831 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35832 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
35833
35834 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
35835 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
35836
35837 This packet is not probed by default.
35838
35839 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35840 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
35841 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
35842 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
35843 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
35844
35845 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35846 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35847
35848 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35849 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
35850 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
35851 @xref{Operating System Information}.
35852
35853 @end table
35854
35855 Reply:
35856 @table @samp
35857 @item m @var{data}
35858 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
35859 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
35860 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
35861 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
35862 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
35863 request.
35864
35865 @item l @var{data}
35866 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
35867 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
35868 than the @var{length} in the request.
35869
35870 @item l
35871 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
35872 There is no more data to be read.
35873
35874 @item E00
35875 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
35876
35877 @item E @var{nn}
35878 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
35879 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
35880
35881 @item @w{}
35882 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
35883 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
35884 @end table
35885
35886 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
35887 @cindex write data into object, remote request
35888 @anchor{qXfer write}
35889 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
35890 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
35891 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
35892 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
35893 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
35894 to access.
35895
35896 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
35897 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
35898 formats, listed below.
35899
35900 @table @samp
35901 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
35902 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
35903 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
35904 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
35905 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
35906
35907 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35908 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35909 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35910
35911 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
35912 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
35913 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
35914 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
35915 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
35916 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
35917 in that context to be accessed.
35918
35919 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35920 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35921 @end table
35922
35923 Reply:
35924 @table @samp
35925 @item @var{nn}
35926 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
35927 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
35928
35929 @item E00
35930 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
35931
35932 @item E @var{nn}
35933 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
35934 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
35935
35936 @item @w{}
35937 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
35938 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
35939 @end table
35940
35941 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
35942 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
35943 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
35944 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
35945 must respond with an empty packet.
35946
35947 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
35948 @cindex query attached, remote request
35949 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
35950 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
35951 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
35952 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
35953 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
35954 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
35955 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
35956
35957 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
35958 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
35959 the @code{quit} command.
35960
35961 Reply:
35962 @table @samp
35963 @item 1
35964 The remote server attached to an existing process.
35965 @item 0
35966 The remote server created a new process.
35967 @item E @var{NN}
35968 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
35969 @end table
35970
35971 @item Qbtrace:bts
35972 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using bts tracing.
35973
35974 Reply:
35975 @table @samp
35976 @item OK
35977 Branch tracing has been enabled.
35978 @item E.errtext
35979 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
35980 @end table
35981
35982 @item Qbtrace:off
35983 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
35984
35985 Reply:
35986 @table @samp
35987 @item OK
35988 Branch tracing has been disabled.
35989 @item E.errtext
35990 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
35991 @end table
35992
35993 @end table
35994
35995 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
35996 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
35997
35998 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
35999 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
36000 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
36001
36002 @menu
36003 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
36004 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
36005 @end menu
36006
36007 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
36008 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
36009
36010 @menu
36011 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
36012 @end menu
36013
36014 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
36015 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
36016 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
36017
36018 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
36019
36020 @table @r
36021
36022 @item 2
36023 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
36024
36025 @item 3
36026 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
36027
36028 @item 4
36029 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
36030
36031 @end table
36032
36033 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
36034 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
36035
36036 @menu
36037 * MIPS Register packet Format::
36038 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
36039 @end menu
36040
36041 @node MIPS Register packet Format
36042 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
36043 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
36044
36045 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
36046 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
36047 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
36048 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
36049 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
36050 most-significant -- least-significant.
36051
36052 @table @r
36053
36054 @item MIPS32
36055 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
36056 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
36057 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
36058
36059 @item MIPS64
36060 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
36061 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
36062 as @code{MIPS32}.
36063
36064 @end table
36065
36066 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
36067 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
36068 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
36069
36070 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
36071
36072 @table @r
36073
36074 @item 2
36075 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
36076
36077 @item 3
36078 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
36079
36080 @item 4
36081 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
36082
36083 @item 5
36084 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
36085
36086 @end table
36087
36088 @node Tracepoint Packets
36089 @section Tracepoint Packets
36090 @cindex tracepoint packets
36091 @cindex packets, tracepoint
36092
36093 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
36094 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
36095
36096 @table @samp
36097
36098 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
36099 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
36100 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
36101 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
36102 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
36103 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
36104 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
36105 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
36106 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
36107 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
36108 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
36109 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
36110 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
36111 actions.
36112
36113 Replies:
36114 @table @samp
36115 @item OK
36116 The packet was understood and carried out.
36117 @item qRelocInsn
36118 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
36119 @item @w{}
36120 The packet was not recognized.
36121 @end table
36122
36123 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
36124 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
36125 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
36126 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
36127 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
36128 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
36129 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
36130
36131 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
36132 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
36133 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
36134 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
36135 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
36136 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
36137 tracepoint actions.
36138
36139 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
36140 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
36141 following forms:
36142
36143 @table @samp
36144
36145 @item R @var{mask}
36146 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
36147 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
36148 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
36149 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
36150 not fit in a 32-bit word.
36151
36152 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
36153 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
36154 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
36155 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
36156 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
36157 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
36158 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
36159
36160 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
36161 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
36162 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
36163 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
36164 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
36165 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
36166 packet).
36167
36168 @end table
36169
36170 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
36171 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
36172 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
36173 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
36174 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
36175 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
36176 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
36177 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
36178
36179 Replies:
36180 @table @samp
36181 @item OK
36182 The packet was understood and carried out.
36183 @item qRelocInsn
36184 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
36185 @item @w{}
36186 The packet was not recognized.
36187 @end table
36188
36189 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
36190 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
36191 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
36192 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
36193 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. @var{type}
36194 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
36195 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
36196 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
36197
36198 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
36199 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
36200 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
36201 fit in a single packet.
36202 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
36203 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
36204
36205 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
36206 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
36207 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
36208 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
36209
36210 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
36211 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
36212 query packets.
36213
36214 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
36215 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
36216 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
36217 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
36218 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
36219 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
36220 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
36221 be found.
36222
36223 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}
36224 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
36225 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
36226 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
36227 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
36228 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
36229 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
36230 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
36231 mentioned in expressions.
36232
36233 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
36234 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
36235 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
36236 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
36237 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
36238
36239 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
36240 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
36241 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
36242 one of the following forms:
36243
36244 @table @samp
36245 @item F @var{f}
36246 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
36247 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
36248 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
36249
36250 @item T @var{t}
36251 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
36252 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
36253
36254 @end table
36255
36256 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
36257 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
36258 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
36259 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
36260
36261 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
36262 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
36263 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
36264 is a hexadecimal number.
36265
36266 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
36267 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
36268 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
36269 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
36270 numbers.
36271
36272 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
36273 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
36274 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
36275
36276 @item qTMinFTPILen
36277 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
36278 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
36279 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
36280 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
36281 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
36282 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
36283 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
36284 arrange for that.
36285
36286 Replies:
36287
36288 @table @samp
36289 @item 0
36290 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
36291 @item @var{length}
36292 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length} is greater
36293 or equal to 1. @var{length} is a hexadecimal number. A reply of 1 means
36294 that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction regardless of size.
36295 @item E
36296 An error has occurred.
36297 @item @w{}
36298 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
36299 @end table
36300
36301 @item QTStart
36302 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
36303 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
36304 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
36305 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
36306 instruction reply packet}).
36307
36308 @item QTStop
36309 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
36310 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
36311
36312 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
36313 @anchor{QTEnable}
36314 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
36315 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
36316 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
36317 of data from it will resume.
36318
36319 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
36320 @anchor{QTDisable}
36321 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
36322 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
36323 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
36324 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
36325
36326 @item QTinit
36327 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
36328 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
36329
36330 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
36331 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
36332 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
36333 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
36334 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
36335
36336 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
36337 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
36338 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
36339 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
36340
36341 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
36342 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
36343 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
36344 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
36345 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
36346 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
36347
36348 @item qTStatus
36349 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
36350 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
36351
36352 The reply has the form:
36353
36354 @table @samp
36355
36356 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
36357 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
36358 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
36359 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
36360
36361 @end table
36362
36363 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
36364 explanations as one of the optional fields:
36365
36366 @table @samp
36367
36368 @item tnotrun:0
36369 No trace has been run yet.
36370
36371 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
36372 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
36373 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
36374 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
36375 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
36376
36377 @item tfull:0
36378 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
36379
36380 @item tdisconnected:0
36381 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
36382
36383 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
36384 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
36385
36386 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
36387 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
36388 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
36389 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression).
36390 @var{text} is hex encoded.
36391
36392 @item tunknown:0
36393 The trace stopped for some other reason.
36394
36395 @end table
36396
36397 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
36398 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
36399 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
36400 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
36401 trace.
36402
36403 @table @samp
36404
36405 @item tframes:@var{n}
36406 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
36407
36408 @item tcreated:@var{n}
36409 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
36410 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
36411
36412 @item tsize:@var{n}
36413 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
36414
36415 @item tfree:@var{n}
36416 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
36417
36418 @item circular:@var{n}
36419 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
36420 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
36421 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
36422 and may fill up.
36423
36424 @item disconn:@var{n}
36425 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
36426 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
36427 that the trace run will stop.
36428
36429 @end table
36430
36431 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
36432 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
36433 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
36434 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
36435 address @var{addr}.
36436
36437 Replies:
36438 @table @samp
36439 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
36440 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
36441 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
36442 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
36443 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
36444
36445 @end table
36446
36447 @item qTV:@var{var}
36448 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
36449 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
36450 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
36451
36452 Replies:
36453 @table @samp
36454 @item V@var{value}
36455 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
36456 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
36457 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
36458 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
36459 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
36460 program is running.
36461
36462 @item U
36463 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
36464 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
36465 was not collected.
36466 @end table
36467
36468 @item qTfP
36469 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
36470 @itemx qTsP
36471 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
36472 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
36473 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
36474 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
36475 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
36476 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
36477
36478 @item qTfV
36479 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
36480 @itemx qTsV
36481 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
36482 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
36483 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
36484 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
36485 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
36486 trace state variables.
36487
36488 @item qTfSTM
36489 @itemx qTsSTM
36490 @anchor{qTfSTM}
36491 @anchor{qTsSTM}
36492 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
36493 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
36494 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
36495 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
36496 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
36497 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
36498
36499 Reply:
36500 @table @samp
36501 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
36502 A single marker
36503 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
36504 a comma-separated list of markers
36505 @item l
36506 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
36507 @item E @var{nn}
36508 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
36509 @item @w{}
36510 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
36511 stub.
36512 @end table
36513
36514 @var{address} is encoded in hex.
36515 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
36516
36517 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
36518 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
36519 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
36520 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
36521 @dfn{last}).
36522
36523 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
36524 @anchor{qTSTMat}
36525 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
36526 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
36527 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
36528 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
36529 tracepoint markers.
36530
36531 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
36532 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
36533 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
36534 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. @var{filename} is encoded
36535 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
36536 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
36537
36538 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
36539 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
36540 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
36541 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
36542 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
36543 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
36544 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
36545 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
36546 available.
36547
36548 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
36549 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
36550 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
36551
36552 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
36553 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
36554 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
36555 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
36556 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
36557 use whatever size it prefers.
36558
36559 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
36560 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
36561 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
36562 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
36563 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
36564
36565 @end table
36566
36567 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
36568 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
36569 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
36570 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
36571 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
36572 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
36573 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
36574 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
36575 it had executed in the original location.
36576
36577 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
36578 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
36579 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
36580 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
36581 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
36582 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
36583 format of the request is:
36584
36585 @table @samp
36586 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
36587
36588 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
36589 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
36590 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
36591 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
36592 memory starting at @var{to}.
36593 @end table
36594
36595 Replies:
36596 @table @samp
36597 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
36598 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. @var{adjusted_size} is
36599 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
36600 @item E @var{NN}
36601 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
36602 relocating the instruction.
36603 @end table
36604
36605 @node Host I/O Packets
36606 @section Host I/O Packets
36607 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
36608 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
36609
36610 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
36611 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
36612 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
36613 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
36614 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
36615 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
36616 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
36617 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
36618 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
36619 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
36620
36621 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
36622 its arguments. They have this format:
36623
36624 @table @samp
36625
36626 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
36627 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
36628 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
36629 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
36630 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
36631 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
36632 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
36633 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
36634 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
36635
36636 @end table
36637
36638 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
36639
36640 @table @samp
36641
36642 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
36643 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
36644 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
36645 @var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
36646 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
36647 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
36648 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
36649 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
36650 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
36651 @var{attachment}.
36652
36653 @item @w{}
36654 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
36655
36656 @end table
36657
36658 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
36659
36660 @table @samp
36661 @item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
36662 Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
36663 return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
36664 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
36665 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
36666 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
36667 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
36668
36669 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
36670 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
36671 -1 if an error occurs.
36672
36673 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
36674 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
36675 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
36676 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
36677 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
36678 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
36679 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
36680 @var{count} was zero.
36681
36682 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
36683 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
36684 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
36685 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
36686 some characters were escaped.
36687
36688 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
36689 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
36690 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
36691 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
36692 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
36693 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
36694 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
36695 error occurred.
36696
36697 @item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
36698 Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
36699 or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
36700
36701 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
36702 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
36703 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
36704
36705 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
36706 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
36707 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
36708 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
36709 some characters were escaped.
36710
36711 @end table
36712
36713 @node Interrupts
36714 @section Interrupts
36715 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
36716
36717 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
36718 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or
36719 a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g},
36720 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
36721
36722 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
36723 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
36724 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
36725 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
36726 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
36727
36728 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
36729 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
36730 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
36731 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
36732 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
36733 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
36734 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
36735 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
36736
36737 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
36738 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
36739 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
36740
36741 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
36742 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
36743 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
36744 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
36745 currently-executing threads and processes.
36746 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
36747 running program, it should send one of the stop
36748 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
36749 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
36750 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
36751 Interrupts received while the
36752 program is stopped are discarded.
36753
36754 @node Notification Packets
36755 @section Notification Packets
36756 @cindex notification packets
36757 @cindex packets, notification
36758
36759 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
36760 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
36761 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
36762 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
36763 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
36764 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
36765 is not a problem.
36766
36767 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
36768 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
36769 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
36770 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
36771 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
36772 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
36773 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
36774
36775 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
36776 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
36777
36778 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
36779 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
36780 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
36781 not they understand it.
36782
36783 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
36784 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
36785 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
36786 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
36787 recipients.
36788
36789 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
36790 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
36791 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
36792 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
36793 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
36794
36795 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
36796 @table @samp
36797 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
36798 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
36799 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
36800 carrying the specific information about the notification.
36801 @var{name} is the name of the notification.
36802 @item @var{ack}
36803 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
36804 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
36805 @end table
36806
36807 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
36808 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
36809
36810 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
36811 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
36812 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
36813 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
36814 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
36815 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
36816 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
36817 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
36818 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
36819 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
36820
36821 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
36822 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
36823 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
36824 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
36825 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
36826 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
36827
36828 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
36829 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
36830 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
36831 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
36832 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
36833
36834 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
36835 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
36836 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
36837 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
36838 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
36839 normally.
36840
36841 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
36842 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
36843 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
36844 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
36845 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
36846 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
36847 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
36848 the process shall be repeated.
36849
36850 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
36851 following example:
36852 @smallexample
36853 <- @code{%%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
36854 @code{...}
36855 -> @code{vStopped}
36856 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
36857 -> @code{vStopped}
36858 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
36859 -> @code{vStopped}
36860 <- @code{OK}
36861 @end smallexample
36862
36863 The following notifications are defined:
36864 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
36865
36866 @item Notification
36867 @tab Ack
36868 @tab Event
36869 @tab Description
36870
36871 @item Stop
36872 @tab vStopped
36873 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
36874 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
36875 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
36876 @value{GDBN}.
36877 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
36878
36879 @end multitable
36880
36881 @node Remote Non-Stop
36882 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
36883
36884 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
36885 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
36886 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
36887 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36888
36889 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
36890 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
36891 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
36892 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
36893 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
36894 probe the target state after a mode change.
36895
36896 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
36897 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
36898 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
36899 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
36900 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
36901 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
36902 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
36903 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
36904 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
36905 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
36906 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
36907
36908 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
36909 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
36910 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
36911 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
36912 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
36913 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
36914 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
36915 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
36916 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
36917 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
36918 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
36919 @samp{OK}.
36920
36921 @node Packet Acknowledgment
36922 @section Packet Acknowledgment
36923
36924 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
36925 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
36926 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
36927 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
36928 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
36929 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
36930 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
36931
36932 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
36933 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
36934 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
36935 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
36936 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
36937
36938 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
36939 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
36940 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
36941 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
36942
36943 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
36944 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
36945 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
36946 @pxref{qSupported}.
36947 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
36948 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
36949 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
36950 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
36951 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
36952 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
36953 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
36954
36955 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
36956 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
36957 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
36958 connection.
36959 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
36960 new connection is established,
36961 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
36962 for the current connection, once disabled.
36963
36964 @node Examples
36965 @section Examples
36966
36967 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
36968 does not get any direct output:
36969
36970 @smallexample
36971 -> @code{R00}
36972 <- @code{+}
36973 @emph{target restarts}
36974 -> @code{?}
36975 <- @code{+}
36976 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
36977 -> @code{+}
36978 @end smallexample
36979
36980 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
36981
36982 @smallexample
36983 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
36984 <- @code{+}
36985 -> @code{s}
36986 <- @code{+}
36987 @emph{time passes}
36988 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
36989 -> @code{+}
36990 -> @code{g}
36991 <- @code{+}
36992 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
36993 -> @code{+}
36994 @end smallexample
36995
36996 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
36997 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
36998 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
36999
37000 @menu
37001 * File-I/O Overview::
37002 * Protocol Basics::
37003 * The F Request Packet::
37004 * The F Reply Packet::
37005 * The Ctrl-C Message::
37006 * Console I/O::
37007 * List of Supported Calls::
37008 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
37009 * Constants::
37010 * File-I/O Examples::
37011 @end menu
37012
37013 @node File-I/O Overview
37014 @subsection File-I/O Overview
37015 @cindex file-i/o overview
37016
37017 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
37018 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
37019 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
37020 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
37021 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
37022 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
37023
37024 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
37025 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
37026 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
37027 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
37028 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
37029
37030 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
37031 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
37032 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
37033 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
37034 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
37035 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
37036 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
37037
37038 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
37039 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
37040 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
37041 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
37042 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
37043
37044 @smallexample
37045 (@value{GDBP}) continue
37046 <- target requests 'system call X'
37047 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
37048 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
37049 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
37050 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
37051 @end smallexample
37052
37053 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
37054 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
37055 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
37056 system are not supported by this protocol.
37057
37058 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
37059
37060 @node Protocol Basics
37061 @subsection Protocol Basics
37062 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
37063
37064 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
37065 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
37066 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
37067 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
37068 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
37069 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
37070 to call the appropriate host system call:
37071
37072 @itemize @bullet
37073 @item
37074 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
37075
37076 @item
37077 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
37078 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
37079 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
37080 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
37081
37082 @end itemize
37083
37084 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
37085
37086 @itemize @bullet
37087 @item
37088 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
37089 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
37090 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
37091 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
37092 packet.
37093
37094 @item
37095 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
37096 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
37097
37098 @item
37099 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
37100
37101 @item
37102 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
37103
37104 @item
37105 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
37106 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
37107 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
37108 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
37109 packet.
37110
37111 @end itemize
37112
37113 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
37114 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
37115
37116 @itemize @bullet
37117 @item
37118 Return value.
37119
37120 @item
37121 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
37122
37123 @item
37124 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
37125
37126 @end itemize
37127
37128 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
37129 the latest continue or step action.
37130
37131 @node The F Request Packet
37132 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
37133 @cindex file-i/o request packet
37134 @cindex @code{F} request packet
37135
37136 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
37137
37138 @table @samp
37139 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
37140
37141 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
37142 This is just the name of the function.
37143
37144 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
37145 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
37146 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
37147 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
37148 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
37149 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
37150 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
37151
37152 @end table
37153
37154
37155
37156 @node The F Reply Packet
37157 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
37158 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
37159 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
37160
37161 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
37162
37163 @table @samp
37164
37165 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
37166
37167 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
37168
37169 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
37170 representation.
37171 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
37172
37173 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
37174 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
37175 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
37176
37177 @smallexample
37178 F0,0,C
37179 @end smallexample
37180
37181 @noindent
37182 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
37183
37184 @smallexample
37185 F-1,4,C
37186 @end smallexample
37187
37188 @noindent
37189 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
37190
37191 @end table
37192
37193
37194 @node The Ctrl-C Message
37195 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
37196 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
37197
37198 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
37199 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
37200 the target should behave as if it had
37201 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
37202 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
37203 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
37204 packet.
37205
37206 It's important for the target to know in which
37207 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
37208
37209 @itemize @bullet
37210 @item
37211 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
37212
37213 @item
37214 The system call on the host has been finished.
37215
37216 @end itemize
37217
37218 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
37219 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
37220 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
37221 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
37222 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
37223 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
37224
37225 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
37226 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
37227 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
37228 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
37229 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
37230 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
37231 or the full action has been completed.
37232
37233 @node Console I/O
37234 @subsection Console I/O
37235 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
37236
37237 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
37238 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
37239 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
37240 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
37241 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
37242 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
37243 conditions is met:
37244
37245 @itemize @bullet
37246 @item
37247 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
37248 @code{read}
37249 system call is treated as finished.
37250
37251 @item
37252 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
37253 newline.
37254
37255 @item
37256 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
37257 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
37258
37259 @end itemize
37260
37261 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
37262 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
37263 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
37264 is stopped at the user's request.
37265
37266
37267 @node List of Supported Calls
37268 @subsection List of Supported Calls
37269 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
37270
37271 @menu
37272 * open::
37273 * close::
37274 * read::
37275 * write::
37276 * lseek::
37277 * rename::
37278 * unlink::
37279 * stat/fstat::
37280 * gettimeofday::
37281 * isatty::
37282 * system::
37283 @end menu
37284
37285 @node open
37286 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
37287 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
37288
37289 @table @asis
37290 @item Synopsis:
37291 @smallexample
37292 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
37293 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
37294 @end smallexample
37295
37296 @item Request:
37297 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
37298
37299 @noindent
37300 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
37301
37302 @table @code
37303 @item O_CREAT
37304 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
37305 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
37306 are concerned.
37307
37308 @item O_EXCL
37309 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
37310 an error and open() fails.
37311
37312 @item O_TRUNC
37313 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
37314 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
37315 truncated to zero length.
37316
37317 @item O_APPEND
37318 The file is opened in append mode.
37319
37320 @item O_RDONLY
37321 The file is opened for reading only.
37322
37323 @item O_WRONLY
37324 The file is opened for writing only.
37325
37326 @item O_RDWR
37327 The file is opened for reading and writing.
37328 @end table
37329
37330 @noindent
37331 Other bits are silently ignored.
37332
37333
37334 @noindent
37335 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
37336
37337 @table @code
37338 @item S_IRUSR
37339 User has read permission.
37340
37341 @item S_IWUSR
37342 User has write permission.
37343
37344 @item S_IRGRP
37345 Group has read permission.
37346
37347 @item S_IWGRP
37348 Group has write permission.
37349
37350 @item S_IROTH
37351 Others have read permission.
37352
37353 @item S_IWOTH
37354 Others have write permission.
37355 @end table
37356
37357 @noindent
37358 Other bits are silently ignored.
37359
37360
37361 @item Return value:
37362 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
37363 occurred.
37364
37365 @item Errors:
37366
37367 @table @code
37368 @item EEXIST
37369 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
37370
37371 @item EISDIR
37372 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
37373
37374 @item EACCES
37375 The requested access is not allowed.
37376
37377 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37378 @var{pathname} was too long.
37379
37380 @item ENOENT
37381 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
37382
37383 @item ENODEV
37384 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
37385
37386 @item EROFS
37387 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
37388 write access was requested.
37389
37390 @item EFAULT
37391 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
37392
37393 @item ENOSPC
37394 No space on device to create the file.
37395
37396 @item EMFILE
37397 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
37398
37399 @item ENFILE
37400 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
37401 has been reached.
37402
37403 @item EINTR
37404 The call was interrupted by the user.
37405 @end table
37406
37407 @end table
37408
37409 @node close
37410 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
37411 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
37412
37413 @table @asis
37414 @item Synopsis:
37415 @smallexample
37416 int close(int fd);
37417 @end smallexample
37418
37419 @item Request:
37420 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
37421
37422 @item Return value:
37423 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
37424
37425 @item Errors:
37426
37427 @table @code
37428 @item EBADF
37429 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
37430
37431 @item EINTR
37432 The call was interrupted by the user.
37433 @end table
37434
37435 @end table
37436
37437 @node read
37438 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
37439 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
37440
37441 @table @asis
37442 @item Synopsis:
37443 @smallexample
37444 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
37445 @end smallexample
37446
37447 @item Request:
37448 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
37449
37450 @item Return value:
37451 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
37452 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
37453 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
37454
37455 @item Errors:
37456
37457 @table @code
37458 @item EBADF
37459 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
37460 reading.
37461
37462 @item EFAULT
37463 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37464
37465 @item EINTR
37466 The call was interrupted by the user.
37467 @end table
37468
37469 @end table
37470
37471 @node write
37472 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
37473 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
37474
37475 @table @asis
37476 @item Synopsis:
37477 @smallexample
37478 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
37479 @end smallexample
37480
37481 @item Request:
37482 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
37483
37484 @item Return value:
37485 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
37486 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
37487 is returned.
37488
37489 @item Errors:
37490
37491 @table @code
37492 @item EBADF
37493 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
37494 writing.
37495
37496 @item EFAULT
37497 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37498
37499 @item EFBIG
37500 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
37501 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
37502
37503 @item ENOSPC
37504 No space on device to write the data.
37505
37506 @item EINTR
37507 The call was interrupted by the user.
37508 @end table
37509
37510 @end table
37511
37512 @node lseek
37513 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
37514 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
37515
37516 @table @asis
37517 @item Synopsis:
37518 @smallexample
37519 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
37520 @end smallexample
37521
37522 @item Request:
37523 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
37524
37525 @var{flag} is one of:
37526
37527 @table @code
37528 @item SEEK_SET
37529 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
37530
37531 @item SEEK_CUR
37532 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
37533 bytes.
37534
37535 @item SEEK_END
37536 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
37537 bytes.
37538 @end table
37539
37540 @item Return value:
37541 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
37542 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
37543 value of -1 is returned.
37544
37545 @item Errors:
37546
37547 @table @code
37548 @item EBADF
37549 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
37550
37551 @item ESPIPE
37552 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
37553
37554 @item EINVAL
37555 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
37556
37557 @item EINTR
37558 The call was interrupted by the user.
37559 @end table
37560
37561 @end table
37562
37563 @node rename
37564 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
37565 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
37566
37567 @table @asis
37568 @item Synopsis:
37569 @smallexample
37570 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
37571 @end smallexample
37572
37573 @item Request:
37574 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
37575
37576 @item Return value:
37577 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
37578
37579 @item Errors:
37580
37581 @table @code
37582 @item EISDIR
37583 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
37584 directory.
37585
37586 @item EEXIST
37587 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
37588
37589 @item EBUSY
37590 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
37591 process.
37592
37593 @item EINVAL
37594 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
37595 of itself.
37596
37597 @item ENOTDIR
37598 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
37599 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
37600 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
37601
37602 @item EFAULT
37603 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
37604
37605 @item EACCES
37606 No access to the file or the path of the file.
37607
37608 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37609
37610 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
37611
37612 @item ENOENT
37613 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
37614
37615 @item EROFS
37616 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
37617
37618 @item ENOSPC
37619 The device containing the file has no room for the new
37620 directory entry.
37621
37622 @item EINTR
37623 The call was interrupted by the user.
37624 @end table
37625
37626 @end table
37627
37628 @node unlink
37629 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
37630 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
37631
37632 @table @asis
37633 @item Synopsis:
37634 @smallexample
37635 int unlink(const char *pathname);
37636 @end smallexample
37637
37638 @item Request:
37639 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
37640
37641 @item Return value:
37642 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
37643
37644 @item Errors:
37645
37646 @table @code
37647 @item EACCES
37648 No access to the file or the path of the file.
37649
37650 @item EPERM
37651 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
37652
37653 @item EBUSY
37654 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
37655 being used by another process.
37656
37657 @item EFAULT
37658 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37659
37660 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37661 @var{pathname} was too long.
37662
37663 @item ENOENT
37664 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
37665
37666 @item ENOTDIR
37667 A component of the path is not a directory.
37668
37669 @item EROFS
37670 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
37671
37672 @item EINTR
37673 The call was interrupted by the user.
37674 @end table
37675
37676 @end table
37677
37678 @node stat/fstat
37679 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
37680 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
37681 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
37682
37683 @table @asis
37684 @item Synopsis:
37685 @smallexample
37686 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
37687 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
37688 @end smallexample
37689
37690 @item Request:
37691 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
37692 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
37693
37694 @item Return value:
37695 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
37696
37697 @item Errors:
37698
37699 @table @code
37700 @item EBADF
37701 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
37702
37703 @item ENOENT
37704 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
37705 path is an empty string.
37706
37707 @item ENOTDIR
37708 A component of the path is not a directory.
37709
37710 @item EFAULT
37711 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37712
37713 @item EACCES
37714 No access to the file or the path of the file.
37715
37716 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37717 @var{pathname} was too long.
37718
37719 @item EINTR
37720 The call was interrupted by the user.
37721 @end table
37722
37723 @end table
37724
37725 @node gettimeofday
37726 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
37727 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
37728
37729 @table @asis
37730 @item Synopsis:
37731 @smallexample
37732 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
37733 @end smallexample
37734
37735 @item Request:
37736 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
37737
37738 @item Return value:
37739 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
37740
37741 @item Errors:
37742
37743 @table @code
37744 @item EINVAL
37745 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
37746
37747 @item EFAULT
37748 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37749 @end table
37750
37751 @end table
37752
37753 @node isatty
37754 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
37755 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
37756
37757 @table @asis
37758 @item Synopsis:
37759 @smallexample
37760 int isatty(int fd);
37761 @end smallexample
37762
37763 @item Request:
37764 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
37765
37766 @item Return value:
37767 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
37768
37769 @item Errors:
37770
37771 @table @code
37772 @item EINTR
37773 The call was interrupted by the user.
37774 @end table
37775
37776 @end table
37777
37778 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
37779 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
37780 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
37781 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
37782 needed.
37783
37784
37785 @node system
37786 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
37787 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
37788
37789 @table @asis
37790 @item Synopsis:
37791 @smallexample
37792 int system(const char *command);
37793 @end smallexample
37794
37795 @item Request:
37796 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
37797
37798 @item Return value:
37799 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
37800 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
37801 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
37802 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
37803 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
37804 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
37805 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
37806
37807 @item Errors:
37808
37809 @table @code
37810 @item EINTR
37811 The call was interrupted by the user.
37812 @end table
37813
37814 @end table
37815
37816 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
37817 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
37818 the host is simplified before it's returned
37819 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
37820 is discarded, and the return value consists
37821 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
37822
37823 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
37824 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
37825 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
37826
37827 @table @code
37828 @item set remote system-call-allowed
37829 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
37830 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
37831 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
37832
37833 @item show remote system-call-allowed
37834 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
37835 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
37836 protocol.
37837 @end table
37838
37839 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
37840 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
37841 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
37842
37843 @menu
37844 * Integral Datatypes::
37845 * Pointer Values::
37846 * Memory Transfer::
37847 * struct stat::
37848 * struct timeval::
37849 @end menu
37850
37851 @node Integral Datatypes
37852 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
37853 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
37854
37855 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
37856 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
37857 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
37858
37859 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
37860 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
37861
37862 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
37863
37864 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
37865 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
37866
37867 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
37868
37869 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
37870 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
37871 byte order.
37872
37873 @node Pointer Values
37874 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
37875 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
37876
37877 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
37878 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
37879 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
37880 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
37881
37882 @smallexample
37883 @code{1aaf/12}
37884 @end smallexample
37885
37886 @noindent
37887 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
37888 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
37889 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
37890 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
37891
37892 @smallexample
37893 @code{123456/d}
37894 @end smallexample
37895
37896 @node Memory Transfer
37897 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
37898 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
37899
37900 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
37901 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
37902 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
37903 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
37904 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
37905 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
37906 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
37907
37908
37909 @node struct stat
37910 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
37911 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
37912
37913 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
37914 is defined as follows:
37915
37916 @smallexample
37917 struct stat @{
37918 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
37919 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
37920 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
37921 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
37922 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
37923 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
37924 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
37925 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
37926 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
37927 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
37928 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
37929 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
37930 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
37931 @};
37932 @end smallexample
37933
37934 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
37935 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
37936 structure is of size 64 bytes.
37937
37938 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
37939 range of values.
37940
37941 @table @code
37942
37943 @item st_dev
37944 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
37945
37946 @item st_ino
37947 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
37948
37949 @item st_mode
37950 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
37951 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
37952
37953 @item st_uid
37954 @itemx st_gid
37955 @itemx st_rdev
37956 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
37957
37958 @item st_atime
37959 @itemx st_mtime
37960 @itemx st_ctime
37961 These values have a host and file system dependent
37962 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
37963 support exact timing values.
37964 @end table
37965
37966 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
37967 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
37968 continuing.
37969
37970 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
37971 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
37972 get truncated on the target.
37973
37974 @node struct timeval
37975 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
37976 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
37977
37978 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
37979 is defined as follows:
37980
37981 @smallexample
37982 struct timeval @{
37983 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
37984 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
37985 @};
37986 @end smallexample
37987
37988 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
37989 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
37990 structure is of size 8 bytes.
37991
37992 @node Constants
37993 @subsection Constants
37994 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
37995
37996 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
37997 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
37998 values before and after the call as needed.
37999
38000 @menu
38001 * Open Flags::
38002 * mode_t Values::
38003 * Errno Values::
38004 * Lseek Flags::
38005 * Limits::
38006 @end menu
38007
38008 @node Open Flags
38009 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
38010 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
38011
38012 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
38013
38014 @smallexample
38015 O_RDONLY 0x0
38016 O_WRONLY 0x1
38017 O_RDWR 0x2
38018 O_APPEND 0x8
38019 O_CREAT 0x200
38020 O_TRUNC 0x400
38021 O_EXCL 0x800
38022 @end smallexample
38023
38024 @node mode_t Values
38025 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
38026 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
38027
38028 All values are given in octal representation.
38029
38030 @smallexample
38031 S_IFREG 0100000
38032 S_IFDIR 040000
38033 S_IRUSR 0400
38034 S_IWUSR 0200
38035 S_IXUSR 0100
38036 S_IRGRP 040
38037 S_IWGRP 020
38038 S_IXGRP 010
38039 S_IROTH 04
38040 S_IWOTH 02
38041 S_IXOTH 01
38042 @end smallexample
38043
38044 @node Errno Values
38045 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
38046 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
38047
38048 All values are given in decimal representation.
38049
38050 @smallexample
38051 EPERM 1
38052 ENOENT 2
38053 EINTR 4
38054 EBADF 9
38055 EACCES 13
38056 EFAULT 14
38057 EBUSY 16
38058 EEXIST 17
38059 ENODEV 19
38060 ENOTDIR 20
38061 EISDIR 21
38062 EINVAL 22
38063 ENFILE 23
38064 EMFILE 24
38065 EFBIG 27
38066 ENOSPC 28
38067 ESPIPE 29
38068 EROFS 30
38069 ENAMETOOLONG 91
38070 EUNKNOWN 9999
38071 @end smallexample
38072
38073 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
38074 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
38075
38076 @node Lseek Flags
38077 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
38078 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
38079
38080 @smallexample
38081 SEEK_SET 0
38082 SEEK_CUR 1
38083 SEEK_END 2
38084 @end smallexample
38085
38086 @node Limits
38087 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
38088 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
38089
38090 All values are given in decimal representation.
38091
38092 @smallexample
38093 INT_MIN -2147483648
38094 INT_MAX 2147483647
38095 UINT_MAX 4294967295
38096 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
38097 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
38098 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
38099 @end smallexample
38100
38101 @node File-I/O Examples
38102 @subsection File-I/O Examples
38103 @cindex file-i/o examples
38104
38105 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
38106 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
38107
38108 @smallexample
38109 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
38110 @emph{request memory read from target}
38111 -> @code{m1234,6}
38112 <- XXXXXX
38113 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
38114 -> @code{F6}
38115 @end smallexample
38116
38117 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
38118 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
38119
38120 @smallexample
38121 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38122 @emph{request memory write to target}
38123 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
38124 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
38125 -> @code{F6}
38126 @end smallexample
38127
38128 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
38129 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
38130
38131 @smallexample
38132 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38133 -> @code{F-1,9}
38134 @end smallexample
38135
38136 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
38137 host is called:
38138
38139 @smallexample
38140 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38141 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
38142 <- @code{T02}
38143 @end smallexample
38144
38145 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
38146 host is called:
38147
38148 @smallexample
38149 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38150 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
38151 <- @code{T02}
38152 @end smallexample
38153
38154 @node Library List Format
38155 @section Library List Format
38156 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
38157
38158 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
38159 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
38160 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
38161 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
38162 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
38163 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
38164 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
38165 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
38166 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
38167 are loaded.
38168
38169 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
38170 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
38171 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
38172 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
38173
38174 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
38175 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
38176 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
38177 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
38178 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
38179 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
38180
38181 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38182 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
38183
38184 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
38185 offset, looks like this:
38186
38187 @smallexample
38188 <library-list>
38189 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
38190 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
38191 </library>
38192 </library-list>
38193 @end smallexample
38194
38195 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
38196 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
38197
38198 @smallexample
38199 <library-list>
38200 <library name="sharedlib.o">
38201 <section address="0x10000000"/>
38202 <section address="0x20000000"/>
38203 <section address="0x30000000"/>
38204 </library>
38205 </library-list>
38206 @end smallexample
38207
38208 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
38209
38210 @smallexample
38211 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
38212 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
38213 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38214 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
38215 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
38216 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
38217 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
38218 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
38219 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
38220 @end smallexample
38221
38222 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
38223 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
38224 section for each library.
38225
38226 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
38227 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
38228 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
38229
38230 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
38231 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
38232 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
38233 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
38234
38235 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
38236 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
38237 target, the following parameters are reported:
38238
38239 @itemize @minus
38240 @item
38241 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
38242 @code{struct link_map}.
38243 @item
38244 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
38245 (Thread Local Storage) access.
38246 @item
38247 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
38248 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
38249 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
38250 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
38251 @item
38252 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
38253 @end itemize
38254
38255 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
38256 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
38257 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
38258
38259 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38260 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
38261
38262 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
38263 looks like this:
38264
38265 @smallexample
38266 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
38267 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
38268 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
38269 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
38270 l_ld="0x152350"/>
38271 </library-list-svr>
38272 @end smallexample
38273
38274 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
38275
38276 @smallexample
38277 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
38278 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
38279 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38280 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
38281 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
38282 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
38283 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
38284 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
38285 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
38286 @end smallexample
38287
38288 @node Memory Map Format
38289 @section Memory Map Format
38290 @cindex memory map format
38291
38292 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
38293 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
38294 memory map.
38295
38296 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
38297 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
38298 lists memory regions.
38299
38300 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38301 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
38302
38303 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
38304
38305 @smallexample
38306 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38307 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
38308 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
38309 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
38310 <memory-map>
38311 region...
38312 </memory-map>
38313 @end smallexample
38314
38315 Each region can be either:
38316
38317 @itemize
38318
38319 @item
38320 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
38321 bytes from there:
38322
38323 @smallexample
38324 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
38325 @end smallexample
38326
38327
38328 @item
38329 A region of read-only memory:
38330
38331 @smallexample
38332 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
38333 @end smallexample
38334
38335
38336 @item
38337 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
38338 bytes in length:
38339
38340 @smallexample
38341 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
38342 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
38343 </memory>
38344 @end smallexample
38345
38346 @end itemize
38347
38348 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
38349 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
38350 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
38351
38352 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
38353
38354 @smallexample
38355 <!-- ................................................... -->
38356 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
38357 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
38358 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
38359 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
38360 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
38361 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
38362 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
38363 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
38364 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
38365 and its type, or device. -->
38366 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
38367 start CDATA #REQUIRED
38368 length CDATA #REQUIRED
38369 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
38370 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
38371 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
38372 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
38373 @end smallexample
38374
38375 @node Thread List Format
38376 @section Thread List Format
38377 @cindex thread list format
38378
38379 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
38380 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
38381 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
38382 the following structure:
38383
38384 @smallexample
38385 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38386 <threads>
38387 <thread id="id" core="0">
38388 ... description ...
38389 </thread>
38390 </threads>
38391 @end smallexample
38392
38393 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
38394 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
38395 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
38396 the thread was last executing on. The content of the of @samp{thread}
38397 element is interpreted as human-readable auxilliary information.
38398
38399 @node Traceframe Info Format
38400 @section Traceframe Info Format
38401 @cindex traceframe info format
38402
38403 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
38404 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
38405 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
38406 collected in a traceframe.
38407
38408 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
38409 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
38410
38411 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38412 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
38413
38414 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
38415
38416 @smallexample
38417 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38418 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
38419 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
38420 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
38421 <traceframe-info>
38422 block...
38423 </traceframe-info>
38424 @end smallexample
38425
38426 Each traceframe block can be either:
38427
38428 @itemize
38429
38430 @item
38431 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
38432 @var{length} bytes from there:
38433
38434 @smallexample
38435 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
38436 @end smallexample
38437
38438 @item
38439 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
38440 collected:
38441
38442 @smallexample
38443 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
38444 @end smallexample
38445
38446 @end itemize
38447
38448 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
38449
38450 @smallexample
38451 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
38452 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38453
38454 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
38455 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
38456 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
38457 <!ELEMENT tvar>
38458 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
38459 @end smallexample
38460
38461 @node Branch Trace Format
38462 @section Branch Trace Format
38463 @cindex branch trace format
38464
38465 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
38466 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
38467 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
38468 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
38469
38470 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
38471 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
38472
38473 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38474 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
38475
38476 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
38477
38478 @smallexample
38479 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38480 <!DOCTYPE btrace
38481 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
38482 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
38483 <btrace>
38484 block...
38485 </btrace>
38486 @end smallexample
38487
38488 @itemize
38489
38490 @item
38491 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
38492 and ending at @var{end}:
38493
38494 @smallexample
38495 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
38496 @end smallexample
38497
38498 @end itemize
38499
38500 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
38501
38502 @smallexample
38503 <!ELEMENT btrace (block)* >
38504 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38505
38506 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
38507 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
38508 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
38509 @end smallexample
38510
38511 @include agentexpr.texi
38512
38513 @node Target Descriptions
38514 @appendix Target Descriptions
38515 @cindex target descriptions
38516
38517 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
38518 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
38519 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
38520 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
38521 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
38522 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
38523 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
38524
38525 @itemize @bullet
38526 @item
38527 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
38528 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
38529 @item
38530 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
38531 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
38532 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
38533 @item
38534 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
38535 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
38536 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
38537 @end itemize
38538
38539 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
38540 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
38541 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
38542 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
38543 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
38544
38545 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38546 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
38547
38548 @menu
38549 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
38550 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
38551 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
38552 descriptions.
38553 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
38554 @end menu
38555
38556 @node Retrieving Descriptions
38557 @section Retrieving Descriptions
38558
38559 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
38560 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
38561 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
38562 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
38563 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
38564 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
38565 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
38566 Format}.
38567
38568 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
38569 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
38570 specify a file are:
38571
38572 @table @code
38573 @cindex set tdesc filename
38574 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
38575 Read the target description from @var{path}.
38576
38577 @cindex unset tdesc filename
38578 @item unset tdesc filename
38579 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
38580 will use the description supplied by the current target.
38581
38582 @cindex show tdesc filename
38583 @item show tdesc filename
38584 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
38585 @end table
38586
38587
38588 @node Target Description Format
38589 @section Target Description Format
38590 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
38591
38592 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
38593 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
38594 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
38595 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
38596 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
38597 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
38598 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
38599
38600 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
38601 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
38602 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
38603 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
38604 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
38605
38606 Here is a simple target description:
38607
38608 @smallexample
38609 <target version="1.0">
38610 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
38611 </target>
38612 @end smallexample
38613
38614 @noindent
38615 This minimal description only says that the target uses
38616 the x86-64 architecture.
38617
38618 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
38619 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
38620 are explained further below.
38621
38622 @smallexample
38623 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38624 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
38625 <target version="1.0">
38626 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
38627 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
38628 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
38629 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
38630 </target>
38631 @end smallexample
38632
38633 @noindent
38634 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
38635 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
38636 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
38637 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
38638 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
38639 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
38640 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
38641 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
38642 the version mismatch.
38643
38644 @subsection Inclusion
38645 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
38646 @cindex XInclude
38647 @ifnotinfo
38648 @cindex <xi:include>
38649 @end ifnotinfo
38650
38651 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
38652 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
38653 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
38654 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
38655 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
38656
38657 @smallexample
38658 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
38659 @end smallexample
38660
38661 @noindent
38662 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
38663 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
38664 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
38665 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
38666 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
38667 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
38668 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
38669 original description.
38670
38671 @subsection Architecture
38672 @cindex <architecture>
38673
38674 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
38675
38676 @smallexample
38677 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
38678 @end smallexample
38679
38680 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
38681 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
38682
38683 @subsection OS ABI
38684 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
38685
38686 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
38687 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
38688
38689 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
38690
38691 @smallexample
38692 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
38693 @end smallexample
38694
38695 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
38696 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
38697
38698 @subsection Compatible Architecture
38699 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
38700
38701 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
38702 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
38703
38704 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
38705
38706 @smallexample
38707 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
38708 @end smallexample
38709
38710 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
38711 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
38712
38713 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
38714 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
38715 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
38716 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
38717 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
38718 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
38719 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
38720
38721 @smallexample
38722 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
38723 <compatible>spu</compatible>
38724 @end smallexample
38725
38726 @subsection Features
38727 @cindex <feature>
38728
38729 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
38730 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
38731 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
38732 has this form:
38733
38734 @smallexample
38735 <feature name="@var{name}">
38736 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
38737 @var{reg}@dots{}
38738 </feature>
38739 @end smallexample
38740
38741 @noindent
38742 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
38743 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
38744 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
38745 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
38746
38747 @subsection Types
38748
38749 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
38750 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
38751 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
38752 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
38753 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
38754
38755 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
38756 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
38757 Types must be defined before they are used.
38758
38759 @cindex <vector>
38760 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
38761 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
38762 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
38763 @var{count}:
38764
38765 @smallexample
38766 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
38767 @end smallexample
38768
38769 @cindex <union>
38770 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
38771 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
38772 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
38773 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
38774
38775 @smallexample
38776 <union id="@var{id}">
38777 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
38778 @dots{}
38779 </union>
38780 @end smallexample
38781
38782 @cindex <struct>
38783 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
38784 it with a structure type. There are two forms of the @samp{<struct>}
38785 element; a @samp{<struct>} element must either contain only bitfields
38786 or contain no bitfields. If the structure contains only bitfields,
38787 its total size in bytes must be specified, each bitfield must have an
38788 explicit start and end, and bitfields are automatically assigned an
38789 integer type. The field's @var{start} should be less than or
38790 equal to its @var{end}, and zero represents the least significant bit.
38791
38792 @smallexample
38793 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
38794 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
38795 @dots{}
38796 </struct>
38797 @end smallexample
38798
38799 If the structure contains no bitfields, then each field has an
38800 explicit type, and no implicit padding is added.
38801
38802 @smallexample
38803 <struct id="@var{id}">
38804 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
38805 @dots{}
38806 </struct>
38807 @end smallexample
38808
38809 @cindex <flags>
38810 If a register's value is a series of single-bit flags, define it with
38811 a flags type. The @samp{<flags>} element has an explicit @var{size}
38812 and contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements. Each field has a
38813 @var{name}, a @var{start}, and an @var{end}. Only single-bit flags
38814 are supported.
38815
38816 @smallexample
38817 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
38818 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
38819 @dots{}
38820 </flags>
38821 @end smallexample
38822
38823 @subsection Registers
38824 @cindex <reg>
38825
38826 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
38827
38828 @smallexample
38829 <reg name="@var{name}"
38830 bitsize="@var{size}"
38831 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
38832 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
38833 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
38834 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
38835 @end smallexample
38836
38837 @noindent
38838 The components are as follows:
38839
38840 @table @var
38841
38842 @item name
38843 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
38844
38845 @item bitsize
38846 The register's size, in bits.
38847
38848 @item regnum
38849 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
38850 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
38851 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
38852 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
38853 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
38854 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
38855 in order of increasing register number.
38856
38857 @item save-restore
38858 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
38859 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
38860 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
38861 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
38862 ABI.
38863
38864 @item type
38865 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
38866 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
38867 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
38868 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
38869 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
38870 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
38871
38872 @item group
38873 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
38874 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
38875 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
38876 in @code{info registers}.
38877
38878 @end table
38879
38880 @node Predefined Target Types
38881 @section Predefined Target Types
38882 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
38883
38884 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
38885 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
38886 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
38887 types. The currently supported types are:
38888
38889 @table @code
38890
38891 @item int8
38892 @itemx int16
38893 @itemx int32
38894 @itemx int64
38895 @itemx int128
38896 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
38897
38898 @item uint8
38899 @itemx uint16
38900 @itemx uint32
38901 @itemx uint64
38902 @itemx uint128
38903 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
38904
38905 @item code_ptr
38906 @itemx data_ptr
38907 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
38908 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
38909 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
38910 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
38911 may be marked as data pointers.
38912
38913 @item ieee_single
38914 Single precision IEEE floating point.
38915
38916 @item ieee_double
38917 Double precision IEEE floating point.
38918
38919 @item arm_fpa_ext
38920 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
38921
38922 @item i387_ext
38923 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
38924
38925 @item i386_eflags
38926 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
38927
38928 @item i386_mxcsr
38929 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
38930
38931 @end table
38932
38933 @node Standard Target Features
38934 @section Standard Target Features
38935 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
38936
38937 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
38938 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
38939 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
38940 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
38941 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
38942 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
38943 can recognize them.
38944
38945 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
38946 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
38947 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
38948 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
38949 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
38950 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
38951 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
38952 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
38953
38954 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
38955 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
38956 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
38957
38958 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
38959 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
38960 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
38961 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
38962
38963 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
38964 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
38965 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
38966
38967 @menu
38968 * AArch64 Features::
38969 * ARM Features::
38970 * i386 Features::
38971 * MIPS Features::
38972 * M68K Features::
38973 * Nios II Features::
38974 * PowerPC Features::
38975 * S/390 and System z Features::
38976 * TIC6x Features::
38977 @end menu
38978
38979
38980 @node AArch64 Features
38981 @subsection AArch64 Features
38982 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
38983
38984 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
38985 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
38986 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
38987
38988 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
38989 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
38990 and @samp{fpcr}.
38991
38992 @node ARM Features
38993 @subsection ARM Features
38994 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
38995
38996 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
38997 ARM targets.
38998 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
38999 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
39000
39001 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
39002 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
39003 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
39004 and @samp{xpsr}.
39005
39006 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
39007 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
39008
39009 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
39010 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
39011 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
39012 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
39013
39014 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
39015 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
39016 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
39017 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
39018 halves of the double-precision registers.
39019
39020 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
39021 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
39022 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
39023 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
39024 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
39025 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
39026
39027 @node i386 Features
39028 @subsection i386 Features
39029 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
39030
39031 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
39032 targets. It should describe the following registers:
39033
39034 @itemize @minus
39035 @item
39036 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
39037 @item
39038 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
39039 @item
39040 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
39041 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
39042 @item
39043 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
39044 @item
39045 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
39046 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
39047 @end itemize
39048
39049 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
39050
39051 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
39052 describe registers:
39053
39054 @itemize @minus
39055 @item
39056 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
39057 @item
39058 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
39059 @item
39060 @samp{mxcsr}
39061 @end itemize
39062
39063 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
39064 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
39065 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
39066
39067 @itemize @minus
39068 @item
39069 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
39070 @item
39071 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
39072 @end itemize
39073
39074 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel(R)
39075 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
39076
39077 @itemize @minus
39078 @item
39079 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
39080 @item
39081 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
39082 @end itemize
39083
39084 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
39085 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
39086
39087 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
39088 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
39089 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
39090
39091 @itemize @minus
39092 @item
39093 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
39094 @end itemize
39095
39096 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
39097
39098 @itemize @minus
39099 @item
39100 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
39101 @end itemize
39102
39103 It should
39104 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
39105
39106 @itemize @minus
39107 @item
39108 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
39109 @item
39110 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
39111 @end itemize
39112
39113 It should
39114 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
39115
39116 @itemize @minus
39117 @item
39118 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
39119 @end itemize
39120
39121 @node MIPS Features
39122 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
39123 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
39124
39125 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
39126 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
39127 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
39128 on the target.
39129
39130 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
39131 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
39132 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39133
39134 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
39135 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
39136 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
39137 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39138
39139 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
39140 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
39141 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
39142 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39143
39144 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
39145 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
39146 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
39147
39148 @node M68K Features
39149 @subsection M68K Features
39150 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
39151
39152 @table @code
39153 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
39154 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
39155 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
39156 One of those features must be always present.
39157 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
39158 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
39159 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
39160 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
39161
39162 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
39163 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
39164 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
39165 @samp{fpiaddr}.
39166 @end table
39167
39168 @node Nios II Features
39169 @subsection Nios II Features
39170 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
39171
39172 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
39173 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
39174 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
39175 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
39176 @samp{mpuacc}).
39177
39178 @node PowerPC Features
39179 @subsection PowerPC Features
39180 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
39181
39182 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
39183 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
39184 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
39185 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39186
39187 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
39188 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
39189
39190 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
39191 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
39192 and @samp{vrsave}.
39193
39194 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
39195 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
39196 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
39197 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
39198 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
39199 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
39200
39201 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
39202 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
39203 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
39204 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
39205 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
39206 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
39207 user.
39208
39209 @node S/390 and System z Features
39210 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
39211 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
39212 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
39213
39214 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
39215 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
39216 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
39217 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
39218 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
39219 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
39220 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
39221 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
39222 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
39223
39224 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
39225 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
39226 @samp{fpc}.
39227
39228 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
39229 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
39230
39231 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
39232 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
39233 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
39234 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
39235 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
39236 32-bit wide.
39237
39238 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
39239 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
39240 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
39241
39242 @node TIC6x Features
39243 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
39244 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
39245 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
39246 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
39247 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
39248 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
39249
39250 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
39251 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
39252 through @samp{B31}.
39253
39254 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
39255 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
39256
39257 @node Operating System Information
39258 @appendix Operating System Information
39259 @cindex operating system information
39260
39261 @menu
39262 * Process list::
39263 @end menu
39264
39265 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
39266 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
39267 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
39268 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
39269 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
39270 on a different aspect of target.
39271
39272 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
39273 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
39274 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
39275 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
39276
39277 @node Process list
39278 @appendixsection Process list
39279 @cindex operating system information, process list
39280
39281 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
39282 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
39283 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
39284 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
39285
39286 An example document is:
39287
39288 @smallexample
39289 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39290 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
39291 <osdata type="processes">
39292 <item>
39293 <column name="pid">1</column>
39294 <column name="user">root</column>
39295 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
39296 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
39297 </item>
39298 </osdata>
39299 @end smallexample
39300
39301 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
39302 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
39303 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
39304 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
39305 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
39306 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
39307 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
39308
39309 @node Trace File Format
39310 @appendix Trace File Format
39311 @cindex trace file format
39312
39313 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
39314 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
39315
39316 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
39317 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
39318 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
39319 in the future.
39320
39321 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
39322 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
39323 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
39324 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
39325 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
39326 of this section.
39327
39328 @c FIXME add some specific types of data
39329
39330 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
39331 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
39332 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
39333 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
39334 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
39335 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
39336 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
39337 endianness.
39338
39339 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
39340
39341 @table @code
39342 @item R @var{bytes}
39343 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
39344 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
39345 actual bytes, in target order and @value{GDBN} register order, not a
39346 hexadecimal encoding.
39347
39348 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
39349 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
39350 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
39351 @var{length} bytes.
39352
39353 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
39354 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
39355 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
39356
39357 @end table
39358
39359 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
39360 of blocks.
39361
39362 @node Index Section Format
39363 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
39364 @cindex .gdb_index section format
39365 @cindex index section format
39366
39367 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
39368 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
39369 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
39370 description.
39371
39372 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
39373 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
39374 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
39375 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
39376 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
39377 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
39378
39379 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
39380
39381 @enumerate
39382 @item
39383 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
39384 unless otherwise noted:
39385
39386 @enumerate
39387 @item
39388 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
39389 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
39390 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
39391 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
39392 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
39393 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
39394 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
39395
39396 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
39397 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
39398 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
39399 currently not flagged as deprecated.
39400
39401 @item
39402 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
39403
39404 @item
39405 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
39406 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
39407 to the next offset.
39408
39409 @item
39410 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
39411
39412 @item
39413 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
39414
39415 @item
39416 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
39417 @end enumerate
39418
39419 @item
39420 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
39421 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
39422 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
39423 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
39424 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
39425 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
39426 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
39427 CU indices.
39428
39429 @item
39430 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
39431 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
39432 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
39433 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
39434
39435 @item
39436 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
39437 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
39438
39439 @enumerate
39440 @item
39441 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
39442
39443 @item
39444 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
39445 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
39446
39447 @item
39448 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
39449 @end enumerate
39450
39451 @item
39452 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
39453 the hash table is always a power of 2.
39454
39455 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
39456 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
39457 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
39458 constant pool.
39459
39460 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
39461 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
39462 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
39463
39464 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
39465 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
39466 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
39467 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
39468 index version:
39469
39470 @table @asis
39471 @item Version 4
39472 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
39473
39474 @item Versions 5 to 7
39475 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
39476 @end table
39477
39478 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
39479
39480 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
39481 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
39482 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
39483 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
39484 collision.
39485
39486 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
39487 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
39488 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
39489 the code.
39490
39491 @item
39492 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
39493 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
39494 strings.
39495
39496 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
39497 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
39498 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
39499 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
39500 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
39501 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
39502
39503 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
39504 @end enumerate
39505
39506 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
39507 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
39508 CU index+attributes value for each use.
39509
39510 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
39511 (bit 0 = LSB):
39512
39513 @table @asis
39514
39515 @item Bits 0-23
39516 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
39517 @item Bits 24-27
39518 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
39519 @item Bits 28-30
39520 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
39521
39522 @table @asis
39523 @item 0
39524 This value is reserved and should not be used.
39525 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
39526 with previous versions of the index.
39527 @item 1
39528 The symbol is a type.
39529 @item 2
39530 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
39531 @item 3
39532 The symbol is a function.
39533 @item 4
39534 Any other kind of symbol.
39535 @item 5,6,7
39536 These values are reserved.
39537 @end table
39538
39539 @item Bit 31
39540 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
39541
39542 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
39543 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
39544 @value{GDBN} sources.
39545
39546 @end table
39547
39548 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
39549 global/static attributes in the index.
39550
39551 @smallexample
39552 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
39553 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
39554 switch (die->tag)
39555 @{
39556 case DW_TAG_typedef:
39557 case DW_TAG_base_type:
39558 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
39559 kind = TYPE;
39560 is_static = 1;
39561 break;
39562 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
39563 kind = VARIABLE;
39564 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
39565 break;
39566 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
39567 kind = FUNCTION;
39568 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
39569 break;
39570 case DW_TAG_constant:
39571 kind = VARIABLE;
39572 is_static = ! is_external;
39573 break;
39574 case DW_TAG_variable:
39575 kind = VARIABLE;
39576 is_static = ! is_external;
39577 break;
39578 case DW_TAG_namespace:
39579 kind = TYPE;
39580 is_static = 0;
39581 break;
39582 case DW_TAG_class_type:
39583 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
39584 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
39585 case DW_TAG_union_type:
39586 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
39587 kind = TYPE;
39588 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
39589 break;
39590 default:
39591 assert (0);
39592 @}
39593 @end smallexample
39594
39595 @node Man Pages
39596 @appendix Manual pages
39597 @cindex Man pages
39598
39599 @menu
39600 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
39601 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
39602 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
39603 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
39604 @end menu
39605
39606 @node gdb man
39607 @heading gdb man
39608
39609 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
39610
39611 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
39612 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
39613 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
39614 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
39615 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
39616 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
39617 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
39618 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
39619 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
39620 @c man end
39621
39622 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
39623 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
39624 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
39625 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
39626
39627 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
39628 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
39629
39630 @itemize @bullet
39631 @item
39632 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
39633
39634 @item
39635 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
39636
39637 @item
39638 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
39639
39640 @item
39641 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
39642 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
39643 @end itemize
39644
39645 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
39646 Modula-2.
39647
39648 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
39649 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
39650 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
39651 by using the command @code{help}.
39652
39653 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
39654 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
39655 executable program as the argument:
39656
39657 @smallexample
39658 gdb program
39659 @end smallexample
39660
39661 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
39662
39663 @smallexample
39664 gdb program core
39665 @end smallexample
39666
39667 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
39668 to debug a running process:
39669
39670 @smallexample
39671 gdb program 1234
39672 gdb -p 1234
39673 @end smallexample
39674
39675 @noindent
39676 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
39677 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
39678 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
39679
39680 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
39681
39682 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
39683 @table @env
39684 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{functiop}
39685 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
39686
39687 @item run [@var{arglist}]
39688 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
39689
39690 @item bt
39691 Backtrace: display the program stack.
39692
39693 @item print @var{expr}
39694 Display the value of an expression.
39695
39696 @item c
39697 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
39698
39699 @item next
39700 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
39701 function calls in the line.
39702
39703 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
39704 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
39705
39706 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
39707 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
39708
39709 @item step
39710 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
39711 function calls in the line.
39712
39713 @item help [@var{name}]
39714 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
39715 about using @value{GDBN}.
39716
39717 @item quit
39718 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
39719 @end table
39720
39721 @ifset man
39722 For full details on @value{GDBN},
39723 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
39724 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
39725 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
39726 @end ifset
39727 @c man end
39728
39729 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
39730 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
39731 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
39732 encountered with no
39733 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
39734 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
39735 Many options have
39736 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
39737 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
39738 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
39739 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
39740 more usual convention.)
39741
39742 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
39743 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
39744 option is used.
39745
39746 @table @env
39747 @item -help
39748 @itemx -h
39749 List all options, with brief explanations.
39750
39751 @item -symbols=@var{file}
39752 @itemx -s @var{file}
39753 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
39754
39755 @item -write
39756 Enable writing into executable and core files.
39757
39758 @item -exec=@var{file}
39759 @itemx -e @var{file}
39760 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
39761 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
39762 dump.
39763
39764 @item -se=@var{file}
39765 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
39766 file.
39767
39768 @item -core=@var{file}
39769 @itemx -c @var{file}
39770 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
39771
39772 @item -command=@var{file}
39773 @itemx -x @var{file}
39774 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
39775
39776 @item -ex @var{command}
39777 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
39778
39779 @item -directory=@var{directory}
39780 @itemx -d @var{directory}
39781 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
39782
39783 @item -nh
39784 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
39785
39786 @item -nx
39787 @itemx -n
39788 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
39789
39790 @item -quiet
39791 @itemx -q
39792 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
39793 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
39794
39795 @item -batch
39796 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
39797 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
39798 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
39799 commands in the command files.
39800
39801 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
39802 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
39803 more useful, the message
39804
39805 @smallexample
39806 Program exited normally.
39807 @end smallexample
39808
39809 @noindent
39810 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
39811 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
39812
39813 @item -cd=@var{directory}
39814 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
39815 instead of the current directory.
39816
39817 @item -fullname
39818 @itemx -f
39819 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
39820 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
39821 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
39822 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
39823 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
39824 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
39825 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
39826 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
39827
39828 @item -b @var{bps}
39829 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
39830 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
39831
39832 @item -tty=@var{device}
39833 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
39834 @end table
39835 @c man end
39836
39837 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
39838 @ifset man
39839 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
39840 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
39841 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
39842
39843 @smallexample
39844 info gdb
39845 @end smallexample
39846
39847 @noindent
39848 should give you access to the complete manual.
39849
39850 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
39851 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
39852 @end ifset
39853 @c man end
39854
39855 @node gdbserver man
39856 @heading gdbserver man
39857
39858 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
39859 @format
39860 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
39861 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
39862
39863 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
39864
39865 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
39866 @c man end
39867 @end format
39868
39869 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
39870 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
39871 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
39872
39873 @ifclear man
39874 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
39875 @end ifclear
39876 @ifset man
39877 Usage (server (target) side):
39878 @end ifset
39879
39880 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
39881 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
39882 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
39883 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
39884
39885 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
39886 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
39887 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
39888
39889 @smallexample
39890 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
39891 @end smallexample
39892
39893 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
39894
39895 @smallexample
39896 @ifset man
39897 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
39898 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
39899 @end ifset
39900 @ifclear man
39901 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
39902 @end ifclear
39903 @end smallexample
39904
39905 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
39906 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
39907 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
39908
39909 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
39910
39911 @smallexample
39912 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
39913 @end smallexample
39914
39915 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
39916 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
39917 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
39918 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
39919 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
39920 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
39921 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
39922 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
39923 print an error message and exit.
39924
39925 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
39926 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
39927
39928 @smallexample
39929 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
39930 @end smallexample
39931
39932 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
39933 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
39934
39935 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
39936 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
39937 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
39938 the program you want to debug.
39939
39940 @smallexample
39941 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
39942 @end smallexample
39943
39944 @ifclear man
39945 @subheading Usage (host side)
39946 @end ifclear
39947 @ifset man
39948 Usage (host side):
39949 @end ifset
39950
39951 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
39952 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
39953 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
39954 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
39955 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
39956 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
39957 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
39958 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
39959 descriptor. For example:
39960
39961 @smallexample
39962 @ifset man
39963 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
39964 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
39965 @end ifset
39966 @ifclear man
39967 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
39968 @end ifclear
39969 @end smallexample
39970
39971 @noindent
39972 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
39973
39974 @smallexample
39975 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
39976 @end smallexample
39977
39978 @noindent
39979 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
39980 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
39981 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
39982 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
39983 `Connection refused'.
39984
39985 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
39986 described in
39987 @ifset man
39988 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
39989 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
39990 @end ifset
39991 @ifclear man
39992 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
39993 @end ifclear
39994 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
39995
39996 @smallexample
39997 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
39998 @end smallexample
39999
40000 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
40001 case.
40002 @c man end
40003
40004 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
40005 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
40006
40007 @itemize @bullet
40008
40009 @item
40010 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
40011
40012 @smallexample
40013 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
40014 @end smallexample
40015
40016 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
40017 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
40018 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
40019 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
40020 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
40021 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
40022 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
40023
40024 @item
40025 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
40026 program:
40027
40028 @smallexample
40029 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40030 @end smallexample
40031
40032 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
40033 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
40034 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
40035 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
40036
40037 @item
40038 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
40039
40040 @smallexample
40041 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40042 @end smallexample
40043
40044 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
40045 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
40046 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
40047 debug several processes in the same session.
40048 @end itemize
40049
40050 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
40051
40052 @table @env
40053
40054 @item --help
40055 List all options, with brief explanations.
40056
40057 @item --version
40058 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
40059
40060 @item --attach
40061 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
40062
40063 @smallexample
40064 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40065 @end smallexample
40066
40067 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
40068 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
40069
40070 @item --multi
40071 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
40072 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
40073 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
40074 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
40075
40076 @smallexample
40077 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40078 @end smallexample
40079
40080 @item --debug
40081 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
40082 process.
40083 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
40084 the developers.
40085
40086 @item --remote-debug
40087 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
40088 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
40089 the developers.
40090
40091 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
40092 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
40093 of debugging output.
40094 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
40095
40096 @item --wrapper
40097 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
40098 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
40099 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
40100 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
40101
40102 @item --once
40103 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
40104 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
40105 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
40106 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
40107
40108 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
40109
40110 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
40111 @c QDisableRandomization.
40112
40113 @end table
40114 @c man end
40115
40116 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
40117 @ifset man
40118 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40119 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40120 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40121
40122 @smallexample
40123 info gdb
40124 @end smallexample
40125
40126 should give you access to the complete manual.
40127
40128 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40129 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40130 @end ifset
40131 @c man end
40132
40133 @node gcore man
40134 @heading gcore
40135
40136 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
40137
40138 @format
40139 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
40140 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
40141 @c man end
40142 @end format
40143
40144 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
40145 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
40146 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
40147 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
40148 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
40149 running without any change.
40150 @c man end
40151
40152 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
40153 @table @env
40154 @item -o @var{filename}
40155 The optional argument
40156 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
40157 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
40158 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
40159 @end table
40160 @c man end
40161
40162 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
40163 @ifset man
40164 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40165 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40166 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40167
40168 @smallexample
40169 info gdb
40170 @end smallexample
40171
40172 @noindent
40173 should give you access to the complete manual.
40174
40175 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40176 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40177 @end ifset
40178 @c man end
40179
40180 @node gdbinit man
40181 @heading gdbinit
40182
40183 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
40184
40185 @format
40186 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
40187 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
40188 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
40189 @end ifset
40190
40191 ~/.gdbinit
40192
40193 ./.gdbinit
40194 @c man end
40195 @end format
40196
40197 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
40198 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
40199 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
40200 described in
40201 @ifset man
40202 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
40203 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
40204 @end ifset
40205 @ifclear man
40206 @ref{Sequences}.
40207 @end ifclear
40208
40209 Please read more in
40210 @ifset man
40211 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
40212 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
40213 @end ifset
40214 @ifclear man
40215 @ref{Startup}.
40216 @end ifclear
40217
40218 @table @env
40219 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
40220 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
40221 @end ifset
40222 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
40223 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
40224 @end ifclear
40225 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
40226 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
40227 See more in
40228 @ifset man
40229 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
40230 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
40231 @end ifset
40232 @ifclear man
40233 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
40234 @end ifclear
40235
40236 @item ~/.gdbinit
40237 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
40238 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
40239
40240 @item ./.gdbinit
40241 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
40242 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
40243 See more in
40244 @ifset man
40245 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
40246 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
40247 @end ifset
40248 @ifclear man
40249 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
40250 @end ifclear
40251 @end table
40252 @c man end
40253
40254 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
40255 @ifset man
40256 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
40257
40258 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40259 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40260 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40261
40262 @smallexample
40263 info gdb
40264 @end smallexample
40265
40266 should give you access to the complete manual.
40267
40268 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40269 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40270 @end ifset
40271 @c man end
40272
40273 @include gpl.texi
40274
40275 @node GNU Free Documentation License
40276 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
40277 @include fdl.texi
40278
40279 @node Concept Index
40280 @unnumbered Concept Index
40281
40282 @printindex cp
40283
40284 @node Command and Variable Index
40285 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
40286
40287 @printindex fn
40288
40289 @tex
40290 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
40291 % meantime:
40292 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
40293 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
40294 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
40295 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
40296 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
40297 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
40298 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
40299 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
40300 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
40301 \page\colophon
40302 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
40303 @end tex
40304
40305 @bye
This page took 1.077003 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.